SEC Info  
    Home      Search      My Interests      Help      Sign In      Please Sign In

New Media Investment Group Inc. – ‘424B4’ on 9/19/14

On:  Friday, 9/19/14, at 4:01pm ET   ·   Accession #:  1193125-14-347050   ·   File #:  333-193887

Previous ‘424B4’:  None   ·   Next & Latest:  ‘424B4’ on 1/15/15

Find Words in Filings emoji
 
  in    Show  and   Hints

  As Of                Filer                Filing    For·On·As Docs:Size              Issuer               Agent

 9/19/14  New Media Investment Group Inc.   424B4                  1:3.9M                                   RR Donnelley/FA

Prospectus   —   Rule 424(b)(4)
Filing Table of Contents

Document/Exhibit                   Description                      Pages   Size 

 1: 424B4       Final Prospectus                                    HTML   2.95M 


Document Table of Contents

Page (sequential) | (alphabetic) Top
 
11st Page   -   Filing Submission
"Table of Contents
"Prospectus Summary
"Risk Factors
"Cautionary Note Regarding Forward Looking Information
"The Restructuring and the Spin Off
"Certain U.S. Federal Income and Estate Tax Considerations for Non-U.S. Holders of Our Common Stock
"Use of Proceeds
"Market Price Information and Dividends
"Capitalization
"Dilution
"Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data
"Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Information
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
"Business
"Our Manager and Management Agreement
"Management
"Compensation of Directors
"Executive Compensation
"Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management
"Certain Relationships and Transactions With Related Persons, Affiliates and Affiliated Entities
"Description of Our Capital Stock
"Shares Eligible for Future Sale
"Underwriting
"Legal Matters
"Experts
"Where You Can Find More Information
"Index to Financial Statements
"Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
"Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 29, 2013 (Successor Company) and December 30, 2012 (Predecessor Company)
"Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
"Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 29, 2014 (unaudited) and December 29, 2013
"Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 (Successor Company) and June 30, 2013 (Predecessor Company)
"Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statement of Stockholders' Equity for the six months ended June 29, 2014
"Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the six months ended June 29, 2014 (Successor Company) and June 30, 2013 (Predecessor Company)
"Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements
"Report of Independent Auditors
"Combined Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2013 and 2012
"Combined Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013
"Combined Statements of Equity for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013
"Combined Statements of Cash Flows for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013
"Notes to Combined Financial Statements
"Independent Auditors' Report
"Independent Auditors' Review Report
"Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2014 (unaudited) and as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 (audited)
"Consolidated Statements of Operations for the sixth month periods ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 (unaudited) and for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2013 (audited)
"Consolidated Statements of Equity for the sixth month period ended June 30, 2014 (unaudited) and for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2013 (audited)
"Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the sixth month periods ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 (unaudited) and for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2013 (audited)

This is an HTML Document rendered as filed.  [ Alternative Formats ]



  Final Prospectus  
Table of Contents

Filed Pursuant to Rule 424(b)(4)
Registration No. 333-193887

 

PROSPECTUS

6,500,000 Shares

New Media Investment Group Inc.

Common Stock

(Par Value, $0.01 per share)

 

 

We are offering 6,500,000 shares of our Common Stock. Our shares of Common Stock were listed on the New York Stock Exchange (the “NYSE”) under the symbol “NEWM” on February 14, 2014. On September 17, 2014, the closing sales price for our Common Stock on the NYSE was $16.76 per share. Please see “Market Price and Dividends” on page 36 for more information.

 

 

Investing in our Common Stock involves risks. See “Risk Factors” beginning on page 14 to read about certain factors you should consider before buying our Common Stock.

 

 

 

     Per
Share
     Total  

Public Offering Price

   $ 16.25       $ 105,625,000.00   

Underwriting Discounts(1)

   $ 0.60       $ 3,765,577.20   

Proceeds, to us (before expenses)

   $ 15.65       $ 101,859,422.80   

 

(1) See “Underwriting” for a description of compensation payable to the underwriters. The underwriters will not receive any underwriting discount or commission on the sale of shares of our Common Stock made in connection with this offering to certain of our officers, directors and other related parties.

The underwriters may also exercise their option to purchase up to an additional 950,625 shares of our common stock at the public offering price from us, less the underwriting discounts and commissions payable by us within 30 days from the date of this Prospectus.

The underwriters expect to deliver the shares of Common Stock against payment on or about September 23, 2014.

NEITHER THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION NOR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION HAS APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED OF THESE SECURITIES OR DETERMINED IF THIS PROSPECTUS IS TRUTHFUL OR COMPLETE. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

This Prospectus does not constitute an offer to sell or the solicitation of an offer to buy any securities.

 

 

 

Citigroup   Credit Suisse

The date of this Prospectus is September 17, 2014.


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

     1   

RISK FACTORS

     14   

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD LOOKING INFORMATION

     30   

THE RESTRUCTURING AND THE SPIN OFF

     31   

CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME AND ESTATE TAX CONSIDERATIONS FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS OF OUR COMMON STOCK

     34   

USE OF PROCEEDS

     36   

MARKET PRICE INFORMATION AND DIVIDENDS

     36   

CAPITALIZATION

     37   

DILUTION

     38   

SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

     39   

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED COMBINED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     43   

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     59   

BUSINESS

     92   

OUR MANAGER AND MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT

     132   

MANAGEMENT

     137   

COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS

     147   

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

     149   

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

     164   

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PERSONS, AFFILIATES AND AFFILIATED ENTITIES

     166   

DESCRIPTION OF OUR CAPITAL STOCK

     169   

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

     174   

UNDERWRITING

     176   

LEGAL MATTERS

     181   

EXPERTS

     181   

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

     181   

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     F-1   

You should rely only on the information contained in this Prospectus and any free writing prospectus prepared by us or on our behalf that we have referred you to. We and the underwriters have not authorized anyone to provide you with additional or different information. If anyone provides you with additional, different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. We take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. This Prospectus is an offer to sell only the shares offered hereby, but only under circumstances and in jurisdictions where it is lawful to do so. We and the underwriters are not making an offer of these securities in any state, country or other jurisdiction where the offer is not permitted. You should not assume that the information in this Prospectus or any free writing prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date of the applicable document regardless of its time of delivery or the time of any sales of our Common Stock (as defined below). Our business, financial condition, results of operations or cash flows may have changed since the date of the applicable document.

 

i


Table of Contents

Presentation of Information

Unless the context otherwise requires, any references in this Prospectus to “we,” “our,” “us” and the “Company” relating to periods prior to the Restructuring (as defined below) mean GateHouse Media, LLC (formerly known as GateHouse Media, Inc.) (“GateHouse,” “Predecessor” or “Predecessor Company”) and for periods after the Restructuring mean New Media Investment Group Inc. (“New Media,” “Successor” or “Successor Company”). All figures included in this Prospectus are as of June 29, 2014, unless stated otherwise.

 

ii


Table of Contents

PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

This summary of certain information contained in this Prospectus may not include all the information that is important to you. To understand fully and for a more complete description of the terms and conditions of this offering, you should read this Prospectus in its entirety and the documents to which you are referred. See “Where You Can Find More Information.”

Our Company

We are a newly listed company primarily focused on investing in a high quality, diversified portfolio of local media assets and on growing our audiences, existing online advertising and digital marketing services businesses.

We are one of the largest publishers of locally based print and online media in the United States as measured by number of daily publications. We operate in 357 markets across 24 states. Our portfolio of products, which includes 425 community publications, 357 related websites, 345 mobile sites, six yellow page directories, and a digital marketing services business (“Propel”), serves more than 130,000 business advertising accounts and reaches approximately 12 million people on a weekly basis. As of September 3, 2014, taking into account our two recent acquisitions completed on June 30, 2014 and our acquisition of The Providence Journal completed on September 3, 2014, our portfolio of products now includes 444 community publications, 372 related websites and 360 mobile sites.

Our print and digital products focus on the local community from both a content, advertising and digital services standpoint. As a result of our focus on small and midsize markets, we are usually the primary, and sometimes the sole, provider of comprehensive and in-depth local market news and information in the communities we serve. Our content is primarily devoted to topics that we believe are highly relevant and of interest to our audiences such as local news and politics, community and regional events, youth sports, opinion and editorial pages, local schools, obituaries, police blotters, and wedding and engagement announcements. Our local news content is unique and highly valued by consumers who live in our markets, and there are limited, and in some cases no competing sources of local content for our target customers.

More than 83% of our daily newspapers have been published for more than 100 years and 100% have been published for more than 50 years. We believe that the longevity of our publications demonstrates the value and relevance of the local information that we provide and has created a strong foundation of reader loyalty as well as a highly recognized media brand name in each community we serve. We believe our brands are a trusted source for local news and information by consumers in our market, and a trusted business partner to locally owned and operated businesses.

We also have a locally oriented, “in-market” sales force that gives us direct face to face access to small and medium sized businesses (“SMBs”) in all of our respective markets, consisting of over 1,000 sales representatives, including 37 dedicated to Propel and 16 third party partnerships. We believe this “in-market” sales presence, combined with our trusted media brands gives us a distinct advantage with regard to growing into new digital categories (such as digital marketing services). Digital marketing services businesses are poised to benefit from the rise in internet advertising, which grew 17% between 2012 and 2013, and 242% between 2005 and 2013, according to the 2014 IAB Internet Advertising Revenue report.

New Media intends to focus its business strategy on stabilizing its core traditional media business and on building its digital marketing services business and growing its audiences and online advertising business, leveraging its strong local brands, its “in-market” sales force and news delivery platforms. We believe this will offset many of the challenges experienced by our Predecessor Company, GateHouse. With its improved capital

 

 

1


Table of Contents

structure and digital focus, combined with its strengths and strategy, we believe that New Media will be able to grow stockholder value. However, there can be no assurances of this. See “Risk Factors.”

We intend to create stockholder value through growth in our revenue and cash flow by stablizing our core traditional media business, expanding Propel, growing our audiences and our online advertising business and pursuing strategic acquisitions of high quality local media assets at attractive valuation levels. However, there is no guarantee that we will be able to accomplish any of these strategic initiatives. A key component of our strategy will be to acquire and operate traditional local media businesses and transform them from print-centric operations to dynamic multi-media operations, through our existing online advertising and digital marketing services businesses. We will also leverage our existing platform to operate these businesses more efficiently. We believe all of these initiatives will lead to revenue and cash flow growth for New Media and will enable us to pay dividends to our stockholders. We intend to distribute a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend to stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance, approval by our board of directors (the “Board of Directors” or the “Board”) and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement (as defined below). The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results.

On July 31, 2014, the Company announced a second quarter 2014 cash dividend of $0.27 per share of common stock, par value $0.01 per share, of New Media (“New Media Common Stock” or our “Common Stock”). The dividend was paid on August 21, 2014 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on August 12, 2014.

Our Strengths

High Quality Assets with Leading Local Businesses. Our publications benefit from a long history in the communities we serve as one of the leading, and often sole, providers of comprehensive and in-depth local content. More than 83% of our daily newspapers have been published for more than 100 years and 100% have been published for more than 50 years. This has resulted in brand recognition for our publications, reader loyalty and high local audience penetration rates, which are highly valued by local advertisers. We continue to build on long-standing relationships with local advertisers and our in-depth knowledge of the consumers in our local markets. We believe our local news content is unique and highly valued by consumers who live in our markets, and there are limited, and in some cases no competing sources of local content for our target customers.

Large Locally Focused Sales Force. We have large and well known “in-market” local sales forces in the markets we serve, consisting of over 1,000 sales representatives, including 37 dedicated to Propel and 16 third party sales affiliations. Our sales forces are generally among the largest locally oriented media sales forces in their respective communities. We have long-standing relationships with many local businesses and have the ability to be face to face with most local businesses due to these unique characteristics we enjoy. We believe our strong brands combined with our “in-market” presence give us a distinct advantage in selling and growing in the digital services sector given the complex nature of these products. We also believe that these qualities provide leverage for our sales force to grow additional future revenue streams in our markets, particularly in the digital sector.

Ability to Acquire and Integrate New Assets. We have created a national platform for consolidating local media businesses and have demonstrated an ability to successfully identify, acquire and integrate local media asset acquisitions. We have acquired over $1.7 billion of assets since 2006. We have acquired both traditional newspaper and directory businesses. We have a scalable infrastructure and platform to leverage for future acquisitions.

Scale Yields Operating Profit Margins and Allows Us to Realize Operating Synergies. We believe we can generate higher operating profit margins than our publications could achieve on a stand-alone basis by leveraging

 

 

2


Table of Contents

our operations and implementing revenue initiatives, especially digital initiatives, across a broader local footprint in a geographic cluster and by centralizing certain back office production, accounting, administrative and corporate operations. We also benefit from economies of scale in the purchase of insurance, newsprint and other large strategic supplies and equipment. Finally, we have the ability to further leverage our centralized services and buying power to reduce operating costs when making future strategic accretive acquisitions.

Local Business Profile Generates Significant Cash Flow. Our local business profile will allow us to generate significant recurring cash flow due to our diversified revenue base and high operating profit margins and maintain our low capital expenditure and working capital requirements. As a result of the Restructuring, which extinguished GateHouse’s Outstanding Debt (as defined below), our interest and debt servicing expenses are significantly lower than GateHouse’s interest and debt servicing expenses. As of June 29, 2014, our debt structure consists of the New Media Credit Agreement. We currently estimate that we will have significant free cash flow totaling $50 to $70 million in 2014 which we believe will lead to stockholder value creation through our investments in organic growth, investments in accretive acquisitions and the return of cash to stockholders in the form of dividends, subject to approval by our Board of Directors. We further believe the strong cash flows generated and available to be invested will lead to consistent future dividend growth.

Experienced Management Team. Our senior management team is made up of executives who have an average of over 20 years of experience in the media industry, including strong traditional and digital media expertise. Our executive officers have broad industry experience with regard to both growing new digital business lines and identifying and integrating strategic acquisitions. Our management team also has key strengths in managing wide geographically disbursed teams, including the sales force, and identifying and centralizing duplicate functions across businesses leading to reduced core infrastructure costs.

Our Strategy

We intend to create stockholder value through a variety of factors including organic growth driven by our consumer and SMB strategies, pursuing attractive strategic acquisitions of high quality local media assets, and through the distribution of a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend. However, there is no guarantee that we will be able to accomplish any of these strategic initiatives.

A key component of our strategy will be to acquire and operate traditional local media businesses and transform them from print-centric operations to dynamic multi-media operations through our existing online advertising and digital marketing services businesses. We will also leverage our existing platform to operate these businesses more efficiently. We believe all of these initiatives will lead to revenue and cash flow growth for New Media and will enable us to pay dividends to our stockholders. We intend to distribute a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend to stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance, approval by our Board of Directors and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement. The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s GAAP net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results. The key elements of our strategy include:

Maintain Our Leading Position in the Delivery of Proprietary Local Content in Our Communities. We seek to maintain our position as a leading provider of unique local content in the markets we serve and to leverage this position to strengthen our relationships with both readers and local businesses, thereby increasing penetration rates and market share. A critical aspect of this approach is to continue to provide local content that is not readily obtainable elsewhere and to be able to deliver that content to our customers across multiple print and digital platforms.

Grow Our New Digital Marketing Services Business. We plan to scale and expand our new recently created digital marketing services business, Propel. We believe Propel will allow us to sell digital marketing

 

 

3


Table of Contents

services to SMBs both in and outside existing New Media markets. The SMB demand for digital service solutions is great and represents a rapidly expanding opportunity. According to 2011 U.S. census data, there are approximately 27 million SMBs in the U.S. and, according to a 2014 U.S. Local Media Forecast by BIA/Kelsey, these businesses are expected to spend $36 billion on digital marketing by 2015. Owners of SMBs often lack the resources and expertise to navigate the digital marketing services sector, with 52% of SMBs not having a website and 90% not having mobile-friendly websites according to a Yodle Small Business Sentiment Survey in 2013. We believe local SMBs will turn to our trusted local media brands to help them navigate through developing their digital marketing presence and strategy. We believe our “in-market” sales presence and strong local brands give us a distinct advantage to being the leading local provider of digital marketing services, through Propel.

Pursue Strategic Accretive Acquisitions. We intend to capitalize on the highly fragmented and distressed local print industries which have greatly reduced valuation levels. We initially expect to focus our investments primarily in the local newspaper sector in small to mid-size markets. We believe we have a strong operational platform as well as a scalable digital marketing services business, Propel. This platform, along with deep industry specific knowledge and experience that our management team has can be leveraged to reduce costs, stabilize the core business and grow digital revenues at acquired properties. The size and fragmentation of the addressable print media market place in the United States, the greatly reduced valuation levels that exist in these industries, and our deep experience make this an attractive place for our initial consolidation focus and capital allocation. Over the longer term we also believe there may be opportunity to diversify and acquire these types of assets internationally, as well as other traditional local media assets such as broadcast TV, out of home advertising (billboards) and radio, in the United States and internationally. We also believe there may be opportunities to acquire other strong businesses that have local sales force and SMB customer relationships or digital product companies, both of which could quickly scale for Propel.

Stabilize Our Core Business Operations. We have four primary drivers in our strategic plans to stabilize our core business operations, including: (i) identifying permanent structural expense reductions in our traditional business cost infrastructure and re-deploying a portion of those costs toward future growth opportunities, primarily on the digital side of our business; (ii) accelerating the growth of both our digital audiences and revenues through improvements to current products, new product development, training, opportunistic changes in hiring to create an employee base with a more diversified skill set and sharing of best practices; (iii) accelerating our consumer revenue growth through subscription pricing increases, pay meters for digital content and growth in our overall subscriber base; and (iv) stabilizing our core print advertising revenues through improvements to pricing, packaging of products for customers that will produce the best results for them, and more technology and training for sales management and sales representatives.

The newspaper industry has experienced declining revenue and profitability over the past several years due to, among other things, advertisers’ shift from print to digital media following the consumer shift, and general market conditions. GateHouse, our Predecessor, was affected by this trend and experienced net losses of $160.8 million during the nine month period ended September 29, 2013 and $29.8 million during the fiscal year ended December 30, 2012. Total revenue decreased by 1.9% to $356.2 million for the nine months ended September 29, 2013 and 5.1% to $488.6 million for the year ended December 30, 2012. The Restructuring significantly reduced New Media’s interest expense. In addition, New Media intends to focus its business strategy on building its digital marketing business and growing its online advertising business, which we believe will offset some of the challenges experienced by GateHouse. With its improved capital structure and digital focus, combined with its strengths and strategy and dividend strategy, we believe that New Media will be able to grow stockholder value. However, there can be no assurance of this. See “Risk Factors.”

 

 

4


Table of Contents

Challenges

We will likely face challenges commonly encountered by recently reorganized entities, including the risk that even under our improved capital structure, we may not be profitable.

As a publisher of locally based print and online media, we face a number of additional challenges, including the risks that:

 

    the growing shift within the publishing industry from traditional print media to digital forms of publication may compromise our ability to generate sufficient advertising revenues;

 

    investments in growing our digital business may not be successful, which could adversely affect our results of operations;

 

    our advertising and circulation revenues may decline if we are unable to compete effectively with other companies in the local media industry; and

 

    we may not be able to successfully acquire local print media assets at attractive valuations due to a rise in valuations from a more competitive landscape of acquirors.

For more information about New Media’s risks and challenges, see “Risk Factors.”

Our Manager and Management Agreement

We are managed by FIG LLC (our “Manager”), an affiliate of Fortress (as defined below), pursuant to the terms of a Management and Advisory Agreement, dated as of November 26, 2013, as amended and restated (the “Management Agreement”), between us and our Manager. The terms of our Management Agreement are described in more detail under “Our Manager and Management Agreement” elsewhere in this Prospectus.

Recent Developments

Acquisitions

On June 30, 2014, the Company completed two acquisitions of 20 publications with a total purchase price of $15.85 million, which includes estimated working capital. The acquisitions include six daily, ten weekly publications, and four shoppers serving areas of Texas, Oklahoma, Kansas and Virginia with an aggregate circulation of approximately 54,000. The acquisitions were funded with $9.85 million of cash and $6 million from the Revolving Credit Facility (as defined below).

On September 3, 2014, the Company completed the acquisition of The Providence Journal with a total purchase price of $46 million. The acquisition includes one daily and two weekly publications serving areas of Rhode Island with a daily circulation of approximately 72,000 and 96,000 on Sunday.

Dividend

On July 31, 2014, the Company announced a second quarter 2014 cash dividend of $0.27 per share of New Media Common Stock. The dividend was paid on August 21, 2014 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on August 12, 2014.

First Amendment to Credit Agreement

On September 3, 2014, the New Media Credit Agreement (as defined below) was amended to provide for additional term loans under the Incremental Facility (as defined below) in an aggregate principal amount of $25 million, which was used to finance a portion of The Providence Journal acquisition.

 

 

5


Table of Contents

Risk Factors

Our business is subject to various risks. For a description of these risks, see the section entitled “Risk Factors” beginning on page 14 and the other information included elsewhere in this Prospectus.

Corporate Information

Our principal executive offices are located at 1345 Avenue of the Americas, New York, New York, 10105. Our telephone number is 212-479-3160 and our website is http://www.newmediainv.com/. Nothing on our website is included or incorporated by reference herein.

Corporate Entity Structure

The chart below sets forth our entity structure and that of our direct and indirect subsidiaries. This chart does not include all of our affiliates and subsidiaries.

 

LOGO

 

 

6


Table of Contents

The Offering

 

Common stock we are offering

6,500,000 shares.

 

Common stock to be issued and outstanding after this offering

36,515,870 shares (37,466,495 shares if the underwriters exercise their over-allotment option in full).

 

Underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares

We have granted the underwriters a 30-day option to purchase up to 950,625 additional shares of our Common Stock at the public offering price, less underwriting discounts and commission.

 

Use of proceeds

The net proceeds to us from this offering, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us and giving effect to the sale of shares of our Common Stock to certain of our officers and directors and an officer of our Manager that will not be subject to underwriting discounts or commissions, will be approximately $100.0 million, or $114.9 million if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of Common Stock in full. We intend to use the proceeds from this offering for working capital and other general corporate purposes, which may include potential investments in, and acquisitions of, local media businesses and assets. Presently, we have no agreements with any potential acquisition parties. We have not yet determined the amount of net proceeds to be used specifically for any of the foregoing purposes. Accordingly, management will have broad discretion over the use of the net proceeds to us from this offering and investors will be relying on the judgment of our management regarding the application of these proceeds. Pending their use, we plan to invest the net proceeds to us from this offering in short term, interest bearing obligations, investment grade instruments, certificates of deposit or direct or guaranteed obligations of the U.S. government. See “Use of Proceeds.”

 

Dividend Policy

We currently intend to distribute a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend to stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance, approval by the Board of Directors and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement. The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s GAAP net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results. However, our ability to pay dividends is subject to a number of risks and uncertainties, and there can be no assurance regarding whether we will pay dividends in the future. See, for example, “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Our Business—We may not be able to pay dividends in accordance with our announced intent or at all.”

 

 

7


Table of Contents

Listing

Our shares were listed on the NYSE under the symbol “NEWM” on February 14, 2014.

 

Risk Factors

See “Risk Factors” for a discussion of factors you should carefully consider before deciding to invest in our Common Stock.

 

Tax Considerations

See “Certain U.S. Federal Income and Estate Tax Considerations for Non-U.S. Holders of Our Common Stock” for more information regarding tax considerations.

Except as otherwise indicated, all information in this prospectus assumes no exercise by the underwriters of their option to purchase an additional 950,625 shares of Common Stock from us.

The number of shares of our Common Stock that will be outstanding after this offering is based on 30,015,870 shares of our Common Stock outstanding as of June 29, 2014, which excludes options to purchase 650,000 shares of our Common Stock, representing 10% of the number of shares being offered by us hereby, that will be granted to an affiliate of our Manager in connection with this offering, pursuant to our Incentive Plan (as defined below) and subject to adjustment if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of our Common Stock.

 

 

8


Table of Contents

Summary Historical Consolidated and Pro Forma Financial Data

The selected consolidated statement of operations data for New Media for the two months ended December 29, 2013, for GateHouse for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 (collectively, the “combined year ended December 29, 2013) and for GateHouse for the year ended December 30, 2012 and the year ended January 1, 2012 and the selected consolidated balance sheet data for New Media as of December 29, 2013 and for GateHouse as of December 30, 2012 have been derived from the audited Consolidated Financial Statements of New Media and GateHouse, our Predecessor, included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected consolidated balance sheet data for GateHouse as of January 1, 2012 has been derived from GateHouse’s audited financial statements not included in this Prospectus. The selected financial data as of and for the combined year ended December 29, 2013, ten months ended November 6, 2013 and the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, have been revised to reflect one of GateHouse’s publications as a discontinued operation for comparability.

The selected condensed consolidated statement of operations data for New Media for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and for GateHouse for the six months ended June 30, 2013 and the selected condensed consolidated balance sheet data for New Media as of June 29, 2014 have been derived from the Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements of New Media and GateHouse, our Predecessor, included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected consolidated balance sheet data for GateHouse as of June 30, 2013 has been derived from GateHouse’s unaudited financial statements not included in this Prospectus.

Operating results for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 included the impact of GateHouse’s emergence from bankruptcy and adoption of fresh start accounting. As a result of the execution of the Restructuring Support Agreement, in which GateHouse, the Administrative Agent (as defined below), Newcastle Investment Corp. (“Newcastle”) and other lenders under the 2007 Credit Facility (as defined below) agreed to support the Restructuring pursuant to the consummation of the Plan (as defined below), all debt, including derivative liabilities and deferred financing assets, was eliminated. This resulted in a significant reduction in our interest expense and the elimination of the gain (loss) on derivative instruments and deferred financing amortization. The adoption of fresh start accounting led to changes in the basis of our property, plant and equipment and intangible assets that will impact future depreciation and amortization expense levels. Other significant changes to our financial information include that we expect to become subject to federal and state income taxation and to pay fees to our Manager (as defined below). The impact of these changes is discussed in greater detail within the Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Information section of this Prospectus. The data should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements, Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, related notes and other financial information included herein.

The following selected unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and for the year ended December 29, 2013 gives effect to the Pro Forma Transactions (as defined below) as if the Pro Forma Transactions had occurred or had become effective as of December 31, 2012 (beginning of our fiscal year 2013). The unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet as of June 29, 2014 gives effect to the Pro Forma Transactions as if they had occurred on June 29, 2014. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information excludes the effects of this offering.

The pro forma financial information is provided for informational and illustrative purposes only and should be read in conjunction with “Use of Proceeds,” “Capitalization,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” New Media’s historical financial statements and related notes thereto, including Predecessor GateHouse’s historical consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, Local Media’s historical combined financial statements and notes thereto, and Providence Journal’s historical consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, each included elsewhere in this Prospectus. In addition, the historical consolidated financial statements of GateHouse, our Predecessor, are not comparable following its emergence from Chapter 11 due to the effects of the consummation of the Plan, as well as adjustments for fresh-start accounting. All tables are presented in thousands unless otherwise noted.

 

 

9


Table of Contents

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information has been prepared to reflect adjustments to our historical consolidated financial information that are (i) directly attributable to the Pro Forma Transactions, (ii) factually supportable and (iii) with respect to the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations, expected to have a continuing impact on our results.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information reflects the following (collectively, the “Pro Forma Transactions”):

 

    commencing from the date of “regular-way” trading of New Media Common Stock on a major U.S. national securities exchange (the “Listing”), New Media’s management and incentive fee payable to the Manager by us;

 

    adoption of fresh-start accounting by GateHouse in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 852, “Reorganizations,” (“ASC 852”) upon confirmation of the plan of reorganization;

 

    cancellation of our Predecessor’s 2007 Credit Facility and related interest rate swaps in exchange for New Media Common Stock pursuant to the Plan and entry into the GateHouse Credit Facilities (as defined below);

 

    impact of Local Media purchase accounting adjustments, in accordance with ASC Topic 805, “Business Combinations,” as a result of GateHouse consolidation of Local Media beginning on September 3, 2013 and Newcastle’s contribution of 100% common stock of Local Media Group Holdings LLC (“Local Media Parent”) to New Media in exchange for New Media Common Stock pursuant to the Plan;

 

    payment of GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility (as defined below) in full and entering into the New Media Credit Agreement; and

 

    impact of Providence Journal purchase accounting adjustments, in accordance with ASC Topic 805, “Business Combinations” (“ASC 805”), and the incremental financing under the New Media Credit Agreement as a result of New Media’s acquisition.

 

    Successor Company          Predecessor
Company
         Combined          Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
  Six Months
Ended
June 29,

2014
    Six Months
Ended
June 29,
2014
         Six Months
Ended
June 30,

2013
         Year Ended
December 29,
2013
         Two Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year
Ended
December 30,
2012
(2)
    Year
Ended
January 1,
2012
 
    Pro Forma     Historical          Historical          Pro Forma          Historical          Historical     Historical     Historical  
(in thousands, except per
share data)
                                                                   

Statement of Operations Data:

                               

Revenues:

                               

Advertising

  $ 197,435      $ 178,460          $ 150,559          $ 421,741          $ 63,340          $ 265,078      $ 330,881      $ 357,134   

Circulation

    107,315        90,471            65,513            216,232            29,525            118,810        131,576        131,879   

Commercial printing and other

    39,228        31,535            14,107            72,152            10,366            29,402        26,097        25,657   
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    343,978        300,466            230,179            710,125            103,231            413,290        488,554        514,670   

Operating costs and expenses:

                               

Operating costs

    196,603        172,470            129,998            395,315            56,614            232,066        268,222        281,884   

Selling, general and administrative

    114,975        102,251            78,722            229,900            28,749            136,832        145,020        146,295   

Depreciation and amortization

    23,161        19,918            19,636            45,972            6,588            33,409        39,888        42,426   

Integration and reorganization costs

    837        837            958            3,335            1,758            1,577        4,393        5,884   

Impairment of long-lived assets

    —          —             —             133,867            —              91,599        —          1,733   

Loss (gain) on sale of assets

    687        687            1,043            1,190            27            1,163        1,238        455   

 

 

10


Table of Contents
    Successor Company          Predecessor
Company
         Combined          Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
  Six Months
Ended
June 29,

2014
    Six Months
Ended
June 29,
2014
         Six Months
Ended
June 30,

2013
         Year Ended
December 29,
2013
         Two Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year
Ended
December 30,
2012
(2)
    Year
Ended
January 1,
2012
 
    Pro Forma     Historical          Historical          Pro Forma          Historical          Historical     Historical     Historical  
(in thousands, except per
share data)
                                                                   

Goodwill and mastheads impairment

    —          —             —             —              —              —          —          385   
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating (loss) income

    (7,715     4,303            (178         (99,454         9,495            (83,356     29,793        35,608   

Interest expense, amortization of deferred financing costs, gain on early extinguishment of debt, (gain) loss on derivative instruments, reorganization items, net, and other

    9,319        17,330            30,425            19,577            1,798            (871,399     57,463        58,361   
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss) income from continuing operations before income taxes

    (1,604     (13,027         (30,603         (119,031         7,697            788,043        (27,670     (22,753

Income tax (benefit) expense

    (628     (3,067         —             (46,600         491            (197     (207     (1,803
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss) income from continuing operations

    (976     (9,960         (30,603         (72,431         7,206            788,240        (27,463     (20,950

Loss from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

    N/A        —             1,034            N/A            —              (1,034     (2,340     (699
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) income

    (976     (9,960         (31,637         (72,431         7,206            787,206        (29,803     (21,649

Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

    N/A        —              —              N/A            —              208        —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) income attributable to New Media

  $ (976   $ (9,960       $ (31,637       $ (72,431       $ 7,206          $ 787,414      $ (29,803   $ (21,649
 

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic net (loss) income from continuing operations attributable to New Media per share

  $ (0.03   $ (0.33       $ (0.53       $ (2.41       $ 0.24          $ 13.58      $ (0.47   $ (0.36

Diluted (loss) income from continuing operations attributable to New Media per share

  $ (0.03   $ (0.33       $ (0.53       $ (2.41       $ 0.24          $ 13.58      $ (0.47   $ (0.36

Basic net (loss) income attributable to New Media common stockholders per share

  $ (0.03   $ (0.33       $ (0.54       $ (2.41       $ 0.24          $ 13.56      $ (0.51   $ (0.37

Diluted net (loss) income attributable to New Media common stockholders per share

  $ (0.03   $ (0.33       $ (0.54       $ (2.41       $ 0.24          $ 13.56      $ (0.51   $ (0.37

Other Data:

                               

Adjusted EBITDA(1)

  $ N/A      $ 24,379          $ 18,450            N/A          $ 16,096          $ 988,265      $ 69,766      $ 80,547   

Cash interest paid

  $ N/A      $ 7,238          $ 7,403            N/A          $ 925          $ 43,606      $ 55,976      $ 58,225   

 

(1)  We define Adjusted EBITDA as net income (loss) from continuing operations before income tax expense (benefit), interest/financing expense, depreciation and amortization and non-cash impairments. Adjusted EBITDA is not a measurement of financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered in isolation or as an alternative to income from operations, net income (loss), cash flow from continuing operating activities or any other measure of performance or liquidity derived in accordance with GAAP. We believe this non-GAAP measure, as we have defined it, is helpful in identifying trends in our day-to-day performance because the items excluded have little or no significance in our day-to-day operations. This measure provides an assessment of controllable expenses and affords management the ability to make decisions which are expected to facilitate meeting current financial goals as well as achieve optimal financial performance. Adjusted EBITDA provides an indicator for management to determine if adjustments to current spending decisions are needed.

 

 

11


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA provides us with a measure of financial performance, independent of items that are beyond the control of management in the short-term, such as depreciation and amortization, taxation and interest expense associated with our capital structure. This metric measures our financial performance based on operational factors that management can impact in the short-term, namely our cost structure or expenses of the organization. Adjusted EBITDA is one of the metrics used by senior management and the board of directors to review the financial performance of our business on a monthly basis.

Not all companies calculate Adjusted EBITDA using the same methods; therefore, the Adjusted EBITDA figures set forth herein may not be comparable to Adjusted EBITDA reported by other companies. A substantial portion of our Adjusted EBITDA must be dedicated to the payment of interest on our outstanding indebtedness and to service other commitments, thereby reducing the funds available to us for other purposes. Accordingly, Adjusted EBITDA does not represent an amount of funds that is available for management’s discretionary use. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Adjusted EBITDA.”

 

(2)  The year ended December 30, 2012 included a 53rd week of operations for approximately 60% of the business.

The table below shows the reconciliation of income (loss) from continuing operations to Adjusted EBITDA for the periods presented:

 

    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
         Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Six Months
Ended
June 29,
2014
         Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2013
         Two
Months Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten
Months Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
(3)
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
 
    Historical          Historical          Historical          Historical     Historical     Historical  
(in thousands)                                                   

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  $ (9,960       $ (30,603       $ 7,206          $ 788,240      $ (27,463   $ (20,950

Income tax expense (benefit)

    (3,067         —              491            (197     (207     (1,803

Loss (gain) on derivative instruments(1)

    51            9            —             14        (1,635     (913

Gain on early extinguishment of debt(2)

    9,047            —              —             —         —         —     

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    758            522            171            842        1,255        1,360   

Write-off of financing costs

    —                    —             —         —         —     

Interest expense

    7,632            28,886            1,640            74,358        57,928        58,309   

Impairment of long-lived assets

    —                    —             91,599        —         1,733   

Depreciation and amortization

    19,918            19,636            6,588            33,409        39,888        42,426   

Goodwill and mastheads impairment

    —              —              —             —         —         385   
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA from continuing operations

  $ 24,379 (a)        $ 18,450 (b)        $ 16,096 (c)        $ 988,265 (d)    $ 69,766 (e)    $ 80,547 (f) 
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Adjusted EBITDA for the six months ended June 29, 2014 included net expenses of $8,985, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $8,985 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $7,461, integration and reorganization costs of $837 and a $687 loss on the sale of assets.
(b)  Adjusted EBITDA for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included net expenses of $7,949, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $7,949 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $6,376, non-cash portion of postretirement benefits expense of $(428), integration and reorganization costs of $958 and a $1,043 loss on the sale of assets.

 

 

12


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $123 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(c)  Adjusted EBITDA for the two months ended December 29, 2013 included net expenses of $4,828, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $4,828 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $3,043, integration and reorganization costs of $1,758 and a $27 loss on the sale of assets.

 

(d)  Adjusted EBITDA for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 included net income of $(930,229), which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $(930,229) are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $(932,969), integration and reorganization costs of $1,577 and a $1,163 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $123 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(e)  Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 30, 2012 included net expenses of $11,264, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $11,264 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $5,378, integration and reorganization costs of $4,393 and a $1,238 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $255 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(f)  Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended January 1, 2012 included net expenses of $10,565, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $10,565 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $4,226, integration and reorganization costs of $5,884 and a $455 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $432 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(1)  Non-cash (gain) loss on derivative instruments is related to interest rate swap agreements which are financing related and are excluded from Adjusted EBITDA.

 

(2)  Non-cash write-off of deferred financing costs are similar to interest expense and amortization of financing fees and are excluded from Adjusted EBITDA.

 

(3)  The year ended December 30, 2012 included a 53rd week of operations for approximately 60% of the business.

 

    As of  
    Successor Company          Predecessor
Company
         Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    June 29,
2014
    June 29,
2014
         June 30,
2013
         December 29,
2013
         December 30,
2012
    January 1,
2012
 
  Pro Forma     Historical          Historical          Historical          Historical     Historical  
(in thousands)                                                   

Balance Sheet Data:

                       

Total assets

  $ 713,561      $ 670,543          $ 433,704          $ 689,953          $ 469,766      $ 510,802   

Total long-term obligations, including current maturities

    231,190        197,660            1,170,220            187,119            1,177,298        1,185,212   

Stockholders’ equity (deficit)

    385,423        385,423            (848,855         395,362            (834,159     (805,632

 

 

13


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

You should carefully consider the following risks and other information in this Prospectus in evaluating us and our Common Stock. Any of the following risks could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations, financial condition or liquidity, in which case, the trading price of our Common Stock could decline and you could lose all or part of your investment. The risk factors generally have been separated into the following groups: Risks Related to Our Business, Risks Related to Our Manager, and Risks Related to Our Common Stock.

Risks Related to Our Business

We depend to a great extent on the economies and the demographics of the local communities that we serve, and we are also susceptible to general economic downturns, which have had, and could continue to have, a material and adverse impact on our advertising and circulation revenues and on our profitability.

Our advertising revenues and, to a lesser extent, circulation revenues, depend upon a variety of factors specific to the communities that our publications serve. These factors include, among others, the size and demographic characteristics of the local population, local economic conditions in general and the economic condition of the retail segments of the communities that our publications serve. If the local economy, population or prevailing retail environment of a community we serve experiences a downturn, our publications, revenues and profitability in that market could be adversely affected. Our advertising revenues are also susceptible to negative trends in the general economy, like the economic downturn recently experienced, that affect consumer spending. The advertisers in our newspapers and other publications and related websites are primarily retail businesses that can be significantly affected by regional or national economic downturns and other developments. Continuing or deepening softness in the U.S. economy could also significantly affect key advertising revenue categories, such as help wanted, real estate and automotive.

Uncertainty and adverse changes in the general economic conditions of markets in which we participate may negatively affect our business.

Current and future conditions in the economy have an inherent degree of uncertainty. As a result, it is difficult to estimate the level of growth or contraction for the economy as a whole. It is even more difficult to estimate growth or contraction in various parts, sectors and regions of the economy, including the markets in which we participate. Adverse changes may occur as a result of weak global economic conditions, rising oil prices, wavering consumer confidence, unemployment, declines in stock markets, contraction of credit availability, declines in real estate values, or other factors affecting economic conditions in general. These changes may negatively affect the sales of our products, increase exposure to losses from bad debts, increase the cost and decrease the availability of financing, or increase costs associated with publishing and distributing our publications.

Our ability to generate revenues is correlated with the economic conditions of two geographic regions of the United States.

Our Company primarily generates revenue in two geographic regions: the Northeast and the Midwest. For the six months ended June 29, 2014, approximately 39% of our total revenues were generated in two states in the Northeast: Massachusetts and New York. During the same period, approximately 28% of our total revenues were generated in two states in the Midwest: Illinois and Ohio. As a result of this geographic concentration, our financial results, including advertising and circulation revenue, depend largely upon economic conditions in these principal market areas. Accordingly, adverse economic developments within these two regions in particular could significantly affect our consolidated operations and financial results.

 

14


Table of Contents

Our indebtedness and any future indebtedness may limit our financial and operating activities and our ability to incur additional debt to fund future needs or dividends.

As of June 29, 2014, New Media’s outstanding indebtedness consists of a credit agreement, entered into on June 4, 2014 (the “New Media Credit Agreement”) by and among New Media Holdings II LLC (the “New Media Borrower”), a wholly owned subsidiary of New Media, New Media Holdings I LLC (“Holdings I”), the lenders party thereto, RBS Citizens, N.A. and Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners, Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch as syndication agent and Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania as administration agent. The New Media Credit Agreement provides for (i) a $200,000 senior secured term facility (the “Term Loan Facility”) and (ii) a $25,000 senior secured revolving credit facility, with a $5,000 sub-facility for letters of credit and a $5,000 sub-facility for swing loans (the “Revolving Credit Facility”). In addition, the New Media Borrower may request one or more new commitments for term loans or revolving loans from time to time up to an aggregate total of $75 million, subject to certain conditions (the “Incremental Facility”). On September 3, 2014, the New Media Credit Agreement was amended to provide for additional term loans under the Incremental Facility in an aggregate principal amount of $25 million. This indebtedness and any future indebtedness we incur could:

 

    require us to dedicate a portion of cash flow from operations to the payment of principal and interest on indebtedness, including indebtedness we may incur in the future, thereby reducing the funds available for other purposes, including dividends or other distributions;

 

    subject us to increased sensitivity to increases in prevailing interest rates;

 

    place us at a competitive disadvantage to competitors with relatively less debt in economic downturns, adverse industry conditions or catastrophic external events; or

 

    reduce our flexibility in planning for or responding to changing business, industry and economic conditions.

In addition, our indebtedness could limit our ability to obtain additional financing on acceptable terms or at all to fund future acquisitions, working capital, capital expenditures, debt service requirements, general corporate and other purposes, which would have a material effect on our business and financial condition. Our liquidity needs could vary significantly and may be affected by general economic conditions, industry trends, performance and many other factors not within our control.

The New Media Credit Agreement contains covenants that restrict our operations and may inhibit our ability to grow our business, increase revenues and pay dividends to our stockholders.

The New Media Credit Agreement contains various restrictions, covenants and representations and warranties. If we fail to comply with any of these covenants or breach these representations or warranties in any material respect, such noncompliance would constitute a default under the New Media Credit Agreement (subject to applicable cure periods), and the lenders could elect to declare all amounts outstanding under the agreements related thereto to be immediately due and payable and enforce their respective interests against collateral pledged under such agreements.

The covenants and restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement generally restrict our ability to, among other things:

 

    incur or guarantee additional debt;

 

    make certain investments, loans or acquisitions;

 

    transfer or sell assets;

 

    make distributions on capital stock or redeem or repurchase capital stock;

 

    create or incur liens;

 

    enter into transactions with affiliates;

 

    consolidate, merge or sell all or substantially all of our assets; and

 

    create restrictions on the payment of dividends or other amounts to us from our restricted subsidiaries.

 

 

15


Table of Contents

The restrictions described above may interfere with our ability to obtain new or additional financing or may affect the manner in which we structure such new or additional financing or engage in other business activities, which may significantly limit or harm our results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. A default and any resulting acceleration of obligations could also result in an event of default and declaration of acceleration under our other existing debt agreements. Such an acceleration of our debt would have a material adverse effect on our liquidity and our ability to continue as a going concern. A default could also significantly limit our alternatives to refinance both the debt under which the default occurred and other indebtedness. This limitation may significantly restrict our financing options during times of either market distress or our financial distress, which are precisely the times when having financing options is most important. For more information regarding the covenants and requirements discussed above, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Indebtedness.”

We may not generate a sufficient amount of cash or generate sufficient funds from operations to fund our operations, pay dividends or repay our indebtedness.

Our ability to make payments on our indebtedness as required depends on our ability to generate cash flow from operations in the future. This ability, to a certain extent, is subject to general economic, financial, competitive, legislative, regulatory and other factors that are beyond our control.

If we do not generate sufficient cash flow from operations to satisfy our debt obligations, including interest payments and the payment of principal at maturity, we may have to undertake alternative financing plans, such as refinancing or restructuring our debt, selling assets, reducing or delaying capital investments or seeking to raise additional capital. We cannot provide assurance that any refinancing would be possible, that any assets could be sold, or, if sold, of the timeliness and amount of proceeds realized from those sales, that additional financing could be obtained on acceptable terms, if at all, or that additional financing would be permitted under the terms of our various debt instruments then in effect. Furthermore, our ability to refinance would depend upon the condition of the finance and credit markets. Our inability to generate sufficient cash flow to satisfy our debt obligations, or to refinance our obligations on commercially reasonable terms or on a timely basis, would materially affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may not be able to pay dividends in accordance with our announced intent or at all.

We have announced our intent to distribute a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend to our stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance, approval by our Board of Directors and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement. The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s GAAP net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results. Although we recently paid a second quarter 2014 cash dividend of $0.27 per share of Common Stock, there can be no guarantee that we will continue to pay dividends in the future or that this recent dividend is representative of the amount of any future dividends. Our ability to declare future dividends will depend on our future financial performance, which in turn depends on the successful implementation of our strategy and on financial, competitive, regulatory, technical and other factors, general economic conditions, demand and selling prices for our products and other factors specific to our industry or specific projects, many of which are beyond our control. Therefore, our ability to generate free cash flow depends on the performance of our operations and could be limited by decreases in our profitability or increases in costs, capital expenditures or debt servicing requirements.

Our Predecessor suspended the payments of dividends commencing with the second quarter of 2008. We own substantially all of our Predecessor’s assets, and our Predecessor experienced revenue and cash flow declines in the past. In addition, we may acquire additional companies with declining cash flow as part of a strategy aimed at stabilizing cash flow through expense reduction and digital expansion. If our strategy is not successful, we may not be able to pay dividends.

As a holding company, we are also dependent on our subsidiaries being able to pay dividends to us. Our subsidiaries are subject to restrictions on the ability to pay dividends under the various instruments governing

 

16


Table of Contents

their indebtedness. If our subsidiaries incur additional debt or losses, such additional indebtedness or loss may further impair their ability to pay dividends or make other distributions to us. In addition, our ability to pay dividends will be substantially affected by the ability of our subsidiaries to provide cash to us. The ability of our subsidiaries to declare and pay dividends to us will also be dependent on their cash income and cash available and may be restricted under applicable law or regulation. Under Delaware law, approval of the board of directors is required to approve any dividend, which may only be paid out of surplus or net profit for the applicable fiscal year. We may not be able to pay dividends in accordance with our announced intent or at all.

The collectability of accounts receivable under adverse economic conditions could deteriorate to a greater extent than provided for in our financial statements and in our projections of future results.

Adverse economic conditions in the United States have increased our exposure to losses resulting from financial distress, insolvency and the potential bankruptcy of our advertising customers. Our accounts receivable are stated at net estimated realizable value and our allowance for doubtful accounts has been determined based on several factors, including receivable agings, significant individual credit risk accounts and historical experience. If such collectability estimates prove inaccurate, adjustments to future operating results could occur.

Our Predecessor experienced declines in its credit ratings, and filed a voluntary petition to reorganize under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, which could adversely affect our ability to obtain new financing to fund our operations and strategic initiatives or to refinance our existing debt at attractive rates.

During 2008, GateHouse’s credit rating was downgraded to below investment grade by both Standard & Poor’s and Moody’s Investors Service. GateHouse’s credit rating was further downgraded in 2009 and 2010. Furthermore, on September 27, 2013, GateHouse filed a voluntary petition to reorganize under Chapter 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code (and emerged from Chapter 11 protection on November 26, 2013). These downgrades and events may negatively affect our cost of financing and subject us to more restrictive covenants than those that might otherwise apply. As a result, our financing options may be limited. Any future downgrades in our credit ratings could further increase our borrowing costs, subject us to more onerous terms and reduce or eliminate our borrowing flexibility in the future. Such limitations on our financing options may adversely affect our ability to refinance existing debt and incur new debt to fund our operations and strategic initiatives.

If there is a significant increase in the price of newsprint or a reduction in the availability of newsprint, our results of operations and financial condition may suffer.

The basic raw material for our publications is newsprint. We generally maintain only a 45 to 55-day inventory of newsprint, although our participation in a newsprint-buying consortium has helped ensure adequate supply. An inability to obtain an adequate supply of newsprint at a favorable price or at all in the future could have a material adverse effect on our ability to produce our publications. Historically, the price of newsprint has been volatile, reaching a high of approximately $826 per metric ton in 2008 and experiencing a low of almost $440 per metric ton in 2002. The average price of newsprint for 2013 was approximately $643 per metric ton. Recent and future consolidation of major newsprint suppliers may adversely affect price competition among suppliers. Significant increases in newsprint costs for properties and periods not covered by our newsprint vendor agreement could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Our Predecessor experienced declines in advertising revenue, and further declines, which could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition, may occur.

Our Predecessor experienced declines in advertising revenue over the past few years, due primarily to the economic recession and advertisers’ shift from print to digital media. Advertising revenue decreased by $26.2 million, or 7.4%, in the year ended December 30, 2012, as compared to the year ended January 1, 2012. Advertising revenue decreased by $29.6 million, or 9.0%, in the year ended December 29, 2013, as compared to the year ended December 30, 2012 for total company excluding Local Media. We continue to search for organic

 

17


Table of Contents

growth opportunities, including in our digital advertising business, and for ways to stabilize print revenue declines through new product launches and pricing. However, there can be no assurance that our advertising revenue will not continue to decline. Further declines in advertising revenue could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.

We compete with a large number of companies in the local media industry; if we are unable to compete effectively, our advertising and circulation revenues may decline.

Our business is concentrated in newspapers and other print publications located primarily in small and midsize markets in the United States. Our revenues primarily consist of advertising and paid circulation. Competition for advertising revenues and paid circulation comes from direct mail, directories, radio, television, outdoor advertising, other newspaper publications, the internet and other media. For example, as the use of the internet and mobile devices has increased, we have lost some classified advertising and subscribers to online advertising businesses and our free internet sites that contain abbreviated versions of our publications. Competition for advertising revenues is based largely upon advertiser results, advertising rates, readership, demographics and circulation levels. Competition for circulation is based largely upon the content of the publication and its price and editorial quality. Our local and regional competitors vary from market to market and many of our competitors for advertising revenues are larger and have greater financial and distribution resources than us. We may incur increased costs competing for advertising expenditures and paid circulation. We may also experience a decline of circulation or print advertising revenue due to alternative media, such as the internet. If we are not able to compete effectively for advertising expenditures and paid circulation, our revenues may decline.

We are undertaking strategic process upgrades that could have a material adverse financial impact if unsuccessful.

We are implementing strategic process upgrades of our business. Among other things we are implementing the standardization and centralization of systems and processes, the outsourcing of certain financial processes and the use of new software for our circulation, advertising and editorial systems. As a result of ongoing strategic evaluation and analysis, we have made and will continue to make changes that, if unsuccessful, could have a material adverse financial impact.

We have invested in growing our digital business, including Propel, but such investments may not be successful, which could adversely affect our results of operations.

We continue to evaluate our business and how we intend to grow our digital business. Internal resources and effort are put towards this business and key partnerships have been entered into to assist with our digital business, including Propel. We continue to believe that our digital businesses, including Propel, offer opportunities for revenue growth to support and, in some cases, offset the revenue trends we have seen in our print business. There can be no assurances that the partnerships we have entered into or the internal strategy being employed will result in generating or increasing digital revenues in amounts necessary to stabilize or offset trends in print revenues. In addition, we have a limited history of operations in this area and there can be no assurances that past performance will be indicative of future performance or future trends. If our digital strategy, including with regard to Propel, is not as successful as we anticipate, our financial condition, results of operations and ability to pay dividends could be adversely affected.

If we are unable to retain and grow our digital audience and advertiser base, our digital businesses will be adversely affected.

Given the ever-growing and rapidly changing number of digital media options available on the internet, we may not be able to increase our online traffic sufficiently and retain or grow a base of frequent visitors to our websites and applications on mobile devices.

 

18


Table of Contents

Accordingly, we may not be able to create sufficient advertiser interest in our digital businesses and to maintain or increase the advertising rates of the inventory on our websites.

In addition, the ever-growing and rapidly changing number of digital media options available on the internet may lead to technologies and alternatives that we are not able to offer or about which we are not able to advise. Such circumstances could directly and adversely affect the availability, applicability, marketability and profitability of the suite of SMB services and the private ad exchange we offer as a significant part of our digital business.

Technological developments and any changes we make to our business strategy may require significant capital investments. Such investments may be restricted by our current or future credit facilities.

Our business is subject to seasonal and other fluctuations, which affects our revenues and operating results.

Our business is subject to seasonal fluctuations that we expect to continue to be reflected in our operating results in future periods. Our first fiscal quarter of the year tends to be our weakest quarter because advertising volume is at its lowest levels following the December holiday season. Correspondingly, our second and fourth fiscal quarters tend to be our strongest because they include heavy holiday and seasonal advertising. Other factors that affect our quarterly revenues and operating results may be beyond our control, including changes in the pricing policies of our competitors, the hiring and retention of key personnel, wage and cost pressures, distribution costs, changes in newsprint prices and general economic factors.

We could be adversely affected by declining circulation.

Overall daily newspaper circulation, including national and urban newspapers, has declined in recent years. For the year ended December 30, 2012, our Predecessor’s circulation revenue decreased by $0.3 million, or 0.2%, as compared to the year ended January 1, 2012. There can be no assurance that our circulation revenue will not decline again in the future. Our Predecessor was able to maintain its annual circulation revenue from existing operations in recent years through, among other things, increases in per copy prices. However, there can be no assurance that we will be able to continue to increase prices to offset any declines in circulation. Further declines in circulation could impair our ability to maintain or increase our advertising prices, cause purchasers of advertising in our publications to reduce or discontinue those purchases and discourage potential new advertising customers, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flows and ability to pay dividends.

The increasing popularity of digital media could also adversely affect circulation of our newspapers, which may decrease circulation revenue and cause more marked declines in print advertising. If we are not successful in offsetting such declines in revenues from our print products, our business, financial condition and prospects will be adversely affected.

Our Predecessor had a history of losses and we may not be able to maintain profitable operations in the future.

Our Predecessor experienced losses from continuing operations of approximately $27.5 million and $21.0 million in 2012 and 2011, respectively. Our results of operations in the future will depend on many factors, including our ability to execute our business strategy and realize efficiencies through our clustering strategy. Our failure to achieve profitability in the future could adversely affect the trading price of our Common Stock and our ability to pay dividends and raise additional capital for growth.

The value of our intangible assets may become impaired, depending upon future operating results.

As a result of the Restructuring, which was considered a triggering event for the non-amortizable intangibles, our Predecessor performed a valuation analysis to determine if an impairment existed as of September 29, 2013. The fair values of our Predecessor’s reporting units for goodwill and newspaper mastheads

 

19


Table of Contents

were estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows, recent industry transaction multiples and using estimates, judgments and assumptions that their management believed were appropriate in the circumstances and were consistent with the terms of the Plan prepared in the context of the Restructuring. The estimates and judgments used in the assessment included multiples for revenue and EBITDA, the weighted average cost of capital and the terminal growth rate. Given the Restructuring, our Predecessor determined that discounted cash flows provided the best estimate of the fair value of its reporting units. The estimated fair value of the Large Daily reporting unit exceeded its carrying value and Step 2 of the analysis was not necessary. The Small Community reporting unit failed the Step 1 goodwill impairment analysis. Our Predecessor performed Step 2 of the analysis using consistent assumptions, as discussed above, and determined an impairment was not present for this reporting unit. The estimated fair value of each reporting unit’s mastheads exceeded their carrying values, using consistent assumptions as discussed above. The masthead fair value was estimated using the relief from royalty valuation method. For further information on goodwill and intangible assets. See Note 8 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Note 6 to New Media’s Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Goodwill and Intangible Assets.”

Due to reductions in our Predecessor’s operating projections during the third quarter in conjunction with the Restructuring, an impairment charge of $68.6 million was recognized for advertiser relationships within the Predecessor’s Metro and Small Community reporting units, an impairment charge of $19.1 million was recognized for subscriber relationships within the Company’s Metro and Small Community reporting units, an impairment charge of $2.1 million was recognized for customer relationships within the Company’s Metro reporting unit and an impairment charge of $1.8 million was recognized for trade names and publication rights within the Ventures business unit. See Note 19 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Fair Value Measurement,” for further information on our Predecessor’s impairment charge and its effect on the Company’s financial statements.

Given the recent revaluation of assets related to fresh start accounting, there is a relatively small amount of fair value excess for certain reporting units as of the second quarter 2014 annual impairment test. Specifically the fair value of the Large Daily Newspapers, Metro Newspapers and Small Community Newspaper reporting units exceeded carrying value by less than 10%. In addition, the masthead fair value for these groups exceeded carrying value by less than 3%. Considering a relatively low headroom for these reporting units and mastheads and declining same store revenue and profitability in the newspaper industry over the past several years, these are considered to be at risk for a future impairment in the event of decline in general economic, market or business conditions or any significant unfavorable changes in the forecasted cash flows, weighted-average cost of capital and/or market transaction multiples.

At June 29, 2014 the carrying value of our goodwill was $126.6 million, mastheads was $46.4 million, and amortizable intangible assets was $98.1 million.

We are subject to environmental and employee safety and health laws and regulations that could cause us to incur significant compliance expenditures and liabilities.

Our operations are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations pertaining to the environment, storage tanks and the management and disposal of wastes at our facilities. Under various environmental laws, a current or previous owner or operator of real property may be liable for contamination resulting from the release or threatened release of hazardous or toxic substances or petroleum at that property. Such laws often impose liability on the owner or operator without regard to fault and the costs of any required investigation or cleanup can be substantial. Although in connection with certain of our Predecessor’s acquisitions we have rights to indemnification for certain environmental liabilities, these rights may not be sufficient to reimburse us for all losses that we might incur if a property acquired by us has environmental contamination.

Our operations are also subject to various employee safety and health laws and regulations, including those pertaining to occupational injury and illness, employee exposure to hazardous materials and employee complaints. Environmental and employee safety and health laws tend to be complex, comprehensive and frequently changing. As a result, we may be involved from time to time in administrative and judicial

 

20


Table of Contents

proceedings and investigations related to environmental and employee safety and health issues. These proceedings and investigations could result in substantial costs to us, divert our management’s attention and adversely affect our ability to sell, lease or develop our real property. Furthermore, if it is determined that we are not in compliance with applicable laws and regulations, or if our properties are contaminated, it could result in significant liabilities, fines or the suspension or interruption of the operations of specific printing facilities.

Future events, such as changes in existing laws and regulations, new laws or regulations or the discovery of conditions not currently known to us, may give rise to additional compliance or remedial costs that could be material.

Sustained increases in costs of employee health and welfare benefits may reduce our profitability. Moreover, our pension plan obligations are currently underfunded, and we may have to make significant cash contributions to our plans, which could reduce the cash available for our business.

In recent years, our Predecessor experienced significant increases in the cost of employee medical benefits because of economic factors beyond its control, including increases in health care costs. At least some of these factors may continue to put upward pressure on the cost of providing medical benefits. Although we have actively sought to control increases in these costs, there can be no assurance that we will succeed in limiting cost increases, and continued upward pressure could reduce the profitability of our businesses.

Our pension and postretirement plans were underfunded by $10.2 million at December 29, 2013. Our pension plan invests in a variety of equity and debt securities, many of which were affected by the disruptions in the credit and capital markets in 2009 and 2010. Future volatility and disruption in the stock markets could cause further declines in the asset values of our pension plans. In addition, a decrease in the discount rate used to determine minimum funding requirements could result in increased future contributions. If either occurs, we may need to make additional pension contributions above what is currently estimated, which could reduce the cash available for our businesses.

We may not be able to protect intellectual property rights upon which our business relies and, if we lose intellectual property protection, our assets may lose value.

Our business depends on our intellectual property, including, but not limited to, our titles, mastheads, content and services, which we attempt to protect through patents, copyrights, trade laws and contractual restrictions, such as confidentiality agreements. We believe our proprietary and other intellectual property rights are important to our success and our competitive position.

Despite our efforts to protect our proprietary rights, unauthorized third parties may attempt to copy or otherwise obtain and use our content, services and other intellectual property, and we cannot be certain that the steps we have taken will prevent any misappropriation or confusion among consumers and merchants, or unauthorized use of these rights. If we are unable to procure, protect and enforce our intellectual property rights, we may not realize the full value of these assets, and our business may suffer. If we must litigate to enforce our intellectual property rights or determine the validity and scope of the proprietary rights of third parties, such litigation may be costly and divert the attention of our management from day-to-day operations.

We depend on key personnel and we may not be able to operate or grow our business effectively if we lose the services of any of our key personnel or are unable to attract qualified personnel in the future.

The success of our business is heavily dependent on our ability to retain our management and other key personnel and to attract and retain qualified personnel in the future. Competition for senior management personnel is intense and we may not be able to retain our key personnel. Although our Predecessor entered into employment agreements with certain of our key personnel, these agreements do not ensure that our key personnel will continue in their present capacity with us for any particular period of time. We do not have key man insurance for any of our current management or other key personnel. The loss of any key personnel would

 

21


Table of Contents

require our remaining key personnel to divert immediate and substantial attention to seeking a replacement. An inability to find a suitable replacement for any departing executive officer on a timely basis could adversely affect our ability to operate or grow our business.

A shortage of skilled or experienced employees in the media industry, or our inability to retain such employees, could pose a risk to achieving improved productivity and reducing costs, which could adversely affect our profitability.

Production and distribution of our various publications requires skilled and experienced employees. A shortage of such employees, or our inability to retain such employees, could have an adverse impact on our productivity and costs, our ability to expand, develop and distribute new products and our entry into new markets. The cost of retaining or hiring such employees could exceed our expectations which could adversely affect our results of operations.

A number of our employees are unionized, and our business and results of operations could be adversely affected if current or additional labor negotiations or contracts were to further restrict our ability to maximize the efficiency of our operations.

As of June 29, 2014, we employed approximately 5,552 employees, of whom approximately 702 (or approximately 12.6%) were represented by 28 unions. 87% of the unionized employees are in three states: Massachusetts, Illinois and Ohio and represent 24%, 34% and 29% of all our union employees, respectively. Most of our unionized employees work under collective bargaining agreements that expire in 2014.

Although our newspapers have not experienced a union strike in the recent past nor do we anticipate a union strike to occur, we cannot preclude the possibility that a strike may occur at one or more of our newspapers at some point in the future. We believe that, in the event of a newspaper strike, we would be able to continue to publish and deliver to subscribers, which is critical to retaining advertising and circulation revenues, although there can be no assurance of this.

Our potential inability to successfully execute cost control measures could result in greater than expected total operating costs.

We and our Predecessor have implemented general cost control measures, and we expect to continue such cost control efforts in the future. If we do not achieve expected savings as a result of such measures or if our operating costs increase as a result of our growth strategy, our total operating costs may be greater than expected. In addition, reductions in staff and employee benefits could affect our ability to attract and retain key employees.

We may not realize all of the anticipated benefits of the synergies between our recent or potential future acquisitions, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our ability to realize the anticipated benefits of the synergies between our recent acquisitions, including our acquisition of The Providence Journal, or potential future acquisitions of assets or companies will depend, in part, on our ability to scale-up to appropriately integrate the businesses of such acquired companies with our business. The process of acquiring assets or companies may disrupt our business and may not result in the full benefits expected. Additionally, we may not be successful in identifying acquisition opportunities, assessing the value, strengths and weaknesses of these opportunities and consummating acquisitions on acceptable terms. Furthermore, suitable acquisition opportunities may not even be made available or known to us. In addition, valuations of potential acquisitions may rise materially, making it economically unfeasible to complete identified acquisitions. The risks associated with integrating the operations of recent and potential future acquisitions include, among others:

 

    uncoordinated market functions;

 

    unanticipated issues in integrating the operations and personnel of the acquired businesses;

 

    the incurrence of indebtedness and the assumption of liabilities;

 

22


Table of Contents
    the incurrence of significant additional capital expenditures, transaction and operating expenses and non-recurring acquisition-related charges;

 

    unanticipated adverse impact on our earnings from the amortization or write-off of acquired goodwill and other intangible assets;

 

    not retaining key employees, vendors, service providers, readers and customers of the acquired businesses; and

 

    the diversion of management’s attention from ongoing business concerns.

If we are unable to successfully implement our acquisition strategy or address the risks associated with integrating the operations of recent or potential future acquisitions, or if we encounter unforeseen expenses, difficulties, complications or delays frequently encountered in connection with the integration of acquired entities and the expansion of operations, our growth and ability to compete may be impaired, we may fail to achieve acquisition synergies and we may be required to focus resources on integration of operations rather than other profitable areas. Moreover, the success of any acquisition will depend upon our ability to effectively integrate the acquired assets or businesses. The acquired assets or businesses may not contribute to our revenues or earnings to any material extent, and cost savings and synergies we expect at the time of an acquisition may not be realized once the acquisition has been completed. Furthermore, if we incur indebtedness to finance an acquisition, the acquired business may not be able to generate sufficient cash flow to service that indebtedness. Unsuitable or unsuccessful acquisitions could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations, cash flow and ability to pay dividends.

Our financial results were affected by the adoption of fresh start reporting and may not reflect historical trends.

Pursuant to the Plan (as defined below), we acquired substantially all of the assets of our Predecessor. The Restructuring resulted in us becoming a new reporting entity and adopting fresh start accounting. As required by fresh start accounting, our Predecessor’s assets and liabilities were adjusted to measured value, and we recognized certain assets and liabilities not previously recognized in our Predecessor’s historical consolidated financial statements. Accordingly, our financial condition and results of operations from and after the Effective Date (as defined below) are not comparable to the financial condition and results of operations reflected in our Predecessor’s historical consolidated financial statements, including those presented herein.

Risks Related to Our Manager

We are dependent on our Manager and may not find a suitable replacement if our Manager terminates the Management Agreement.

We are externally managed by FIG LLC (the Manager) pursuant to the management agreement that we entered into on November 26, 2013, as amended and restated (the “Management Agreement”). Our Manager does not have any prior experience directly managing our Company or media-related assets. We are completely reliant on our Manager, which has significant discretion as to the implementation of our operating policies and strategies, to conduct our business. We are subject to the risk that our Manager will terminate the Management Agreement and that we will not be able to find a suitable replacement for our Manager in a timely manner, at a reasonable cost or at all. Furthermore, we are dependent on the services of certain key employees of our Manager whose compensation is partially or entirely dependent upon the amount of incentive or management compensation earned by our Manager and whose continued service is not guaranteed, and the loss of such services could adversely affect our operations.

 

23


Table of Contents

There may be conflicts of interest in our relationship with our Manager, including with respect to corporate opportunities.

We have entered into a Management Agreement with FIG LLC, an affiliate of Fortress Investment Group LLC (“Fortress”), pursuant to which our management team will not be required to exclusively dedicate their services to us and will provide services for other entities affiliated with our Manager.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws provide that if Fortress or any of their officers, directors or employees acquire knowledge of a potential transaction that could be a corporate opportunity, they have no duty, to the fullest extent permitted by law, to offer such corporate opportunity to us, our stockholders or our affiliates. In the event that any of our directors and officers who is also a director, officer or employee of Fortress acquires knowledge of a corporate opportunity or is offered a corporate opportunity, provided that this knowledge was not acquired solely in such person’s capacity as a director or officer of the Company and such person acts in good faith, then to the fullest extent permitted by law such person is deemed to have fully satisfied such person’s fiduciary duties owed to us and is not liable to us if Fortress, or its affiliates, pursues or acquires the corporate opportunity or if such person did not present the corporate opportunity to us.

The ability of our Manager and its officers and employees to engage in other business activities, subject to the terms of our Management Agreement with our Manager, may reduce the amount of time our Manager, its officers or other employees spend managing us. In addition, we may engage in material transactions with our Manager or another entity managed by our Manager or one of its affiliates that present an actual, potential or perceived conflict of interest. It is possible that actual, potential or perceived conflicts could give rise to investor dissatisfaction, litigation or regulatory enforcement actions. Appropriately dealing with conflicts of interest is complex and difficult, and our reputation could be damaged if we fail, or appear to fail, to deal appropriately with one or more potential, actual or perceived conflicts of interest. Regulatory scrutiny of, or litigation in connection with, conflicts of interest could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, which could materially adversely affect our business in a number of ways, including causing an inability to raise additional funds, a reluctance of counterparties to do business with us, a decrease in the prices of our equity securities and a resulting increased risk of litigation and regulatory enforcement actions.

The management compensation structure that we have agreed to with our Manager, as well as compensation arrangements that we may enter into with our Manager in the future (in connection with new lines of business or other activities), may have unintended consequences for us. We have agreed to pay our Manager a management fee that is not tied to our performance. The management fee may not sufficiently incentivize our Manager to generate attractive risk-adjusted returns for us. In addition, our Manager may be eligible to receive incentive compensation, which may incentivize our Manager to invest in high risk investments. In evaluating investments and other management strategies, the opportunity to earn incentive compensation may lead our Manager to place undue emphasis on the maximization of such measures at the expense of other criteria, such as preservation of capital, in order to achieve higher incentive compensation. Investments with higher yield potential are generally riskier or more speculative than lower-yielding investments. Moreover, because our Manager receives compensation in the form of options in connection with the completion of our common equity offerings, our Manager may be incentivized to cause us to issue additional Common Stock, which could be dilutive to existing stockholders. See “Description of Our Capital Stock—Corporate Opportunity.”

We may compete with affiliates of our Manager, which could adversely affect our and their results of operations.

Affiliates of our Manager are not restricted in any manner from competing with us. Affiliates of our Manager may decide to invest in the same types of assets that we invest in. See “—Risks Related to Our Manager—There may be conflicts of interest in our relationship with our Manager, including with respect to corporate opportunities.”

 

24


Table of Contents

It would be difficult and costly to terminate our Management Agreement with our Manager.

It would be difficult and costly for us to terminate our Management Agreement with our Manager. The Management Agreement may only be terminated annually upon (i) the reasonable affirmative vote of a majority of at least two-thirds of our independent directors, or by a vote of the holders of a simple majority of the outstanding shares of our Common Stock, that there has been unsatisfactory performance by our Manager that is materially detrimental to us or (ii) a determination by a simple majority of our independent directors that the management fee payable to our Manager is not fair, subject to our Manager’s right to prevent such a termination by accepting a mutually acceptable reduction of fees. Our Manager will be provided 60 days’ prior notice of any termination and will be paid a termination fee equal to the amount of the management fee earned by the Manager during the twelve month period preceding such termination. In addition, following any termination of the Management Agreement, our Manager may require us to purchase its right to receive incentive compensation at a price determined as if our assets were sold for their fair market value (as determined by an appraisal, taking into account, among other things, the expected future value of the underlying investments) or otherwise we may continue to pay the incentive compensation to our Manager. These provisions may increase the effective cost to us of terminating the Management Agreement, thereby adversely affecting our ability to terminate our Manager without cause. In addition, our independent directors may not vigorously enforce the provisions of our Management Agreement against our Manager. For example, our independent directors may refrain from terminating our Manager because doing so could result in the loss of key personnel. Furthermore, we are dependent on our Manager and may not find a suitable replacement if our Manager terminates the Management Agreement.

Our Manager will not be liable to us for any acts or omissions performed in accordance with the Management Agreement, including with respect to the performance of our investments.

Pursuant to our Management Agreement, our Manager will not assume any responsibility other than to render the services called for thereunder in good faith and will not be responsible for any action of our Board in following or declining to follow its advice or recommendations. Our Manager, its members, managers, officers and employees will not be liable to us or any of our subsidiaries, to our Board, or our or any subsidiary’s stockholders or partners for any acts or omissions by our Manager, its members, managers, officers or employees, except by reason of acts constituting bad faith, willful misconduct, gross negligence or reckless disregard of our Manager’s duties under our Management Agreement. We shall, to the full extent lawful, reimburse, indemnify and hold our Manager, its members, managers, officers and employees and each other person, if any, controlling our Manager harmless of and from any and all expenses, losses, damages, liabilities, demands, charges and claims of any nature whatsoever (including attorneys’ fees) in respect of or arising from any acts or omissions of an indemnified party made in good faith in the performance of our Manager’s duties under our Management Agreement and not constituting such indemnified party’s bad faith, willful misconduct, gross negligence or reckless disregard of our Manager’s duties under our Management Agreement.

Our Manager’s due diligence of business opportunities or other transactions may not identify all pertinent risks, which could materially affect our business, financial condition, liquidity and results of operations.

Our Manager intends to conduct due diligence with respect to each business opportunity or other transaction it pursues. It is possible, however, that our Manager’s due diligence processes will not uncover all relevant facts, particularly with respect to any assets we acquire from third parties. In these cases, our Manager may be given limited access to information about the business opportunity and will rely on information provided by the target of the business opportunity. In addition, if business opportunities are scarce, the process for selecting bidders is competitive, or the timeframe in which we are required to complete diligence is short, our ability to conduct a due diligence investigation may be limited, and we would be required to make business decisions based upon a less thorough diligence process than would otherwise be the case. Accordingly, business opportunities and other transactions that initially appear to be viable may prove not to be over time, due to the limitations of the due diligence process or other factors.

 

25


Table of Contents

Risks Related to our Common Stock

There can be no assurance that the market for our stock will provide you with adequate liquidity.

A “when-issued” trading market for our Common Stock on the NYSE began on February 4, 2014 and “regular-way” trading of our Common Stock began on February 14, 2014. There can be no assurance that an active trading market for our common stock will develop or be sustained in the future, and the market price of our common stock may fluctuate widely, depending upon many factors, some of which may be beyond our control. These factors include, without limitation:

 

    our business profile and market capitalization may not fit the investment objectives of any stockholder;

 

    a shift in our investor base;

 

    our quarterly or annual earnings, or those of other comparable companies;

 

    actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating results;

 

    changes in accounting standards, policies, guidance, interpretations or principles;

 

    announcements by us or our competitors of significant investments, acquisitions or dispositions;

 

    the failure of securities analysts to cover our Common Stock;

 

    changes in earnings estimates by securities analysts or our ability to meet those estimates;

 

    the operating and stock price performance of other comparable companies;

 

    overall market fluctuations; and

 

    general economic conditions.

Stock markets in general have experienced volatility that has often been unrelated to the operating performance of a particular company. These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the trading price of our Common Stock.

Sales or issuances of shares of our common stock could adversely affect the market price of our Common Stock.

Sales of substantial amounts of shares of our Common Stock in the public market, or the perception that such sales might occur, could adversely affect the market price of our Common Stock. The issuance of our common stock in connection with property, portfolio or business acquisitions or the settlement of awards that may be granted under our Incentive Plan (as defined below) or otherwise could also have an adverse effect on the market price of our Common Stock. See “Shares Eligible for Future Sale.”

We and our officers and directors have agreed that, for a period of 45 days from the date of this Prospectus, we and they will not, without the prior written consent of the underwriters, dispose of or hedge any shares or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for our Common Stock. The underwriters, in their sole discretion, may release any of the securities subject to these lock-up agreements at any time, which, in the case of officers and directors, shall be with notice. If the restrictions under the lock-up agreements are waived, our Common Stock may become available for sale into the market, subject to applicable law, which could reduce the market price for our Common Stock.

Failure to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting in accordance with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act could have a material adverse effect on our business and stock price.

As a public company, we are required to maintain effective internal control over financial reporting in accordance with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Internal control over financial reporting is complex and may be revised over time to adapt to changes in our business, or changes in applicable accounting

 

26


Table of Contents

rules. We cannot assure you that our internal control over financial reporting will be effective in the future or that a material weakness will not be discovered with respect to a prior period for which we had previously believed that internal controls were effective. If we are not able to maintain or document effective internal control over financial reporting, our independent registered public accounting firm will not be able to certify as to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. Matters impacting our internal controls may cause us to be unable to report our financial information on a timely basis, or may cause us to restate previously issued financial information, and thereby subject us to adverse regulatory consequences, including sanctions or investigations by the SEC, or violations of applicable stock exchange listing rules. There could also be a negative reaction in the financial markets due to a loss of investor confidence in us and the reliability of our financial statements. Confidence in the reliability of our financial statements is also likely to suffer if we or our independent registered public accounting firm reports a material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting. This could materially adversely affect us by, for example, leading to a decline in our share price and impairing our ability to raise capital, if and when desirable.

If you purchase shares of Common Stock in this offering, you will suffer immediate dilution in the book value of your shares.

The public offering price is substantially higher than the pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per share of our Common Stock based on the total value of our tangible assets less our total liabilities immediately following this offering.

Therefore, if you purchase shares of our Common Stock in this offering, you will experience immediate and substantial dilution of $10.71 per share in the price you pay for shares of our Common Stock as compared to its pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value giving effect to this offering, based upon the public offering price of $16.25 per share. For further information on this calculation, see “Dilution” elsewhere in this Prospectus.

Your percentage ownership in New Media may be diluted in the future.

We may issue additional equity in order to raise capital or in connection with future acquisitions and strategic investments, which would dilute investors’ percentage ownership in New Media. In addition, your percentage ownership may be diluted if we issue equity instruments such as debt and equity financing.

Your percentage ownership in New Media may also be diluted in the future as a result of the New Media Warrants (as defined below). The New Media Warrants collectively represent the right to acquire New Media Common Stock, which in the aggregate are equal to 5% of New Media Common Stock as of the Effective Date (calculated prior to dilution from shares of New Media Common Stock issued pursuant to the Local Media Contribution (as defined below)) at a strike price of $46.35 calculated based on a total equity value of New Media prior to the Local Media Contribution of $1.2 billion as of the Effective Date. As a result, New Media Common Stock may be subject to dilution upon the exercise of such New Media Warrants.

Furthermore, your percentage ownership in New Media may be diluted in the future because of equity awards that we expect will be granted to our Manager pursuant to our Management Agreement. Our Board of Directors approved a Nonqualified Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan (the “Incentive Plan”) which provides for the grant of equity and equity-based awards, including restricted stock, stock options, stock appreciation rights, performance awards, restricted stock units, tandem awards and other equity-based and non-equity based awards, in each case to our Manager, to the directors, officers, employees, service providers, consultants and advisors of our Manager who perform services for us, and to our directors, officers, employees, service providers, consultants and advisors. Any future grant would cause further dilution. We have initially reserved 15 million shares of our Common Stock for issuance under the Incentive Plan; on the first day of each fiscal year beginning during the ten-year term of the Incentive Plan and in and after calendar year 2015, that

 

27


Table of Contents

number will be increased by a number of shares of our Common Stock equal to 10% of the number of shares of our Common Stock newly issued by us during the immediately preceding fiscal year (and, in the case of fiscal year 2014, after the effective date of the Incentive Plan). For a more detailed description of the Incentive Plan, see “Management—Nonqualified Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan.”

In connection with this offering, we will issue to an affiliate of our Manager options to purchase shares of our Common Stock, equal in number to 10% of the number of shares being offered hereby, with an exercise price equal to the offering price per share paid by the public or other ultimate purchaser. This option will also be granted upon the successful completion of any future offering of shares of our Common Stock or any shares of preferred stock. Our board of directors may also determine to issue options to the Manager or its affiliates that are not subject to the Plan, provided that the number of shares underlying any options granted to the Manager in connection with capital raising efforts would not exceed 10% of the shares sold in such offering and would be subject to NYSE rules.

Provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws and of Delaware law may prevent or delay an acquisition of our company, which could decrease the trading price of our Common Stock.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws and Delaware law contain provisions that are intended to deter coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids by making such practices or bids unacceptably expensive to the raider and to encourage prospective acquirers to negotiate with our Board rather than to attempt a hostile takeover. These provisions provide for:

 

    a classified board of directors with staggered three-year terms;

 

    amendment of provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws regarding the election of directors, classes of directors, the term of office of directors, the filling of director vacancies and the resignation and removal of directors only upon the affirmative vote of at least 80% of the then issued and outstanding shares of our capital stock entitled to vote thereon (provided, however, that for so long as Newcastle and certain other affiliates of Fortress and permitted transferees (collectively, the “Fortress Stockholders”) beneficially own at least 20% of our issued and outstanding Common Stock, such provisions may be amended with the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting interest of stockholders entitled to vote or by a majority of the entire Board of Directors);

 

    amendment of provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation regarding corporate opportunity only upon the affirmative vote of at least 80% of the then issued and outstanding shares of our Common Stock entitled to vote thereon;

 

    removal of directors only for cause and only with the affirmative vote of at least 80% of the voting interest of stockholders entitled to vote in the election of directors (provided, however, that for so long as the Fortress Stockholders beneficially own at least 20% of our issued and outstanding Common Stock, directors may be removed with or without cause with the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting interest of stockholders entitled to vote);

 

    our Board to determine the powers, preferences and rights of our preferred stock and to issue such preferred stock without stockholder approval;

 

    provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws prevent stockholders from calling special meetings of our stockholders (provided, however, that for so long as the Fortress Stockholders beneficially own at least 20% of our issued and outstanding Common Stock, Fortress Stockholders may call special meetings of our stockholders);

 

    advance notice requirements applicable to stockholders for director nominations and actions to be taken at annual meetings;

 

28


Table of Contents
    a prohibition, in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, stating that no holder of shares of our Common Stock will have cumulative voting rights in the election of directors, which means that the holders of majority of the issued and outstanding shares of our Common Stock can elect all the directors standing for election; and

 

    action by our stockholders outside a meeting, in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and our amended and restated bylaws, only by unanimous written consent (provided, however, that for so long as the Fortress Stockholders beneficially own at least 20% of our issued and outstanding Common Stock, our stockholders may act without a meeting by written consent of a majority of the voting interest of stockholders entitled to vote).

Public stockholders who might desire to participate in these types of transactions may not have an opportunity to do so, even if the transaction is considered favorable to stockholders. These anti-takeover provisions could substantially impede the ability of public stockholders to benefit from a change in control or a change in our management and Board and, as a result, may adversely affect the market price of our Common Stock and your ability to realize any potential change of control premium. See “Description of Our Capital Stock—Anti-Takeover Effects of Delaware Law, Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws.”

 

29


Table of Contents

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD LOOKING INFORMATION

Certain statements in this Prospectus may constitute forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 that reflect our current views regarding, among other things, our future growth, results of operations, performance and business prospects and opportunities, as well as other statements that are other than historical fact. Words such as “anticipate(s),” “expect(s),” “intend(s),” “plan(s),” “target(s),” “project(s),” “believe(s),” “will,” “aim,” “would,” “seek(s),” “estimate(s)” and similar expressions are intended to identify such forward-looking statements.

Forward-looking statements are based on management’s current expectations and beliefs and are subject to a number of known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that could lead to actual results materially different from those described in the forward-looking statements. We can give no assurance that our expectations will be attained. Our actual results, liquidity and financial condition may differ from the anticipated results, liquidity and financial condition indicated in these forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements are not a guarantee of future performance and involve risks and uncertainties, and there are certain important factors that could cause our actual results to differ, possibly materially from expectations or estimates reflected in such forward-looking statements, including, among others:

 

    general economic, market and political conditions;

 

    the potential adverse effects of the Restructuring;

 

    the risk that we may not realize the anticipated benefits of the Local Media Acquisition (as defined below) or potential future acquisitions;

 

    the availability and cost of capital for future investments;

 

    our ability to pay dividends;

 

    our ability to realize the benefits of the Management Agreement;

 

    the competitive environment in which we operate;

 

    our ability to grow our digital business and digital audience and advertiser base;

 

    our ability to recruit and retain key personnel.

Additional factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from our expectations include, but are not limited, to the risks identified by us under the heading “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this Prospectus. Such forward-looking statements speak only as of the date on which they are made. Except to the extent required by law, we expressly disclaim any obligation to release publicly any updates or revisions to any forward-looking statements contained herein to reflect any change in our expectations with regard thereto or change in events, conditions or circumstances on which any statement is based.

 

30


Table of Contents

THE RESTRUCTURING AND THE SPIN OFF

The Restructuring

We acquired our operations as part of the restructuring of GateHouse. On September 27, 2013, GateHouse commenced Chapter 11 cases in the Bankruptcy Court (the “Restructuring”) in which it sought confirmation of its Joint Prepackaged Chapter 11 Plan (as modified, amended or supplemented from time to time, the “Plan”) sponsored by Newcastle, as the holder of the majority of the Outstanding Debt (as defined below). The Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Plan on November 6, 2013. GateHouse effected the transactions contemplated by the Plan and emerged from Chapter 11 protection on November 26, 2013 (the “Effective Date”).

Pursuant to the Restructuring, Newcastle offered to purchase GateHouse’s obligations under the 2007 Credit Facility (as defined below) and certain interest rate swaps secured thereunder (collectively, the “Outstanding Debt”) in cash and at 40% of (i) $1,167,449,812.96 of principal of claims under the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement by and among certain affiliates of GateHouse, the lenders from time to time party thereto and Cortland Products Corp., as administrative agent (the “Administrative Agent”), dated February 27, 2007 (as amended, the “2007 Credit Facility”), plus (ii) accrued and unpaid interest at the applicable contract non-default rate with respect thereto, plus (iii) all amounts, excluding any default interest, arising from transactions in connection with interest rate swaps secured under the 2007 Credit Facility (the “Cash-Out Offer”) on the Effective Date. The holders of the Outstanding Debt had the option of receiving, in satisfaction of their Outstanding Debt, their pro rata share of the (i) Cash-Out Offer and/or (ii) New Media Common Stock and Net Proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities. All pensions, trade and all other unsecured claims will be paid in the ordinary course.

On the Effective Date (1) reorganized GateHouse became a wholly owned subsidiary of New Media as a result of (a) the cancellation and discharge of the currently outstanding equity interests of GateHouse (the holders of which received warrants issued by New Media (as described below)) and (b) the issuance of equity interests in the reorganized GateHouse to New Media; (2) Local Media Parent, which was a wholly owned subsidiary of Newcastle following the acquisition of Local Media from News Corp. by Newcastle on September 3, 2013 (the “Local Media Acquisition”), became a wholly owned subsidiary of New Media as a result of Newcastle’s transfer of Local Media Parent to New Media (the “Local Media Contribution”); (3) New Media entered into the Management Agreement with the Manager (4) New Media entered into the GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement (the “GateHouse Management Agreement”) with GateHouse; and (5) all of GateHouse’s Outstanding Debt was cancelled and discharged and the holders of the Outstanding Debt received, at their option, their pro rata share of the (i) Cash-Out Offer and/or (ii) New Media Common Stock and the net proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities. Pursuant to the Cash-Out Offer, Newcastle offered to buy the claims of the holders of the Outstanding Debt. As a result of these transactions, Newcastle owned 84.6% of New Media as of the Effective Date. See Note 2 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Voluntary Reorganization Under Chapter 11.”

As of the Effective Date of the Plan, New Media’s debt structure consisted of multiple credit facilities. The Revolving Credit, Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “First Lien Credit Facility”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among GateHouse, GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, LLC, f/k/a GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, Inc. (“GMIH”), certain wholly-owned subsidiaries of GMIH (collectively with GMIH and GateHouse, the “Loan Parties”), PNC Bank, National Association, as the administrative agent, Crystal Financial LLC, as term loan B agent and each of the lenders party thereto provided for (i) a term loan A in the aggregate principal amount of $25 million, (ii) a term loan B in the aggregate principal amount of $50 million, and (iii) a revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $40 million (of which $25 million was funded on the Effective Date). Borrowings under the First Lien Credit Facility bore interest at a rate per annum equal to (i) with respect to the revolving credit facility, the applicable Revolving Interest Rate (as defined the First Lien Credit Agreement), (ii) with respect to the term loan A, the Term Loan A Rate (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement) and (iii) with respect to the term loan B, the Term Loan B Rate (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement).

 

31


Table of Contents

The Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “Second Lien Credit Facility” and together with the First Lien Credit Facility, the “GateHouse Credit Facilities”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among the Loan Parties, Mutual Quest Fund and each of the lenders party thereto provided for a term loan in an aggregate principal amount of $50 million. Borrowings under the Second Lien Credit Facility bore interest, at the Loan Parties’ option, equal to (1) the LIBOR Rate (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Facility) plus 11.00% or (2) the Alternate Base Rate (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Facility) plus 10.00%. The GateHouse Credit Facilities were fully paid on June 4, 2014.

Pursuant to the Plan, holders of the Outstanding Debt who elected to receive New Media Common Stock received their pro rata share of the proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities, net of certain transaction expenses (the “Net Proceeds”). The Net Proceeds distributed to holders of the Outstanding Debt totaled $149 million. GateHouse’s entry into the GateHouse Credit Facilities was not a condition to the effectiveness of the Plan.

Additionally, the Credit Agreement dated September 3, 2013, by and among Local Media Parent, the borrowers party thereto, the lenders party thereto, Capital One Business Credit Corp., as successor to Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch, as administrative agent (the “Local Media Credit Facility Administrative Agent”) and collateral agent and Credit Suisse Loan Funding LLC, as lead arranger (the “Local Media Credit Facility”) provided for a $33.0 million senior secured term loan which was funded on September 3, 2013 and a senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $10 million, whose full availability was activated on October 25, 2013. The Local Media Credit Facility was amended on October 17, 2013 and on February 28, 2014. The October 17, 2013 amendment corrected a typographical mistake. The February 28, 2014 amendment provided that among other things, sales of real property collateral and reinvestment of the proceeds from such sales could only be made with the consent of the Local Media Credit Facility Administrative Agent, modified the properties included in the real property collateral, and set forth in detail the documentary post-closing requirements with respect to the real property collateral. The Local Media Credit Facility was paid in full on June 4, 2014.

Subsequent to the Restructuring, we entered into the New Media Credit Agreement. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Indebtedness” for more information.

Upon emergence from Chapter 11, we adopted fresh-start reporting in accordance with ASC Topic 852, “Reorganizations.” Under fresh-start accounting, a new entity is deemed to have been created on the Effective Date of the Plan for financial reporting purposes and GateHouse’s recorded amounts of assets and liabilities will be adjusted to reflect their estimated fair values. As a result of the adoption of fresh-start accounting, our reorganized company post-emergence financial statements will generally not be comparable with the financial statements of our Predecessor prior to emergence, including the historical financial information in this Prospectus. As a result of the adoption of fresh-start accounting, our reorganized company post-emergence financial statements are generally not comparable with the financial statements of our Predecessor prior to emergence, including the historical financial information in this Prospectus. See Note 2 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Voluntary Reorganization Under Chapter 11.”

New Media Warrants

On the Effective Date, New Media was deemed to have issued and distributed 1,362,479 10-year warrants (the “New Media Warrants”) to the former equity holders of GateHouse (the “Former Equity Holders”). The New Media Warrants collectively represent the right to acquire New Media Common Stock, which in the aggregate was equal to 5% of New Media Common Stock as of the Effective Date (calculated prior to dilution from shares of New Media Common Stock issued pursuant to the Local Media Contribution) at a strike price per share of $46.35 calculated based on a total equity value of New Media prior to the Local Media Contribution of $1.2 billion as of the Effective Date. Former equity interests were cancelled under the Plan. New Media Warrants

 

32


Table of Contents

will not have the benefit of antidilution protections, other than customary protections including for stock splits and stock dividends. The New Media Warrants expire on November 26, 2023. This description is a summary and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, the provisions of the Amended and Restated Warrant Agreement filed as Exhibit 10.35 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Spin-Off from Newcastle

On September 27, 2013, Newcastle announced that its board of directors unanimously approved a plan to spin-off our Company. Newcastle’s board of directors made the determination to spin-off our assets because it believes that our value could be increased over time through a strategy aimed at acquiring local media assets and organically growing our digital marketing business. In addition, Newcastle’s board of directors believed that our Company’s prospects would be enhanced by the ability to operate unfettered by REIT requirements. In order to effect the separation and spin-off of our Company, we filed a registration statement on Form S-1, as amended, which was declared effective by the SEC on January 30, 2014.

Each share of Newcastle common stock outstanding as of 5:00 PM, Eastern Time, on February 6, 2014, the Record Date, entitled the holder thereof to receive 0.07219481485 shares of our Common Stock . The spin-off was completed on February 13, 2014. Immediately thereafter, we became a publicly traded company independent from Newcastle trading on the NYSE under the ticker symbol “NEWM.”

 

33


Table of Contents

CERTAIN U.S. FEDERAL INCOME AND ESTATE TAX CONSIDERATIONS FOR

NON-U.S. HOLDERS OF OUR COMMON STOCK

The following is a discussion of certain U.S. federal income and estate tax considerations generally applicable to the ownership and disposition of our Common Stock by Non-U.S. Holders. For purposes of this section under the heading “Certain U.S. Federal Income and Estate Tax Considerations for Non-U.S. Holders of our Common Stock,” a “Non-U.S. Holder” means a beneficial owner of our Common Stock that is a nonresident alien individual, a foreign corporation, or any other person that is not subject to U.S. federal income tax on a net income basis in respect of such Common Stock.

This discussion deals only with Common Stock held as capital assets by Non-U.S. Holders who acquire Common Stock in this offering. This discussion does not cover all aspects of U.S. federal income taxation that may be relevant to the purchase, ownership or disposition of our Common Stock by investors in light of their specific facts and circumstances. In particular, this discussion does not address all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to persons in special tax situations, including persons that will hold our Common Stock in connection with a U.S. trade or business or a U.S. permanent establishment, certain former citizens or residents of the United States, and persons that are a “controlled foreign corporation,” a “passive foreign investment company” or a partnership or other pass-through entity for U.S. federal income tax purposes, or are otherwise subject to special treatment under the Internal Revenue Code (the “Code”). This section does not address any other U.S. federal tax considerations (such as gift tax) or any state, local or non-U.S. tax considerations. You should consult your own tax advisors about the tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and disposition of our Common Stock in light of your own particular circumstances, including the tax consequences under state, local, foreign and other tax laws and the possible effects of any changes in applicable tax laws.

Furthermore, this discussion is based upon on the Code, U.S. Treasury regulations, published administrative interpretations of the IRS, and judicial decisions, all of which are subject to differing interpretations or to change, possibly with retroactive effect. We have not sought any ruling from the IRS with respect to the statements made and the conclusions reached in this discussion, and there can be no assurance that the IRS will agree with such statements and conclusions.

Dividends

In the event that we make a distribution of cash or property with respect to our Common Stock, any such distributions generally will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. If a distribution exceeds our current and accumulated earnings and profits, the excess will be treated as a tax-free return of a Non-U.S. Holder’s investment, up to such Non-U.S. Holder’s tax basis in our Common Stock. Any remaining excess will be treated as capital gain, subject to the tax treatment described below in “—Sale, Exchange or Other Taxable Disposition of our Common Stock.”

Dividends paid to a Non-U.S. Holder generally will be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at a 30% rate, or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable tax treaty. Even if a Non-U.S. Holder is eligible for a lower treaty rate, we and other payors will generally be required to withhold at a 30% rate (rather than the lower treaty rate) on dividend payments to such Non-U.S. Holder, unless:

 

    such Non-U.S. Holder has furnished to us or such other payor a valid IRS Form W-8-BEN-E or other documentary evidence establishing its entitlement to the lower treaty rate with respect to such payments and neither we nor our paying agent (or other payor) have actual knowledge or reason to know to the contrary, and

 

   

in the case of actual or constructive dividends, if required by the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act or any intergovernmental agreement enacted pursuant to that law, such Non-U.S. Holder or any entity through which it receives such dividends have provided the withholding agent with certain information

 

34


Table of Contents
 

with respect to its or the entity’s direct and indirect U.S. owners, and if such Non-U.S. Holder holds our Common Stock through a foreign financial institution, such institution has entered into an agreement with the U.S. government to collect and provide to the U.S. tax authorities information about its accountholders (including certain investors in such institution or entity) and such Non-U.S. Holder has provided any required information to such institution.

If a Non-U.S. Holder is eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. federal withholding tax pursuant to an applicable income tax treaty or otherwise, it may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by timely filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS. Investors are encouraged to consult with their own tax advisors regarding the possible implications of these withholding requirements on their investment in our Common Stock.

Sale, Exchange or Other Taxable Disposition of our Common Stock

A Non-U.S. Holder generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax with respect to gain recognized on a sale, exchange or other taxable disposition of our Common Stock unless:

 

    in the case of an individual, such holder is present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of the sale, exchange or other taxable disposition, and certain other conditions are met, or

 

    we are or have been a United States real property holding corporation for federal income tax purposes and a Non-U.S. Holder held, directly or indirectly, at any time during the five-year period ending on the date of the disposition, more than 5% of our Common Stock.

In the case of the sale or disposition of our Common Stock on or after January 1, 2017, a Non-U.S. Holder may be subject to a 30% withholding tax on the gross proceeds of the sale or disposition unless the requirements described in the last bullet point under “—Dividends” above are satisfied. Investors are encouraged to consult with their own tax advisors regarding the possible implications of these withholding requirements on their investment in our Common Stock and the potential for a refund or credit in the case of any withholding tax.

We have not been, are not and do not anticipate becoming a United States real property holding corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

We must report annually to the IRS and to each Non-U.S. Holder the amount of dividends paid to such holder and the tax withheld with respect to such dividends, regardless of whether withholding was required. Copies of the information returns reporting such dividends and withholding may also be made available to the tax authorities in the country in which Non-U.S. Holders reside under the provisions of an applicable income tax treaty.

A Non-U.S. Holder may be subject to backup withholding for dividends paid to it unless it certifies under penalty of perjury that it is a Non-U.S. Holder or otherwise establish an exemption. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be allowed as a refund or a credit against such Non-U.S. Holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability provided the required information is timely furnished to the IRS.

U.S. Federal Estate Tax

Any Common Stock held (or deemed held) by an individual Non-U.S. Holder at the time of his or her death will be included in such Non-U.S. Holder’s gross estate for U.S. federal estate tax purposes, unless an applicable estate tax treaty provides otherwise.

 

35


Table of Contents

USE OF PROCEEDS

The net proceeds to us from this offering, after deducting underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us and giving effect to the sale of shares of our Common Stock to certain of our officers and directors and an officer of our Manager that will not be subject to underwriting discounts or commissions, will be approximately $100.0 million, or $114.9 million if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of Common Stock in full. We intend to use the proceeds from this offering for working capital and other general corporate purposes, which may include potential investments in, and acquisitions of, local media businesses and assets. Presently, we have no agreements with any potential acquisition parties. We have not yet determined the amount of net proceeds to be used specifically for any of the foregoing purposes. Accordingly, management will have broad discretion over the use of the net proceeds to us from this offering and investors will be relying on the judgment of our management regarding the application of these proceeds. Pending their use, we plan to invest the net proceeds to us from this offering in short term, interest bearing obligations, investment grade instruments, certificates of deposit or direct or guaranteed obligations of the U.S. government.

MARKET PRICE INFORMATION AND DIVIDENDS

Market Price Data

New Media Common Stock trades on the NYSE under the trading symbol “NEWM” since the spin-off from Newcastle. A “when-issued” trading market for New Media’s Common Stock on the NYSE began on February 4, 2014 and “regular-way” trading of New Media Common Stock began on February 14, 2014. Prior to February 4, 2014, there was no public market for New Media Common Stock. Set forth in the table below for the periods presented are the high and low sale prices for New Media Common Stock as reported on the NYSE.

 

     HIGH      LOW  

Fiscal Year Ending December 28, 2014:

     

First Quarter (since February 4, 2013)

   $ 15.65       $ 10.35   

Second Quarter

   $ 15.79       $ 12.89   

Third Quarter (through September 17, 2014)

   $ 17.95       $ 13.59   

From the most recent available Company information, on September 17, 2014 there were approximately 49 holders of record.

Dividends

New Media currently intends to distribute a substantial portion our free cash flow as a dividend to stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance, Board approval and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement. The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s GAAP net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results. On July 31, 2014, the Company announced a second quarter 2014 cash dividend of $0.27 per share of New Media Common Stock. The dividend was paid on August 21, 2014 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on August 12, 2014.

 

36


Table of Contents

CAPITALIZATION

The following table sets forth cash and cash equivalents and capitalization of New Media as of June 29, 2014 (i) on an actual basis, (ii) on a pro forma basis to give effect to the Pro Forma Adjustments and (iii) on a pro forma as adjusted basis to give effect to the Pro Forma Adjustments as well as the sale of 6,500,000 shares of Common Stock by us in this offering at a public offering price of $16.25 per share, after deducting the underwriting discount and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

This table should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements, Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, related notes and other financial information, including the unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information, included herein.

 

     As of June 29, 2014  
     Actual     Pro forma     Pro forma
as adjusted
 
     (in thousands, except share data)  

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31,347      $ 18,347      $ 118,359   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Debt:

      

New Media Credit Agreement(1)

     192,398        225,898        225,898   

Long-term liabilities, including current portion

     5,262        5,292        5,292   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long-term debt, including current portion

   $ 197,660      $ 231,190      $ 231,190   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity:

      

Common stock, $0.01 par value, 30,015,870, 30,015,870 and 36,515,870 shares issued and outstanding on an actual, pro forma and pro forma as adjusted basis, respectively

     300        300        365   

Additional paid-in-capital

     387,419        387,419        487,366   

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     458        458        458   

Retained earnings

     (2,754     (2,754     (2,754
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     385,423        385,423        485,435   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total capitalization

   $ 583,083      $ 616,613      $ 716,625   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) The New Media Credit Agreement provides for (i) a $200 million senior secured term facility and (ii) a $25 million senior secured revolving credit facility, with a $5 million sub-facility for letters of credit and a $5 million sub-facility for swing loans. In addition, the New Media Borrower may request one or more new commitments for term loans or revolving loans from time to time up to an aggregate total of $75 million subject to certain conditions.

 

37


Table of Contents

DILUTION

If you invest in our Common Stock, your ownership interest will be diluted to the extent of the difference between the public offering price per share of our Common Stock and the pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per share of our Common Stock upon consummation of this offering. Net tangible book value per share represents the book value of our total tangible assets less the book value of our total liabilities divided by the number of shares of Common Stock then issued and outstanding.

After giving effect to the Pro Forma Adjustments, our net pro forma net tangible book value as of June 29, 2014 would have been approximately $102,166,000, or approximately $3.40 per share, based on 30,015,870 shares of Common Stock issued and outstanding as of such date.

After giving effect to the Pro Forma Adjustments as well as the sale of 6,500,000 shares of Common Stock by us in this offering at a public offering price of $16.25 per share, our pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value as of June 29, 2014 would have been approximately $202,178,423, or approximately $5.54 per share. This represents an immediate and substantial dilution of $10.71 per share to new investors purchasing Common Stock in this offering. The following table illustrates this dilution per share:

 

Public offering price per share

      $ 16.25   

Pro forma net tangible book value per share as of June 29, 2014 after giving effect to the Pro Forma Adjustments but before giving effect this offering

   $ 3.40      

Increase in net tangible book value per share attributable to this offering

     2.14      
  

 

 

    

Pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per share after giving effect to the Pro Forma Adjustments as well as this offering

        5.54   
     

 

 

 

Dilution per share to new investors in this offering

      $ 10.71   
     

 

 

 

The following table summarizes, as of June 29, 2014 on a pro forma basis for the Pro Forma Adjustments as well as this offering, the differences between the number of shares of Common Stock received from us in the spin-off and the total price and the average price per share attributed to existing stockholders’ shares of Common Stock and paid by the new investors in this offering, before deducting the underwriting discounts and estimated offering expenses payable by us, at a public offering price of $16.25 per share.

 

     Shares Purchased     Total Consideration     Average
Price
per
Share
 
     Number      Percent     Amount      Percent    
     (in thousands)     

 

    (in thousands)     

 

       

Existing stockholders

     30,016         82.2     387,719         78.6   $ 12.92   

New investors

     6,500         17.8     105,625         21.4   $ 16.25   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

Total

     36,516         100.0     493,344         100.0  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of Common Stock in full, the pro forma as adjusted net tangible book value per share after this offering as of June 29, 2014 would be approximately $5.79 per share and the dilution to new investors per share after this offering would be $10.46 per share.

The pro forma information discussed above is for illustrative and informational purposes only. See “Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Information.”

 

38


Table of Contents

SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

The selected consolidated statement of operations data for New Media for the two months ended December 29, 2013, for GateHouse for the ten months ended November 6, 2013, for GateHouse for the year ended December 30, 2012 and for the year ended January 1, 2012 and the selected consolidated balance sheet data for New Media as of December 29, 2013 and for GateHouse as of December 30, 2012 have been derived from the Audited Consolidated Financial Statements of New Media and GateHouse, our Predecessor, included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected consolidated statement of operations data for GateHouse for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 and the selected consolidated balance sheet data for GateHouse as of January 1, 2012December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009 have been derived from GateHouse’s audited financial statements not included in this Prospectus. The selected financial data as of and for the combined year ended December 29, 2013, ten months ended November 6, 2013 and the years ended December 30, 2012January 1, 2012, December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2009 have been revised to reflect one of GateHouse’s publications as a discontinued operation for comparability.

The selected condensed consolidated statement of operations data for New Media for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and for GateHouse for the six months ended June 30, 2013 and the selected condensed consolidated balance sheet data for New Media as of June 29, 2014 have been derived from the Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements of New Media and GateHouse, our Predecessor, included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The selected consolidated balance sheet data for GateHouse as of June 30, 2013 has been derived from Gate House’s unaudited financial statements not included in this Prospectus.

Operating results for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 included the impact of our emergence from bankruptcy and adoption of fresh start accounting. The historical consolidated financial statements of our Predecessor are not comparable following its emergence from Chapter 11 due to the effects of the consummation of the Plan, as well as adjustments for fresh-start accounting. The data should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements, Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, related notes, Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations and other financial information included herein.

 

    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
         Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Six Months
Ended
June 29,
2014
         Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2013
         Two Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
(2)
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
    Year Ended
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2009
 
(in thousands, except per share data)                                                               

Statement of Operations Data:

                           

Revenues:

                           

Advertising

  $ 178,460          $ 150,559          $ 63,340          $ 265,078      $ 330,881      $ 357,134      $ 385,579      $ 398,927   

Circulation

    90,471            65,513            29,525            118,810        131,576        131,879        133,192        138,233   

Commercial printing and other

    31,535            14,107            10,366            29,402        26,097        25,657        25,967        30,960   
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    300,466            230,179            103,231            413,290        488,554        514,670        544,738        568,120   

Operating costs and expenses:

                           

Operating costs

    172,470            129,998            56,614            232,066        268,222        281,884        296,974        324,263   

Selling, general and administrative

    102,251            78,722            28,749            136,832        145,020        146,295        154,516        159,197   

Depreciation and amortization

    19,918            19,636            6,588            33,409        39,888        42,426        45,080        54,237   

Integration and reorganization costs

    837            958            1,758            1,577        4,393        5,884        2,324        1,857   

Impairment of long-lived assets

    —             —              —             91,599        —          1,733        430        193,041   

Loss (gain) on sale of assets

    687            1,043            27            1,163        1,238        455        1,551        (418

Goodwill and mastheads impairment

    —             —              —             —         —          385        —         273,914   
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

    4,303            (178         9,495            (83,356     29,793        35,608        43,863        (437,971

Interest expense, amortization of deferred financing costs, gain on early extinguishment of debt, (gain) loss on derivative instruments, reorganization items, net, and other

    17,330            30,425            1,798            (871,399     57,463        58,361        69,520        72,502   
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

    (13,027         (30,603         7,697            788,043        (27,670     (22,753     (25,657     (510,473

Income tax expense (benefit)

    (3,067         —              491            (197     (207     (1,803     (155     342   
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

    (9,960         (30,603         7,206            788,240        (27,463     (20,950     (25,502     (510,815

Loss from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

    —              (1,034         —               (1,034     (2,340     (699     (542     (19,287
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

    (9,960         (31,637         7,206            787,206        (29,803     (21,649     (26,044     (530,102
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

39


Table of Contents
    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
         Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Six Months
Ended
June 29,
2014
         Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2013
         Two Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
(2)
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
    Year Ended
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2009
 
(in thousands, except per share data)                                                               

Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

    —              —              —             208        —          —         —         —    
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to New Media

  $ (9,960       $ (31,637       $ 7,206          $ 787,414      $ (29,803   $ (21,649   $ (26,044   $ (530,102
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic net income (loss) from continuing operations attributable to New Media per share

  $ (0.33       $ (0.53       $ 0.24          $ 13.58      $ (0.47   $ (0.36   $ (0.46   $ (8.93

Diluted income (loss) from continuing operations attributable to New Media per share

  $ (0.33       $ (0.53       $ 0.24          $ 13.58      $ (0.47   $ (0.36   $ (0.46   $ (8.93

Basic net income (loss) attributable to New Media common stockholders per share

  $ (0.33       $ (0.54       $ 0.24          $ 13.56      $ (0.51   $ (0.37   $ (0.45   $ (9.24

Diluted net income (loss) attributable to New Media common stockholders per share

  $ (0.33       $ (0.54       $ 0.24          $ 13.56      $ (0.51   $ (0.37   $ (0.45   $ (9.24

Other Data:

                           

Adjusted EBITDA(1)

  $ 24,379          $ 18,450          $ 16,096          $ 988,265      $ 69,766      $ 80,547      $ 89,511      $ 82,571   

Cash interest paid

  $ 7,238          $ 7,403          $ 925          $ 43,606      $ 55,976      $ 58,225      $ 59,317      $ 67,950   

 

(1) We define Adjusted EBITDA as net income (loss) from continuing operations before income tax expense (benefit), interest/financing expense, depreciation and amortization and non-cash impairments. Adjusted EBITDA is not a measurement of financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered in isolation or as an alternative to income from operations, net income (loss), cash flow from continuing operating activities or any other measure of performance or liquidity derived in accordance with GAAP. We believe this non-GAAP measure, as we have defined it, is helpful in identifying trends in our day-to-day performance because the items excluded have little or no significance in our day-to-day operations. This measure provides an assessment of controllable expenses and affords management the ability to make decisions which are expected to facilitate meeting current financial goals as well as achieve optimal financial performance. Adjusted EBITDA provides an indicator for management to determine if adjustments to current spending decisions are needed.

Adjusted EBITDA provides us with a measure of financial performance, independent of items that are beyond the control of management in the short-term, such as depreciation and amortization, taxation and interest expense associated with our capital structure. This metric measures our financial performance based on operational factors that management can impact in the short-term, namely our cost structure or expenses of the organization. Adjusted EBITDA is one of the metrics used by senior management and the board of directors to review the financial performance of our business on a monthly basis.

Not all companies calculate Adjusted EBITDA using the same methods; therefore, the Adjusted EBITDA figures set forth herein may not be comparable to Adjusted EBITDA reported by other companies. A substantial portion of our Adjusted EBITDA must be dedicated to the payment of interest on our outstanding indebtedness and to service other commitments, thereby reducing the funds available to us for other purposes. Accordingly, Adjusted EBITDA does not represent an amount of funds that is available for management’s discretionary use. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Adjusted EBITDA.”

 

(2) The year ended December 30, 2012 included a 53rd week of operations for approximately 60% of the business.

 

40


Table of Contents

The table below shows the reconciliation of income (loss) from continuing operations to Adjusted EBITDA for the periods presented:

 

    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
        Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Six months
ended
June 29,
2014
         Six months
ended
June 30,
2013
        Two Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
(3)
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
    Year Ended
December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31,
2009
 
(in thousands)                                                              

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  $ (9,960       $ (30,603     $ 7,206          $ 788,240      $ (27,463   $ (20,950   $ (25,502   $ (510,815

Income tax expense (benefit)

    (3,067         —           491            (197     (207     (1,803     (155     342   

Loss (gain) on derivative instruments(1)

    51            9          —             14        (1,635     (913     8,277        12,672   

Gain on early extinguishment of debt (2)

    9,047            —           —             —         —         —          —          (7,538

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    758            522          171            842        1,255        1,360        1,360        1,360   

Write-off of financing costs

    —                  —             —         —         —          —         743   

Interest expense

    7,632            28,886          1,640            74,358        57,928        58,309        60,021        64,615   

Impairment of long-lived assets

    —                  —             91,599        —         1,733        430        193,041   

Depreciation and amortization

    19,918            19,636          6,588            33,409        39,888        42,426        45,080        54,237   

Goodwill and mastheads impairment

    —              —           —             —         —         385        —         273,914   
 

 

 

       

 

 

     

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA from continuing operations

  $ 24,379 (a)        $ 18,450 (b)      $ 16,096 (c)        $ 988,265 (d)    $ 69,766 (e)    $ 80,547 (f)    $ 89,511 (g)    $ 82,571 (h) 
 

 

 

       

 

 

     

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a)  Adjusted EBITDA for the six months ended June 29, 2014 included net expenses of $8,985, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $8,985 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $7,461, integration and reorganization costs of $837 and a $687 loss on the sale of assets.
(b)  Adjusted EBITDA for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included net expenses of $7,949, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $7,949 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $6,376, non-cash portion of postretirement benefits expense of $(428), integration and reorganization costs of $958 and a $1,043 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $123 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(c)  Adjusted EBITDA for the two months ended December 29, 2013 included net expenses of $4,828, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $4,828 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $3,043, integration and reorganization costs of $1,758 and a $27 loss on the sale of assets.
(d)  Adjusted EBITDA for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 included net income of $(930,229), which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $(930,229) are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $(932,969), integration and reorganization costs of $1,577 and a $1,163 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $123 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(e)  Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 30, 2012 included net expenses of $11,264, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $11,264 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $5,378, integration and reorganization costs of $4,393 and a $1,238 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $255 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(f)  Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended January 1, 2012 included net expenses of $10,565, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $10,565 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $4,226, integration and reorganization costs of $5,884 and a $455 loss on the sale of assets.

 

41


Table of Contents

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $432 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(g)  Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2010 included net expenses of $8,880, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $8,880 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $5,005, integration and reorganization costs of $2,324 and a $1,551 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $463 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(h)  Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2009 included net expenses of $10,071, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $10,071 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $8,632, integration and reorganization costs of $1,857 and a $418 gain on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $(855) of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(1)  Non-cash (gain) loss on derivative instruments is related to interest rate swap agreements which are financing related and are excluded from Adjusted EBITDA.

 

(2)  Non-cash write-off of deferred financing costs are similar to interest expense and amortization of financing fees and are excluded from Adjusted EBITDA.

 

(3)  The year ended December 30, 2012 included a 53rd week of operations for approximately 60% of the business.

 

    As of  
    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
         Successor
Company
        

 

    Predecessor Company  
    June 29,
2014
         June 30,
2013
         December 29,
2013
         December 30,
2012
    January 1,
2012
    December 31,
2010
    December 31,
2009
 
(in thousands)                                                         

Balance Sheet Data:

                         

Total assets

  $ 670,543          $ 433,704          $ 689,953          $ 469,766      $ 510,802      $ 546,327      $ 591,929   

Total long-term obligations, including current maturities

    197,660            1,170,220            187,119            1,177,298        1,185,212        1,197,347        1,222,102   

Stockholders’ equity (deficit)

    385,423            (848,855         395,362            (834,159     (805,632     (792,121     (753,576

 

42


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED COMBINED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

The following unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet as of June 29, 2014 and the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and for the year ended December 29, 2013 are based on (i) the audited consolidated financial statements of New Media known as the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013 and the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 (ii) the unaudited consolidated financial statements of New Media as of and for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and (iii) the consolidated financial statements of The Providence Journal Company (“Providence Journal”) as of and for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and for the year ended December 31, 2013, each included in this Prospectus.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and for the year ended December 29, 2013 gives effect to the Pro Forma Transactions (as defined below) as if the Pro Forma Transactions had occurred or had become effective as of December 31, 2012 (beginning of our fiscal year 2013). The unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet as of June 29, 2014 gives effect to the Pro Forma Transactions as if they had occurred on June 29, 2014. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information excludes the effects of this offering.

The pro forma financial information is provided for informational and illustrative purposes only and should be read in conjunction with “Use of Proceeds,” “Capitalization,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” New Media’s historical financial statements and related notes thereto, including Predecessor GateHouse’s historical consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, Local Media’s historical combined financial statements and notes thereto, and Providence Journal’s historical consolidated financial statements and notes thereto, each included elsewhere in this Prospectus.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information has been prepared to reflect adjustments to our historical consolidated financial information that are (i) directly attributable to the Pro Forma Transactions, (ii) factually supportable and (iii) with respect to the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations, expected to have a continuing impact on our results.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information reflects the following Pro Forma Transactions:

 

    commencing from the date of the Listing, New Media’s management and incentive fee payable to the Manager by us;

 

    adoption of fresh-start accounting by GateHouse in accordance with ASC 852, upon confirmation of the Plan;

 

    cancellation of our Predecessor’s 2007 Credit Facility and related interest rate swaps in exchange for New Media Common Stock pursuant to the Plan and entry into the GateHouse Credit Facilities;

 

    impact of Local Media purchase accounting adjustments, in accordance with ASC 805, as a result of GateHouse consolidation of Local Media beginning on September 3, 2013 and Newcastle’s contribution of 100% common stock of Local Media Parent to New Media in exchange for New Media Common Stock pursuant to the Plan;

 

    payment of GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility in full and entering into the New Media Credit Agreement; and

 

    impact of Providence Journal purchase accounting adjustments, in accordance with ASC 805, and the incremental financing under the New Media Credit Agreement in connection with New Media’s acquisition.

The impact of adoption of fresh-start accounting, cancellation of Predecessor 2007 Credit Facility, refinancing of GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility and acquisition of Local Media are already reflected in the Company’s historical consolidated balance sheet as of June 29, 2014 and the impact of

 

43


Table of Contents

adoption of fresh-start accounting and acquisition of Local Media are already reflected in the historical consolidated statement of operations of New Media for the six months ended June 29, 2014; accordingly, no pro forma adjustment has been made to these financial statements as the impact of such transactions is included in our respective historical financial information.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations for the year-ended December 29, 2013 excludes approximately $947.6 million of non-recurring charges that the Company incurred in connection with certain Pro Forma Transactions, including reorganization gain on the extinguishment of debt, gain on fresh-start accounting and other reorganization expenses.

Each of the transactions reflected in the adjustments is described in more detail below.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information is included for illustrative and informational purposes only and does not purport to reflect our results of operations or financial condition had the pro forma transactions occurred at an earlier date. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information also should not be considered representative of our future financial condition or results of operations.

GateHouse Effects of Plan and Fresh-Start and Other Adjustments

New Media had no operations until November 26, 2013, when it assumed control of GateHouse and Local Media. GateHouse was determined to be the Predecessor to New Media, as the operations of GateHouse comprise substantially all of the business operations of the combined entities. On September 27, 2013, our Predecessor filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code. On November 6, 2013 (the “Confirmation Date”) the Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Plan. Our Predecessor effected the transactions contemplated by the Plan and emerged from Chapter 11 protection on the Effective Date.

Upon confirmation of the Plan by the Bankruptcy Court on November 6, 2013, New Media adopted fresh start accounting. Under fresh start accounting, a new entity is deemed to have been created for financial reporting purposes and the Predecessor’s recorded amounts of assets and liabilities were adjusted to reflect their estimated fair values. As a result of the adoption of fresh start accounting, New Media’s reorganized company post-emergence financial statements is generally not comparable with the financial statements of the Predecessor prior to November 6, 2013.

The Plan discharged claims and interests against our Predecessor primarily through the (a) issuance of New Media Common Stock, (b) Newcastle’s contribution of 100% common stock of Local Media Parent to New Media in exchange for New Media Common Stock, (c) reinstatement of certain claims, and (d) issuance of the New Media Warrants to the Former Equity Holders in our Predecessor. See Note 3 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Fresh Start Accounting.”

On November 26, 2013, GateHouse entered into the Gatehouse Credit Facilities. Pursuant to the Plan, but not a condition to the effectiveness of the Plan, holders of the 2007 Credit Facility and related interest rate swaps outstanding debt who elected to receive New Media Common Stock received their pro rata share of the Net Proceeds. The Net Proceeds distributed to these holders totaled $149.0 million. The GateHouse Credit Facilities were subsequently refinanced on June 4, 2014. See following section “New Media Refinancing Adjustments”.

On the Effective Date, New Media entered into the Management Agreement pursuant to which the Manager will manage the operations of New Media. Commencing from the Listing, New Media will pay its Manager a management fee equal to 1.5% of New Media’s Total Equity (as defined in the Management Agreement) and the Manager is eligible to receive incentive compensation.

The effects of the Plan, adoption of fresh start accounting and entry into the GateHouse Credit Facilities and Management Agreement are collectively referred to as the Restructuring.

 

44


Table of Contents

The Restructuring transactions are reflected in the audited financial statements of New Media as of the Confirmation Date and November 26, 2013 for the GateHouse Credit Facilities. As such, the historical consolidated balance sheet reflects these transactions. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations combines the Predecessor ten months ended November 6, 2013 and the Successor, New Media, two months ended December 29, 2013. The Successor two months ended December 29, 2013 reflects the effects of the Restructuring. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations gives effect to the Restructuring for the Predecessor period as if the Restructuring had occurred on December 31, 2012.

The “GateHouse Effects of Plan and Fresh-Start and Other Adjustments” column in the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations gives effect to the following: (i) the termination of the 2007 Credit Facility and related interest rate swap and (ii) the revised depreciation and amortization expense due to the revaluation of the tangible and intangible assets upon the application of fresh-start accounting by GateHouse, in accordance with ASC 852. The reorganization gain resulting from the extinguishment of the prepetition debt pursuant to the Plan, gain on fresh-start accounting, and other reorganization expenses were approximately $947.6 million. The reorganization gain and other reorganization expenses is eliminated in the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations as the reorganization gains and expenses are non-recurring. The “GateHouse Effects of Plan and Fresh-Start and Other Adjustments” column also includes the Company’s entry into the GateHouse Credit Facilities and Management Agreement as though not directly an element of the Plan, they are components of the overall restructuring.

For additional information regarding the “GateHouse Effects of Plan Adjustments and Fresh-Start and Other Adjustments,” see the notes to the pro forma financial information.

Local Media Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments

On September 3, 2013, Newcastle completed the acquisition of Local Media from News Corp. At that time, the Local Media operations were managed by GateHouse, pursuant to a management and advisory agreement. As a result of this agreement, management determined that Local Media was a variable interest entity and that GateHouse was the primary beneficiary because it had both the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic performance of Local Media and it participated in the residual returns of Local Media that could be significant to Local Media. Because GateHouse was the primary beneficiary, it consolidated Local Media beginning September 3, 2013.

As part of the Plan, Newcastle agreed to contribute 100% of the stock of Local Media Parent to New Media. Following the Restructuring, the Company accounted for the consolidation of Local Media under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with ASC 805 as New Media obtained a controlling financial interest in Local Media. Accordingly, the assets acquired and liabilities assumed were recorded at their acquisition date fair values. Such acquisition value was not materially different from the acquisition value allocated upon GateHouse’s consolidation of Local Media in accordance with ASC 805 on September 3, 2013.

As Local Media was consolidated in GateHouse historical results beginning on September 3, 2013, the pro forma adjustments are only for the period from December 31, 2012 through September 2, 2013. These adjustments are included in a separate column labeled as “Local Media Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments” to reflect the purchase accounting impact on depreciation, amortization and interest expense as if the purchase accounting occurred as of December 31, 2012.

Local Media’s fiscal year ends on the last Sunday in June. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statements of operations were created with a year end on the last Sunday in December, which is consistent with the historical consolidated financial statements of GateHouse. Local Media results from September 3, 2013 are included in the historical GateHouse results of operations. The historical results of Local Media for the eight months ended September 2, 2013 were derived by taking the historical results of operations of Local Media for

 

45


Table of Contents

the year ended June 30, 2013, and subtracting Local Media’s historical results of operations for the six months ended December 30, 2012, and adding the two months of historical results of operations from July 1, 2013 to September 2, 2013.

See Note 4 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Local Media Acquisition.”

To conform the fiscal periods of Local Media’s historical combined financial statements to that of New Media, the following amounts were excluded from the pro forma financial information. Local Media had revenue of $28,320 and net income of $1,505 for the two month period from July 1, 2013 to September 2, 2013.

 

     Local Media’s Fiscal Year
Ended
June 30, 2013
 
     Excluded from the
Year Ended
December 29, 2013
 

Revenues

   $ 83,345   

Income from continuing operations

   $ 11,913   

New Media Refinancing Adjustments

On June 4, 2014, New Media entered the New Media Credit Agreement which provides for (i) the Term Loan Facility and (ii) the Revolving Credit Facility. The Term Loan Facility matures on June 4, 2020 and the maturity date for the Revolving Credit Facility is June 4, 2019. In addition, New Media may request one or more new commitments for term loans or revolving loans from time to time up to an aggregate total of $75,000.

The proceeds of the New Media Credit Agreement, which included a $6,725 original issue discount, were used to repay in full all amounts outstanding under the GateHouse Credit Facilities, the Local Media Credit Facility and to pay fees associated with the financing, with the balance going to the Company for general corporate purposes.

One lender under the New Media Credit Agreement was also a lender under the GateHouse Credit Facilities. This portion of the transaction was accounted for as a modification under ASC Topic 470-50, “Debt Modifications and Extinguishments” (“ASC 470-50”), as the difference between the present value of the cash flows under the New Media Credit Agreement and the present value of the cash flows under the GateHouse Credit Facilities was less than 10%. The unamortized deferred financing costs and original issuance discount balances as of the refinance date pertaining to this lender’s portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities will be amortized over the terms of the new facility. The remaining portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities and the Local Media Credit Facility debt refinancing constituted an extinguishment of debt under ASC 470-50, and was accounted for accordingly.

The refinancing related adjustments are reflected in the unaudited financial statements of New Media as of June 29, 2014. As such, the historical consolidated balance sheet reflects this transaction. Adjustments to the statement of operations related to the refinancing are in a separate column titled “New Media Refinancing Adjustments” to reflect the impact on interest expense and amortization of deferred financing costs as if the refinancing occurred as of December 31, 2012.

See Note 7 to New Media’s Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Indebtedness.”

Providence Journal Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments

On September 3, 2014, New Media completed its acquisition of the assets of The Providence Journal Company. The “Providence Journal Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments” column of the pro forma financial information gives effect to preliminary purchase accounting adjustments in accordance with ASC 805.

 

46


Table of Contents

The Providence Journal acquisition was financed with $9.0 million of revolving debt that will mature on June 4, 2019, $25.0 million of additional term debt under the New Media Credit Agreement that will mature on June 4, 2020 and $13.0 million of cash. The revolving debt has an interest rate of LIBOR plus 5.25% and the term loan has an interest rate of LIBOR, or minimum of 1%, plus 6.25%. Financing costs of $0.5 million and original issue discount of $0.5 million were incurred related to the consummation of this debt. The purchase price of approximately $46.0 million will be allocated to the fair value of the net assets acquired and any excess value over the tangible and identifiable intangible assets will be recorded as goodwill.

The Company obtained a third party independent valuation to assist in the determination of the fair values of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets. The property, plant and equipment valuation includes an analysis of recent comparable sales and offerings of land parcels in each of the subject’s markets. The estimated fair value is supported by the consideration to be paid and was determined using standard generally accepted appraisal practices and valuation procedures. The valuation firm used the three basic approaches to value: the cost approach (used for equipment where an active secondary market is not available and building improvements), the direct sales comparison (market) approach (used for land and equipment where an active secondary market is available) and the income approach (used for intangible assets). These approaches used are based on the cost to reproduce assets, market exchanges for comparable assets and the capitalization of income. Useful lives range from 1 to 5 years for personal property and 7 to 19 years for real property.

The valuation utilized a relief from royalty method, an income approach, to determine the fair value of mastheads. Key assumptions utilized in this valuation include revenue projections, a royalty rate of 1.5%, a long term growth rate of 0.0%, a tax rate of 39.2% and a discount rate of 24.0%. The Company valued the following intangible assets using the income approach, specifically the excess earnings method: subscriber relationships, advertiser relationships and customer relationships. In determining the fair value of these intangible assets, the excess earnings approach values the intangible asset at the present value of the incremental after-tax cash flows attributable only to the asset after deducting contributory asset charges. The incremental after-tax cash flows attributable to the subject intangible asset are then discounted to their present value. A static pool approach using historical attrition rates was used to estimate attrition rates of 3.0% to 10.0% for advertiser relationships, subscriber relationships and customer relationships. The long term growth rate was estimated to be 0.0% and the discount rate was estimated at 24.5%. Amortizable lives range from 14 to 17 years for subscriber relationships, advertiser relationships and customer relationships, while mastheads are considered a non-amortizable intangible asset.

The valuations used in this Prospectus represent current estimates based on data available. However, updates to these valuations will be completed as of the acquisition date based on the results of asset and liability valuations, as well as the related calculation of deferred income taxes. The differences between the actual valuations and the current estimated valuations used in preparing the pro forma financial information may be material and will be reflected in our future balance sheets and may affect amounts, including depreciation and amortization expense, which we will recognize in our statement of operations post acquisition. As such, the pro forma financial information may not accurately represent our post acquisition financial condition or results from operations and any differences may be material.

 

47


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Statements of Operations

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

    Year Ended December 29, 2013  
    New Media
Historical
Two

Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
    GateHouse
Predecessor
Ten

Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    GateHouse
Effects of
Plan, Fresh
Start and
Other
Adjustments
    Local
Media
Historical
September 2,
2013
    Local Media
Purchase
Accounting
and Other
Adjustments
    New Media
Refinancing
Adjustments
    Providence
Journal
Historical
December 31,
2013
    Providence
Journal
Purchase
Accounting
and Other
Adjustments
    Pro Forma
Year
Ended
December 29,
2013
 

Revenues:

                 

Advertising

  $ 63,340      $ 265,078        $ 52,308          $ 41,015        $ 421,741   

Circulation

    29,525        118,810          33,855            34,042          216,232   

Commercial printing and other

    10,366        29,402          17,372            15,012          72,152   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    103,231        413,290        —          103,535        —          —          90,069        —          710,125   

Operating costs and expenses:

                 

Operating costs

    56,614        232,066          93,358        (34,131 )(h)        80,024        (32,616 )(n)      395,315   

Selling, general, and administrative

    28,749        136,832        (2,428 )(a,f)        34,131 (h)          32,616 (n)      229,900   

Depreciation and amortization

    6,588        33,409        (8,058 )(b)      5,351        2,195 (i)        7,872        (1,385 )(o)      45,972   

Integration and reorganization costs

    1,758        1,577                    3,335   

Impairment of long-lived and intangible assets

    —          91,599          42,268                133,867   

Loss on sale of assets

    27        1,163                    1,190   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

    9,495        (83,356     10,486        (37,442     (2,195     —          2,173        1,385        (99,454

Interest expense

    1,640        74,358        (73,988 )(c)        1,656 (j)      12,108 (l)        2,386 (p)      18,160   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    171        842        (754 )(d)        284 (j)      56 (m)        83 (p)      682   

Loss on derivative instruments

    —          14        (14 )(e)                —     

Other (income) expense

    (13     1,004                (256       735   

Reorganization items, net

    —          (947,617     947,617 (f)                —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

    7,697        788,043        (862,375     (37,442     (4,135     (12,164     2,429        (1,084     (119,031

Income tax expense

    491        (197     (26,382 )(q)      (13,742     (2,535 )(q)      (4,762 )(q)      1,269 (q)      (742 )(q)      (46,600
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  $ 7,206      $ 788,240      $ (835,993   $ (23,700   $ (1,600   $ (7,402   $ 1,160      $ (342   $ (72,431
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss per share:

                 

Basic and diluted:

                 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  $ 0.24                    $ (2.41 )(g) 

Basic weighted average shares outstanding

    30,000,000                      30,000,000   

Diluted weighted average shares outstanding

    30,000,000                      30,000,000   

 

48


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Statements of Operations

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

    Six Months Ended June 29, 2014  
    New Media
Historical
June 29, 2014
    New Media
Refinancing
Adjustments
         Providence
Journal
June 30, 2014
    Providence Journal
Purchase Accounting
and Other
Adjustments
    Pro Forma
June 29, 2014
 

Revenues:

            

Advertising

  $ 178,460           $ 18,975        $ 197,435   

Circulation

    90,471             16,844          107,315   

Commercial printing and other

    31,535             7,693          39,228   
 

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    300,466        —             43,512        —          343,978   

Operating costs and expenses:

            

Operating costs

    172,470             37,935        (13,802 )(n)      196,603   

Selling, general, and administrative

    102,251        (1,078   (a,k)        13,802  (n)      114,975   

Depreciation and amortization

    19,918             3,599        (356 )(o)      23,161   

Integration and reorganization costs

    837                 837   

(Gain) loss on sale of assets

    687                 687   
 

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating loss

    4,303        1,078           1,978        356        7,715   

Interest expense

    7,632        255      (l)        1,194  (p)      9,081   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    758        (459   (m)        42  (p)      341   

Loss on early extinguishment of debt

    9,047        (9,047   (k)          —     

(Gain) loss on derivative instruments

    51        (51   (m)          —     

Other (income) expense

    (158          55          (103
 

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

    (13,027     10,380           1,923        (880     (1,604

Income tax benefit

    (3,067     2,031      (q)      827        (419 ) (q)      (628
 

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss from continuing operations

  $ (9,960   $ 8,349         $ 1,096      $ (461     (976
 

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss per share:

            

Basic and diluted:

            

Loss from continuing operations

  $ (0.33            $ (0.03 )(g) 

Basic weighted average shares outstanding

    30,000,000                 30,000,000   

Diluted weighted average shares outstanding

    30,000,000                 30,000,000   

 

Plan Adjustments, Fresh-Start and Other Adjustments

 

a. Commencing from the Listing, we pay our Manager a management fee equal to 1.5% per annum of Total Equity calculated and payable monthly in arrears in cash. Total Equity is generally the equity transferred by Newcastle to the Company upon Listing, plus total net proceeds from any equity capital raised (including through stock offerings), plus certain capital contributions to subsidiaries, plus the equity value of assets transferred to the Company prior to or after the date of the Management Agreement, less capital dividends and capital distributions. In addition to the management fee and commencing from the Listing, our Manager is eligible to receive on a quarterly basis annual incentive compensation in an amount equal to the product of 25.0% of the dollar amount by which (a) the adjusted net income of the Company exceeds (b)(i) the weighted daily average Total Equity (plus cash capital raising costs), multiplied by (ii) a simple interest rate of 10.0% per annum.

 

49


Table of Contents

This adjustment reflects the impact of the management fee and is calculated based on the pro forma financial information. For purposes of the pro forma, the equity value of $390.4 million, which is equal to the equity transferred by Newcastle to the Company upon Listing, is utilized and resulted in a management fee of $5.9 million for the year ended December 29, 2013. An adjustment of $0.7 million is included for the six months ended June 29, 2014 to reflect the pro forma impact of the management fee from the beginning of the year to the Listing date, refer to table below:

 

     Six months ended
June 29,
2014
 

Total Equity

   $ 390,449   
  

 

 

 

Base management fee of 1.5%

     2,928   

Elimination of historical management fee

     (2,229
  

 

 

 

Management fee adjustment

   $ 699   
  

 

 

 

The adjusted net loss, which excludes depreciation and amortization and adjusts for cash taxes, was $73.1 million for the year ended December 29, 2013 resulted in no incentive compensation for the year. The table below sets forth the calculation of the incentive compensation:

 

     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

New Media pro forma net loss

   $ (72,431 )

Plus: income taxes

     (46,600 )

Plus: depreciation and amortization

     45,972   

Less: cash taxes

     —    
  

 

 

 

Adjusted net loss

     (73,059 )

10% of Total Equity

     39,045   
  

 

 

 

Adjusted net income less 10% of Total Equity

     —    
  

 

 

 

Incentive compensation at 25% of the excess of adjusted net income over 10% of Total Equity

   $ —    
  

 

 

 

No incentive compensation is included in the pro forma statement of operations for the six months ended June 29, 2014.

 

b. This adjustment reflects the adoption of fresh start accounting resulting in the revaluation of the tangible and intangible assets. The fair value of Predecessor GateHouse’s property, plant and equipment exceeded its carrying value by approximately $97.5 million and its intangible assets carrying value exceeded its fair value by approximately $33.3 million. This adjustment eliminates the historical depreciation and amortization expense and records the incremental ten months of depreciation and amortization based on the fair values determined as of the Confirmation Date. Refer to the audited consolidated financial statements of New Media for the year ended December 29, 2013 for additional information on the useful lives and fair value disclosures.

The following tables provide the details on the depreciation and amortization adjustments:

 

     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

Incremental ten months Successor GateHouse depreciation

   $ 18,211   

Elimination of Predecessor GateHouse depreciation*

     (13,266 )
  

 

 

 

Total increase in depreciation adjustment

   $ 4,945   
  

 

 

 

 

50


Table of Contents
     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

Incremental ten months Successor GateHouse amortization

   $ 5,243   

Elimination of Predecessor GateHouse amortization

     (18,246 )
  

 

 

 

Total decrease in amortization adjustment

   $ (13,003 )  
  

 

 

 

 

  * Excludes $1.9 million of depreciation expense for Local Media Predecessor included in the column “GateHouse Predecessor ten months ended November 6, 2013 from date of acquisition (September 3, 2013) through November 6, 2013. See Note i for depreciation adjustment related to Local Media.

 

c. The Restructuring provided for substantial changes to our debt structure as of November 26, 2013. This adjustment eliminates the Predecessor GateHouse interest expense of approximately $74.0 million, excluding $0.4 million of interest expense for Local Media Predecessor included in the column “GateHouse Predecessor ten months ended November 6, 2013 from acquisition date (September 3, 2013) through November 6, 2013.

 

d. The pro forma impact associated with the extinguishment of the 2007 Credit Facility is $0.8 million, which excludes $0.1 million for Local Media Predecessor included in the column “GateHouse Predecessor ten months ended November 6, 2013 from acquisition date (September 3, 2013) through November 6, 2013, is eliminated by this adjustment.

 

e. The Restructuring of the debt eliminated the derivative instruments that are secured pursuant to the 2007 Credit Facility. As a result, this adjustment eliminates any gain or loss on these instruments included in the column “GateHouse Predecessor ten months ended November 6, 2013.”

 

f. Reflects the elimination of our bankruptcy-related reorganization expenses of $8.3 million, which were recorded as a selling, general, and administrative expense, and reorganization items incurred during Chapter 11 of $947.6 million as follows:

 

     Predecessor
Company
 

Write-off of predecessor deferred financing fees

   $ 948   

Credit agreement amendment fees

     6,790   

Bankruptcy fees

     11,643   

Net gain on reorganization adjustments

     (722,796

Net gain on fresh start adjustments

     (246,243

Adjustment to the allowed claim for derivative instruments

     2,041   
  

 

 

 

Total reorganization items

     (947,617
  

 

 

 

 

g. Our Predecessor’s equity interests outstanding were cancelled pursuant to the Plan and New Media issued shares of Common Stock with a par value of $0.01 per share. The number of shares used to compute pro forma basic and diluted loss per share is 30,000,000 which is the number of weighted average shares outstanding as of June 29, 2014. The pro forma basic and diluted loss per share for the year ended December 29, 2013 is estimated to be $2.41 and the pro forma basic and diluted loss per share for the six months ended June 29, 2014 is estimated to be $0.03.

 

     Year ended
December 29, 2013
 

Pro forma net loss

   $ (72,431 )

New Media Common Stock outstanding

     30,000   
  

 

 

 

Pro forma loss per share (amounts in dollars)

   $ (2.41 )  

 

51


Table of Contents
     Six months ended
June 29, 2014
 

Pro forma net loss

   $ (976 )

New Media Common Stock outstanding

     30,000   
  

 

 

 

Pro forma loss per share (amounts in dollars)

   $ (0.03 )  

We did not include any potential shares issuable upon exercise of the New Media Warrants or unvested restricted share grants in the diluted loss per share calculation as their effect would have been anti-dilutive to the per share calculations. See Note 3 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Fresh Start Accounting.”

Local Media Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments

 

h. Historical results for Local Media reported operating expense, which includes both operating and selling, Local Media Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments general and administrative expenses. This adjustment allocates expense to both categories to conform to our statement of operations classification.

 

i. Upon the acquisition, the purchase price of Local Media was allocated to the fair value of its assets and liabilities. The fair value of its property, plant and equipment exceeded its carrying value as of the acquisition date by approximately $9.4 million. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of operations reflects the depreciation adjustment based on the fair value. The pro forma adjustment to depreciation expense includes an increase of $2.2 million for the year ended December 29, 2013. No adjustment was made for amortization expense as the fair value change was minimal. See Note 4 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Local Media Acquisition.”

 

j. The financing of the Local Media Acquisition included $33.0 million of debt, which matures in September 2018 and has an interest rate of LIBOR, or minimum of 1.00%, plus 6.50%. Financing costs of $1.9 million were incurred related to this financing and are amortized over the five year term. This adjustment estimates the impact of interest expense and the amortization of deferred financing costs for Local Media. Every 1/8 of a percent change in LIBOR, after the 1.0% minimum is exceeded, would result in a $41,000 change in annual interest expense.

The following table provides the interest expense and financing fee amortization.

 

     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

Interest expense on Local Media financing at 7.50%

   $ 1,656   

Deferred financing fees amortized over 5 years

   $ 284   

New Media Refinancing Adjustments

 

k. As part of the debt refinancing, $1.8 million of third party fees associated with the modified debt did not meet capitalization requirements and were expense as incurred during the six months ended June 29, 2014. Additionally, a loss of $9.0 million was recognized on the extinguishment of the debt. This adjustment eliminates the impact of these nonrecurring items.

 

l. The debt refinancing and entering into the New Media Credit Agreement will result in a net increase to the interest expense of $12.1 million for the year ended December 29, 2013. This includes the annual amortization of the additional original issuance discount of $6.7 million from the New Media Credit Agreement as well as approximately $0.9 million of original issuance discount related to the modification of the GateHouse Credit Facilities in relation to the lender under both agreements. The $7.6 million of original issue discount will be amortized over the 6 year term of the New Media Credit Agreement.

For the six months ended June 29, 2014, the debt refinancing will result in a $0.3 million increase in interest expense.

 

52


Table of Contents

The tables below provide the calculation of the pro forma interest expense:

 

     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

Full year interest expense on New Media Term Loan Facility at 7.25%

   $ 14,500   

Full year original issuance discount accretion on New Media Term Loan Facility

     1,274   

Elimination of GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility interest expense

     (3,666 )
  

 

 

 

Total increase to interest expense adjustment

   $ 12,108   
  

 

 

 

 

     Six months ended
June 29,
2014
 

Six months interest expense on New Media Term Loan Facility at 7.25%

   $ 7,250   

Six months original issuance discount accretion on New Media Term Loan Facility

     637   

Elimination of GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility interest expense

     (7,632 )
  

 

 

 

Total increase to interest expense adjustment

   $ 255   
  

 

 

 

Our weighted average interest rate on the New Media Credit Agreement was approximately 7.25% as the Revolving Credit Facility is assumed to be undrawn. A 1/8% increase or decrease in the weighted average interest rate, including from an increase in LIBOR (excluding the impact of the LIBOR floor), would increase or decrease interest expense on the New Media Credit Agreement by approximately $0.2 million annually.

 

     Drawn      Rate     Weighted Average  

Revolving Credit Facility

   $ —           5.45 %     —   %

Term Loan Facility

     200,000         7.25 %     7.25 %
  

 

 

      

 

 

 
   $ 200,000           7.25 %  
  

 

 

      

 

 

 

 

m. As a result of the refinancing, the Company had a total of $3.6 million of deferred financing fees related to the New Media Credit Agreement. These deferred financing fees included arrangement fees, legal and other related costs. The following table presents the pro forma impact of the deferred financing fees associated with the New Media Credit Agreement and those associated with the elimination of the GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility.

 

     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

Total new deferred financing fees

   $ 3,593   

Amortization period

     5-6 years   

Full year New Media Credit Agreement deferred financing fees

     599   

Elimination of GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility deferred financing fees

     (543 )
  

 

 

 

Total deferred financing fee adjustment

   $ 56   
  

 

 

 

 

53


Table of Contents
     Six months ended
June 29,
2014
 

Total new deferred financing fees

   $ 3,593   

Amortization period

     5-6 years   

Six months New Media Credit Agreement deferred financing fees

     299   

Elimination of GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility deferred financing fees

     (758 )
  

 

 

 

Total deferred financing fee adjustment

   $ (459
  

 

 

 

As part of the refinancing, the interest rate swap associated with the GateHouse Credit Facilities was terminated. This adjustment also eliminates the loss associated with this derivative instrument for the six months ended June 29, 2014.

Providence Journal Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments

 

n. Historical results for The Providence Journal reported operating expense, which includes both operating and selling, Providence Journal Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments general and administrative expenses. This adjustment allocates expense to both categories to conform to our statement of operations classification.

 

o. In accordance with ASC 805, the purchase price of The Providence Journal will be allocated to the fair value of its assets and liabilities. For purposes of the pro forma statements of operations, the fair value of its property, plant and equipment exceeded its carrying value by approximately $0.6 million and the fair value of its intangible assets exceeded its carrying value by approximately $5.9 million based on the current estimate. This adjustment modifies historical depreciation and amortization expense based on the estimated fair value of property, plant and equipment and definite-lived intangible assets. The amount of the purchase price allocated to property, plant and equipment and intangible assets and the related pro forma calculation of depreciation and amortization expense are preliminary and subject to the completion of appraisals to determine the fair market value of the tangible and intangible assets.

 

p. The financing of the Providence Journal acquisition included $34.0 million of debt, $9.0 million under the revolving credit facility and $25.0 million of additional term loans under the New Media Credit Agreement (collectively “Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition”), net of $0.5 million of original issue discount and $0.5 million of deferred financing fees. This adjustment recognizes the additional interest and deferred financing amortization cost related to the debt as reflected in the following tables.

 

     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

Full year interest expense on Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition at 6.77%

   $ 2,303   

Full year original issuance discount accretion on Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition

     83   
  

 

 

 

Total increase to interest expense adjustment

   $ 2,386   
  

 

 

 

 

     Six months ended
June 29,
2014
 

Six months interest expense on Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition at 6.77%

   $ 1,152   

Six months original issuance discount accretion on Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition

     42   
  

 

 

 

Total increase to interest expense adjustment

   $ 1,194   
  

 

 

 

 

54


Table of Contents

Our weighted average interest rate on the Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition is estimated to be approximately 6.77%. A 1/8% increase or decrease in the weighted average interest rate, including from an increase in LIBOR (excluding the impact of the LIBOR floor), would increase or decrease interest expense on the New Media Credit Agreement by approximately $0.03 million annually.

 

     Drawn      Rate     Weighted Average  

Revolving Credit Facility

   $ 9,000        5.45 %     1.44 %

Term Loan Facility

     25,000        7.25 %     5.33 %
  

 

 

      

 

 

 
   $  34,000           6.77 %
  

 

 

      

 

 

 

 

     Year ended
December 29,
2013
 

Total new deferred financing fees

   $ 500   

Amortization period

     5-6 years   

Full year Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition deferred financing fees

     83   
  

 

 

 

Total deferred financing fee adjustment

   $ 83   
  

 

 

 

 

     Six months ended
June 29,
2014
 

Total new deferred financing fees

   $ 500   

Amortization period

     5-6 years   

Six months Financing of Providence Journal Acquisition deferred financing fees

     42   
  

 

 

 

Total deferred financing fee adjustment

   $ 42   
  

 

 

 

Tax Impact on Pro Forma Adjustments

 

q. This adjustment provides the estimated impact of income tax expense or benefit based on the Company’s estimated effective tax rate of 39.15%.

The table below provides a calculation of the pro forma income tax expense for New Media for the year ended December 29, 2013:

 

New Media historical two months ended December 29, 2013 pre-tax net income

   $ 7,697   

GateHouse Predecessor ten months ended November 6, 2013 pre-tax net income

     788,043   

Effects of Plan and fresh start and other adjustments

     (862,375

Local Media pre acquisition

     (37,442 )

Local Media adjustments

     (4,135 )

New Media refinancing adjustments

     (12,164 )

Providence Journal pre acquisition

     2,429  

Providence Journal adjustments

     (1,084
  

 

 

 

New Media pro forma pre-tax net loss

   $ (119,031 )

Effective tax rate

     39.15 %
  

 

 

 

Income tax benefit

   $ (46,600 )
  

 

 

 

 

55


Table of Contents

The table below provides a calculation of the pro forma income tax expense for New Media for the six months ended June 29, 2014:

 

New Media historical June 29, 2014 pre-tax net income

   $ (13,027

New Media refinancing adjustments

     10,380  

Providence Journal pre acquisition

     1,923  

Providence Journal adjustments

     (880
  

 

 

 

New Media pro forma pre-tax net loss

   $ (1,604

Effective tax rate

     39.15 %
  

 

 

 

Income tax benefit

   $ (628 )
  

 

 

 

 

56


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP AND SUBSIDIARIES

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Balance Sheet

(In thousands)

 

     As of June 29, 2014  
     New
Media
Historical
June 29,
2014
    Providence
Journal
Historical
June 30,
2014
     Providence
Journal
Purchase
Accounting
and Other
Adjustments
        Pro
Forma
June 29,
2014
 

Assets

           

Current assets:

           

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31,347      $ 213       $ (13,213   (r,s)   $ 18,347   

Restricted cash

     6,477               6,477   

Accounts receivable, net

     65,322        7,423             72,745   

Inventory

     7,463        2,657             10,120   

Prepaid expenses

     7,974        2,054             10,028   

Other current assets

     15,057        466         (466   (u)     15,057   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total current assets

     133,640        12,813         (13,679       132,774   

Property, plant, and equipment, net

     258,498        30,539         598      (t)     289,635   

Goodwill

     126,571           3,441      (t)     130,012   

Intangible assets, net

     144,475        2,915         5,855      (t)     153,245   

Deferred financing costs, net

     3,543           500      (r)     4,043   

Other assets

     3,816        36             3,852   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 670,543      $ 46,303       $ (3,285     $ 713,561   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

           

Current liabilities:

           

Current portion of long-term liabilities

   $ 646             $ 646   

Current portion of long-term debt

     1,500         $ 250      (r)     1,750   

Accounts payable

     5,454        1,914             7,368   

Accrued expenses

     40,853        3,169             44,022   

Deferred revenue

     31,746        4,405             36,151   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     80,199        9,488         250          89,937   

Long-term liabilities:

           

Long-term debt

     190,898           33,250      (r)     224,148   

Long-term liabilities, less current portion

     4,616        5,211         (5,181   (u)     4,646   

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations

     9,407               9,407   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     285,120        14,699         28,319          328,138   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity:

           

Common stock

     300               300   

Additional paid-in capital

     387,419               387,419   

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     458               458   

(Accumulated deficit) retained earnings

     (2,754     31,604         (31,604   (v)     (2,754
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     385,423        31,604         (31,604       385,423   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

   $ 670,543      $ 46,303       $ (3,285     $ 713,561   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

Providence Journal Purchase Accounting and Other Adjustments

 

r.

The Providence Journal acquisition was financed with $9.0 million of revolving debt that will mature on June 4, 2019, $25.0 million of additional term debt under the New Media Credit Agreement that will mature

 

57


Table of Contents
  on June 4, 2020 and $13.0 million of cash. The revolving facility has an interest rate of LIBOR plus 5.25% and the term loan has an interest rate of LIBOR, or minimum of 1%, plus 6.25%. Financing costs of $0.5 million and original issue discount of $0.5 million are anticipated to be incurred related to the consummation of this debt. This adjustment recognizes the deferred financing costs, debt and cash amounts.

 

s. This adjustment removes those assets that were not assumed in the Providence Journal acquisition, including cash.

 

t. In accordance with ASC 805, the purchase price for Providence Journal will be allocated to the fair value of its assets and liabilities (including identifiable intangible assets). The value assigned to property, plant and equipment, goodwill and intangible assets is preliminary and subject to the completion of valuations to determine the fair market value of the tangible and intangible assets.

 

u. This adjustment eliminates the net deferred tax asset and liability balances related to assets and liabilities acquired. The preliminary purchase price allocation does not result in a difference between book and tax basis, as such no deferred tax balance is recorded.

 

v. This adjustment eliminates the historical stockholders’ equity as a result of the Providence Journal purchase accounting.

 

58


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF

FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

Unless otherwise specified or the context otherwise requires, for purposes of this section under the heading “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” references to “we,” “our” “us” and the “Company” relating to periods prior to the Restructuring (as defined below) mean GateHouse Media, Inc. (“GateHouse,” or our “Predecessor”) and its consolidated subsidiaries and for periods after the Restructuring, mean New Media Investment Group Inc. (“New Media”).

The following discussion of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with our Consolidated Financial Statements, Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements and notes to those statements appearing in this Prospectus. The discussion and analysis below includes certain forward-looking statements that are subject to risks, uncertainties and other factors under the heading “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this Prospectus that could cause our actual future growth, results of operations, performance and business prospects and opportunities to differ materially from those expressed in, or implied by, such forward-looking statements. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Information.”

Comparability of Information

As a result of our commencement of Chapter 11 cases in the Bankruptcy Court (the “Restructuring”) in which GateHouse sought confirmation of its Joint Prepackaged Chapter 11 Plan (as modified, amended or supplemented from time to time, the “Plan”), all of GateHouse’s debt, including derivative liabilities and deferred financing assets, was eliminated on November 6, 2013, the confirmation date of the Plan. Fresh start accounting also led to changes in the basis of our assets and liabilities including property, plant and equipment and intangible assets that will impact future depreciation and amortization expense levels. As a result of the adoption of fresh start accounting, New Media’s reorganized company post-emergence financial statements will generally not be comparable with the financial statements of our Predecessor prior to emergence, including historical financial information in this Prospectus.

Overview

New Media is a newly listed company that owns, operates and invests in high quality local media assets. We have a particular focus on owning and acquiring strong local media assets in small to mid-size markets. With our collection of assets, we focus on two large business categories; consumers and small to medium size businesses (“SMBs”).

Our portfolio of media assets spans across 357 markets and 24 states. Our products include 425 community print publications, 357 websites, 345 mobile sites, six yellow page directories and a digital marketing services business (“Propel”). We reach over 12 million people per week and serve over 130,000 business customers.

We are focused on growing our consumer revenues primarily through our penetration into the local consumer market that values comprehensive local news and receives their local news primarily from our products. We believe our rich local content, our strong media brands, and multiple platforms for delivering content will impact our reach into the local consumers leading to growth in subscription income. We also believe our local consumer penetration will lead to transaction revenues as we link consumers with local businesses. For our SMB business category, we focus on leveraging our strong local media brands, our in-market sales force and our high consumer penetration rates with a variety of products and services that we believe will help SMBs expand their marketing, advertising and other digital lead generation platforms.

Our business strategy is to be the preeminent provider of local news, information, advertising and digital services in the markets we operate in today. We aim to grow our business organically through what we believe are both our consumer and SMB strategies. We also plan to pursue strategic acquisitions of high quality local

 

59


Table of Contents

media assets at attractive valuation levels. Finally, we intend to distribute a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend to stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance and approval by our board of directors (the “Board of Directors” or the “Board”) and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement (as defined below). The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results.

On July 31, 2014, the Company announced a second quarter 2014 cash dividend of $0.27 per share of Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share, of New Media (“New Media Common Stock” or our “Common Stock”). The dividend was paid on August 21, 2014 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on August 12, 2014.

Our focus on owning and operating dominant local content oriented media properties in small to mid-size markets, we believe, puts us in a position to better execute on our strategy. We believe that being the dominant provider of local news and information in the markets in which we operate, and distributing that content across multiple print and digital platforms, gives us an opportunity to grow our audiences and reach. Further, we believe our strong local media brands and our in-markets presence gives us the opportunity to expand our advertising and lead generation products with local business customers.

Central to our business strategy is Propel. We launched the business in 2012 and have seen rapid growth since then. We believe Propel and its digital marketing service products will be a key component to our overall organic growth strategy.

The opportunity Propel looks to seize upon is as follows:

There are approximately 27 million SMBs in the U.S. Of these, approximately 26.7 million have 20 employees or less.

Many of the owners and managers of these SMBs do not have the resources or expertise to navigate the fast evolving digital marketing sector, but they increasingly know they have to be present there to stay connected with current and future customers. Propel is designed to offer a complete set of digital marketing services to SMBs that are turn-key with results that are transparent to the business owners. Propel provides four broad categories of digital services: building businesses a presence, helping businesses to be located by consumers online, engaging with consumers, and growing their customer base.

We believe our local media properties are uniquely positioned to sell these digital marketing services to local business owners. Our strong and trusted local brands, combined with our in-market sales presence give us a distinct advantage to sell these services, which are new and can be complicated to local business owners.

Our core products include:

 

    87 daily newspapers with total paid circulation of approximately 712,000;

 

    243 weekly newspapers (published up to three times per week) with total paid circulation of approximately 303,000 and total free circulation of approximately 719,000;

 

    95 “shoppers” (generally advertising-only publications) with total circulation of approximately 1.9 million;

 

    357 locally focused websites and 345 mobile sites, which extend our businesses onto the internet and mobile devices with approximately 118 million page views per month;

 

    six yellow page directories, with a distribution of approximately 432,000, that cover a population of approximately 1.1 million people; and

 

    Propel digital marketing services.

 

60


Table of Contents

In addition to our core products, we also opportunistically produce niche publications that address specific local market interests such as recreation, sports, healthcare and real estate.

Our advertising revenue tends to follow a seasonal pattern, with higher advertising revenue in months containing significant events or holidays. Accordingly, our first quarter, followed by our third quarter, historically are our weakest quarters of the year in terms of revenue. Correspondingly, our second and fourth fiscal quarters, historically, are our strongest quarters. We expect that this seasonality will continue to affect our advertising revenue in future periods.

Our Predecessor has experienced on-going declines in print advertising revenue streams and increased volatility of operating performance, despite our geographic diversity, well-balanced portfolio of products, broad customer base and reliance on smaller markets. We may experience additional declines and volatility in the future. These declines in print advertising revenue have come with the shift from traditional media to the internet for consumers and businesses. We believe our local advertising tends to be less sensitive to economic cycles than national advertising because local businesses generally have fewer advertising channels through which to reach their target audience. We are making investments in digital platforms, such as Propel, as well as online, and mobile applications, to support our print publications in order to capture this shift as witnessed by our Predecessor’s digital advertising revenue growth, which doubled between 2009 and 2012.

Our operating costs consist primarily of labor, newsprint, and delivery costs. Our selling, general and administrative expenses consist primarily of labor costs.

Compensation represents just over 50% of our operating expenses. Over the last few years, we have worked to drive efficiencies and centralization of work throughout our Company. Additionally, we have taken steps to cluster our operations thereby increasing the usage of facilities and equipment while increasing the productivity of our labor force. We expect to continue to employ these steps as part of our business and clustering strategy.

The Company’s operating segments (Large Community Newspapers, Small Community Newspapers, Local Media Newspapers and Ventures) are aggregated into one reportable segment.

Recent Developments

Restructuring

On September 4, 2013, our Predecessor, GateHouse, and its affiliated debtors (the “Debtors”) announced that our Predecessor, the Administrative Agent (as defined below), Newcastle Investment Corp. (“Newcastle”) and other lenders (the “Participating Lenders”) under the Amended and Restated Credit Agreement by and among certain affiliates of our Predecessor, the lenders from time to time party thereto and Cortland Products Corp., as administrative agent (the “Administrative Agent”), dated February 27, 2007 (the “2007 Credit Facility”) entered into the Restructuring Support Agreement, effective September 3, 2013 (the “Support Agreement”), in which the parties agreed to support, subject to the terms and conditions of the Support Agreement, the Restructuring pursuant to the consummation of the Plan. The Support Agreement relates to the Restructuring of our Predecessor’s obligations under the 2007 Credit Facility and certain interest rate swaps secured thereunder (collectively, the “Outstanding Debt”) and our Predecessor’s equity pursuant to the Plan.

On September 20, 2013, our Predecessor commenced a pre-packaged solicitation of the Plan (the “Solicitation”). Under the Support Agreement, which terminated on the Effective Date (as defined below), each of the Participating Lenders agreed to (a) support and take any reasonable action in furtherance of the Restructuring, (b) timely vote their Outstanding Debt to accept the Plan and not change or withdraw such vote, (c) support approval of the Disclosure Statement (as defined below) and confirmation of the Plan, as well as certain relief to be requested by Debtors from the Bankruptcy Court, (d) refrain from taking any action inconsistent with the confirmation or consummation of the Plan, and (e) not propose, support, solicit or participate in the formulation of any plan other than the Plan. Holders of Outstanding Debt sufficient to meet the

 

61


Table of Contents

requisite threshold of 67% in amount and majority in number (calculated without including any insider) necessary for acceptance of the Plan under the Bankruptcy Code voted to accept the Plan in the Solicitation. 100% of the holders of the Outstanding Debt voted to accept the Plan under the terms of the Support Agreement. On September 27, 2013, our Predecessor filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code, case number 13-12503. As a result, Debtors commenced Chapter 11 cases and sought approval of the disclosure statement for the Plan (the “Disclosure Statement”) and confirmation of the Plan therein. The Plan was confirmed by the Bankruptcy Court on November 6, 2013 and our Predecessor effected the transactions contemplated by the Plan to emerge from bankruptcy protection on November 26, 2013 (the “Effective Date”). On the Effective Date, Newcastle owned 84.6% of New Media’s total equity.

The Plan discharged claims and interests against our Predecessor primarily through the (a) issuance of New Media Common Stock and/or payment of cash to holders of claims in connection with the 2007 Credit Facility and related interest rate swaps, (b) reinstatement of certain claims, (c) entry into the Management Agreement (as defined below), (d) issuance of warrants by New Media to former equity holders of our Predecessor and (e) entry into the GateHouse Credit Facilities (as defined below) the net proceeds of which were distributed to holders that elected to receive New Media Common Stock. See Note 2 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Voluntary Reorganization Under Chapter 11.”

Pursuant to the Restructuring, Newcastle purchased the Outstanding Debt claims in cash and at 40% of (i) $1,167 million of principal of claims under the 2007 Credit Facility, plus (ii) accrued and unpaid interest at the applicable contract non-default rate with respect thereto, plus (iii) all amounts, excluding any default interest, arising from transactions in connection with interest rate swaps secured under the 2007 Credit Facility (the “Cash-Out Offer”) on the Effective Date. The holders of the Outstanding Debt had the option of receiving, in satisfaction of their Outstanding Debt, their pro rata share of the (i) Cash-Out Offer and/or (ii) New Media Common Stock and the net proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities. Newcastle received its pro rata share of New Media Common Stock and the $149 million in net proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities (as defined below) for all Outstanding Debt it holds, including Outstanding Debt purchased in the Cash-Out Offer. All pensions, trade and all other unsecured claims will be paid in the ordinary course.

On the Effective Date, New Media entered into the Management Agreement pursuant to which the Manager will manage the operations of New Media. The annual management fee will be 1.50% of New Media’s Total Equity (as defined in the Management Agreement) and the Manager is eligible to receive incentive compensation.

On August 27, 2013, our Predecessor entered into a management agreement (the “Local Media Management Agreement”) with and among Local Media Group Holdings LLC (“Local Media Parent”) to manage the operations of its direct subsidiary Local Media Group Inc. (formerly known as Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.) (“Local Media”). The Company has determined that the Local Media Management Agreement resulted in Local Media being a variable interest entity (“VIE”) and has consolidated Local Media’s financial position and results of operations from September 3, 2013. On September 3, 2013, Local Media Parent completed its acquisition of thirty three publications from News Corp Inc. Local Media was not part of the bankruptcy filing. However, as part of the Plan, Newcastle agreed to contribute 100% of the stock of Local Media Parent to New Media as of the Effective Date. The contribution was made to New Media to assign Newcastle’s rights under the stock purchase agreement to which it acquired Local Media as of the Effective Date. Consideration received by Newcastle was the New Media Common Stock collectively equal to the cost of the acquisition of Local Media by Newcastle (as adjusted pursuant to the Plan) upon emergence from Chapter 11 on the Effective Date. The Company accounted for the consolidation of Local Media under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 805, “Business Combinations,” as New Media received a controlling financial interest in Local Media following the Restructuring. The Local Media Management Agreement was terminated effective June 4, 2014.

Upon Gatehouse’s emergence from Chapter 11, New Media adopted fresh start reporting in accordance with ASC Topic 852, “Reorganizations” (“ASC 852”). Under fresh start accounting, a new entity is deemed to have

 

62


Table of Contents

been created on the Effective Date for financial reporting purposes and our Predecessor’s recorded amounts of assets and liabilities will be adjusted to reflect their estimated fair values. As a result of the adoption of fresh start accounting, New Media’s reorganized company post-emergence financial statements will generally not be comparable with the financial statements of our Predecessor prior to emergence, including the historical financial information in this Prospectus. See “The Restructuring and Spin Off” and Note 2 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Voluntary Reorganization Under Chapter 11,” and Note 3 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Fresh Start Accounting.”

Industry

The newspaper industry and our Predecessor have experienced declining same store revenue and profitability over the past several years. As a result, we previously implemented plans to reduce costs and preserve cash flow. We have also invested in potential growth opportunities, primarily in the digital space and particularly our Propel business, among other digital initiatives. We believe the cost reductions and the new digital initiatives, together with the Restructuring described below, will provide the appropriate capital structure and financial resources necessary to invest in the business and ensure our future success and provide sufficient cash flow to enable us to meet our commitments for the next year.

General economic conditions, including declines in consumer confidence, continued high unemployment levels, declines in real estate values, and other trends, have also impacted the markets in which we operate. Additionally, media companies continue to be impacted by the migration of consumers and businesses to an internet and mobile-based, digital medium. These conditions may continue to negatively impact print advertising and other revenue sources as well as increase operating costs in the future, even after an economic recovery. We expect that we will have adequate capital resources and liquidity to meet our working capital needs, borrowing obligations and all required capital expenditures for at least the next twelve months.

We periodically perform testing for impairment of goodwill and newspaper mastheads in which the fair value of our reporting units for goodwill impairment testing and individual newspaper mastheads were estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows and recent industry transaction multiples, using estimates, judgments and assumptions, that we believe were appropriate in the circumstances. Should general economic, market or business conditions decline, and have a negative impact on estimates of future cash flow and market transaction multiples, we may be required to record additional impairment charges in the future.

Spin-off from Newcastle

On February 13, 2014, Newcastle completed the spin-off of the Company. Each share of Newcastle common stock outstanding as of 5:00 PM, Eastern Time, on February 6, 2014 (the “Record Date”), entitled the holder thereof to receive 0.07219481485 shares of New Media Common Stock (the “Distribution” or the “spin-off”). On February 14, 2014 New Media became a separate, publicly traded company trading on the NYSE under the ticker symbol “NEWM”. As a result of the spin-off, the fees included in the Management Agreement with the Manager became effective.

Acquisitions

On June 30, 2014, the Company completed two acquisitions of 20 publications with a total purchase price of $15.85 million, which includes estimated working capital. The acquisitions include six daily, ten weekly publications, and four shoppers serving areas of Texas, Oklahoma, Kansas and Virginia with an aggregate circulation of approximately 54,000. The acquisitions were funded with $9.85 million of cash and $6 million from the Revolving Credit Facility (as defined below).

On September 3, 2014, the Company completed the acquisition of The Providence Journal with a total purchase price of $46 million. The acquisition includes one daily and two weekly publications serving areas of Rhode Island with a daily circulation of approximately 72,000 and 96,000 on Sunday.

 

63


Table of Contents

Dividend

On July 31, 2014, the Company announced a second quarter 2014 cash dividend of $0.27 per share of New Media Common Stock. The dividend was paid on August 21, 2014 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on August 12, 2014.

Critical Accounting Policy Disclosure

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make decisions based on estimates, assumptions and factors it considers relevant to the circumstances. Such decisions include the selection of applicable principles and the use of judgment in their application, the results of which could differ from those anticipated. Due to the bankruptcy filing, we have applied debtor-in-possession accounting and fresh start accounting as described in ASC 852 for the applicable periods of 2013. The following accounting policies require significant estimates and judgments.

Goodwill and Long-Lived Assets

The application of the purchase method of accounting for business combinations and fresh start accounting related to reorganization require the use of significant estimates and assumptions in the determination of the fair value of assets and liabilities in order to properly allocate the purchase price consideration or enterprise value between assets that are depreciated and amortized from goodwill. Our estimates of the fair values of assets and liabilities are based upon assumptions believed to be reasonable, and when appropriate, include assistance from independent third-party valuation firms. See Note 3 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Fresh Start Accounting” and Note 4 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements, “Local Media Acquisition.”

As a result of the application of fresh start accounting we have a significant amount of goodwill. Goodwill at June 29, 2014 was $126.6 million. We assess the potential impairment of goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives on an annual basis as of the end or our second fiscal quarter in accordance with the provisions of Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) ASC Topic 350 “Intangibles—Goodwill and Other.” We perform our impairment analysis on each of our reporting units. The reporting units have discrete financial information and are regularly reviewed by management. The fair value of the applicable reporting unit is compared to its carrying value. Calculating the fair value of a reporting unit requires us to make significant estimates and assumptions. We estimate fair value by applying third-party market value indicators to projected cash flows and/or projected earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, and amortization. In applying this methodology, we rely on a number of factors, including current operating results and cash flows, expected future operating results and cash flows, future business plans, and market data. If the carrying value of the reporting unit exceeds the estimate of fair value, we calculate the impairment as the excess of the carrying value of goodwill over its implied fair value.

We account for long-lived assets in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 360, Property, Plant and Equipment.” We assess the recoverability of our long-lived assets, including property, plant and equipment and definite lived intangible assets, whenever events or changes in business circumstances indicate the carrying amount of the assets, or related group of assets, may not be fully recoverable. Factors leading to impairment include significant under-performance relative to historical or projected results, significant changes in the manner of use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business and significant negative industry or economic trends. The assessment of recoverability is based on management’s estimates by comparing the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows generated by the underlying asset, or other appropriate grouping of assets, to its carrying value to determine whether an impairment existed at its lowest level of identifiable cash flows. If the carrying amount of the asset is greater than the expected undiscounted cash flows to be generated by such asset, an impairment is recognized to the extent the carrying value of such asset exceeds its fair value.

The fair values of our reporting units for goodwill impairment testing and individual newspaper mastheads are estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows, recent industry transaction multiples and using estimates, judgments and assumptions that management believes are appropriate in the circumstances.

 

64


Table of Contents

The sum of the fair values of the reporting units are reconciled to our current market capitalization (based upon the stock market price) plus an estimated control premium.

Significant judgment is required in determining the fair value of our goodwill and long-lived assets to measure impairment, including the determination of multiples of revenue and Adjusted EBITDA (as defined below) and future earnings projections. The estimates and judgments that most significantly affect the future cash flow estimates are assumptions related to revenue, and in particular, potential changes in future advertising (including the impact of economic trends and the speed of conversion of advertising and readership to online products from traditional print products); trends in newsprint prices; and other operating expense items.

We performed annual impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets during the second quarter of 2014, 2013, 2012 and 2011. Additionally, we performed impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles during the first quarter of 2012 and the fourth quarter of 2011 due to operational management changes. As a result, impairment charges related to goodwill were recorded in fiscal 2012 and 2011. See Note 8 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Note 6 to New Media’s Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Goodwill and Intangible Assets,” for additional information.

Newspaper mastheads (newspaper titles and website domain names) are not subject to amortization and are tested for impairment annually, or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired. The impairment test consists of a comparison of the fair value of each group of mastheads with their carrying amount. We used a relief from royalty approach which utilizes a discounted cash flow model to determine the fair value of each newspaper masthead. Our judgments and estimates of future operating results in determining the reporting unit fair values are consistently applied in determining the fair value of mastheads. We performed impairment tests on newspaper mastheads as of June 29, 2014, June 30, 2013July 1, 2012April 1, 2012January 1, 2012 and June 26, 2011. See Note 8 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Note 6 to New Media’s Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Goodwill and Intangible Assets,” for a discussion of the impairment charges taken.

Intangible assets subject to amortization (primarily advertiser and subscriber lists) are tested for recoverability whenever events or change in circumstances indicate that their carrying amounts may not be recoverable. The carrying amount of each asset group is not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result from the use of such asset group. We performed impairment tests on long lived assets (including intangible assets subject to amortization) as of June 29, 2014, September 29, 2013June 30, 2013July 1, 2012 and June 26, 2011. Due to reductions in the Company’s operating projections during the third quarter of 2013 in conjunction with the bankruptcy process, an impairment charge was recognized for intangible assets subject to amortization. See Note 8 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Note 6 to New Media’s Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Goodwill and Intangible Assets,” for a discussion of the impairment charges taken.

Given the recent revaluation of assets related to fresh start accounting, there is a relatively small amount of fair value excess for certain reporting units as of the second quarter 2014 annual impairment testing. Specifically the fair value of the Large Daily Newspapers, Metro Newspapers and Small Community Newspaper reporting units exceeded carrying value by less than 10%. In addition, the masthead fair value for these groups exceeded carrying value by less than 3%. Considering a relatively low headroom for these reporting units and mastheads and declining same store revenue and profitability in the newspaper industry over the past several years, these are considered to be at risk for a future impairment in the event of decline in general economic, market or business conditions or any significant unfavorable changes in the forecasted cash flows, weighted-average cost of capital and/or market transaction multiples.

 

65


Table of Contents

Derivative Instruments

The bankruptcy filing was a termination event under our Predecessor’s interest rate swap agreements. We record all of our derivative instruments on our balance sheet at fair value pursuant to ASC Topic 815, “Derivatives and Hedging” (“ASC 815”) and ASC Topic 820 “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures.” Fair value is based on counterparty quotations adjusted for our credit related risk. Our derivative instruments are measured using significant unobservable inputs and they represent all liabilities measured at fair value. To the extent a derivative qualifies as a cash flow hedge under ASC 815, unrealized changes in the fair value of the derivative are recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income. However, any ineffective portion of a derivative’s change in fair value is recognized immediately in earnings. Fair values of derivatives are subject to significant variability based on market conditions, such as future levels of interest rates. This variability could result in a significant increase or decrease in our accumulated other comprehensive income and/or earnings but will generally have no effect on cash flows, provided the derivative is carried through to full term. We also assess the capabilities of our counterparties to perform under the terms of the contracts. A change in the assessment could have an impact on the accounting and economics of our derivatives.

Revenue Recognition

Advertising revenue is recognized upon publication of the advertisement. Circulation revenue from subscribers is billed to customers at the beginning of the subscription period and is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the related subscription. Circulation revenue from single copy sales is recognized based on date of publication, net of provisions for related returns. Revenue for commercial printing is recognized upon delivery. Directory revenue is recognized on a straight-line basis over the period in which the corresponding directory is distributed.

Income Taxes

We account for income taxes under the provisions of ASC Topic 740, “Income Taxes” (“ASC 740”). Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the difference between the financial statement and tax bases of assets and liabilities using tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to affect taxable income. The assessment of the realizability of deferred tax assets involves a high degree of judgment and complexity. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amounts that are expected to be realized. When we determine that it is more likely than not that we will be able to realize our deferred tax assets in the future in excess of our net recorded amount, an adjustment to the deferred tax asset would be made and reflected either in income or as an adjustment to goodwill. This determination will be made by considering various factors, including our expected future results, that in our judgment will make it more likely than not that these deferred tax assets will be realized.

FASB issued Interpretation No. 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes, an interpretation of SFAS No. 109” and now codified as ASC 740. ASC 740 prescribes a comprehensive model for how a company should recognize, measure, present and disclose in its financial statements uncertain tax positions that a company has taken or expects to take on a tax return. Under ASC 740, the financial statements will reflect expected future tax consequences of such positions presuming the taxing authorities’ full knowledge of the position and all relevant facts, but without considering time values.

Pension and Postretirement Liabilities

ASC Topic 715, “Compensation—Retirement Benefits” requires recognition of an asset or liability in the consolidated balance sheet reflecting the funded status of pension and other postretirement benefit plans such as retiree health and life, with current-year changes in the funded status recognized in the statement of stockholders’ equity.

 

66


Table of Contents

The determination of pension plan obligations and expense is based on a number of actuarial assumptions. Two critical assumptions are the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets and the discount rate applied to pension plan obligations. For other postretirement benefit plans, which provide for certain health care and life insurance benefits for qualifying retired employees and which are not funded, critical assumptions in determining other postretirement benefit obligations and expense are the discount rate and the assumed health care cost-trend rates.

Our only pension plan has assets valued at $20.3 million and the plan’s benefit obligation is $24.3 million resulting in the plan being 83% funded.

To determine the expected long-term rate of return on the pension plan’s assets, we consider the current and expected asset allocations, as well as historical and expected returns on various categories of plan assets, input from the actuaries and investment consultants, and long-term inflation assumptions. We used an assumption of 8.0% for its expected return on pension plan assets for 2013. If we were to reduce its rate of return by 50 basis points then the expense for 2013 would have increased approximately $0.1 million.

The assumed health care cost-trend rate also affects other postretirement benefit liabilities and expense. A 100 basis point increase in the health care cost trend rate would result in an increase of approximately $0.4 million in the December 29, 2013 postretirement benefit obligation and a 100 basis point decrease in the health care cost trend rate would result in a decrease of approximately $0.3 million in the December 29, 2013 postretirement benefit obligation.

Self-Insurance Liability Accruals

We maintain self-insured medical and workers’ compensation programs. We purchase stop loss coverage from third parties which limits our exposure to large claims. We record a liability for healthcare and workers’ compensation costs during the period in which they occur as well as an estimate of incurred but not reported claims.

 

67


Table of Contents

Results of Operations

The following table summarizes our historical results of operations for New Media, otherwise known as the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013 and for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and the Predecessor Company for the three and six months ended June 30, 2013, for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012. We believe the comparison of combined results for the year ended December 29, 2013 versus the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, respectively, provides the best analysis of our results of operations, while the adoption of fresh start accounting presents the results of operations of a new reporting entity, the only consolidated statement of operations items impacted by the bankruptcy reorganization under Chapter 11 are depreciation and amortization expense, interest expense, and reorganization items. Those effects of fresh start accounting are discussed in more detail in the respective sections below.

 

    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
         Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
         Combined          Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Three
Months
Ended

June 29,
2014
         Three
Months
Ended

June 30,
2013
         Six
Months
Ended
June 29,
2014
         Six
Months
Ended

June 30,
2013
         Year
Ended

December  29,
2013
         Two
Months

Ended
December  29,
2013
         Ten
Months

Ended
November  6,
2013
    Year
Ended

December  30,
2012
(1)
    Year
Ended

January 1,
2012
 
(in thousands)                                                                                    

Revenues:

                                         

Advertising

  $ 95,837          $ 79,220          $ 178,460          $ 150,559          $ 328,418          $ 63,340          $ 265,078      $ 330,881      $ 357,134   

Circulation

    46,102            33,047            90,471            65,513            148,335            29,525            118,810        131,576        131,879   

Commercial printing and other

    16,494            7,331            31,535            14,107            39,768            10,366            29,402        26,097        25,657   
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    158,433            119,598            300,466            230,179            516,521            103,231            413,290        488,554        514,670   

Operating costs and expenses:

                                         

Operating costs

    87,615            64,978            172,470            129,998            288,680            56,614            232,066        268,222        281,884   

Selling, general and administrative

    52,235            41,156            102,251            78,722            165,581            28,749            136,832        145,020        146,295   

Depreciation and amortization

    10,109            9,791            19,918            19,636            39,997            6,588            33,409        39,888        42,426   

Integration and reorganization costs

    412            741            837            958            3,335            1,758            1,577        4,393        5,884   

Impairment of long-lived assets

    —             —             —             —             91,599            —             91,599        —         1,733   

Loss on sale of assets

    688            649            687            1,043            1,190            27            1,163        1,238        455   

Goodwill and mastheads impairment

    —             —             —             —             —             —             —         —         385   
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

    7,374            2,283            4,303            (178         (73,861         9,495            (83,356     29,793        35,608   

Interest expense

    3,827            14,456            7,632            28,886            75,998            1,640            74,358        57,928        58,309   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    333            261            758            522            1,013            171            842        1,255        1,360   

Loss (gain) on derivative instruments

    9,047            —             9,047            —             14            —             14        (1,635     (913

Other (income) expense

    76            5            51            9            991            (13         1,004        (85     (395

Reorganization items, net

    (159         737            (158         1,008            (947,617         —             (947,617     —         —    
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

    (5,750         (13,176         (13,027         (30,603         795,740            7,697            788,043        (27,670     (22,753

Income tax expense (benefit)

    (2,481         —             (3,067                   294            491            (197     (207     (1,803
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

  $ (3,269       $ (13,176       $ (9,960       $ (30,603       $ 795,446          $ 7,206          $ 788,240      $ (27,463   $ (20,950
 

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) The year ended December 30, 2012 included a 53rd week of operations for approximately 60% of the business.

 

68


Table of Contents

Three Months Ended June 29, 2014 Compared To Three Months Ended June 30, 2013

Revenue. Total revenue for the Successor Company for the three months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $38.8 million, or 32.5%, to $158.4 million from $119.6 million for the Predecessor Company for the three months ended June 30, 2013. The increase in total revenue was comprised of a $16.6 million, or 21.0%, increase in advertising revenue and a $13.0 million, or 39.5%, increase in circulation revenue, and a $9.2 million, or 125.0%, increase in commercial printing and other revenue. The increase in revenue of $38.8 includes revenues from acquisitions of $42.8 million; $21.7 million from advertising, $13.8 million from circulation, and $7.3 million from commercial printing and other. Same store revenue for the Successor Company for the three months ended June 29, 2014 decreased by $0.9 million, or 0.5%, to $158.4 million. The decrease in same store revenue was comprised of a $3.9 million, or 3.9%, decrease in advertising revenue, which was partially offset by a $0.3 million, or 0.8%, increase in circulation revenue and a $2.7 million, or 19.3%, increase in commercial printing and other revenue. Same store advertising revenue declines were primarily driven by declines on the print side of our business in the local retail category. The local retail print declines reflect both secular pressures and a continuing uncertain economic environment. These secular trends and economic conditions have also led to a decline in our print circulation volumes which have been offset by price increases in select locations. The $2.7 million increase in commercial printing and other revenue is primarily the result of the growth in Propel, our small business marketing service business within GateHouse Ventures.

Operating Costs. Operating costs for the Successor Company for the three months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $22.6 million, or 34.8%, to $87.6 million from $65.0 million for the Predecessor Company for the three months ended June 30, 2013. The increase in operating costs of $22.6 million includes operating costs from acquisitions of $24.2 million, which were partially offset by a $1.6 million decrease in legacy operating costs. This decline in legacy operating costs was primarily due to a decrease in compensation expenses, newsprint expenses, and hauling and delivery expenses of $0.6 million, $0.5 million, and $0.4 million, respectively. On a same store basis, operating costs for the Successor Company for the three months ended June 29, 2014 decreased by $2.1 million, or 2.4%, to $87.6 million. These decreases are the result of permanent cost reductions as we continue to work to consolidate operations and improve the productivity of our labor force.

Selling, General and Administrative. Selling, general and administrative expenses for the Successor Company for the three months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $11.1 million, or 26.9%, to $52.2 million from $41.1 million for the Predecessor Company for the three months ended June 30, 2013. The increase in selling, general and administrative expenses of $11.1 million includes selling, general and administrative expenses from acquisitions of $10.3 million. The additional $0.8 million increase in selling, general and administrative expenses was primarily due to an increase in professional and consulting fees of $1.8 million, which was partially offset by a decrease in compensation expenses, outside services, and postage expenses of $0.5 million, $0.3 million, and $0.3 million, respectively. On a same store basis, selling, general and administrative expenses for the Successor Company for the three months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $1.9 million, or 3.8%, to $52.2 million related to $1.8 million of debt refinancing fees that did not meet capitalization requirements.

Integration and Reorganization Costs. During the three months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013, we recorded integration and reorganization costs of $0.4 million and $0.7 million, respectively, primarily resulting from severance costs related to the continued consolidation of our operations resulting from our ongoing implementation of our plans to reduce costs and preserve cash flow.

Interest Expense. Interest expense for the three months ended June 29, 2014 decreased by $10.6 million to $3.8 million from $14.4 million for the three months ended June 30, 2013. The decrease in interest expense was primarily due to the decrease in our total outstanding debt as a result of our restructuring during 2013.

Loss on Early Extinguishment of Debt. During the three months ended June 29, 2014, we recorded a loss of $9.0 million due to the early extinguishment of long-term debt.

 

69


Table of Contents

Income Tax Benefit. During the three months ended June 29, 2014, we recorded an income tax benefit of $2.5 million due to the interim period treatment driven by the annualized effective rate excess of the deferred tax liability related to indefinite lived assets.

Loss from Continuing Operations. Loss from continuing operations for the three months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013 was $3.3 million and $13.2 million, respectively. Our net loss from continuing operations decreased due to the factors noted above.

Six months Ended June 29, 2014 Compared To Six months Ended June 30, 2013

Revenue. Total revenue for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $70.3 million, or 30.5%, to $300.5 million from $230.2 million for the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013. The increase in total revenue was comprised of a $27.9 million, or 18.5%, increase in advertising revenue and a $25.0 million, or 38.1%, increase in circulation revenue, and a $17.4 million, or 123.5%, increase in commercial printing and other revenue. The increase in revenue of $70.3 includes revenues from acquisitions of $79.0 million; $39.2 million from advertising, $26.2 million from circulation, and $13.6 million from commercial printing and other. Same store revenue for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 decreased by $4.9 million, or 1.6%, to $300.5 million. The decrease in same store revenue was comprised of a $10.6 million, or 5.6%, decrease in advertising revenue, which was partially offset by a $0.1 million, or 0.1%, increase in circulation revenue and a $5.6 million, or 21.6%, increase in commercial printing and other revenue. Same store advertising revenue declines were primarily driven by declines on the print side of our business in the local retail and classified categories. The local retail print declines reflect both secular pressures and a continuing uncertain economic environment. These secular trends and economic conditions have also led to a decline in our print circulation volumes, which have been offset by price increases in select locations. The $5.6 million increase in commercial printing and other revenue is primarily the result of the growth in Propel, our small business marketing service business within GateHouse Ventures.

Operating Costs. Operating costs for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $42.5 million, or 32.7%, to $172.5 million from $130.0 million for the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013. The increase in operating costs of $42.5 million includes operating costs from acquisitions of $46.7 million which were partially offset by a $4.2 million decrease in legacy operating costs. This decline in legacy operating costs was primarily due to a decrease in compensation expenses, newsprint expenses, hauling and delivery, and professional and consulting fees of $1.8 million, $1.2 million, $0.9 million, and $0.2 million, respectively. On a same store basis, operating costs for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 decreased by $5.1 million, or 2.8%, to $172.5 million. These decreases are the result of permanent cost reductions as we continue to work to consolidate operations and improve the productivity of our labor force.

Selling, General and Administrative. Selling, general and administrative expenses for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $23.5 million, or 29.9%, to $102.2 million from $78.7 million for the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013. The increase in selling, general and administrative expenses of $23.5 million includes selling, general and administrative expenses from acquisitions of $20.8 million. The additional $2.7 million increase in selling, general and administrative expenses was primarily due to an increase in professional and consulting fees of $2.7 million. On a same store basis, selling, general and administrative expenses for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 increased by $3.7 million, or 3.7%, to $102.2 million, which includes $1.8 million of debt refinancing fees that did not meet capitalization requirements.

Integration and Reorganization Costs. During the six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013, we recorded integration and reorganization costs of $0.8 million and $1.0 million, respectively, primarily resulting from severance costs related to the continued consolidation of our operations resulting from our ongoing implementation of our plans to reduce costs and preserve cash flow.

 

70


Table of Contents

Interest Expense. Interest expense for the six months ended June 29, 2014 decreased by $21.3 million to $7.6 million from $28.9 million for the six months ended June 30, 2013. The decrease in interest expense was primarily due to the decrease in our total outstanding debt as a result of our restructuring during 2013.

Loss on Early Extinguishment of Debt. During the six months ended June 29, 2014, we recorded a loss of $9.0 million due to the early extinguishment of long-term debt.

Income Tax Benefit. During the six months ended June 29, 2014, we recorded an income tax benefit of $3.1 million due to the interim period treatment driven by the annualized effective rate excess of the deferred tax liability related to indefinite lived assets.

Loss from Continuing Operations. Loss from continuing operations for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013 was $10.0 million and $30.6 million, respectively. Our net loss from continuing operations decreased due to the factors noted above.

Year Ended December 29, 2013 Compared To Year Ended December 30, 2012

Revenue. Total revenue for the year ended December 29, 2013 increased by $28.0 million, or 5.7%, to $516.5 million from $488.5 million for the year ended December 30, 2012. The increase in total revenue was comprised of a $2.5 million, or 0.7%, decrease in advertising revenue which was offset by a $16.8 million, or 12.7%, increase in circulation revenue and a $13.7 million, or 52.4%, increase in commercial printing and other revenue. Advertising revenue includes $27.2 million from Local Media in 2013 while total company excluding Local Media (“GateHouse Standalone”) declines were $29.6 million or 9.0%. Advertising revenue declines were primarily driven by declines on the print side of our business in the local retail and classified categories, which were partially offset by growth in digital advertising. The local retail print declines reflect both secular pressures and a continuing uncertain economic environment. These secular trends and economic conditions have also led to a decline in our print circulation volumes which have been slightly offset by price increases in certain locations. Our circulation revenue was also impacted by approximately $1.4 million for a net to gross accounting change at two of our larger locations in 2013. The increase in circulation revenue was primarily due to circulation revenue from Local Media of $16.4 million. The increase in commercial printing and other revenue was primarily due to commercial printing and other revenue from growth of our small business marketing services at Propel combined with Local Media commercial print and other revenue of $9.7 million.

Operating Costs. Operating costs for the year ended December 29, 2013 increased by $20.5 million, or 7.6%, to $288.7 million from $268.2 million for the year ended December 30, 2012. The increase in operating costs primarily relates to operating costs from Local Media of $32.0 million and by an increase in GateHouse Standalone outside service expenses of $4.7 million. These increases in operating costs were partially offset by a decrease in GateHouse Standalone compensation expenses, newsprint expenses, professional and consulting fees, supplies, repairs and maintenance, and travel expenses of $6.2 million, $4.5 million, $3.5 million, $0.9 million, $0.4 million, and $0.4 million, respectively. These GateHouse Standalone decreases are the result of permanent cost reductions as we continue to work to consolidate operations and improve the productivity of our labor force.

Selling, General and Administrative. Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 29, 2013 increased by $20.6 million, or 14.2%, to $165.6 million from $145.0 million for the year ended December 30, 2012. The increase in selling, general and administrative expenses primarily relates to selling, general and administrative expenses from Local Media of $12.9 million and an increase in GateHouse Standalone outside services and professional and consulting fees of $8.5 million and $1.4 million respectively. These increases in selling, general and administrative expenses were partially offset by a decrease in compensation expenses of $2.0 million. The increase in GateHouse Standalone outside services is primarily from legal expenses of $6.5 million related to reorganization costs prior to filing bankruptcy.

Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense for the year ended December 29, 2013 increased by $0.1 million to $40.0 million from $39.9 million for the year ended December 30, 2012.

 

71


Table of Contents

Depreciation and amortization expense increased due to depreciation expense of Local Media of $3.8 million, which was offset by a reduction in depreciation expense due to the sale and disposal of assets. The application of fresh start accounting did not have a material impact on depreciation and amortization.

Integration and Reorganization Costs. During the years ended December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, we recorded integration and reorganization costs of $3.3 million and $4.4 million, respectively, primarily resulting from severance costs related to the continued consolidation of our operations resulting from our ongoing implementation of our plans to reduce costs and preserve cash flow.

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets. During the year ended December 29, 2013, we incurred a charge of $91.6 million related to the impairment on our advertiser relationships, subscriber relationships, customer relationships and other intangible assets due to reductions in our operating projections within our various reporting units. There were no such charges during the year ended December 30, 2012.

Interest Expense. Interest expense for the year ended December 29, 2013 increased by $18.1 million to $76.0 million from $57.9 million for the year ended December 30, 2012, which primarily resulted from the reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income of $26.3 million related to the dedesignation of the hedging relationship related to swap agreements in connection with the bankruptcy filing. The 2013 interest expense was also impacted by there being no interest on the GateHouse debt in November and significantly lower debt balance in December.

Loss (Gain) on Derivative Instruments. During the year ended December 30, 2012, we recorded a net gain on derivative instruments of $1.6 million, which was comprised of reclassifications of accumulated other comprehensive income amortization related to swaps terminated in 2008 that were partially offset by the impact of the ineffectiveness of our remaining swap agreements. The accumulated other comprehensive income reclassification for swaps terminated in 2008 was fully amortized in 2012 and the 2013 loss on derivative instruments relates only to the ineffectiveness of our remaining swaps.

Reorganization Items, Net. Costs directly attributable to the bankruptcy filing are reported as reorganization items, net during the predecessor ten month period ending November 6, 2013. Reorganization items, net primarily relates to the gain on extinguishment of debt of $722.8 million and the revaluation of assets of $246.2 million which were partially offset by $11.6 million of third party bankruptcy fees and a $6.8 million credit agreement amendment fee.

Income Tax Expense (Benefit). During the year ended December 29, 2013, we recorded an income tax expense of $0.3 million due to the state tax related to the bankruptcy filing. During the year ended December 30, 2012, we recorded an income tax benefit of $0.2 million due to a reduction in uncertain tax positions which was partially offset by a tax expense due to the elimination of the tax effect related to the expiration of a previously terminated swap that could be fully recognized for tax purposes in the current year.

Net Income (Loss) from Continuing Operations. Net income from continuing operations for the year ended December 29, 2013 was $795.4 million and net loss from continuing operations for the year ended December 30, 2012 was $27.5 million. Our net income from continuing operations increased due to the factors noted above.

Year Ended December 30, 2012 Compared To Year Ended January 1, 2012

Comparisons to the prior year were impacted by two factors around the number of days in the reporting period. First, there was a 53rd week in 2011 for approximately 60% of the business already on a 52 week (5-4-4 quarterly) reporting cycle. Also in 2011, the remaining 40% of the Company changed its reporting cycle from a calendar year to a 52 week reporting cycle in order to be consistent with the rest of the Company. We estimate the 53rd week in 2011 resulted in $4.8 million of revenue and $3.8 million of operating and selling, general and administrative expense. Comparisons below have not been adjusted for this calendar change.

 

72


Table of Contents

Revenue. Total revenue for the year ended December 30, 2012 decreased by $26.1 million, or 5.1%, to $488.5 million from $514.6 million for the year ended January 1, 2012. The difference between same store revenue and GAAP revenue for the current period is immaterial, therefore, further revenue discussions will be limited to GAAP results. The decrease in total revenue was comprised of a $26.2 million, or 7.4%, decrease in advertising revenue and a $0.3 million, or 0.2%, decrease in circulation revenue which was partially offset by a $0.4 million, or 1.7%, increase in commercial printing and other revenue. Advertising revenue declines were primarily driven by declines on the print side of our business in the local retail and classified categories, which were partially offset by growth in digital advertising. The local retail print declines reflect both secular pressures and an uncertain and weak economic environment. These secular trends and economic conditions have also led to a decline in our print circulation volumes which have been offset by price increases in select locations. Our circulation revenue was also impacted by approximately $1.5 million for a net to gross accounting change due to a change from a carrier to a distributor model at one of our largest locations in 2012. The $0.4 million increase in commercial printing and other revenue is primarily the result of the launch of our small business marketing services and the stabilizing of our commercial printing operations during 2012.

Operating Costs. Operating costs for the year ended December 30, 2012 decreased by $13.7 million, or 4.8%, to $268.2 million from $281.9 million for the year ended January 1, 2012. The decrease in operating costs was primarily due to a decrease in compensation expenses, newsprint and ink, delivery and utility expenses of $12.4 million, $6.5 million, $3.3 million and $0.8 million, respectively, which were partially offset by an increase in outside services of $9.1 million. This decrease is the result of permanent cost reductions as we continue to work to consolidate operations and improve the productivity of our labor force.

Selling, General and Administrative. Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 30, 2012 decreased by $1.3 million, or 0.9%, to $145.0 million from $146.3 million for the year ended January 1, 2012. The decrease in selling, general and administrative expenses was primarily due to a decrease in compensation of $1.6 million. We expect that the majority of these reductions will be permanent in nature.

Depreciation and Amortization. Depreciation and amortization expense for the year ended December 30, 2012 decreased by $2.5 million to $39.9 million from $42.4 million for the year ended January 1, 2012. The decrease in depreciation and amortization expense was primarily due to the sale and disposal of assets in 2011 and 2012, which reduced depreciation expense.

Integration and Reorganization Costs. During the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, we recorded integration and reorganization costs of $4.4 million and $5.9 million, respectively, primarily resulting from severance costs related to the consolidation of certain print and other operations.

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets. During the year ended January 1, 2012, we incurred an impairment charge of $1.7 million related to the consolidation of our print operations and property, plant and equipment which were classified as held for sale. There were no such charges during the year ended December 30, 2012.

Goodwill and Mastheads Impairment. During the year ended January 1, 2012, we recorded a $0.4 million impairment on our goodwill due to an operational management change in the fourth quarter of 2011 which transferred a goodwill balance of $0.4 million to a reporting unit that previously did not have a goodwill balance. A similar operational change occurred in the first quarter of 2012 and resulted in a $0.2 million impairment that was subsequently reclassified to discontinued operations.

Interest Expense. Total interest expense for the year ended December 30, 2012 decreased by $0.4 million, or 0.7%, to $57.9 million from $58.3 million for the year ended January 1, 2012. The decrease was due to declines in interest rates and their related impact on the unhedged position or our debt and a slight decrease in our total outstanding debt.

 

73


Table of Contents

Loss (Gain) on Derivative Instruments. During the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, we recorded a net gain of $1.6 million and $0.9 million, respectively, which was comprised of reclassifications of accumulated other comprehensive income amortization related to swaps terminated in 2008 that were partially offset by the impact of the ineffectiveness of our remaining swap agreements.

Income Tax Expense (Benefit). During the year ended December 30, 2012, we recorded an income tax benefit of $0.2 million due to a reduction in uncertain tax positions which was partially offset by a tax expense due to the elimination of the tax effect related to the expiration of a previously terminated swap that could be fully recognized for tax purposes in the current year. During the year ended January 1, 2012, we recorded an income tax benefit of $1.8 million primarily due to the elimination of the tax effect related to the expiration of a previously terminated swap that could be fully recognized for tax purposes in the current year.

Net Loss from Continuing Operations. Net loss from continuing operations for the year ended December 30, 2012 was $27.5 million. Net loss from continuing operations for the year ended January 1, 2012 was $21.0 million. Our net loss from continuing operations increased due to the factors noted above.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Our primary cash requirements are for working capital, debt obligations and capital expenditures. We have no material outstanding commitments for capital expenditures. We expect our 2014 capital expenditure to total approximately between $5.5 million and $6.5 million. Our long term debt and debt service obligations were significantly reduced following the Restructuring. For more information on our long term debt and debt service obligations, see Note 7 to the Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Indebtedness.” Our principal sources of funds have historically been, and are expected to continue to be, cash provided by operating activities.

New Media Investment Group Inc., as a holding company, has no operations of its own and accordingly it has no independent means of generating revenue, and its internal sources of funds to meet its cash needs, including payment of expenses, are dividends and other permitted payments from our subsidiaries. The subsidiaries of New Media Investment Group Inc. have the operations that generate our revenue.

In the future, we expect to fund our operations through cash provided by operating activities, the incurrence of debt or the issuance of additional equity securities. The Company expects that it will have adequate capital resources and liquidity to meet its working capital needs, borrowing obligations and all required capital expenditures for at least the next twelve months.

Our leverage may adversely affect our business and financial performance and restricts our operating flexibility. The level of our indebtedness and our on-going cash flow requirements may expose us to a risk that a substantial decrease in operating cash flows due to, among other things, continued or additional adverse economic developments or adverse developments in our business, could make it difficult for us to meet the financial and operating covenants contained in our credit facilities. In addition, our leverage may limit cash flow available for general corporate purposes such as capital expenditures and our flexibility to react to competitive, technological and other changes in our industry and economic conditions generally.

GateHouse Credit Facilities

The Revolving Credit, Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “First Lien Credit Facility”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among GateHouse, GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, LLC formerly known as GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, LLC, Inc. (“GMIH”), certain wholly-owned subsidiaries of GMIH (collectively with GMIH and GateHouse, the “Loan Parties”), PNC Bank, National Association, as the administrative agent, Crystal Financial LLC, as term loan B agent, and each of the lenders party thereto provided for (i) a term loan A in the aggregate principal amount of $25 million, (ii) a term loan B in the aggregate

 

74


Table of Contents

principal amount of $50 million, and (iii) a revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $40 million. The Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “Second Lien Credit Facility” and together with the First Lien Credit Facility, the “GateHouse Credit Facilities”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among the Loan Parties, Mutual Quest Fund and each of the lenders party thereto provided for a term loan in an aggregate principal amount of $50 million. The GateHouse Credit Facilities were secured by a first and second priority security interest in substantially all the assets of the Loan Parties.

The GateHouse Credit Facilities imposed upon GateHouse certain financial and operating covenants, including, among others, requirements that GateHouse satisfy certain financial tests, including a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of not less than 1.0 to 1.0, a maximum leverage ratio of not greater than 3.25 to 1.0, a minimum EBITDA and a limitation on capital expenditures, and restrictions on GateHouse’s ability to incur additional debt, incur liens and encumbrances, consolidate, amalgamate or merge with any other person, pay dividends, dispose of assets, make certain restricted payments, engage in transactions with affiliates, materially alter the business it conducts and taking certain other corporate actions.

The GateHouse Credit Facilities were paid in full on June 4, 2014.

Local Media Credit Facility

Certain of Local Media Parents’s subsidiaries (together, the “Borrowers”) and Local Media Parent entered into a Credit Agreement, dated as of September 3, 2013, with a syndicate of financial institutions with Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch, as administrative agent (the “Local Media Credit Facility”). The Local Media Credit Facility provided for: (a) a $33 million term loan facility; and (b) a $10 million revolving credit facility, with a $3 million sub-facility for letters of credit and a $4 million sub-facility for swing loans. On October 25, 2013, CS assigned the revolving loan commitment to Capital One Business Corp and the revolving credit facility was activated.

The Local Media Credit Facility contained financial covenants that required Local Media Parent and the Borrowers to maintain (a) a Leverage Ratio of not more than 2.5 to 1.0 and a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) of at least 2.0 to 1.0, each measured at the end of each fiscal quarter for the four-quarter period then ended. The Local Media Credit Facility contained affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Local Media and the Borrowers customarily found in loan agreements for similar transactions, including, but not limited to, restrictions on their ability to incur indebtedness, create liens on assets, engage in certain lines of business, engage in mergers or consolidations, dispose of assets, make investments or acquisitions, engage in transactions with affiliates, pay dividends or make other restricted payments. The Local Media Credit Facility contained customary events of default, including, but not limited to, defaults based on a failure to pay principal, interest, fees or other obligations, subject to specified grace periods (other than with respect to principal); any material inaccuracy of representation or warranty; breach of covenants; default in other material indebtedness; a Change of Control (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility); bankruptcy and insolvency events; material judgments; certain ERISA events; and impairment of collateral. The Local Media Credit Facility was amended on October 17, 2013 and on February 28, 2014. The October 17, 2013 amendment corrected a typographical mistake. The February 28, 2014 amendment provided that among other things, sales of real property collateral and reinvestment of the proceeds from such sales could only be made with the consent of the Administrative Agent, modified the properties included in the real property collateral, and set forth in detail the documentary post-closing requirements with respect to the real property collateral.

The Local Media Credit Facility was paid in full on June 4, 2014.

 

75


Table of Contents

New Media Credit Agreement

On June 4, 2014, New Media Holdings II LLC (the “New Media Borrower”), a wholly owned subsidiary of New Media, entered into a credit agreement (the “New Media Credit Agreement”) among the New Media Borrower, New Media Holdings I LLC (“Holdings”), the lenders party thereto, RBS Citizens, N.A. and Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners, Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch as syndication agent and Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania as administration agent which provides for (i) a $200 million senior secured term facility (the “Term Loan Facility”) and (ii) a $25 million senior secured revolving credit facility, with a $5 million sub-facility for letters of credit and a $5 million sub-facility for swing loans, (the “Revolving Credit Facility” and together with the Term Loan Facility, the “Senior Secured Credit Facilities”). In addition, the New Media Borrower may request one or more new commitments for term loans or revolving loans from time to time up to an aggregate total of $75 million (the “Incremental Facility”) subject to certain conditions. On June 4, 2014, the New Media Borrower borrowed $200 million under the Term Loan Facility (the “Term Loans”). The Term Loans mature on June 4, 2020 and the maturity date for the Revolving Credit Facility is June 4, 2019. The proceeds of the Term Loans, which included a $6.7 million original issue discount, were used to repay in full all amounts outstanding under the GateHouse Credit Facilities, the Local Media Credit Facility and to pay fees associated with the financing, with the balance going to the Company for general corporate purposes.

The New Media Credit Agreement contains customary representations and warranties and customary affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Holdings, the New Media Borrower and the New Media Borrower’s subsidiaries, including, among other things, restrictions on indebtedness, liens, investments, fundamental changes, dispositions, and dividends and other distributions. The New Media Credit Agreement contains a financial covenant that requires Holdings I, the New Media Borrower and the New Media Borrower’s subsidiaries to maintain a maximum total leverage ratio of 3.25:1.00. The New Media Credit Agreement contains customary events of default. The foregoing descriptions of the Senior Secured Credit Facilities are qualified in their entirety by reference to the Senior Secured Credit Facilities. The New Media Credit Agreement was amended on July 17, 2014 to cure an omission.

One lender under the New Media Credit Agreement was also a lender under the GateHouse Credit Facilities. This portion of the transaction was accounted for as a modification under ASC Subtopic 470-50, “Debt Modifications and Extinguishments” (“ASC Subtopic 470-50”), as the difference between the present value of the cash flows under the New Media Credit Agreement and the present value of the cash flows under the GateHouse Credit Facilities was less than 10%. The unamortized deferred financing costs and original issuance discount balances as of the refinance date pertaining to this lender’s portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities will be amortized over the terms of the new facility. The remaining portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities and the Local Media Credit Facility debt refinancing constituted an extinguishment of debt under ASC Subtopic 470-50, and was accounted for accordingly. In connection with this transaction, the Company incurred approximately $10.2 million of fees and expenses, of which $6.7 million were recognized as original issue discount and $1.7 million were capitalized as deferred financing costs. These amounts will be amortized over the term of the new Senior Secured Credit Facilities. Additionally, The Company recorded a loss on early extinguishment of debt of $9.0 million associated with this transaction, which consisted of the write-off of unamortized deferred financing costs and other expenses not eligible for capitalization under ASC Subtopic 470-50.

On September 3, 2014, the New Media Credit Agreement was amended to provide for additional term loans under the Incremental Facility in an aggregate principal amount of $25 million (such term loans, the “Incremental Term Loan,” and such amendment, the “Incremental Amendment”). The Incremental Term Loan is on terms identical to the term loans that were extended pursuant to the New Media Credit Agreement and will mature on June 4, 2020. In addition, the New Media Borrower was required to pay an upfront fee of 2.00% of the aggregate amount of the Incremental Term Loan as of the effective date of the Incremental Amendment.

 

76


Table of Contents

As of June 29, 2014, the Company is in compliance with all of the covenants and obligations under the New Media Credit Agreement.

Refer to “Indebtedness” section below for further discussion of the New Media Credit Agreement.

Cash Flows

Six Months Ended June 29, 2014 Compared to Six Months Ended June 30, 2013

The following table summarizes our historical cash flows.

 

     Successor Company
Six months ended
June 29, 2014
    Predecessor
Company
Six months ended
June 30, 2013
 

Cash provided by (used in) operating activities

   $ 3,181      $ (1,089 )

Cash used in investing activities

     (9,356     (1,278 )

Cash provided by (used in) financing activities

     5,711        (6,648 )

The discussion of our cash flows that follows is based on our historical cash flows for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and for the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013.

Cash Flows from Operating Activities. Net cash provided by operating activities for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 was $3.2 million, an increase of $4.3 million when compared to $1.1 million of cash used in operating activities for the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013. This $4.3 million increase was the result of a decrease in net loss of $21.7 million and an increase in non-cash charges of $4.7, which was offset by a decrease in cash provided by working capital of $22.1 million.

The $22.1 million decrease in cash provided by working capital for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 when compared to the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013 is primarily attributable to a decrease in accrued expenses and accounts payable and an increase in other assets.

The $4.7 million increase in non-cash charges primarily consisted of an increase in non-cash loss on early extinguishment of debt of $5.9 million, an increase in depreciation and amortization of $0.2 million, and increase in amortization of deferred financing costs of $0.2 million, and an increase in non-cash interest expense of $0.1 million. These increases were offset by a decrease in loss on the sale of assets of $1.5 million and an increase in pension and other postretirement benefit obligations of $0.2 million.

Cash Flows from Investing Activities. Net cash used in investing activities for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 was $9.4 million. During the six months ended June 29, 2014, we used $8.0 million, net of cash acquired, for acquisitions and $1.6 million for capital expenditures, which was offset by $0.3 million we received from the sale of publications and other assets.

Net cash used in investing activities for the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013 was $1.3 million. During the six months ended June 30, 2013, the Predecessor used $2.0 million for capital expenditures, which was offset by $0.7 million we received from the sale of publications and other assets.

Cash Flows from Financing Activities. Net cash provided by financing activities for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 was $5.7 million due to borrowings under term loans of $193.3 million and borrowings under the revolving credit facility of $7.1 million, which were offset by repayments under long-term debt of $158.0 million, repayments under the revolving credit facility of $32.1 million, and the payment of debt issuance costs of $4.6 million.

 

77


Table of Contents

Net cash used in financing activities for the Predecessor Company for the six months ended June 30, 2013 was $6.6 million due to a repayment under the 2007 Credit Facility, as amended.

Changes in Financial Position

The discussion that follows highlights significant changes in our financial position and working capital from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014.

Accounts Receivable. Accounts receivable decreased $6.1 million from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, which relates to the timing of cash collections and lower same store revenue recognized in the 2014 six month period compared to 2013, which was partially offset by $0.7 million of assets acquired in the six month period ending June 29, 2014.

Other Current Assets. Other current assets increased $3.3 million from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, which primarily relates to an increase in deferred income taxes.

Property, Plant, and Equipment. Property, plant, and equipment decreased $11.7 million during the period from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, of which $16.7 million relates to depreciation and $1.1 million relates to assets sold or classified as held for sale, which was partially offset by $5.1 million of assets acquired and $1.6 million that was used for capital expenditures.

Deferred Financing Costs, Net. Deferred financing costs, net decreased $4.8 million during the period from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, of which $5.9 million relates to the non-cash loss on early extinguishment of debt and $0.8 million relates to amortization of deferred financing costs, which was offset by $1.7 million of new debt issuance costs that were capitalized related to the New Media Credit Agreement.

Current Portion of Long-term Debt. Current portion of long-term debt decreased $2.8 million from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, due to the amortization terms within the New Media Credit Agreement (1% annually) compared to the GateHouse Credit Facilities and Local Media Credit Facility.

Accounts Payable. Accounts payable decreased $5.5 million from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, which primarily relates to the timing of vendor payments. This decrease was partially offset by $0.1 million of liabilities acquired in the first three months of 2014.

Accrued Expenses. Accrued expenses decreased $15.0 million from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, due to the payment of legal fees of $6.7 million, a $4.6 payment of a pension liability made by Local Media on behalf of the seller (an affiliate of Dow Jones & Company, Inc.) which was accrued for at December 29, 2013, the payment of debt issuance costs of $2.7 million which were accrued at December 29, 2013, and $1.0 million of accrued bonuses at December 29, 2013 which were paid in the first six months of 2014. These decreases in accrued expenses were partially offset by $0.4 million which was acquired in the first three months of 2014.

Long-term Debt. Long-term debt increased $13.2 million from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, due to borrowings under term loans of $191.8 million, which includes a $6.7 million original issue discount, borrowings under the revolving credit facility of $7.1 million, and $0.1 million non-cash interest expense. These increases were offset by repayments under long-term debt of $152.9 million, repayments under the revolving credit facility of $32.1 million, an $0.8 million reclassification from long-term debt to current portion of long-term debt.

(Accumulated Deficit) Retained Earnings. Retained earnings decreased $10.0 million from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014, due to a net loss of $10.0 million.

 

78


Table of Contents

Year Ended December 29, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 30, 2012 and Year Ended December 30, 2012 Compared to Year Ended January 1, 2012

The following table summarizes our historical cash flows for the periods presented.

 

     Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
     Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Year
Ended

January 1,
2012
 
(in thousands)                              

Cash provided by (used in) operating activities

   $ 16,160          $ (5,972   $ 23,499      $ 22,439   

Cash used in investing activities

     (1,377         (2,799     (1,044     (731

Cash used in financing activities

     (3,690         (5,038     (7,140     (11,249

Cash Flows from Operating Activities. Net cash provided by operating activities for the two months ended December 29, 2013 was $16.2 million. The net cash provided by operating activities resulted from net income of $7.2 million, depreciation and amortization of $6.6 million, a net increase in cash provided by working capital of $2.2 million, and amortization of deferred financing costs of $0.2 million. The increase in cash provided by working capital primarily resulted from an increase accrued expenses and accounts payable offset by an increase in accounts receivable.

Net cash used in operating activities for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 was $6.0 million. The net cash used in operating activities resulted from non-cash reorganization items, net of $954.6 million and an increase funding of pension and other post-retirement obligations of $1.1 million, partially offset by net income of $787.2 million, an impairment of long-lived assets of $91.6 million, an increase in non-cash interest related to unrealized losses upon dedesignation of cash flow hedges of $26.3 million, depreciation and amortization of $33.5 million, a net increase in cash provided by working capital of $8.0 million, a $2.3 million loss on the sale of assets, and amortization of deferred financing costs of $0.8 million. The increase in cash provided by working capital primarily resulted from an increase in accrued expenses.

Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 30, 2012 was $23.5 million. The net cash provided by operating activities resulted from a depreciation and amortization of $40.6 million, a net increase in cash provided by working capital of $10.3 million, an impairment of long-lived assets of $2.1 million, a $1.3 million loss on the sale of assets, amortization of deferred financing costs of $1.2 million, a goodwill impairment charge of $0.2 million, and non-cash compensation of $0.1 million, partially offset by a net loss of $29.8 million, a gain of $1.6 million on derivative instruments, and an increase funding of pension and other post-retirement obligations of $0.9 million. The increase in cash provided by working capital primarily resulted from a decrease in prepaid expenses related to a newsprint pricing agreement that required a prepayment of $10 million in fiscal 2011. No such prepayment was required in fiscal 2012.

Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended January 1, 2012 was $22.4 million. The net cash provided by operating activities resulted from a depreciation and amortization of $43.4 million, an impairment of long-lived assets of $2.1 million, amortization of deferred financing costs of $1.4 million, a $0.8 million loss on the sale of assets, non-cash compensation of $0.5 million, a goodwill impairment charge of $0.4 million, partially offset by a net loss of $21.6 million, an increase funding of pension and other post-retirement obligations of $1.9 million, a net decrease in cash provided by working capital of $1.6 million, and a gain of $0.9 million on derivative instruments. The decrease in cash provided by working capital primarily resulted from a decrease in accrued expenses and an increase in prepaid expenses related to a newsprint pricing agreement that allowed for fixed pricing in 2012 below market rates from December 31, 2010 to January 1, 2012 offset by a decrease in accounts receivable and an increase in accounts payable.

 

79


Table of Contents

Cash Flows from Investing Activities. Net cash used in investing activities for the two months ended December 29, 2013 was $1.4 million. During the two months ended December 29, 2013, we used $1.5 million for capital expenditures, which was offset by 0.1 million received from the sale of publications, other assets and insurance proceeds.

Net cash used in investing activities for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 was $2.8 million. During the ten months ended November 6, 2013, we used $3.6 million for capital expenditures, which was offset by $0.8 million received from the sale of publications, other assets and insurance proceeds.

Net cash used in investing activities for the year ended December 30, 2012 was $1.0 million. During the year ended December 30, 2012, we used $4.6 million for capital expenditures, which was offset by $3.6 million received from the sale of publications, other assets and insurance proceeds.

Net cash used in investing activities for the year ended January 1, 2012 was $0.7 million. During the year ended January 1, 2012, we used $3.3 million for capital expenditures, which was offset by $2.6 million received from the sale of publications, other assets and insurance proceeds.

Cash Flows from Financing Activities. Net cash used in financing activities for the two months ended December 29, 2013 was $3.7 million due to the payment of dividends of $149.0 million and the payment of debt issuance costs of $3.7 million offset by borrowings under the GateHouse Credit Facilities of $149.0 million.

Net cash used in financing activities for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 was $5.0 million due to a repayment under the 2007 Credit Facility of $6.6 million which was offset by additional paid-in capital of $1.6 million related to the VIE Local Media.

Net cash used in financing activities for the year ended December 30, 2012 was $7.1 million due to repayments under the 2007 Credit Facility.

Net cash used in financing activities for the year ended January 1, 2012 was $11.2 million due to a repayment under the 2007 Credit Facility.

Changes in Financial Position

The discussion that follows highlights significant changes in our financial position and working capital from December 29, 2013 to December 30, 2012.

Accounts Receivable. Accounts receivable increased $16.7 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013. This increase was due to $14.3 million of receivables related to the Local Media acquisition during the third quarter of 2013, which was partially offset by the timing of cash collections and lower revenue recognized in 2013 compared to 2012.

Inventory. Inventory increased $1.7 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, which primarily relates to the Local Media acquisition during the third quarter of 2013.

Prepaid Expenses. Prepaid expenses increased $2.2 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, which primarily relates to the Local Media acquisition during the third quarter of 2013.

Property, Plant, and Equipment. Property, plant, and equipment increased $153.6 million during the period from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $97.5 million relates to fresh start accounting adjustments, $73.7 million relates to the Local Media consolidation in the third quarter of 2013, and $5.2 million that was related to capital expenditures. These increases in property, plant, and equipment were partially offset by $20.7 of depreciation and $2.2 million relates to assets sold, classified as held for sale and discontinued operations.

 

80


Table of Contents

Goodwill. Goodwill increased $112.2 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $111.0 million relates to fresh start accounting adjustments and $1.2 million from the Local Media Contribution (as defined below) and consolidation.

Intangible Assets. Intangible assets decreased $73.6 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $91.6 million relates to an impairment charge in the third quarter and $19.3 million of amortization, which were offset by an increase of $33.3 million of fresh start accounting adjustments and $4.1 million from the Local Media consolidation in the third quarter of 2013.

Deferred Financing Costs, Net. Deferred financing costs, net increased $6.6 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $8.5 million relates to the payment and accrual related to our new debt facilities, which was offset by $1.0 million of amortization of deferred financing costs and the write-off of deferred financing costs of $0.9 million on our former debt.

Current Portion of Long-term Debt. Current portion of long-term debt decreased $2.3 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, due to a $6.6 million principal payment as required by the 2007 Credit Facility, as amended, which represented 50% of the Excess Cash Flow related to the fiscal year ended December 30, 2012, which was offset by $3.5 million in borrowings under the GateHouse Credit Facilities and $0.8 million in borrowings under the Local Media Credit Facility.

Accounts Payable. Accounts payable increased $1.6 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $1.3 million relates to Local Media consolidation during the third quarter of 2013 and $1.0 million primarily relates to the timing of vendor payments, which was partially offset by $0.7 million from the disposal of a non wholly owned subsidiary in Chicago, Illinois.

Accrued Expenses. Accrued expenses increased $28.7 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, which primarily resulted from $16.6 million from the Local Media Contribution (as defined below) and consolidation during the third quarter of 2013 and the $14.5 million accrual of professional and legal fees that were not paid as of December 29, 2013.

Accrued Interest. Accrued interest decreased $3.8 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, which primarily resulted from the reduction of our outstanding debt balances in connection with the bankruptcy filing.

Long-term Debt. Long-term debt decreased $989.7 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $1,167.5 million resulted from the elimination of the 2007 Credit Facility in connection with the bankruptcy filing, which was offset by $145.5 million in borrowings under the GateHouse Credit Facilities and $32.2 million in borrowings under the Local Media Credit Facility.

Derivative Instruments. Derivative instrument liability decreased $45.7 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $19.3 million was due to changes in the fair value measurement of our interest rate swaps and $26.3 million resulted from the elimination of the derivative instrument liability in connection with the bankruptcy filing.

Pension and Other Postretirement Benefit Obligations. Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations decreased $5.3 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $3.3 million relates to fresh start accounting adjustments and a $2.0 million change to the Company’s pension and postretirement plans throughout the year.

Additional Paid-In Capital. Additional paid-in capital decreased $443.9 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $831.4 million relates to fresh start accounting adjustments and $149.0 million payment of dividends. These decreases were offset by additional paid-in capital of $536.4 million related to the issuance of new common stock, warrants, and the contribution of Local Media in connection with emergence from Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy.

 

81


Table of Contents

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss). Accumulated other comprehensive income increased $53.1 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, of which $26.3 million resulted from a release of accumulated other comprehensive loss related to the termination of the derivative agreements, $19.3 resulted from the change in fair value of the interest rate swaps, $6.9 million relates to the elimination of the Predecessor accumulated other comprehensive loss as part of the fresh start accounting, and a $0.5 million change to the Company’s pension and postretirement plans.

Retained Earnings (Accumulated Deficit). Accumulated deficit decreased $1,618.1 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013, due to plan effects and fresh start accounting adjustments of $1,792.7 million that reset accumulated deficit to zero, and Successor net income of $7.2 million which was partially offset by Predecessor net loss of $181.8 million during the period from December 31, 2012 through November 6, 2013.

Noncontrolling Interest. Noncontrolling interest decreased $2.2 million from December 30, 2012 to December 29, 2013 due to $2.2 million related to the disposal of a non wholly owned subsidiary.

Indebtedness

GateHouse Credit Facilities

The First Lien Credit Facility provided for (i) a term loan A in the aggregate principal amount of $25,000, (ii) a term loan B in the aggregate principal amount of $50,000, (iii) and a revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $40,000.

The Second Lien Credit Facility provided for a term loan in an aggregate principal amount of $50,000. The GateHouse Credit Facilities were secured by a first and second priority security interest in substantially all the assets of the Loan Parties.

The GateHouse Credit Facilities imposed upon GateHouse certain financial and operating covenants, including, among others, requirements that GateHouse satisfy certain financial tests, including a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of not less than 1.0 to 1.0, a maximum leverage ratio of not greater than 3.25 to 1.0, a minimum EBITDA and a limitation on capital expenditures, and restrictions on GateHouse’s ability to incur additional debt, incur liens and encumbrances, consolidate, amalgamate or merge with any other person, pay dividends, dispose of assets, make certain restricted payments, engage in transactions with affiliates, materially alter the business it conducts and taking certain other corporate actions.

The GateHouse Credit Facilities were paid in full on June 4, 2014.

Local Media Credit Facility

The Local Media Credit Facility provided for: (a) a $33,000 term loan facility; and (b) a $10,000 revolving credit facility, with a $3,000 sub-facility for letters of credit and a $4,000 sub-facility for swing loans. The Borrowers used the proceeds of the Local Media Credit Facility to (a) fund a portion of the acquisition of Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Local Media Acquisition”), (b) provide for working capital and other general corporate purposes of the Borrowers and (c) fund certain fees, costs and expenses associated with the transactions contemplated by the Local Media Credit Facility and consummation of the Local Media Acquisition. The Local Media Credit Facility was secured by a first priority security interest in substantially all assets of the Borrowers and Local Media Parent. In addition, the loans and other obligations of the Borrowers under the Local Media Credit Facility were guaranteed by Local Media Group Holdings LLC.

The Local Media Credit Facility contained financial covenants that required Local Media Parent and the Borrowers to maintain (a) a Leverage Ratio of not more than 2.5 to 1.0 and a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) of at least 2.0 to 1.0, each measured at the end of each fiscal quarter

 

82


Table of Contents

for the four-quarter period then ended. The Local Media Credit Facility contained affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Local Media and the Borrowers customarily found in loan agreements for similar transactions, including, but not limited to, restrictions on their ability to incur indebtedness, create liens on assets, engage in certain lines of business, engage in mergers or consolidations, dispose of assets, make investments or acquisitions, engage in transactions with affiliates, pay dividends or make other restricted payments. The Local Media Credit Facility contained customary events of default, including, but not limited to, defaults based on a failure to pay principal, interest, fees or other obligations, subject to specified grace periods (other than with respect to principal); any material inaccuracy of representation or warranty; breach of covenants; default in other material indebtedness; a Change of Control (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility); bankruptcy and insolvency events; material judgments; certain ERISA events; and impairment of collateral. The Local Media Credit Facility was amended on October 17, 2013 and February 28, 2014. The October 17, 2013 amendment corrected a typographical mistake. The February 28, 2014 amendment provided that among other things, sales of real property collateral and reinvestment of the proceeds from such sale could only be made with the consent of the Administrative Agent, modified the properties included in the real property collateral, and set forth in detail the documentary post-closing requirements with respect to the real property collateral.

The Local Media Credit Facility was paid in full on June 4, 2014.

New Media Credit Agreement

The New Media Credit Agreement provides for the Senior Secured Credit Facilities. In addition, the New Media Borrower may request one or more new commitments under the Incremental Facility subject to certain conditions. On June 4, 2014, the New Media Borrower borrowed the Term Loans. The Term Loans mature on June 4, 2020 and the maturity date for the Revolving Credit Facility is June 4, 2019.

The proceeds of the Term Loans, which included a $6,725 original issue discount, were used to repay in full all amounts outstanding under the GateHouse Credit Facilities, the Local Media Credit Facility and to pay fees associated with the financing, with the balance going to the Company for general corporate purposes.

Borrowings under the Term Loan Facility bear interest, at the New Media Borrower’s option, at a rate equal to either (i) the Eurodollar Rate (as defined in the New Media Credit Agreement), plus an applicable margin equal to 6.25% per annum (subject to a Eurodollar Rate floor of 1.00%) or (ii) the Base Rate (as defined in the New Media Credit Agreement), plus an applicable margin equal to 5.25% per annum (subject to a Base Rate floor of 2.00%).

Borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facility bear interest, at the New Media Borrower’s option, at a rate equal to either (i) the Eurodollar Rate, plus an applicable margin equal to 5.25% per annum or (ii) the Base Rate, plus an applicable margin equal to 4.25% per annum, with a step down based on achievement of a certain total leverage ratio.

If any borrowings under the Incremental Facility have an all-in yield more than 50 basis points greater than the Term Loans (the “Incremental Yield”), the all-in yield for the Term Loans shall be adjusted to be 50 basis points less than the Incremental Yield.

The Senior Secured Credit Facilities are unconditionally guaranteed by Holdings I and certain subsidiaries of the New Media Borrower (collectively, the “Guarantors”) and is required to be guaranteed by all future material wholly-owned domestic subsidiaries, subject to certain exceptions. All obligations under the New Media Credit Agreement are secured, subject to certain exceptions, by substantially all of the New Media Borrower’s assets and the assets of the Guarantors, including (a) a pledge of 100% of the equity interests of the New Media Borrower and the Guarantors (other than Holdings I), (b) a mortgage lien on the New Media Borrower’s material real property and that of the Guarantors and (c) all proceeds of the foregoing.

Repayments made under the Term Loans are equal to 1.0% annually of the original principal amount in equal quarterly installments for the life of the Term Loans, with the remainder due at maturity. The New Media

 

83


Table of Contents

Borrower is permitted to make voluntary prepayments at any time without premium or penalty, except in the case of prepayments made in connection with certain repricing transactions with respect to the Term Loans effected within six months of the closing date of the New Media Credit Agreement, to which a 1.00% prepayment premium applies. The New Media Borrower is required to repay borrowings under the Senior Secured Credit Facilities (without payment of a premium) with (i) net cash proceeds of certain debt obligations (except as otherwise permitted under the New Media Credit Agreement), (ii) net cash proceeds from non-ordinary course asset sales (subject to reinvestment rights and other exceptions), and (iii) commencing with the Company’s fiscal year started December 30, 2013, 100% of Excess Cash Flow (as defined in the New Media Credit Agreement), subject to step-downs to 50%, 25% and 0% of Excess Cash Flow based on achievement of a total leverage ratio of less than or equal to 3.00 to 1.00 but greater than 2.75 to 1.00; less than or equal to 2.75 to 1.00 but greater than 2.50 to 1.00; and less than or equal to 2.50 to 1.00, respectively.

The New Media Credit Agreement contains customary representations and warranties and customary affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Holdings I, the New Media Borrower and the New Media Borrower’s subsidiaries, including, among other things, restrictions on indebtedness, liens, investments, fundamental changes, dispositions, and dividends and other distributions. The New Media Credit Agreement contains a financial covenant that requires Holdings I, the New Media Borrower and the New Media Borrower’s subsidiaries to maintain a maximum total leverage ratio of 3.25 to 1.00. The New Media Credit Agreement contains customary events of default. The foregoing descriptions of the Senior Secured Credit Facilities are qualified in their entirety by reference to the Senior Secured Credit Facilities. The New Media Credit Agreement was amended on July 17, 2014 to cure an omission.

One lender under the New Media Credit Agreement was also a lender under the GateHouse Credit Facilities. This portion of the transaction was accounted for as a modification under ASC Subtopic 470-50, “Debt Modifications and Extinguishments” (“ASC Subtopic 470-50”), as the difference between the present value of the cash flows under the New Media Credit Agreement and the present value of the cash flows under the GateHouse Credit Facilities was less than 10%. The unamortized deferred financing costs and original issuance discount balances as of the refinance date pertaining to this lender’s portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities will be amortized over the terms of the new facility. The remaining portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities and the Local Media Credit Facility debt refinancing constituted an extinguishment of debt under ASC Subtopic 470-50, and was accounted for accordingly. In connection with this transaction, the Company incurred approximately $10,202 of fees and expenses, of which $6,725 were recognized as original issue discount and $1,700 were capitalized as deferred financing costs. These amounts will be amortized over the term of the new Senior Secured Credit Facilities. Additionally, the Company recorded a loss on early extinguishment of debt of $9,047 associated with this transaction, which consisted of the write-off of unamortized deferred financing costs and other expenses not eligible for capitalization under ASC Subtopic 470-50.

On September 3, 2014, the New Media Credit Agreement was amended to provide for the Incremental Term Loan. The Incremental Term Loan is on terms identical to the term loans that were extended pursuant to the New Media Credit Agreement and will mature on June 4, 2020. In addition, the New Media Borrower was required to pay an upfront fee of 2.00% of the aggregate amount of the Incremental Term Loan as of the effective date of the Incremental Amendment.

As of June 29, 2014, the Company is in compliance with all of the covenants and obligations under the New Media Credit Agreement.

 

84


Table of Contents

Summary Disclosure About Contractual Obligations and Commercial Commitments

The following table reflects a summary of our contractual cash obligations, including estimated interest payments where applicable, as of December 29, 2013:

 

     2014      2015      2016      2017      2018      Thereafter      Total  
     (In Thousands)  

Debt obligations

   $ 19,086       $ 20,518       $ 25,005       $ 26,602       $ 118,159       $ 56,280       $ 265,650   

Noncompete payments

     286         250         200         200         200         —          1,136   

Operating lease obligations

     4,320         3,594         3,277         3,205         2,299         1,895         18,590   

Letters of credit

     5,182         —          —          —          —          —          5,182   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 28,874       $ 24,362       $ 28,482       $ 30,007       $ 120,658       $ 58,175       $ 290,558   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The table above excludes future cash requirements for pension and postretirement obligations. The periods in which these obligations will be settled in cash are not readily determinable and are subject to numerous future events and assumptions. We estimate cash requirements for these obligations in 2014 totaling approximately $1,913. See Note 16 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Note 11 to New Media’s Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Pension and Postretirement Benefits.”

We do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements reasonably likely to have a current or future effect on our financial statements.

The refinancing of the GateHouse Credit Facilities and the Local Media Credit Facility with the New Media Credit Agreement on June 4, 2014 impacted our contractual obligations as they relate to debt obligations. The New Media Credit Agreement increased our overall debt, lowered our average interest rate and decreased our annual amortization requirements. The result had no material impact on our overall interest obligations, lowered our annual amortization payments and increased the payoff amount at termination. See Note 7 to New Media’s Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Indebtedness,” for more information.

Contractual Commitments

Credit Amendment

On or around September 4, 2013, GateHouse and certain lenders (including Newcastle) constituting the “Required Lenders” under the 2007 Credit Agreement entered into the Amendment Agreement to the 2007 Credit Agreement effective September 3, 2013 ( the “Credit Amendment”). Pursuant to the terms of the Credit Amendment, GateHouse obtained the following improvement in terms: a clarified and expanded definition of “Eligible Assignee”; an increase in the base amount in the formula used to calculate the “Permitted Investments” basket from $35 million to a base of $50 million; the removal of the requirement that GateHouse’s annual financial statements not have a “going concern” or like qualification to the audit; the removal of a cross default from any Secured Hedging Agreement to the 2007 Credit Agreement; the removal of a Bankruptcy Default, as defined therein, arising from actions in furtherance of or indicating consent to the specified actions; and a waiver of any prior Default or Event of Default, as defined therein, including without limitation from the negotiation, entry into, or performance of the Support Agreement or the investment commitment letter entered into in connection with the Restructuring pursuant to which the Plan Sponsor agreed to purchase the Cash-Out Offer claims.

In consideration of the changes described above, GateHouse agreed to pay each of the lenders party to the Credit Amendment that timely executed and delivered its signature to the Credit Amendment and the Support Agreement, an amendment fee equal to 3.5% multiplied by the aggregate outstanding amount of the loans held (including through trades pending settlement) by such lender, unless waived in writing. Newcastle and certain other lenders elected to waive their amendment fee pursuant to the Credit Amendment. Newcastle indemnified other lenders with respect to their entry into the Credit Amendment, subject to the limitations set forth in the Credit Amendment. Such fee amounted to $6.8 million.

 

85


Table of Contents

Derivative Instruments

The bankruptcy filing on September 27, 2013, was a termination event under our Predecessor’s interest rate swap agreements.

On February 25, 2014, the Company entered into an interest rate swap with a notional amount of $6,250, which would have matured in November 2018, to economically hedge the risk of fluctuations in interest payments with respect to the First Lien Credit Facility under the GateHouse Credit Facilities. The interest rate swap agreement was terminated on June 4, 2014 when the GateHouse Credit Facilities were paid in full. Under the swap agreement, the Company received interest equivalent to one-month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 1.5%, with settlements occurring monthly. The Company did not designate this swap as a cash flow hedge for accounting purposes. The gains (losses) on the swap were recorded in gain (loss) on derivative instruments on the consolidated statements of operations. The counterparty on the interest rate swap was PNC Bank, N.A.

No other material changes were made to our contractual commitments during the period from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

In July 2013, the FASB issued ASU No. 2013-11, Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists” which requires an unrecognized tax benefit to be presented as a reduction to a deferred tax asset for a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss or a tax credit carryforward that the entity intends to use as of the reporting date. The Company will adopt the provisions of ASU No. 2013-11 in fiscal 2014. Adoptions of ASU No. 2013-11 are not expected to have a material impact on the financial statements.

In April 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-08, “Presentation of Financial Statements and Property, Plant, and Equipment: Reporting Discontinued Operations and Disclosures of Disposals of Components of an Entity”. ASU 2014-08 changes the criteria for reporting discontinued operations while enhancing disclosures in this area and is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2014. The amendments in ASU No. 2014-08 are not expected to have a material impact on the financial statements.

In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-09, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers.” ASU 2014-09 will replace all current U.S. GAAP guidance on this topic and eliminate all industry-specific guidance. The new revenue recognition standard provides a unified model to determine when and how revenue is recognized. The core principle is that a company should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. This guidance will be effective for annual and interim reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2016. The Company is currently reviewing the amendments in ASU No. 2014-09, but does not expect them to have a material impact on the financial statements.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

A non-GAAP financial measure is generally defined as one that purports to measure historical or future financial performance, financial position or cash flows, but excludes or includes amounts that would not be so adjusted in the most comparable GAAP measure. In this Prospectus, we define and use “Adjusted EBITDA,” a non-GAAP financial measure, as set forth below.

Adjusted EBITDA

We define Adjusted EBITDA as follows:

Income (loss) from continuing operations before:

 

    Income tax expense (benefit);

 

86


Table of Contents
    interest/financing expense;

 

    depreciation and amortization; and

 

    non-cash impairments.

Management’s Use of Adjusted EBITDA

Adjusted EBITDA is not a measurement of financial performance under GAAP and should not be considered in isolation or as an alternative to income from operations, net income (loss), cash flow from continuing operating activities or any other measure of performance or liquidity derived in accordance with GAAP. We believe this non-GAAP measure, as we have defined it, is helpful in identifying trends in our day-to-day performance because the items excluded have little or no significance on our day-to-day operations. This measure provides an assessment of controllable expenses and affords management the ability to make decisions which are expected to facilitate meeting current financial goals as well as achieve optimal financial performance. We believe that it also provides an indicator for management to determine if adjustments to current spending decisions are needed.

Adjusted EBITDA provides us with a measure of financial performance, independent of items that are beyond the control of management in the short-term, such as depreciation and amortization, taxation, non-cash impairments and interest expense associated with our capital structure. This metric measures our financial performance based on operational factors that management can impact in the short-term, namely the cost structure or expenses of the organization. Adjusted EBITDA is one of the metrics we use to review the financial performance of our business on a monthly basis.

Limitations of Adjusted EBITDA

Adjusted EBITDA has limitations as an analytical tool. It should not be viewed in isolation or as a substitute for GAAP measures of earnings or cash flows. Material limitations in making the adjustments to our earnings to calculate Adjusted EBITDA and using this non-GAAP financial measure as compared to GAAP net income (loss), include: the cash portion of interest/financing expense, income tax (benefit) provision and charges related to gain (loss) on sale of facilities represent charges (gains), which may significantly affect our financial results.

A reader of our financial statements may find this item important in evaluating our performance, results of operations and financial position. We use non-GAAP financial measures to supplement our GAAP results in order to provide a more complete understanding of the factors and trends affecting our business.

Adjusted EBITDA is not an alternative to net income, income from operations or cash flows provided by or used in operations as calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP. Readers of our financial statements should not rely on Adjusted EBITDA as a substitute for any such GAAP financial measure. We strongly urge readers of our financial statements to review the reconciliation of income (loss) from continuing operations to Adjusted EBITDA, along with our consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report. We also strongly urge readers of our financial statements to not rely on any single financial measure to evaluate our business. In addition, because Adjusted EBITDA is not a measure of financial performance under GAAP and is susceptible to varying calculations, the Adjusted EBITDA measure, as presented in this Prospectus, may differ from and may not be comparable to similarly titled measures used by other companies.

We use Adjusted EBITDA as a measure of our core operating performance, which is evidenced by the publishing and delivery of news and other media and excludes certain expenses that may not be indicative of our core business operating results. We consider the unrealized (gain) loss on derivative instruments and the (gain) loss on early extinguishment of debt to be financing related costs associated with interest expense or amortization of financing fees. Accordingly, we exclude financing related costs such as the early extinguishment of debt because they represent the write-off of deferred financing costs and we believe these non-cash write-offs are

 

87


Table of Contents

similar to interest expense and amortization of financing fees, which by definition are excluded from Adjusted EBITDA. Additionally, the non-cash gains (losses) on derivative contracts, which are related to interest rate swap agreements to manage interest rate risk, are financing costs associated with interest expense. Such charges are incidental to, but not reflective of, our core operating performance and it is appropriate to exclude charges related to financing activities such as the early extinguishment of debt and the unrealized (gain) loss on derivative instruments which, depending on the nature of the financing arrangement, would have otherwise been amortized over the period of the related agreement and does not require a current cash settlement.

The table below shows the reconciliation of income (loss) from continuing operations to Adjusted EBITDA for the periods presented:

 

    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
    Successor
Company
         Predecessor
Company
    Combined          Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Three
months
ended

 June 29, 
2014
         Three
months
ended

June 30,
2013
    Six
months
ended
June 29,
2014
         Six
months
ended

June 30,
2013
    Year
Ended
December  29,
2013
         Two
Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten
Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year
Ended
December 30,
2012
(3)
    Year
Ended
January  1,
2012
    Year
Ended
December  31,
2010
    Year
Ended
December  31,
2009
 
(in thousands)                                                                                      

Loss from continuing operations

  $ (3,269       $ (13,176   $ (9,960       $ (30,603   $ 795,446          $ 7,206          $ 788,240      $ (27,463   $ (20,950   $ (25,502   $ (510,815

Income tax expense (benefit)

    (2,481         —         (3,067         —         294            491            (197     (207     (1,803     (155     342   

(Gain) loss on derivative instruments(1)

    76            5        51            9        14            —             14        (1,635     (913     8,277        12,672   

Gain on early extinguishment of debt(2)

    9,047            —         9,047            —         —             —             —         —         —         —         (7,538

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    333            261        758            522        1,013            171            842        1,255        1,360        1,360        1,360   

Write-off of financing costs

    —             —         —             —         —             —             —         —         —         —         743   

Interest expense

    3,827            14,456        7,632            28,886        75,998            1,640            74,358        57,928        58,309        60,021        64,615   

Impairment of long-lived assets

              —         —             —         91,599            —             91,599        —         1,733        430        193,041   

Depreciation and amortization

    10,109            9,791        19,918            19,636        39,997            6,588            33,409        39,888        42,426        45,080        54,237   

Goodwill and mastheads impairment

    —             —         —             —         —             —             —         —         385       —         273,914   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA from continuing operations

  $ 17,642 (a)        $ 11,337 (b)    $ 24,379 (c)        $ 18,450 (d)    $ 1,004,361          $ 16,096 (e)        $ 988,265 (f)    $ 69,766 (g)    $ 80,547 (h)    $ 89,511 (i)    $ 82,571 (j) 
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Adjusted EBITDA for the three months ended June 29, 2014 included net expenses of $6,622, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $6,622 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $5,522, integration and reorganization costs of $412 and a $688 loss on the sale of assets.

 

(b) Adjusted EBITDA for the three months ended June 30, 2013 included net expenses of $6,280, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $6,280 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $5,103, non-cash portion of postretirement benefits expense of $(213), integration and reorganization costs of $741 and a $649 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $275 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(c) Adjusted EBITDA for the six months ended June 29, 2014 included net expenses of $8,985, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $8,985 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $7,461, integration and reorganization costs of $837 and a $687 loss on the sale of assets.

 

88


Table of Contents
(d) Adjusted EBITDA for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included net expenses of $7,949, which are one-time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $7,949 is non-cash compensation and other expense of $6,376, non-cash portion of postretirement benefits expense of $(428), integration and reorganization costs of $958 and a $1,043 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $123 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(e) Adjusted EBITDA for the two months ended December 29, 2013 included net expenses of $4,828, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $4,828 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $3,043, integration and reorganization costs of $1,758 and a $27 loss on the sale of assets.

 

(f) Adjusted EBITDA for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 included net income of $(930,229), which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $(930,229) are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $(932,969), integration and reorganization costs of $1,577 and a $1,163 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $123 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(g) Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 30, 2012 included net expenses of $11,264, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $11,264 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $5,378, integration and reorganization costs of $4,393 and a $1,238 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $255 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(h) Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended January 1, 2012 included net expenses of $10,565, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $10,565 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $4,226, integration and reorganization costs of $5,884 and a $455 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $432 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(i) Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2010 included net expenses of $8,880, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $8,880 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $5,005, integration and reorganization costs of $2,324 and a $1,551 loss on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $463 of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(j) Adjusted EBITDA for the year ended December 31, 2009 included net expenses of $10,071, which are one time in nature or non-cash compensation. Included in these net expenses of $10,071 are non-cash compensation and other expenses of $8,632, integration and reorganization costs of $1,857 and a $418 gain on the sale of assets.

Adjusted EBITDA also does not include $(855) of EBITDA generated from our discontinued operations.

 

(1) Non-cash (gain) loss on derivative instruments is related to interest rate swap agreements which are financing related and are excluded from Adjusted EBITDA.
(2) Non-cash write-off of deferred financing costs are similar to interest expense and amortization of financing fees and are excluded from Adjusted EBITDA.
(3) The year ended December 30, 2012 included a 53rd week of operations for approximately 60% of the business.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

We are exposed to market risk from changes in interest rates and commodity prices. Changes in these factors could cause fluctuations in earnings and cash flow. In the normal course of business, exposure to certain of these market risks is managed as described below.

 

89


Table of Contents

Interest Rates

On September 27, 2013, GateHouse filed for bankruptcy and on November 26, 2013, GateHouse emerged from bankruptcy with an improved capital structure. The interest rate discussion below is based on GateHouse’s capital structure and interest rates pre-filing and post-emergence.

Pre Bankruptcy Filing

The pre-filing discussion is based on our Predecessor’s average long-term debt of $1,171.2 million and interest rate swaps totaling $625.0 million during the pre-filing period.

On August 18, 2008, our Predecessor terminated interest rate swaps with a total notional amount of $570.0 million. At September 27, 2013, after consideration of the interest rate swaps described below, $542.5 million of the remaining principal amount of our Predecessor’s term loans were subject to floating interest rates.

The bankruptcy filing on September 27, 2013, was a termination event under our Predecessor’s interest rate swap agreements. Our Predecessor’s debt structure and interest rate risks were primarily managed through the use of floating rate debt and interest rate swaps.

On February 27, 2007, our Predecessor executed an interest rate swap in the notional amount of $100.0 million with a forward starting date of February 28, 2007. The interest rate swap had a term of seven years. Under this swap, our Predecessor paid an amount to the swap counterparty representing interest on a notional amount at a rate of 5.14% and received an amount from the swap counterparty representing, interest on the notional amount at a rate equal to the one month LIBOR.

On April 4, 2007, our Predecessor executed an additional interest rate swap in the notional amount of $250.0 million with a forward starting date of April 13, 2007. The interest rate swap had a term of seven years. Under this swap, our Predecessor paid an amount to the swap counterparty representing interest on a notional amount at a rate of 4.971% and received an amount from the swap counterparty representing interest on the notional amount at a rate equal to one month LIBOR.

On April 13, 2007, our Predecessor executed an additional interest rate swap in the notional amount of $200.0 million with a forward starting date of April 30, 2007. The interest rate swap had a term of seven years. Under this swap, our Predecessor paid an amount to the swap counterparty representing interest on a notional amount at a rate of 5.079% and received an amount from the swap counterparty representing interest on the notional amount at a rate equal to one month LIBOR.

On September 18, 2007, our Predecessor executed an additional interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $75.0 million with a forward starting date of September 18, 2007. The interest rate swap had a term of seven years. Under the swap, our Predecessor paid an amount to the swap counterparty representing interest on a notional amount at a rate of 4.941% and received an amount from the swap counterparty representing interest on the notional amount at a rate equal to one month LIBOR.

Post Emergence

From emergence through June 4, 2014, we had on average long-term debt of $183.0 million. During this period, our debt structure had multiple tranches with variable rates plus a fixed margin. We had $108.0 million of debt with minimum variable rates ranging from 0.75% to 1.00% and $75.0 million of debt with no minimum variable rate. The fixed margin on our debt ranged from 3.25% to 11.0% with a weighted average fixed margin of 7.39%. Our primary exposure was to LIBOR. A 100 basis point change in LIBOR would change our income from continuing operations before income taxes on an annualized basis by approximately $1.1 million, based on average pro forma floating rate debt outstanding during 2013, and average amounts outstanding under the revolving credit facility during 2013.

 

90


Table of Contents

On June 4, 2014, we refinanced our debt and entered into a new credit agreement. From June 4, 2014 through June 29, 2014, our average debt outstanding was $200.0 million. We currently have $200.0 million of term debt with a minimum variable rate plus a fixed margin. The minimum variable rate is 1.0% and the fixed margin is 6.25%. Our primary exposure is to LIBOR. A 100 basis point change in LIBOR would change our interest expense on an annualized basis by approximately $0.3 million, based on average floating rate debt outstanding during 2013 and after consideration of minimum variable rates.

Commodities

Certain materials we use are subject to commodity price changes. We manage this risk through instruments such as purchase orders, membership in a buying consortium, fixed pricing agreements for certain newsprint purchases and continuing programs to mitigate the impact of cost increases through identification of sourcing and operating efficiencies. Primary commodity price exposures are newsprint, energy costs and, to a lesser extent, ink.

A $10 per metric ton newsprint price change would result in a corresponding annualized change in our income from continuing operations before income taxes of $0.4 million based on newsprint usage for the year ended December 29, 2013 of approximately 42,800 metric tons. In 2014, 95% of the companies’ newsprint is fixed through a pricing agreement, therefore only 5% of the usage would be impacted by a price increase.

 

91


Table of Contents

BUSINESS

General Overview

New Media was formed as a Delaware corporation on June 18, 2013. Pursuant to the Restructuring, Newcastle owned approximately 84.6% of New Media until February 13, 2014, upon which date Newcastle distributed the shares that it held in New Media to its shareholders on a pro rata basis. New Media had no operations until November 26, 2013, when it assumed control of GateHouse and Local Media Parent. GateHouse was determined to be the predecessor to New Media, as the operations of GateHouse comprise substantially all of the business operations of the combined entities. Both New Media and Newcastle are externally managed and advised by an affiliate of Fortress Investment Group LLC (“Fortress”).

New Media is a newly listed company that owns, operates and invests in high quality local media assets. We have a particular focus on owning and acquiring strong local media assets in small to mid-size markets. With our collection of assets, we focus on two large business categories; consumers and SMBs.

Our portfolio of media assets today spans across 357 markets and 24 states. Our products include 425 community print publications, 357 websites, 345 mobile sites, six yellow page directories and Propel. We reach over 12 million people per week and serve over 130,000 business customers.

We are focused on growing our consumer revenues primarily through our penetration into the local consumer market that values comprehensive local news and receives their news primarily from our products. We believe our rich local content, our strong media brands, and multiple platforms for delivering content will impact our reach into the local consumers leading to growth in subscription income. We also believe our local consumer penetration will lead to transaction revenues as we link consumers with local businesses. For our SMB business category, we focus on leveraging our strong local media brands, our in-market sales force and our high consumer penetration rates with a variety of products and services that we believe will help SMBs expand their marketing, advertising and other digital lead generation platforms.

Our business strategy is to be the preeminent provider of local news, information, advertising and digital services in the markets we operate in today. We aim to grow our business organically through what we believe are both our consumer and SMB strategies. We also plan to pursue strategic acquisitions of high quality local media assets at attractive valuation levels. Finally, we intend to distribute a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend to stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance, approval by our board of directors (the “Board of Directors”) and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement. The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s U.S. GAAP net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results.

On July 31, 2014, the Company announced a second quarter 2014 cash dividend of $0.27 per share of New Media Common Stock. The dividend was paid on August 21, 2014 to shareholders of record as of the close of business on August 12, 2014.

We believe that our focus on owning and operating dominant local-content-oriented media properties in small to mid-size markets puts us in a position to better execute our strategy. We believe that being the dominant provider of local news and information in the markets in which we operate and distributing that content across multiple print and digital platforms, gives us an opportunity to grow our audiences and reach. Further, we believe our strong local media brands and our in-market sales presence gives us the opportunity to expand our advertising and lead generation products with local business customers.

 

92


Table of Contents

Central to our business strategy is Propel. We launched the business in 2012 and have seen rapid growth since then. We believe Propel and its digital marketing service products will be a key component to our overall organic growth strategy.

We believe that Propel will allow us to capitalize on the following opportunities in the marketplace:

There are approximately 27 million SMBs in the U.S. according to the 2011 U.S. Census data. Of these, approximately 26.7 million have 20 employees or less.

Many of the owners and managers of these SMBs do not have the resources or expertise to navigate the fast evolving digital marketing sector, but are increasingly aware of the need to establish and maintain a digital presence in order to stay connected with current and future customers.

Propel is designed to offer a complete set of turn-key digital marketing services to SMBs that provides transparent results to the business owners. Propel provides four broad categories of services: building businesses a presence, helping businesses to be located by consumers online, engaging with consumers, and growing their customer base.

We believe our local media properties are uniquely positioned to sell these digital marketing services to local business owners. Our strong and trusted local brands, combined with our in-market sales presence give us a distinct advantage to sell these services, which are new and can be complicated to local business owners.

Our core products include:

 

    87 daily newspapers with total paid circulation of approximately 712,000;

 

    243 weekly newspapers (published up to three times per week) with total paid circulation of approximately 303,000 and total free circulation of approximately 719,000;

 

    95 “shoppers” (generally advertising-only publications) with total circulation of approximately 1.9 million;

 

    357 locally focused websites and 345 mobile sites, which extend our businesses onto the internet and mobile devices with approximately 118 million page views per month;

 

    six yellow page directories, with a distribution of approximately 432,000, that cover a population of approximately 1.1 million people; and

 

    Propel digital marketing services.

In addition to our core products, we also opportunistically produce niche publications that address specific local market interests such as recreation, sports, healthcare and real estate.

Our print and online products focus on the local community from a content, advertising, and digital marketing perspective. As a result of our focus on small and midsize markets, we are usually the primary, and sometimes, the sole provider of comprehensive and in-depth local market news and information in the communities we serve. Our content is primarily devoted to topics that we believe are highly relevant and of interest to our audience such as local news and politics, community and regional events, youth sports, opinion and editorial pages, local schools, obituaries, weddings and police reports.

More than 83% of our daily newspapers have been published for more than 100 years and 100% have been published for more than 50 years. We believe that the longevity of our publications demonstrates the value and relevance of the local information that we provide and has created a strong foundation of reader loyalty and a highly recognized media brand name in each community we serve. As a result of these factors, we believe that our publications have high local audience penetration rates in our markets, thereby providing advertisers with strong local market reach.

 

93


Table of Contents

We believe the large number of publications we have, our focus on smaller markets, and our geographic diversity also provide the following benefits to our strategy:

 

    Diversified revenue streams, both in terms of customers and markets;

 

    Operational efficiencies realized from clustering of business assets;

 

    Operational efficiencies realized from centralization of back office functions;

 

    Ability to provide consistent management practices and ensure best practices; and

 

    Less competition and high barriers to entry.

The newspaper industry has experienced declining revenue and profitability dating back to 2007 due to, among other things, advertisers’ shift from print to digital media and general market conditions. Our Predecessor was affected by this trend and has experienced a history of net operating losses. For the fiscal year ended December 30, 2012, our Predecessor experienced a net loss of $29.8 million.

Our revenues derived from our SMB category come from a variety of print and digital advertising products, digital service products we offer through our Propel business, and commercial printing services. Our consumer category revenue comes primarily from subscription income as consumers pay for our deep, rich local contents, both in print and online, however primarily print today.

Our operating costs consist primarily of labor, newsprint, and delivery costs. Our selling, general and administrative expenses consist primarily of labor costs.

Compensation represents just over 50% of our operating expenses. Over the last few years, we have worked to drive efficiencies through centralization of back office functions, outsourcing and leveraging our scale to purchase more effectively. Additionally, we have taken steps to cluster our operations, thereby increasing the usage of facilities and equipment while increasing the productivity of our labor force. We expect to continue to employ these steps as part of our business and clustering strategy.

Local Media Acquisition

Newcastle acquired Local Media on September 3, 2013 from News Corp. Inc. (the “Local Media Acquisition”) and contributed to New Media 100% of the stock of Local Media Parent (which owns all of Local Media’s stock) on our Predecessor’s emergence from bankruptcy on the Effective Date of the Plan (the “Local Media Contribution”). Local Media is the publisher of locally-based print and online media. Local Media publishes eight daily community newspapers and seventeen weekly papers in seven states in the New England, Mid-Atlantic and Pacific Coast regions of the United States. Local Media also publishes associated internet sites, magazines and other news and advertising niche publications and offers commercial print and household distribution services. During the period ended December 29, 2013, the Local Media portfolio of products had a combined average circulation of 195,000 daily, as well as 180,734 average daily unique visitors to its local websites. Local Media has five print production facilities which are located in Hyannis, Massachusetts; Middletown, New York; Medford, Oregon; Portsmouth, New Hampshire; and Stockton, California.

In exchange for the contribution of Local Media, Newcastle received shares of New Media Common Stock, equal in value to the cost of the Local Media Acquisition. Local Media Parent is now a wholly owned subsidiary of New Media.

GateHouse managed the assets of Local Media pursuant to the Local Media Management Agreement. The agreement had a two-year term, with automatic renewal for successive two-year periods unless terminated. While the agreement was in effect, GateHouse was entitled to receive an annual management fee of $1.1 million, subject to adjustments (up to a maximum annual management fee of $1.2 million), and an annual incentive compensation fee based on exceeding EBITDA targets of Local Media. The Local Media Management Agreement was terminated effective June 4, 2014.

 

94


Table of Contents

On the Effective Date, New Media entered into the Management Agreement pursuant to which the Manager will manage the operations of New Media. The annual management fee will be 1.50% of New Media’s Total Equity and the Manager is eligible to receive incentive compensation.

Restructuring and Spin-off from Newcastle Investment Corp.

We acquired our operations as part of the Restructuring of our Predecessor, GateHouse. On September 27, 2013, GateHouse commenced the Restructuring in which it sought confirmation of its bankruptcy plan sponsored by Newcastle, as the holder of the majority of the Outstanding Debt. The Plan relates to the Restructuring of our Predecessor’s obligations under its Outstanding Debt. The Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Plan on November 6, 2013 and GateHouse consequently emerged from Chapter 11 protection on November 26, 2013.

Pursuant to the Restructuring, Newcastle made the Cash-Out Offer to purchase the Outstanding Debt in cash on the Effective Date. The holders of the Outstanding Debt had the option of receiving, in satisfaction of their Outstanding Debt, their pro rata share of the (i) Cash-Out Offer and/or (ii) New Media Common Stock and net proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities. All pensions, trade and all other unsecured claims will be paid in the ordinary course.

On the Effective Date (i) GateHouse became our wholly-owned subsidiary as a result of (a) the cancellation and discharge of the currently outstanding equity interests in GateHouse (the holders of which received warrants issued by New Media) and (b) the issuance of equity interests in the reorganized GateHouse to New Media; (2) Local Media Parent, which was a wholly-owned subsidiary of Newcastle, following the Local Media Acquisition became a wholly-owned subsidiary of New Media as a result of Newcastle’s transfer of Local Media Parent to New Media; (3) New Media entered into the Management Agreement with our Manager, (4) New Media entered into the GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement (the “GateHouse Management Agreement”) with GateHouse; and (5) all of GateHouse’s Outstanding Debt was cancelled and discharged and the holders of the Outstanding Debt received, at their option, their pro rata share of the (i) Cash-Out Offer and/or (ii) New Media Common Stock and the net proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities. Pursuant to the Cash-Out Offer, Newcastle offered to buy the claims of the holders of the Outstanding Debt. As a result of these transactions, Newcastle owned 84.6% of New Media as of the Effective Date. The GateHouse Management Agreement was terminated effective June 4, 2014.

On September 27, 2013, Newcastle announced that its board of directors unanimously approved a plan to spin-off our Company. Newcastle’s board of directors made the determination to spin-off our assets because it believed that our value can be increased over time through a strategy aimed at acquiring local media assets and organically growing our digital marketing business. In order to effect the separation and spin-off of our Company, we filed a registration statement on Form S-1, as amended, which was declared effective by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) on January 30, 2014.

Each share of Newcastle common stock outstanding as of 5:00 PM, Eastern Time, on February 6, 2014, the Record Date, entitled the holder thereof to receive 0.07219481485 shares of our Common Stock. The spin-off was completed on February 13, 2014, the Distribution Date. Immediately thereafter, we became publicly traded company independent from Newcastle trading on the NYSE Exchange under the ticker symbol “NEWM.”

Acquisitions

On February 28, 2014, the Company completed its acquisition of five publicatinos from Freedom Communications for an aggregate purchase price of $8 million. The acquisition includes two daily and three weekly publications serving Southern California with an aggregate circulation of approximately 56,000.

On June 30, 2014, the Company completed two acquisitions of 20 publications with a total purchase price of $15.85 million, which includes estimated working capital. The acquisitions include six daily, ten weekly publications, and four shoppers serving areas of Texas, Oklahoma, Kansas and Virginia with an aggregate circulation of approximately 54,000. The acquisitions were funded with $9.85 million of cash and $6 million from the Revolving Credit Facility.

 

95


Table of Contents

On September 3, 2014, the Company completed the acquisition of The Providence Journal with a total purchase price of $46 million. The acquisition includes one daily and two weekly publications serving areas of Rhode Island with a daily circulation of approximately 72,000 and 96,000 on Sunday.

Industry Overview

We operate in what is sometimes referred to as the “hyper-local” or community news market and market within the media industry. Media companies that serve this segment provide highly focused local content and advertising that is generally unique to each market they serve and is not readily obtainable from other sources. Local publications include community newspapers, websites, shoppers, traders, real estate guides, special interest magazines and directories. Due to the unique local nature of their content and audience, community publications compete for advertising customers with other forms of traditional media, including direct mail, directories, radio, television, and outdoor advertising. They also compete with new local and national digital and social media businesses for advertising, digital services and customers. We believe that local print and online publications in smaller markets are the most effective medium for local retail advertising, which emphasizes the price of goods in an effort to move inventory on a regular basis, in contrast to radio, broadcast and cable, television, and the internet, which are generally used for image or branding advertising. In addition, we believe local print and online publications generally have the highest local audience penetration rates, which allows local advertisers to get their message to a large portion of the local audience. Finally, national digital competitors tend to have no local in-market sales presence which we believe gives the local community publications an advantage when selling these types of products and services.

Locally focused media in small and midsize communities is distinct from national and urban media delivered through outlets such as television, radio, metropolitan and national newspapers and the internet. Larger media outlets tend to offer broad based information to a geographically scattered audience, which tends to be more of a commodity. In contrast, locally focused media delivers a highly focused product that is often the only source of local news and information in the market it serves. Our segment of the media industry is also characterized by high barriers to entry, both economic and social. Small and midsize communities can generally only sustain one newspaper. Moreover, the brand value associated with long-term reader and advertiser loyalty, and the high start-up costs associated with developing and distributing content and selling advertisements, help to limit competition.

We also believe there is a growing need among small to mid-size businesses to be able to generate leads and interact with consumers across all the digital platforms, which takes many forms including websites, mobile sites, tablets and social media. These local business owners and managers lack the time, expertise and resources to capitalize on the potential of these new consumer-reaching channels. National competitors in this category do not generally have a local in-market presence. We believe this represents a substantial opportunity for our local media business.

Advertising Market

The primary sources of advertising revenue for local publications are small businesses, corporations, government agencies and individuals who reside in the market that a publication serves. By combining paid circulation publications with total market coverage publications such as shoppers and other specialty publications (tailored to the specific attributes of a local community), local publications are able to reach nearly 100% of the households in a distribution area. As macroeconomic conditions in advertising change due to increasing internet and mobile usage and the wide array of available information sources, we have seen advertisers shift their focus to incorporate a digital advertising and services component into their overall local marketing strategy. To that end, in addition to printed products, the majority of our local publications have an online presence that further leverages the local brand, ensures higher penetration into the market, and provides a digital alternative for local advertisers to reach consumers. We also have a strong digital marketing services business, Propel.

 

96


Table of Contents

Digital Media

The time spent online and on mobile devices each day by media consumers continues to grow and newspaper, web and mobile sites offer a wide variety of content providing comprehensive, in-depth and up to the minute coverage of news and current events. The ability to generate, publish and archive more news and information than most other sources has allowed newspapers to produce some of the most visited sites on the internet. Newspaper websites have proven to be some of the most visited websites by online media news consumers.

We believe that our local publications are well positioned to capitalize on their existing market presence and grow their total audience base by publishing proprietary local content digitally: via the internet, mobile websites and mobile applications. Local digital media include traditional classifieds, directories of business information, local advertising, databases, audience-contributed content and mobile applications. We believe this additional community-specific content will further extend and expand both the reach and the brand of our publications with readers and advertisers. We believe that building a strong local digital business extends the core audience of a local publication.

The opportunity created by the digital extension of the core audience makes local digital advertising an attractive complement for existing print advertisers, while opening up opportunities to attract new local advertisers that have not previously advertised with local publications. In addition, we believe that national advertisers have an interest in reaching buyers on a hyper-local level and, although they historically have not been significant advertisers in community publications, we believe the digital media offers them a powerful medium to reach local audiences. This opportunity is further enhanced by our behavioral targeting products, which allow advertisers to reach specific demographics of our audience and follow that audience across multiple websites, delivering advertisements across the platforms. Further, digital marketing services businesses are poised to benefit from the rise in internet marketing spend, which grew 17% between 2012 and 2013, and 242% between 2005 and 2013, according to the 2014 IAB Internet Advertising Revenue report.

We believe that a strong digital business will enhance our revenues. In addition, we believe that we have the expertise and sales resources to help other businesses maximize their digital opportunities. Accordingly, we have launched our digital marketing services business, Propel, designed to help SMBs utilize the digital space to generate leads, interact with consumers and grow their businesses. Our digital revenue derived from advertising circulation and other revenue has grown since the launch of Propel in 2012. New Media’s digital revenue was $33.0 million and $48.6 million for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and the year ended December 29, 2013, a 44.7% and 22.4% growth as compared with the same periods in 2013 and 2012, which had digital revenue of $22.8 million and $39.7 million, respectively. Of this, $5.5 million and $6.4 million, or 16.7% and 13.2% of digital revenue for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and the year ended December 29, 2013, respectively, was attributable to Propel. See “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Our Business—We have invested in growing our digital business, but such investments may not be successful, which could adversely affect our results of operations.”

We anticipate that the digital marketing services sector will continue to grow as SMBs move from print to digital marketing in connection with consumers spending more time online. According to the 2011 U.S. Census data, there are approximately 27 million SMBs in the US, 26.7 million of the SMBs have 20 employees or less, and these businesses are expected to spend $36 billion on digital marketing by 2015 (according to the 2014 U.S. Local Media Forecast by BIA/Kelsey). Owners of these businesses often lack the resources and expertise to navigate the digital marketing services sector. Recent studies done by Google Places For Businesses in 2012 and the Small Business Sentiment Survey by Yodle in 2013 indicate that although 89% of consumers expect all businesses to have a website and 97% of consumers search for local businesses online, 52% of SMBs do not have a website and 90% do not have a mobile website. Further, 60% of SMBs with websites were found to not have a phone number on their home page according to the 2012 BIA/Kelsey. Propel offers SMBs digital services, including website design, search engine optimization, mobile websites, social media, retargeting and other advertising services. Our Predecessor believed, and we too believe, that Propel is well positioned to assist SMBs in the digital space and expects Propel to contribute meaningfully to future revenue growth. Propel is also able to leverage the more than 1,000 New Media sales representatives within the local markets served.

 

97


Table of Contents

Circulation

Overall daily newspaper print circulation, including national and urban newspapers, has been declining slowly over the past several years. Small and midsize local market newspapers have generally had smaller declines and more stability in their paid print circulation volumes due to the relevant and unique hyper-local news they produce. In addition, this unique and valuable hyper-local content along with multiple delivery platforms now available will allow smaller market newspapers to continue to raise prices, leading to stable circulation revenues. Data and technology now available to newspapers allow them to target pricing more at the household level rather than purely by market. This will lead to more effective pricing strategies and enhance stability for circulation revenues. According to the Newspaper Association of America, pay meters and pricing helped the newspaper industry grow circulation revenue by 5% from 2011 to 2012.

Our Strengths

High Quality Assets with Leading Local Businesses. Our publications benefit from a long history in the communities we serve as one of the leading, and often sole, providers of comprehensive and in-depth local content. More than 83% of our daily newspapers have been published for more than 100 years and 100% have been published for more than 50 years. This has resulted in brand recognition for our publications, reader loyalty and high local audience penetration rates, which are highly valued by local advertisers. We continue to build on long-standing relationships with local advertisers and our in-depth knowledge of the consumers in our local markets. We believe our local news content is unique and highly valued by consumers who live in our markets, and there are limited, and in some cases no competing sources of local content for our target customers.

Large Locally Focused Sales Force. We have large and well known “in-market” local sales forces in the markets we serve, consisting of over 1,000 sales representatives, including 37 dedicated to Propel and 16 third party sales affiliations. Our sales forces are generally among the largest locally oriented media sales forces in their respective communities. We have long-standing relationships with many local businesses and have the ability to be face to face with most local businesses due to these unique characteristics we enjoy. We believe our strong brands combined with our “in-market” presence give us a distinct advantage in selling and growing in the digital services sector given the complex nature of these products. We also believe that these qualities provide leverage for our sales force to grow additional future revenue streams in our markets, particularly in the digital sector.

Ability to Acquire and Integrate New Assets. We have created a national platform for consolidating local media businesses and have demonstrated an ability to successfully identify, acquire and integrate local media asset acquisitions. We have acquired over $1.7 billion of assets since 2006. We have acquired both traditional newspaper and directory businesses. We have a scalable infrastructure and platform to leverage for future acquisitions.

Scale Yields Operating Profit Margins and Allows Us to Realize Operating Synergies. We believe we can generate higher operating profit margins than our publications could achieve on a stand-alone basis by leveraging our operations and implementing revenue initiatives, especially digital initiatives, across a broader local footprint in a geographic cluster and by centralizing certain back office production, accounting, administrative and corporate operations. We also benefit from economies of scale in the purchase of insurance, newsprint and other large strategic supplies and equipment. Finally, we have the ability to further leverage our centralized services and buying power to reduce operating costs when making future strategic accretive acquisitions.

Local Business Profile Generates Significant Cash Flow. Our local business profile will allow us to generate significant recurring cash flow due to our diversified revenue base and high operating profit margins and maintain our low capital expenditure and working capital requirements. As a result of the Restructuring, which extinguished GateHouse’s Outstanding Debt, our interest and debt servicing expenses are significantly lower than GateHouse’s interest and debt servicing expenses. As of June 29, 2014, our debt structure consists of the New Media Credit Agreement. We currently estimate that we will have significant free cash flow totaling $50 to $70 million in 2014 which we believe will lead to stockholder value creation through our investments in

 

98


Table of Contents

organic growth, investments in accretive acquisitions and the return of cash to stockholders in the form of dividends, subject to approval by our Board of Directors. We further believe the strong cash flows generated and available to be invested will lead to consistent future dividend growth.

Experienced Management Team. Our senior management team is made up of executives who have an average of over 20 years of experience in the media industry, including strong traditional and digital media expertise. Our executive officers have broad industry experience with regard to both growing new digital business lines and identifying and integrating strategic acquisitions. Our management team also has key strengths in managing wide geographically disbursed teams, including the sales force, and identifying and centralizing duplicate functions across businesses leading to reduced core infrastructure costs.

Our Strategy

We intend to create stockholder value through a variety of factors including organic growth driven by our consumer and SMB strategies, pursuing attractive strategic acquisitions of high quality local media assets, and through the distribution of a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend. However, there is no guarantee that we will be able to accomplish any of these strategic initiatives.

A key component of our strategy will be to acquire and operate traditional local media businesses and transform them from print-centric operations to dynamic multi-media operations through our existing online advertising and digital marketing services businesses. We will also leverage our existing platform to operate these businesses more efficiently. We believe all of these initiatives will lead to revenue and cash flow growth for New Media and will enable us to pay dividends to our stockholders. We intend to distribute a substantial portion of our free cash flow as a dividend to stockholders, through a quarterly dividend, subject to satisfactory financial performance, approval by our Board of Directors and dividend restrictions in the New Media Credit Agreement. The Board of Directors’ determinations regarding dividends will depend on a variety of factors, including the Company’s GAAP net income, free cash flow generated from operations or other sources, liquidity position and potential alternative uses of cash, such as acquisitions, as well as economic conditions and expected future financial results. The key elements of our strategy include:

Maintain Our Leading Position in the Delivery of Proprietary Local Content in Our Communities. We seek to maintain our position as a leading provider of unique local content in the markets we serve and to leverage this position to strengthen our relationships with both readers and local businesses, thereby increasing penetration rates and market share. A critical aspect of this approach is to continue to provide local content that is not readily obtainable elsewhere and to be able to deliver that content to our customers across multiple print and digital platforms.

Grow Our New Digital Marketing Services Business. We plan to scale and expand our new recently created digital marketing services business, Propel. We believe Propel will allow us to sell digital marketing services to SMBs both in and outside existing New Media markets. The SMB demand for digital service solutions is great and represents a rapidly expanding opportunity. According to 2011 U.S. census data, there are approximately 27 million SMBs in the U.S. and, according to a 2014 U.S. Local Media Forecast by BIA/Kelsey, these businesses are expected to spend $36 billion on digital marketing by 2015. Owners of SMBs often lack the resources and expertise to navigate the digital marketing services sector, with 52% of SMBs not having a website and 90% not having mobile-friendly websites according to a Yodle Small Business Sentiment Survey in 2013. We believe local SMBs will turn to our trusted local media brands to help them navigate through developing their digital marketing presence and strategy. We believe our “in-market” sales presence and strong local brands give us a distinct advantage to being the leading local provider of digital marketing services, through Propel.

Pursue Strategic Accretive Acquisitions. We intend to capitalize on the highly fragmented and distressed local print industries which have greatly reduced valuation levels. We initially expect to focus our investments

 

99


Table of Contents

primarily in the local newspaper sector, in small to mid-size markets. We believe we have a strong operational platform as well as a scalable digital marketing services business, Propel. This platform, along with deep industry specific knowledge and experience that our management team has can be leveraged to reduce costs, stabilize the core business and grow digital revenues at acquired properties. The size and fragmentation of the addressable print media market place in the United States, the greatly reduced valuation levels that exist in these industries, and our deep experience make this an attractive place for our initial consolidation focus and capital allocation. Over the longer term we also believe there may be opportunity to diversify and acquire these types of assets internationally, as well as other traditional local media assets such as broadcast TV, out of home advertising (billboards) and radio, in the United States and internationally. We also believe there may be opportunities to acquire other strong businesses that have local sales force and SMB customer relationships or digital product companies, both of which could quickly scale for Propel.

Stabilize Our Core Business Operations. We have four primary drivers in our strategic plans to stabilize our core business operations, including: (i) identifying permanent structural expense reductions in our traditional business cost infrastructure and re-deploying a portion of those costs toward future growth opportunities, primarily on the digital side of our business; (ii) accelerating the growth of both our digital audiences and revenues through improvements to current products, new product development, training, opportunistic changes in hiring to create an employee base with a more diversified skill set and sharing of best practices; (iii) accelerating our consumer revenue growth through subscription pricing increases, pay meters for digital content and growth in our overall subscriber base; and (iv) stabilizing our core print advertising revenues through improvements to pricing, packaging of products for customers that will produce the best results for them, and more technology and training for sales management and sales representatives.

The newspaper industry has experienced declining revenue and profitability over the past several years due to, among other things, advertisers’ shift from print to digital media following the consumer shift, and general market conditions. GateHouse, our Predecessor, was affected by this trend and experienced net losses of $160.8 million during the nine month period ended September 29, 2013 and $29.8 million during the fiscal year ended December 30, 2012. Total revenue decreased by 1.9% to $356.2 million for the nine months ended September 29, 2013 and 5.1% to $488.6 million for the year ended December 30, 2012. The Restructuring significantly reduced New Media’s interest expense. In addition, New Media intends to focus its business strategy on building its digital marketing business and growing its online advertising business, which we believe will offset some of the challenges experienced by GateHouse. With its improved capital structure and digital focus, combined with its strengths and strategy and dividend strategy, we believe that New Media will be able to grow stockholder value. However, there can be no assurance of this. See “Risk Factors.”

Challenges

We will likely face challenges commonly encountered by recently reorganized entities, including the risks that even under our improved capital structure, we may not be profitable.

As a publisher of locally based print and online media, we face a number of additional challenges, including the risks that:

 

    the growing shift within the publishing industry from traditional print media to digital forms of publication may compromise our ability to generate sufficient advertising revenues;

 

    investments in growing our digital business may not be successful, which could adversely affect our results of operations;

 

    our advertising and circulation revenues may decline if we are unable to compete effectively with other companies in the local media industry; and

 

    we may not be able to successfully acquire local print media assets at attractive valuations due to a rise in valuations from a more competitive landscape of acquirers.

For more information about New Media’s risks and challenges, see “Risk Factors.”

 

100


Table of Contents

Products

Our product mix consists of four publication types: (i) daily newspapers, (ii) weekly newspapers, (iii) shoppers and (iv) niche publications. Most of these publications have a digital presence as discussed in the following table. Some of the key characteristics of each of these types of publications are also summarized in the table below.

 

   

Daily Newspapers

 

Weekly Newspapers

 

Shoppers

 

Niche Publications

Cost:

  Paid   Paid and free   Paid and free   Paid and free

Distribution:

  Distributed four to seven days per week   Distributed one to three days per week   Distributed weekly   Distributed weekly, monthly or on annual basis

Format:

  Printed on newsprint, folded   Printed on newsprint, folded   Printed on newsprint, folded or booklet   Printed on newsprint or glossy, folded, booklet, magazine or book

Content:

  50% editorial (local news and coverage of community events, some national headlines) and 50% ads (including classifieds)   50% editorial (local news and coverage of community events, some national headlines for smaller markets which cannot support a daily newspaper) and 50% ads (including classifieds)   Almost 100% ads, primarily classifieds, display and inserts   Niche content and targeted ads (e.g., Chamber of Commerce city guides, tourism guides and special interest publications such as, seniors, golf, real estate, calendars and directories)

Income:

  Revenue from advertisers, subscribers, rack/box sales   Paid: Revenue from advertising, subscribers, rack/box sales   Paid: Revenue from advertising, rack/box sales   Paid: Revenue from advertising, rack/box sales
    Free: Advertising revenue only, provide 100% market coverage   Free: Advertising revenue only, provide 100% market coverage   Free: Advertising revenue only

Internet Availability:

  Maintain locally oriented websites, mobile sites and mobile apps, for select locations   Major publications maintain locally oriented websites and mobile sites for select locations   Major publications maintain locally oriented websites   Selectively available online

Overview of Operations

We operate in four publication groups: Small Community Newspapers, Metros, Large Daily Newspapers and Local Media. We also operate over 357 related websites and 345 mobile sites.

The following table sets forth information regarding our publications.

 

     Number of Publications      Circulation(1)  

Operating Group

   Dailies      Weeklies      Shoppers      Paid      Free      Total
Circulation
 

Small Community Newspapers

     58         103         66         270,418         1,100,483         1,370,901   

Metro Newspapers

     7         117         7         254,776         478,223         732,999   

Large Daily Newspapers

     12         3         11         228,535         542,150         770,685   

Local Media

     10         20         11         262,116         511,331         773,447   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     87         243         95         1,015,845         2,632,187         3,648,032   

 

101


Table of Contents

 

(1) Circulation statistics are estimated by our management as of June 29, 2014.

Small Community Newspaper Group. Our Small Community Newspaper group encompasses publications typically located in communities that have a population less than 35,000 people, in the states of Illinois, Missouri, Kansas, Michigan, California, Minnesota, Arkansas, New York, Louisiana, Pennsylvania, West Virginia, Colorado, Nebraska, Oklahoma, North Dakota, Tennessee, and Iowa. There are a total of 58 daily newspapers, 103 weekly newspapers and 66 shoppers. In addition to a good geographic mix, we benefit from a diverse economic and employment base across this group.

From the western shore of Lake Michigan to the eastern shore of the Mississippi River and running over 400 miles north to south, Illinois is a picture of manufacturing, agricultural and recreational diversity. Coupled with major daily newspapers from our Large Daily Newspaper Group in Rockford, Peoria, and the state capital of Springfield, we are the largest publishing company in Illinois. Twenty paid daily newspapers, 30 paid weekly newspapers, and 17 shoppers provide coverage across the state which is supported by four print production facilities.

La Junta in the southeastern part of the state represents the Colorado properties. Along with La Junta we also serve Bent County and Fowler and produce the weekly agricultural newspaper, The Ag Journal.

We are represented in California by two daily newspapers in Ridgecrest and Yreka, five paid weekly papers in Dunsmuir, Mt. Shasta, Weed, Gridley and Taft, and three shoppers in Gridley, Mt. Shasta, Ridgecrest and Yreka. These publications reach from northern California through the southern desert and China Lake naval base in Ridgecrest.

The greatest concentration of circulation and market presence in Missouri is in the northern part of the state where we operate seven daily newspapers, four weekly newspapers and five shoppers. We serve the 22,000 square mile area from Hannibal, on the state’s eastern border, to the western border and from Columbia in the south to the Iowa border in the north. Local employers include the University of Missouri and other colleges, local and federal governments, State Farm Insurance and 3M.

Our southern Missouri operations are clustered around Lake of the Ozarks and Joplin. Located midway between Kansas City and St. Louis and approximately 90 miles from Springfield, Missouri, our three daily newspapers, seven weekly newspapers and three shoppers that serve the Lake of the Ozarks area reach approximately 165,000 people.

Located in southwest Missouri and southeast Kansas is our Joplin cluster with three daily and four weekly newspapers and four shoppers, serving a population of approximately 170,000. There are several colleges and universities in the area, a National Guard Fort, several large medical centers and a diverse mix of retail businesses, including the 120-store Northpark Mall.

This group also includes our Kansas City cluster with six publications (two daily and two weekly newspapers and two shoppers) located in the eastern Kansas cities of Leavenworth and Lansing and on the Missouri side, Independence and Blue Springs. The Leavenworth Times was one of our original daily newspapers and the balance of the cluster was acquired afterward. In addition, we secured the military publication, The Fort Leavenworth Lamp, in Fort Leavenworth. The Kansas City cluster is home to several prominent companies, including Hallmark, H&R Block, Interstate Bakeries, and the University of Kansas.

The Wichita cluster consists of three dailies, six weeklies and three shoppers in the towns of Andover, Augusta, El Dorado, Pratt, Wellington, Newton and McPherson near Wichita, Kansas. The clustering of the small dailies in this area allows the group to sell advertisers a package providing access to multiple communities. Major aircraft manufacturers Boeing, Bombardier, Cessna and Raytheon have facilities nearby and McConnell Air Force Base is a major component of the local economy.

 

102


Table of Contents

We also have clusters in and around Grand Forks, North Dakota (home to the Grand Forks Air Force Base and the University of North Dakota) and near Mason City, Iowa, where Cargill, ConAgra, Kraft, Winnebago and Fort Dodge Animal Health, a division of Wyeth, each maintain significant operations.

We are represented in southwestern Minnesota through seven paid weekly newspapers and four shoppers. St. James, Redwood Falls, Sleepy Eye, Granite Falls, Cottonwood, Wabasso, and Montevideo are all communities with populations of 10,000 and under. These papers represent the primary local news and information source for these communities.

In Louisiana, we have an operating cluster in the southwestern part of the state, located between Lake Charles and Alexandria. This cluster consists of five publications located in the cities of Leesville, Sulpher, DeRidder and Vinton. Local employers include major manufacturers such as Alcoa, Firestone, International Paper and Proctor & Gamble.

Our Baton Rouge cluster consists of four weeklies and three shoppers in the southeastern Louisiana cities of Donaldsville, Gonzales, and Plaquemine. Numerous petrochemical companies such as BASF, Exxon Mobil and Dow Chemical, plus universities including Louisiana State, support the local economies.

In southwestern New York, our operations are centered around five publications based in Steuben County. In Corning, The Leader, a 6,566 circulation daily newspaper, dominates the eastern half of the county and shares its hometown namesake with Corning Incorporated. The Hornell Evening Tribune circulates daily throughout the western half of the county. Situated directly between these two dailies in the county seat of Bath is the 10,850 circulation Steuben Courier, a free-distribution weekly. The Pennysaver Plus, a standalone shopper, solidifies this flagship group.

We also have a strong presence in the print advertising markets in three other New York counties that surround Steuben. In Allegany County to the west, the Wellsville Daily Reporter and its shopper, the Pennysaver Plus, cover most households. In Livingston County to the north, the Pennysaver Plus and the Genesee Country Express complement one another with combined circulation of 24,295. In Yates County to the north and east, The Chronicle-Express and Chronicle Ad-Visor shopper distribute weekly to nearly 14,000 households centered around the county seat of Penn Yan.

In nearby Chemung County, the 17,690 circulation Horseheads Shopper anchors our presence in this area. The majority of the southwestern New York cluster parallels Interstate 86 across the central southern tier of New York State, which is benefiting from continued improvement and expansion under an omnibus federal highway appropriations bill. Moreover, the cluster has several colleges and universities nearby, including Cornell University, Ithaca College, Elmira College and Houghton College.

Our Honesdale cluster, approximately 30 miles from Scranton, Pennsylvania, consists of seven publications in the cities of Carbondale, Honesdale and Hawley, Pennsylvania, along with Liberty, New York, located just across the Delaware River to the east. The cluster was created from our daily and shopper operations in Honesdale and later supplemented by our acquisition of weeklies and shoppers in Carbondale and Liberty. Local employers include General Dynamics, Blue Cross/Blue Shield, Commonwealth Telephone and various colleges and universities, medical centers and governmental agencies.

Our Pennsylvania/West Virginia cluster includes dailies in Waynesboro, Pennsylvania, Keyser and Ripley, West Virginia. We also have two weeklies throughout the group and a commercial printing operation in Ravenswood, West Virginia.

We have a strong presence in southern Michigan where five of our dailies, Adrian, Coldwater, Holland, Hillsdale and Sturgis, along with two weeklies and seven shoppers blanket the southern tier of the state and into

 

103


Table of Contents

Indiana. The 11,265 circulation Holland Sentinel is the flagship publication of the group. This area has several large employers, including Delphi, ConAgra, Tecumseh Products, Kellogg, JCI, Herman Miller, Hayworth, Gentex, Jackson State Prison, and a number of colleges and universities.

The communities we serve in the Small Community Newspaper group are largely rural but also support educational institutions, government agencies (including prisons and military bases), tourism, veterinary medicine and ethanol and agricultural chemical manufacturing. The area also includes automotive (including recreational vehicles), boat, home construction products and furniture manufacturing businesses.

The following table sets forth information regarding the number of publications and production facilities in the Small Community Newspaper Group:

 

     Publications      Production
Facilities
 

State of Operations

   Dailies      Weeklies      Shoppers     

Illinois

     15         30         10         2   

Missouri

     12         15         12         5   

Kansas

     5         8         7         1   

Michigan

     8         2         10         4   

California

     2         5         3         1   

Minnesota

     1         8         6         0   

Arkansas

     3         11         0         2   

New York

     3         4         7         0   

Louisiana

     1         8         4         1   

Pennsylvania

     2         4         2         2   

West Virginia

     1         2         2         2   

Colorado

     1         3         0         1   

Nebraska

     0         2         1         0   

Oklahoma

     2         0         1         2   

North Dakota

     1         0         1         1   

Tennessee

     1         0         0         0   

Iowa

     0         1         0         0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     58         103         66         24   

Metro Newspaper Group. Our Metro Newspaper Group includes publications that are typically within 50 miles of a metropolitan area with total population greater than 1.0 million people in the states of Massachusetts, New York, and Delaware. We are one of the largest community newspaper publishers in Massachusetts by number of daily publications and also publish a large concentration of weekly newspapers, serving 113 communities in markets across eastern Massachusetts. The three largest daily newspapers in this region are: The Patriot Ledger (founded in 1837 with circulation of 28,770), the Enterprise (founded in 1880 with circulation of 17,890) and the MetroWest Daily News (founded in 1897 with circulation of 14,127). We also have over 160 web sites, with more than 5.5 million average combined monthly unique visitors in Massachusetts.

Many of the towns within our Massachusetts footprint were founded in the 1600s and our daily and weekly newspapers in the region have long been institutions within these communities. In fact, our Massachusetts publications have 29 daily and weekly newspapers that are over 100 years old. The Boston designated market areas is the eighth largest market in the United States with 2.5 million households and 6.5 million people, and ranks first nationally in concentration of colleges and universities. Massachusetts has more than 1.0 million households in the region earning greater than $75,000, and a substantial homeownership rate. We reach 1.4 million readers in the eastern Massachusetts market. Eastern Massachusetts is also an employment center for technology, biotechnology, healthcare and higher education.

 

104


Table of Contents

In New York we operate and own a combination of 16 publications in Suburban Rochester that span four counties and have a combined circulation of 118,816. This market has a tourism industry and is known for boutique wineries and recreational activities. The flagship of Messenger Post Media is the 7,820 circulation Daily Messenger in Canandaigua.

The Delaware cluster publishes six weekly newspapers, one shopper, and various specialty papers that cover most of the state of Delaware, and range from suburban Wilmington in the north to Georgetown, Delaware at the southern end of the state. The weekly Express shopper serves nearly all of lower Delaware and a good portion of the Eastern Shore of Maryland. Circulation for the cluster is primarily free, and totals approximately 94,129 weekly.

The following table sets forth information regarding the number of publications and production facilities in the Metro Newspaper Group:

 

     Publications      Production
Facilities
 

State of Operations

   Dailies      Weeklies      Shoppers     

Massachusetts

     6         100         2         2   

New York

     1         11         4         1   

Delaware

         0         6             1             1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     7         117         7         4   

Large Daily Newspaper Group. Our Large Daily Newspaper Group includes publication clusters in communities that typically have more than 35,000 people and are greater than 50 miles from a major metropolitan area. These publications are in Illinois, New York, Ohio, and Connecticut with a total of 12 daily newspapers, 3 weekly newspapers and 11 shoppers. In addition to a good geographic mix, we benefit from a diverse economic and employment base across this group.

Approximately 85 miles to the west of Chicago, Illinois is the Rockford Register Star supported by its 31,682 daily paid circulation base and its total market coverage (“TMC”) product The Weekly, with six zoned editions. The Rockford Register Star operates successful web sites that have more than 520,000 average monthly unique visitors.

The Journal (Freeport, IL) Standard is published Tuesdays through Sundays. The newspaper’s coverage area includes Caroll, Jo Daviess, Ogle and Stephenson counties. The newspaper has a daily circulation of 6,471 and a Sunday circulation of 7,199. The Journal Standard also publishes a website journalstandard.com and receives a monthly average of 1.1 million page views and monthly unique visitors over 175,000.

The Peoria Journal Star with its daily paid circulation of 46,976 is the dominant newspaper in Peoria, Tazewell and Woodford Counties and is also distributed in an additional 17 surrounding counties. There are two shoppers—JS Shopper and Pekin Extra—which have a combined weekly circulation of 94,573. The Peoria facility provides print services to our neighboring New Media publications and commercial printing for Lee Enterprises’ The Pantagraph. The market includes manufacturing facilities for Caterpillar and Komatsu, and higher education at Bradley University, Illinois Central College and Midstate College. Peoria has a large medical community including OSF Healthcare, Methodist Medical Center, Proctor Hospital, University of Illinois College of Medicine and St. Jude Children’s Hospital Midwest Affiliate. It has agricultural facilities Archer Daniels Midland, LG Seeds and the USDA Ag Lab. The Journal Star has pjstar.com and pjstar.mobi with combined monthly average of page views of over 6.9 million per month. The combined average monthly unique visitors are over 1.1 million.

The Springfield State Journal-Register with a daily paid circulation of 30,895 and a Sunday paid circulation of 41,961 covers the state capital of Illinois. The daily paid circulation includes a branded edition of 2,820 of the Lincoln Courier. The State Journal-Register also has successful web sites with monthly unique visitors of more than 1.4 million.

 

105


Table of Contents

The Ohio cluster is anchored in Canton, Ohio and covers Stark and Tuscarawas Counties. It is comprised of three daily newspapers, one weekly publication and two shoppers. The Repository is a 45,150 daily newspaper that covers the entire area of Stark County. The Dover New Philadelphia Times Reporter is a 15,195 daily publication located 40 miles south of Canton in Tuscarawas County. The Massillon Independent is an 7,462 circulation daily that circulates in western Stark County. The Suburbanite is a 32,600 weekly publication that circulates in the affluent northern Stark County area. The Ohio facility also provides commercial print services to the Akron Beacon Journal. The Ohio cluster has very successful web sites with more than 1.4 million combined monthly unique visitors. Together the newspapers and web sites dominate their local markets.

The Central New York cluster is anchored by the Observer-Dispatch in Utica, New York which has circulation of 26,021 Daily and 32,975 Sunday subscribers. The Utica operations include one daily and one shoppers and one weekly newspaper in Hamilton. Utica also has web sites with combined monthly unique visitors of more than 588,000. Other dailies in this group are located in Herkimer and Little Falls. The Utica and Herkimer County operations take advantage of numerous synergies in printing, circulation, and advertising.

Our Norwich, Connecticut publication diversifies the Large Daily Newspapers as the eastern Connecticut economy differs from the nation and New England markedly. Primary economic drivers include casinos, military submarine manufacture and pharmaceutical research. Major industrial employers in the region include General Dynamics, Pfizer, Dow Chemical, Dominion Resources and the United States Navy.

The following table sets forth information regarding the number of publications and production facilities in the Large Daily Newspaper Group:

 

     Publications      Production
Facilities
 

State of Operations

   Dailies      Weeklies      Shoppers     

Illinois

     5         0         7         2   

New York

     3         2         1         0   

Ohio

     3         1         2         2   

Connecticut

           1               0               1               0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     12         3         11         4   

Local Media Group. Local Media operates in five publication group clusters: the (1) New York/Pennsylvania Media Group, (2) Southeastern Massachusetts Media Group, (3) Seacoast Media Group (Coastal New Hampshire and Maine cluster), (4) San Joaquin Media Group (Stockton, California cluster) and (5) Southern Oregon Media Group.

New York/Pennsylvania Media Group. This cluster includes the Hudson Valley Media Group and the Pocono Mountains Media Group.

The Hudson Valley Media Group publishes one paid daily, two free weekly newspapers, and one shopper. The flagship publication of the Hudson Valley Media Group is the Times Herald-Record. The Times Herald-Record, with a daily circulation of 55,421, is the premier daily and Sunday local paper in Orange County, NY.

The Pocono Mountains Media Group publishes one paid daily, one free weekly newspaper, and one shopper. The flagship publication of the Pocono Mountains Media Group is the Pocono Record. The Pocono Record, with a daily circulation of 15,988, is the premier daily and Sunday local paper in the Pocono Mountains area.

Southeastern Massachusetts Media Group. This cluster includes the Cape Cod Media Group, the Southcoast Media Group and the Nantucket Island Media Group.

 

106


Table of Contents

The Cape Cod Media Group publishes one paid daily, one paid weekly newspaper and one shopper. The flagship publication of the Cape Cod Media Group is the Cape Cod Times. The Cape Cod Times, with a daily circulation of 40,729 is the premier daily and Sunday local paper on Cape Cod. The Barnstable Patriot, the paid weekly newspaper, has a weekly circulation of 2,287.

The Southcoast Media Group publishes one paid daily newspaper, four paid weekly newspapers, two shoppers and one free weekly newspaper. The flagship publication of the Southcoast Media Group is the Standard-Times. The Standard-Times, with a daily circulation of 20,836, is the premier daily and Sunday local paper in the New Bedford, MA area. The other paid weeklies, the Spectator, the Chronicle, the Middleboro Gazette and the Advocate, have weekly circulations of 3,249, 1,718, 3,382 and 546, respectively.

The Nantucket Island Media Group publishes The Inquirer and Mirror. With a weekly circulation of 7,582, it has the largest circulation of any island newspaper.

Seacoast Media Group. The Seacoast Media Group publishes one paid daily, one paid Sunday paper, two newspapers which are published three times a week and two paid weekly newspapers. The flagship publication of the Seacoast Media Group is the Portsmouth Herald. The Portsmouth Herald, with a daily circulation of 9,173, is the premier daily and Sunday local paper in coastal New Hampshire. Seacoast Sunday, the Sunday paper, has a Sunday circulation of 13,869. The Hampton Union and the Exeter News-Letter, the two newspapers published three times a week, have weekly circulations of 3,192 and 4,052, respectively. The two paid weekly newspapers, the York County Coast Star and the York Weekly, have weekly circulations of 3,345 and 1,815, respectively.

San Joaquin Media Group. The San Joaquin Media Group publishes one paid daily, one free weekly paper, and one shopper. The flagship publication of the San Joaquin Media Group is the Record. The Record, with a daily circulation of 30,029, is the premier daily and Sunday local paper in the Stockton, CA area.

Southern Oregon Media Group. The Southern Oregon Media Group publishes two paid daily papers and two shoppers. The flagship publication of the Southern Oregon Media Group is the Medford Mail Tribune. The Medford Mail Tribune, with a daily circulation of 20,209, is the premier daily and Sunday local paper in southern Oregon. The other paid daily paper, the Ashland Daily Tidings, has a daily circulation of 1,254.

The following table sets forth information regarding the number of publications and production facilities in the Local Media Group:

 

     Publications      Production
Facilities
 

State of Operations

   Dailies      Weeklies      Shoppers     

Massachusetts

     2         7         3         1   

New Hampshire

     1         4         0         1   

New York

     1         2         1         1   

Oregon

     2         0         2         1   

California

     3         4         4         1   

Pennsylvania

     1         1         1         0   

Maine

     0         2         0         0   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     10         20         11         5   

Directories

The core of our directory portfolio is comprised of the three yellow page directories, which are located in and around the Sacramento, California area, primarily in Roseville, California. The three directories have an aggregate circulation of approximately 360,000 and service Roseville, Auburn/Grass Valley/Nevada City and Folsom/El Dorado/Placerville, reaching four counties within the Sacramento region.

 

107


Table of Contents

Our SureWest Directories portfolio is highlighted by the Roseville directory. The Roseville directory is the incumbent (with a circulation of approximately 200,000) and has served the local Roseville community for over 100 years and has achieved more than 50% market share.

We also own three additional directories including two Michigan and Indiana phone guides servicing St. Joseph County, Michigan and LaGrange County, Indiana, and Branch County, Michigan and Steuben County, Indiana, respectively, and one yellow page directory based in Mt. Shasta, California.

Propel Marketing

Propel is our digital marketing services division with digital products designed for SMBs. We believe the digital services industry represents a large and expanding opportunity. Propel is a business we created to attack that opportunity.

There are approximately 27 million SMBs in the United States today and about 26.7 million have less than 20 employees. Although these businesses are increasingly beginning to recognize the need to establish and maintain a strategy for the digital space, most do not have the time, expertise or resources to handle this themselves.

Propel is a company that can become the outsourced digital marketing service department for those SMBs. Propel’s products help an SMB build a presence across digital platforms, help them get found by consumers, help them engage with and grow their customer base. We pull these products together for the SMB with a proprietary customer dashboard which integrates activity and results for all Propel products.

We also believe Propel gives us an opportunity to expand beyond our current geographic boundaries, as its product set could be of value to SMBs around the country.

Revenue

Our operations generate three primary types of revenue: (i) advertising, (ii) circulation (including home delivery subscriptions, single copy sales and digital subscriptions) and (iii) other (primarily commercial printing and digital marketing services). In 2013, these revenue streams accounted for approximately 63%, 29% and 8%, respectively, of our total revenue. The contribution of advertising, circulation and other revenue to our total revenue for New Media, known as the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013 and the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 was as follows:

 

     Successor Company          Predecessor Company  
     Two Months
Ended
December 29,

2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
     Year Ended
December 30,
2012
     Year Ended
January 1,
2012
 
(in thousands)                                

Revenue:

              

Advertising

   $ 63,340          $ 265,078       $ 330,881       $ 357,134   

Circulation

     29,525            118,810         131,576         131,879   

Commercial printing and other

     10,366            29,402         26,097         25,657   
  

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total revenue

   $ 103,231          $ 413,290       $ 488,554       $ 514,670   
  

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Advertising

Advertising revenue, which includes revenue generated from online and mobile products, is the largest component of our revenue, accounting for approximately 63%, 68% and 69% of our total revenue in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. We categorize advertising as follows:

 

    Local Retail—local retailers, local stores for national retailers, grocers, drug stores, department and furniture stores, local financial institutions, niche shops, restaurants and other consumer related businesses.

 

108


Table of Contents
    Local Classified—local legal, obituaries, employment, automotive, real estate and other advertising.

 

    Online—banner, display, classified, behavioral targeting, audience extension, search and other advertising on websites or mobile devices.

 

    National—national and major accounts such as wireless communications companies, airlines and hotels, generally placed with us through agencies.

We believe that our advertising revenue tends to be less volatile than the advertising revenue of large metropolitan and national print media because we rely primarily on local, rather than national advertising and our classified revenue, tends to be more local market oriented (job listing for example). We generally derive 95% or more of our advertising revenue from local advertising (local retail, local classified and online) and less than 5% from national advertising. We believe that local advertising tends to be less sensitive to economic cycles than national advertising because local businesses generally have fewer effective advertising channels through which they may reach their customers.

Our advertising rate structures vary among our publications and are a function of various factors, including local market conditions, competition, circulation, readership and demographics. Management works with local newspaper management to set advertising rates and a portion of our publishers’ incentive compensation is based upon growing advertising revenue. Our sales compensation program emphasizes digital and new business growth. We share advertising concepts throughout our network of publishers and advertising directors including periodic special section programs, enabling them to utilize advertising products and sales strategies that are successful in other markets we serve.

Substantially all of our advertising revenue is derived from a diverse group of local retailers and local classified advertisers, resulting in very limited customer concentration. No single advertiser accounted for more than 1% of our total revenue in 2013, 2012 or 2011 and our 20 largest advertisers account for less than 10% of total revenue.

Our advertising revenue tends to follow a seasonal pattern, with higher advertising revenue in months containing significant events or holidays. Accordingly, our first quarter, followed by our third quarter, historically are our weakest quarters of the year in terms of revenue. Correspondingly, our second fiscal quarter, and fourth fiscal quarter, historically are our strongest quarters. We expect that this seasonality will continue to affect our advertising revenue in future periods.

We have experienced declines in advertising revenue over the past few years, due primarily to the secular pressures on the business as consumers and advertisers shift time and spend from traditional media to the internet. We continue to search for organic growth opportunities, specifically with digital advertising and ways to stabilize print revenue declines through strengthening local news product, value based pricing and training of sales staff.

Circulation

Our circulation revenue is derived from home delivery sales to subscribers, single copy sales at retail stores and vending racks and boxes, and digital subscriptions. We own 87 paid daily publications that range in circulation from approximately 500 to 55,000 and 169 paid weekly publications that range in circulation from approximately 100 to 13,000. Circulation revenue accounted for approximately 29%, 27% and 26% of our total revenue in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

Subscriptions are typically sold for three to twelve-month terms and often include promotions to extend the average subscription period or convert someone to become a subscriber. We also provide bundled print and digital subscriptions and employ pay meters for our website content at most of our daily publications. We implement marketing programs to increase readership through subscription and single copy sales, including company-wide and local circulation contests, direct mail programs, door-to-door sales and strategic alliances

 

109


Table of Contents

with local schools in the form of “Newspapers in Education” programs. In addition, since the adoption of the Telemarketing Sales Rule by the Federal Trade Commission in 2003, which created a national “do not call” registry, we have increased our use of “EZ Pay” programs, kiosks, sampling programs, in-paper promotions and online promotions to increase our circulation.

We encourage subscriber use of EZ Pay, a monthly credit card charge or direct bank debit payment program, which has led to higher retention rates for subscribers. We also use an active stop-loss program for all expiring subscribers. Additionally, in order to improve our circulation revenue and circulation trends, we periodically review the need for quality enhancements, such as:

 

    Increasing the amount of unique hyper-local content;

 

    Increasing the use of color and color photographs;

 

    Improving graphic design, including complete redesigns;

 

    Developing creative and interactive promotional campaigns;

 

    Improving customer service and company wide customer retention efforts; and

 

    Better use of demographic data to specifically target pricing and customer acquisition opportunities.

We believe that our unique and valuable hyper-local content allows us to continue to produce products of great relevance to our local market audiences. This allows us to be able to periodically raise prices, both for home delivery and on a single copy basis, resulting in increased circulation revenues. We also believe this unique hyper-local content will allow us to find ways to grow circulation revenues from our wide array of digital products.

Other

We provide commercial printing services to third parties on a competitive bid basis as a means to generate incremental revenue and utilize excess printing capacity. These customers consist primarily of other publishers that do not have their own printing presses and do not compete with our publications. We also print other commercial materials, including flyers, business cards and invitations. Additionally, this category includes Propel, which provides internet marketing solutions for SMBs. Other sources of revenue, including commercial printing and Propel, accounted for approximately 8%, 5% and 5% of our total revenue in 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

Printing and Distribution

We own and operate 37 print facilities. Our print facilities produce 10 publications on average and are generally located within 60 miles of the communities served. By clustering our production resources or outsourcing where cost beneficial, we are able to reduce the operating costs of our publications while increasing the quality of our small and midsize market publications that would typically not otherwise have access to high quality production facilities. We also believe that we are able to reduce future capital expenditure needs by having fewer overall pressrooms and buildings. We believe our superior production quality is critical to maintaining and enhancing our position as the leading provider of local news coverage in the markets we serve. As other print media businesses look to reduce costs, we believe we have the opportunity to leverage our unutilized press time to grow our commercial print customer base and revenue.

The distribution of our daily newspapers is typically outsourced to independent, locally based, third-party distributors that also distribute a majority of our weekly newspapers and non-newspaper publications. We continuously evaluate lower cost options for newspaper delivery. In addition, certain of our shopper and weekly publications are delivered via the U.S. Postal Service.

 

110


Table of Contents

Availability of Raw Materials for Our Business—Newsprint

The basic raw material for our publications is newsprint. We generally maintain only a 45 to 55-day inventory of newsprint.

Historically, the market price of newsprint has been volatile, reaching a high of approximately $826 per metric ton in 2008 and a low of $440 per metric ton in 2002. However, from 2010 to 2013 there was much less volatility in newsprint pricing and our Predecessor benefited from negotiating a fixed annual price for a majority of its newsprint. The average market price of newsprint during 2013 was approximately $643 per metric ton.

In 2012 our Predecessor consumed approximately 41,400 metric tons of newsprint (inclusive of commercial printing) and the cost of our newsprint consumption totaled approximately $27.7 million. In contrast, in 2013, we consumed approximately 42,800 metric tons of newsprint (inclusive of commercial printing) and the cost of our newsprint consumption totaled approximately $27.5 million. Our newsprint expense typically averages less than 10% of total revenue, which we believe generally compares favorably to larger, metropolitan newspapers.

For our 2012 and 2013 purchases of newsprint our Predecessor negotiated a fixed price for approximately 75% and 95%, respectively, of our newsprint tons which allowed our Predecessor to eliminate some of the volatility of the market price.

Competition

Each of our publications competes for advertising revenue to varying degrees with traditional media outlets such as direct mail, yellow pages, radio, outdoor advertising, broadcast and cable television, magazines, local, regional and national newspapers, shoppers and other print and online media sources, including local blogs. We also increasingly compete with new digital and social media companies for advertising revenue. However, we believe that barriers to entry remain high in many of the markets we serve in terms of being the preeminent source for local news and information therein, because our markets are generally not large enough to support a second newspaper and because our local news gathering infrastructures, sales networks and relationships would be time consuming and costly to replicate. We also have highly recognized local brand names and long histories in the towns we serve.

We also provide our readers with community-specific content, which is generally not available from other media sources. We believe that our direct and focused coverage of the market and our cost effective advertising rates relative to more broadly circulated metropolitan newspapers allow us to tailor an approach for our advertisers. As a result, our publications generally capture a large share of local advertising in the markets they serve.

The level of competition and the primary competitors we face vary from market to market. Competition tends to be based on market penetration, demographic and quality factors, as opposed to price factors. The competitive environment in each of our operating regions is discussed in greater detail below.

Small Community Newspaper Group. The Small Community Newspaper Group operates in 164 markets and we believe our publications are the dominant print advertising media in the vast majority of these markets. There are radio stations in or within 20 miles of every market in which we operate, but we do not believe that any of these radio station operators pose a significant competitive threat to our publications. Yellow page advertising is prevalent in all of our markets with either a local phone book or a regional phone book. We believe that, in most cases, yellow page advertising is geared more towards the professional services advertisers such as attorneys and doctors and not the local retail advertisers, as is the focus with our non-directory publications. Lee Enterprises publishes the Southern Illinoisan in Carbondale, which is a regional newspaper that competes with our dailies in Marion, Benton, West Frankfort and DuQuoin. In all four of these cases, we believe our

 

111


Table of Contents

publications are the dominant local daily, but do compete on a regional basis with the larger dailies. We also compete with shoppers or weekly newspapers. This competition comes from small independent operators and is not significant. We have very little television competition in this group because of our geographic location in relation to major markets. There are no local television affiliates in our markets.

In the southern regions of this group we believe our publications are generally the dominant media. Our major competition comes from regional daily newspapers, specifically: The Advocate in Baton Rouge, Louisiana; The American Press in Lake Charles, Louisiana; The Joplin Globe; and the Wichita Eagle. We also face competition from numerous other daily and weekly papers, local radio stations, shopping guides, directories and niche publications.

In the Northeast market we believe our publications are generally the dominant media. The competition we face in this region are from major newspaper companies: daily newspapers owned by Gannett Company, Inc. (The Star-Gazette in Elmira, NY and the Chambersburg (PA) Public-Opinion); Times-Shamrock Company’s Scranton (PA) The Times-Tribune and Towanda Daily/Sunday Review; Community Newspaper Holdings, Inc.’s Sunbury Daily Item; and Ogden-Nutting’s Williamsport Sun-Gazette. We believe our publications tend to be the dominant local publication in those markets.

In our Great Lakes markets we believe our publications are generally the dominant media in those markets. Our only significant competition comes from regional television stations in Adrian, Michigan. We also face competition from dozens of other competitors such as other local daily and weekly papers and niche publications, as well as radio and television stations, directories, direct mail and non-local internet websites, but none of these have proven to be significant.

Metro Newspaper Group. In the Metro Newspaper Group, the Boston Globe and boston.com, a metropolitan daily and website, respectively, owned by John Henry, compete with us throughout eastern Massachusetts. In addition, we compete in Massachusetts with more than 30 other weekly or daily newspaper companies (that publish a combined total of approximately 16 dailies and 50 weeklies), three major radio station operators, five local network television broadcasters, one cable company and numerous niche publications for advertising revenues. We believe that our publications generally deliver the highest household coverage in their respective markets.

Large Daily Newspaper Group. In our Large Daily Newspaper Group we believe our publications are generally the dominant media in those markets. Daily newspapers owned by Gannett Company, Inc. (Daily Sentinel in Rome, NY and The Dispatch in Oneida, NY) compete within the New York market. We also face competition from other major newspaper companies in other regional markets such as Newhouse Newspaper’s Syracuse Post-Standard. Our competitors also include numerous other daily and weekly newspapers, local radio stations, shopping guides, directories and niche publications. We believe our publications, many of which have an extensive history in the relevant market, tend to be the dominant local publication.

Local Media. Local Media operates in 14 local markets across the United States. We believe our publications in these markets are generally the dominant media and that each have an audience far larger than the competitors. Daily newspapers owned by Gannett Company, Inc. (Poughkeepsie Journal in Poughkeepsie, NY) and 21st Century Media, Inc. (Daily Freeman in Kingston, NY), compete within the New York market. Our Cape Cod and New Bedford, Massachusetts newspapers experience competition similar to the Metro Newspaper Group. Their territories border with the Boston Globe and boston.com, a metropolitan daily and website, respectively, but they remain dominant in their markets.

We face competition from other newspaper companies that include daily and weekly newspapers, local websites, local radio stations, local television stations, shopping guides, directories and niche publications. None of our competitors have proven to be significant. Our publications and websites have a rich history in our markets which we believe uniquely positions them for unmatched reach and relevancy in their local audiences.

 

112


Table of Contents

Employees

As of June 29, 2014, we had approximately 4,930 full time equivalent employees, consisting of hourly and salaried employees. We employ union personnel at a number of our core publications representing approximately 615 full-time equivalent employees. As of June 29, 2014, there were 27 collective bargaining agreements covering union personnel. Most of our unionized employees work under collective bargaining agreements that expire in 2014. We believe that relations with our employees are generally good and we have had no work stoppages at any of our publications.

Environmental Matters

We believe that we are in substantial compliance with all applicable laws and regulations for the protection of the environment and the health and safety of our employees based upon existing facts presently known to us. Compliance with federal, state, and local environmental laws and regulations relating to the discharge of substances into the environment, the disposal of hazardous wastes and other related activities has had, and will continue to have, an impact on our operations, but has, since the incorporation of our Predecessor in 1997, been accomplished without having a material adverse effect on its operations. While it is difficult to estimate the timing and ultimate costs to be incurred due to uncertainties about the status of laws, regulations and technology, based on information currently known to us and insurance procured with respect to certain environmental matters, we do not expect environmental costs or contingencies to be material or to have a material adverse effect on our financial performance. Our operations involve risks in these areas, however, and we cannot assure you that we will not incur material costs or liabilities in the future which could adversely affect us.

Properties

We own and operate 37 print facilities across the United States. GateHouse’s print facilities range in size from approximately 500 to 82,000 square feet (combined printing and office space). GateHouse’s executive offices are located in Fairport, New York, where we lease approximately 15,000 square feet under a lease terminating in June 2014. Local Media’s executive offices are in a 47,000 square feet owned building in Middletown, New York.

We maintain our properties in good condition and believe that our current facilities are adequate to meet the present needs of our business. We do not believe any individual property is material to our financial condition or results of operations.

Corporate Governance and Public Information

The address of New Media’s website is http://www.newmediainv.com/. Stockholders can access a wide variety of information on New Media’s website, under the “Investor Relations” tab, including news releases, SEC filings, information New Media is required to post online pursuant to applicable SEC rules, newspaper profiles and online links. New Media makes available via its website all filings it makes under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, including Forms 10-K, 10-Q and 8-K, and related amendments, as soon as reasonably practicable after they are filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. All such filings are available free of charge. Neither the content of New Media’s corporate website nor any other website referred to in this Prospectus are incorporated by reference into this Prospectus unless expressly noted. The public may read and copy any information New Media files with the SEC at the SEC’s public reference room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. The public may obtain information on the operation of the public reference room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC also maintains a website (http://www.sec.gov) where New Media’s filings filed with the SEC are available free of charge.

 

113


Table of Contents

List of New Media’s Dailies, Weeklies, Shoppers, Websites and Directories

As of June 29, 2014, New Media’s dailies, weeklies, shoppers, websites and directories were as listed below. GateHouse and Local Media maintain registered trademarks in many of the masthead names listed below. Maintaining such trademarks allows us to exclusively use the masthead name to the exclusion of third parties.

Small Community Newspaper Group

 

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

Illinois

   Benton   

Benton Evening News

www.bentoneveningnews.com

   Daily
   Canton   

Daily Ledger

www.cantondailyledger.com

   Daily
   Carmi   

The Carmi Times

www.carmitimes.com

   Daily
   Du Quoin   

Du Quoin Evening Call

www.duquoin.com

   Daily
   El Dorado    El Dorado Daily Journal    Daily
   Galesburg   

The Register-Mail

www.galesburg.com

   Daily
   Harrisburg   

Harrisburg Daily Register

www.dailyregister.com

   Daily
   Kewanee   

Star-Courier

www.starcourier.com

   Daily
   Macomb   

McDonough County Voice

www.mcdonoughvoice.com

   Daily
   Marion   

The Daily Republican

www.dailyrepublicannews.com

   Daily
   Monmouth   

Daily Review Atlas

www.reviewatlas.com

   Daily
   Olney   

The Olney Daily Mail

www.olneydailymail.com

   Daily
   Pekin   

Pekin Daily Times

www.pekintimes.com

   Daily
   Pontiac   

Daily Leader

www.pontiacdailyleader.com

   Daily
   West Frankfort   

Daily American

www.dailyamericannews.com

   Daily
   Abingdon   

Abingdon Argus-Sentinel

www.eaglepublications.com

   Paid Weekly
   Aledo   

The Times Record

www.aledotimesrecord.com

   Paid Weekly
   Augusta   

Augusta Eagle-Scribe

www.eaglepublicatons.com

   Paid Weekly
   Cambridge   

Cambridge Chronicle

www.cambridgechron.com

   Paid Weekly
   Carmi    The Weekly Times    Paid Weekly
   Chester   

Randolph County Herald Tribune

www.randolphcountyheraldtribune.com

   Paid Weekly
   Christopher    The Progress    Paid Weekly
   Du Quoin    Du Quoin News    Paid Weekly
   Du Quoin    Ashley News    Paid Weekly

 

114


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

   Fairbury    The Blade    Paid Weekly
   Flora   

Clay County Advocate Press

www.advocatepress.com

   Paid Weekly
   Galva   

Galva News

www.galvanews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Geneseo   

The Geneseo Republic

www.geneseorepublic.com

   Paid Weekly
   Murphysboro   

Murphysboro American

www.murphysboroamerican.com

   Paid Weekly
   Newton   

Newton Press Mentor

www.pressmentor.com

   Paid Weekly
   Oquawka    Oquawka Current    Paid Weekly
   Orion   

Orion Gazette

www.oriongazette.com

   Paid Weekly
   Roseville   

Roseville Independent

www.eaglepublications.com

   Paid Weekly
   Shawneetown    Ridgway News    Paid Weekly
   Shawneetown    Gallatin Democrat    Paid Weekly
   Steelville    The Steelville Ledger    Paid Weekly
   Teutopolis   

Teutopolis Press-Deiterich Gazette

www.teutopolispress.com

   Paid Weekly
   West Frankfort   

SI Trader

www.sitraders.com

   Paid Weekly
   Chillicothe   

Chillicothe Times Bulletin

www.chillicothetimesbulletin.com

   Free Weekly
   East Peoria   

East Peoria Times-Courier

www.eastpeoriatimescourier.com

   Free Weekly
   Galesburg   

Knox County Neighbors

www.galesburg.com

   Free Weekly
   Macomb    Daily Brief    Free Weekly
   Metamora   

Woodford Times

www.woodfordtimes.com

   Free Weekly
   Morton   

Morton Times News

www.mortontimesnews.com

   Free Weekly
   Washington   

Washington Times Reporter

www.washingtontimesreporter.com

   Free Weekly
   Aledo    Town Crier Advertiser    Shopper
   Canton    Fulton County Shopper    Shopper
   Flora    CCAP Special    Shopper
   Galatia   

Money Stretcher

www.galatiamoneystretcher.com

   Shopper
   Geneseo    Henry County Advertizer/Shopper    Shopper
   Macomb    McDonough County Choice    Shopper
   Monmouth    Pennysaver    Shopper
   Olney    Richland County Shopper    Shopper
   Olney    Jasper County News Eagle    Shopper
   Pontiac    Livingston Shopping News    Shopper

Missouri

   Camdenton   

Lake Sun Leader

www.lakenewsonline.com

   Daily
   Carthage   

The Carthage Press

www.carthagepress.com

   Daily

 

115


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

   Chillicothe   

Constitution Tribune

www.chillicothenews.com

   Daily
   Hannibal   

Hannibal Courier Post

www.hannibal.net

   Daily
   Independence   

The Examiner

www.examiner.net

   Daily
   Kirksville   

Kirksville Daily Express & News

www.kirksvilledailyexpress.com

   Daily
   Macon   

Chronicle Herald

www.maconch.com

   Daily
   Mexico   

The Mexico Ledger

www.mexicoledger.com

   Daily
   Moberly   

Moberly Monitor Index

www.moberlymonitor.com

   Daily
   Neosho   

Neosho Daily News

www.neoshodailynews.com

   Daily
   Rolla   

Rolla Daily News

www.therolladailynews.com

   Daily
   Waynesville   

The Daily Guide

www.waynesvilledailyguide.com

   Daily
   Aurora   

Aurora Advertiser

www.auroraadvertiser.net

   Paid Weekly
   Boonville   

Boonville Daily News

www.boonvilledailynews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Brookfield   

The Linn County Leader

www.linncountyleader.com

   Paid Weekly
   Greenfield   

The Vedette

www.greenfieldvedette.com

   Paid Weekly
   St James   

St James Leader Journal

www.leaderjournal.com

   Paid Weekly
   Boonville    Weekly    Free Weekly
   Camdenton   

West Side Star

www.lakenewsonline.com

   Free Weekly
   Carthage    The Carthage Press Wednesday TMC    Free Weekly
   Hannibal    Salt River Journal    Free Weekly
   Neosho    The Neighborhood Showcase    Free Weekly
   Osage Beach    Lake Area News Focus    Free Weekly
   Osage Beach    Lake of the Ozarks Real Estate    Free Weekly
   Osage Beach    Tube Tab    Free Weekly
   Osage Beach    Vacation News    Free Weekly
   Rolla    Rolla Daily News “Plus”    Free Weekly
   Aurora    Big AA Shopper    Shopper
   Brookfield    Sho-Me Shopper    Shopper
   Camdenton    Penny Saver    Shopper
   Chillicothe    Chillicothe C-T Shopper    Shopper
   Greenfield    Lake Stockton Shopper    Shopper
   Joplin    Big Nickel    Shopper
   Kirksville    Nemo Trader    Shopper
   Kirksville    Kirksville Crier    Shopper
   Macon   

Macon Journal

www.maconch.com

   Shopper

 

116


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

   Moberly    The Shopper    Shopper
   Osage Beach    Lake of the Ozarks Boats    Shopper
   Waynesville    Pulaski County Weekly    Shopper

Kansas

   Dodge City   

Dodge City Daily Globe

www.dodgeglobe.com

   Daily
   Leavenworth   

The Leavenworth Times

www.leavenworthtimes.com

   Daily
   McPherson   

McPherson Sentinel

www.mcphersonsentinel.com

   Daily
   Newton   

The Newton Kansan

www.thekansan.com

   Daily
   Pittsburg   

The Morning Sun

www.morningsun.net

   Daily
   El Dorado   

The Butler County Times-Gazette

www.butlercountytimesgazette.com

   Paid Weekly
   Greensburg   

Kiowa County Signal

www.kiowacountysignal.com

   Paid Weekly
   Pratt   

The Pratt Tribune

www.pratttribune.com

   Paid Weekly
   St. John   

St John News

www.sjnewsonline.com

   Paid Weekly
   Wellington   

Wellington Daily News

www.wellingtondailynews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Dodge City    La Estrella    Free Weekly
   Leavenworth    Lansing This Week    Free Weekly
   Leavenworth   

The Fort Leavenworth Lamp

www.ftleavenworthlamp.com

   Free Weekly
   Dodge City    Shoppers Weekly    Shopper
   El Dorado    Shoppers Guide    Shopper
   Hiawatha    Penny Press 4    Shopper
   Leavenworth    Chronicle Shopper    Shopper
   McPherson/Newton    South Central Kansas Shoppers Guide    Shopper
   Pittsburg    The Sunland Shopper    Shopper
   Pratt    Sunflower Shopper    Shopper

Michigan

   Adrian   

The Daily Telegram

www.lenconnect.com

   Daily
   Cheboygan   

Cheboygan Daily Tribune

www.cheboygannews.com

www.mackinacjournal.com

   Daily
   Coldwater   

The Daily Reporter

www.thedailyreporter.com

   Daily
   Hillsdale   

Hillsdale Daily News

www.hillsdale.net

   Daily
   Holland   

The Holland Sentinel

www.hollandsentinel.com

   Daily
   Ionia   

Sentinel-Standard

www.sentinel-standard.com

   Daily
   Sault Ste Marie   

The Evening News

www.sooeveningnews.com

   Daily

 

117


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

   Sturgis   

Sturgis Journal

www.sturgisjournal.com

   Daily
   Coldwater   

Bronson Journal

www.thebronsonjournal.com

   Paid Weekly
   Coldwater    Jonesville Independent    Paid Weekly
   Adrian   

Adrian Access Shopper

www.accessshoppersguide.com

   Shopper
   Allegan   

Flashes Shopping Guide (Allegan/Lakeshore)

www.flashespublishers.com

   Shopper
   Cheboygan    Shopper Fair    Shopper
   Coldwater    The Reporter Extra    Shopper
   Coldwater    Coldwater Shoppers Guide    Shopper
   Hillsdale   

Tip Off Shopping Guide

www.tipoffonline.com

   Shopper
   Holland   

Flashes Shopping Guide (Holland/Zeeland)

www.flashespublishers.com

   Shopper
   Ionia    Sentinel-Standard TMC    Shopper
   Sault Ste Marie    Tri County Buyers Guide    Shopper
   Sturgis    Sturgis Gateway Shopper    Shopper

California

   Ridgecrest   

The Daily Independent

www.ridgecrestca.com

www.rocketeer2.com

   Daily
   Yreka   

Siskiyou Daily News

www.siskiyoudaily.com

   Daily
   Gridley   

Gridley Herald

www.gridleyherald.com

   Paid Weekly
   Mt Shasta   

Weed Press

www.mtshastanews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Mt Shasta   

Dunsmuir News

www.mtshastanews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Mt Shasta   

Mt Shasta Herald

www.mtshastanews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Taft   

Midway Driller

www.taftmidwaydriller.com

   Paid Weekly
   Gridley   

Gidley Shopping News

www.gridleyherald.com

   Shopper
   Mt Shasta    Super Saver Advertiser    Shopper
   Ridgecrest    Super Tuesday    Shopper

Minnesota

   Crookston   

Crookston Daily Times

www.crookstontimes.com

   Daily
   Cottonwood    Tri-County News    Paid Weekly
   Granite Falls   

Granite Falls Advocate-Tribune

www.granitefallsnews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Montevideo   

Montevideo American News

www.montenews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Redwood Falls   

Redwood Gazette

www.redwoodfallsgazette.com

   Paid Weekly
   Sleepy Eye   

Sleepy Eye Herald Dispatch

www.sleepyeyenews.com

   Paid Weekly
   St James   

St James Plaindealer

www.stjamesnews.com

   Paid Weekly

 

118


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

   Wabasso    The Wabasso Standard    Paid Weekly
   Halstad    The Valley Journal    Free Weekly
   Crookston    Crookston Valley Shopper    Shopper
   Halstad    The Shopper    Shopper
   Montevideo   

The Star Advisor

www.montenews.com

   Shopper
   Redwood Falls    Redwood Falls Livewire    Shopper
   Sleepy Eye    Brown County Reminder    Shopper
   St James    Town and Country Shopper    Shopper

Arkansas

   Arkadelphia   

Daily Siftings Herald

www.siftingsherald.com

   Daily
   Hope   

Hope Star

www.hopestar.com

   Daily
   Stuttgart   

Stuttgart Daily Leader

www.stuttgartdailyleader.com

   Daily
   Gurdon   

Gurdon Times

www.thegurdontimes.com

   Paid Weekly
   Heber Springs   

The Sun Times

www.thesuntimes.com

   Paid Weekly
   Helena   

The Daily World

www.helena-arkansas.com

   Paid Weekly
   Hope   

Nevada County Picayune

www.picayune-times.com

   Paid Weekly
   Newport   

Newport Independent

www.newportindependent.com

   Paid Weekly
   White Hall   

The White Hall Journal

www.whitehalljournal.com

   Paid Weekly
   Arkadelphia   

Arkadelphia Extra

www.siftingsherald.com

   Free Weekly
   Helena   

Daily World TMC

www.helena-arkansas.com

   Free Weekly
   Hope   

Star Extra

www.hopestar.com

   Free Weekly
   Stuttgart   

The Xtra

www.stuttgartdailyleader.com

   Free Weekly
   White Hall    The Arsenel Sentinel    Free Weekly

New York

   Corning   

The Leader

www.the-leader.com

   Daily
   Hornell   

Evening Tribune

www.eveningtribune.com

   Daily
   Wellsville   

Wellsville Daily Reporter

www.wellsvilledaily.com

   Daily
   Dansville   

Genesee Country Express

www.dansvilleonline.com

   Paid Weekly
   Penn Yan   

The Chronicle-Express

www.chronicle-express.com

   Paid Weekly
   Saugerties   

Saugerties Post Star

www.poststarnews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Bath   

Steuben Courier-Advocate

www.steubencourier.com

   Free Weekly

 

119


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

   Corning    Corning Pennysaver    Shopper
   Hornell    Pennysaver Plus    Shopper
   Horseheads    The Shopper    Shopper
   Liberty    Catskill Shopper    Shopper
   Penn Yan    Chronicle Ad-Visor    Shopper
   Saugerties    Saugerties Pennysaver    Shopper
   Saugerties    Mountain Pennysaver    Shopper

Louisiana

   Bastrop   

The Bastrop Daily Enterprise

www.bastropenterprise.com

   Daily
   DeRidder   

Beauregard Daily News

www.beauregarddailynews.net

   Paid Weekly
   Donaldsonville   

The Donaldsonville Chief

www.donaldsonvillechief.com

   Paid Weekly
   Gonzales   

Gonzales Weekly Citizen

www.weeklycitizen.com

   Paid Weekly
   Leesville   

Leesville Daily Leader

www.leesvilledailyleader.com

   Paid Weekly
   Plaquemine   

Post South

www.postsouth.com

   Paid Weekly
   Sulphur   

Southwest Daily News

www.sulphurdailynews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Sulphur    Vinton News    Paid Weekly
   Sterlington    North Quachita Weekly    Free Weekly
   Gonzales   

The Marketeer

www.weeklycitizen.com

   Shopper
   Gonzales   

Nickel Ads

www.weeklycitizen.com

   Shopper
   Plaquemine   

West Bank Shopper

www.postsouth.com

   Shopper
   Sulphur    Calcasieu Shopper    Shopper

Pennsylvania

   Honesdale   

The Wayne Independent

www.wayneindependent.com

   Daily
   Waynesboro   

The Record Herald

www.therecordherald.com

   Daily
   Carbondale   

The Villager

www.moscowvillager.com

   Paid Weekly
   Carbondale   

Carbondale News

www.thecarbondalenews.com

   Paid Weekly
   Greencastle   

The Echo Pilot

www.echo-pilot.com

   Paid Weekly
   Hawley   

News Eagle

www.neagle.com

   Paid Weekly
   Hawley    The Pike Pennysaver    Shopper
   Honesdale    The Independent Extra    Shopper

West Virginia

   Keyser   

Mineral Daily News Tribune

www.newstribune.info

   Daily
   Ripley   

The Jackson Herald

www.jacksonnewspapers.com

   Paid Weekly
   Ripley   

The Jackson Star News

www.jacksonnewspapers.com

   Paid Weekly

 

120


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

   Keyser    Today’s Shopper    Shopper
   Ravenswood   

Star Herald Weekender

www.jacksonnewspapers.com

   Shopper

Colorado

   LaJunta   

LaJunta Tribune Democrat

www.lajuntatribunedemocrat.com

   Daily
   LaJunta   

Ag Journal

www.agjournalonline.com

   Paid Weekly
   LaJunta   

Fowler Tribune

www.fowlertribune.com

   Paid Weekly
   Las Pimas   

Bent County Democrat

www.bcdemocratonline.com

   Paid Weekly

Nebraska

   Nebraska City   

Nebraska City News Press

www.ncnewspress.com

   Paid Weekly
   Syracuse   

Syracuse Journal Democrat

www.journaldemocrat.com

   Paid Weekly
   Nebraska City    Penny Press 1    Shopper

Oklahoma

   Ardmore   

The Daily Ardmoreite

www.ardmoreite.com

   Daily
   Shawnee   

The Shawnee News-Star

www.news-star.com

   Daily
   Ardmore    Entertainment Spotlight    Shopper

North Dakota

   Devils Lake   

Devils Lake Daily Journal

www.devilslakejournal.com

   Daily
   Devils Lake    The Country Peddler    Shopper

Tennessee

   Oak Ridge   

The Oak Ridger

www.oakridger.com

   Daily

Iowa

   Hamburg   

Hamburg Reporter

www.hamburgreporter.com

   Paid Weekly

Metro Newspaper Group

 

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation
Type

Massachusetts

   Brockton   

The Enterprise

www.enterprisenews.com

   Daily
   Fall River   

The Herald News

www.heraldnews.com

   Daily
   Framingham   

The Metrowest Daily News

www.metrowestdailynews.com

   Daily
   Milford   

The Milford Daily News

www.milforddailynews.com

   Daily
   Quincy   

Patriot Ledger

www.patriotledger.com

   Daily
   Taunton   

Taunton Daily Gazette

www.tauntongazette.com

   Daily
   Abington   

Abington Mariner

www.wickedlocal.com/abington

   Paid Weekly
   Acton/Roxborough   

The Beacon

www.wickedlocal.com/acton

   Paid Weekly

 

121


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation
Type

   Allston   

Allston/Brighton Tab

www.wickedlocal.com/allston

   Paid Weekly
   Arlington   

The Arlington Advocate

www.wickedlocal.com/arlington

   Paid Weekly
   Bedford   

Bedford Minuteman

www.wickedlocal.com/bedford

   Paid Weekly
   Belmont   

Belmont Citizen-Herald

www.wickedlocal.com/belmont

   Paid Weekly
   Beverly   

Beverly Citizen

www.wickedlocal.com/beverly

   Paid Weekly
   Billerica   

Billerica Minuteman

www.wickedlocal.com/billerica

   Paid Weekly
   Boxford   

Tri-Town Transcript

www.wickedlocal.com/boxford

   Paid Weekly
   Braintree   

Braintree Forum

www.wickedlocal.com/braintree

   Paid Weekly
   Brewster   

The Cape Codder

www.wickedlocal.com/capecod

   Paid Weekly
   Burlington   

Burlington Union

www.wickedlocal.com/burlington

   Paid Weekly
   Cambridge   

Cambridge Chronicle & Tab

www.wickedlocal.com/cambridge

   Paid Weekly
   Carver   

Carver Reporter

www.wickedlocal.com/carver

   Paid Weekly
   Chelmsford   

Chelmsford Independent

www.wickedlocal.com/chelmsford

   Paid Weekly
   Cohasset   

Cohasset Mariner

www.wickedlocal.com/cohasset

   Paid Weekly
   Concord   

The Concord Journal

www.wickedlocal.com/concord

   Paid Weekly
   Danvers   

Danvers Herald

www.wickedlocal.com/danvers

   Paid Weekly
   Dedham   

Dedham Transcript

www.wickedlocal.com/dedham

   Paid Weekly
   Dover   

Dover/Sherborn Press

www.wickedlocal.com/dover

   Paid Weekly
   Easton   

Easton Journal

www.wickedlocal.com/easton

   Paid Weekly
   Framingham   

Westwood Press

www.wickedlocal.com/westwood

   Paid Weekly
   Georgetown   

Georgetown Record

www.wickedlocal.com/georgetown

   Paid Weekly
   Hamilton   

Hamilton-Wenham Chronicle

www.wickedlocal.com/hamilton

   Paid Weekly
   Hanover   

Hanover Mariner

www.wickedlocal.com/hanover

   Paid Weekly
   Hingham   

The Hingham Journal

www.wickedlocal.com/hingham

   Paid Weekly
   Holbrook   

Holbrook Sun

www.wickedlocal.com/holbrook

   Paid Weekly
   Hopkinton   

Hopkinton Crier

www.wickedlocal.com/hopkinton

   Paid Weekly

 

122


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation
Type

   Hudson   

Hudson Sun

www.wickedlocal.com/hudson

   Paid Weekly
   Hyannis   

The Register

www.wickedlocal.com/barnstable

   Paid Weekly
   Ipswich   

Ipswich Chronicle

www.wickedlocal.com/ipswich

   Paid Weekly
   Kingston   

Kingston Reporter

www.wickedlocal.com/kingston

   Paid Weekly
   Lexington   

Lexington Minuteman

www.wickedlocal.com/lexington

   Paid Weekly
   Lincoln   

Lincoln Journal

www.wickedlocal.com/lincoln

   Paid Weekly
   Littleton   

Littleton Independent

www.wickedlocal.com/littleton

   Paid Weekly
   Malden   

Malden Observer

www.wickedlocal.com/malden

   Paid Weekly
   Mansfield   

Mansfield News

www.wickedlocal.com/mansfield

   Paid Weekly
   Marblehead   

Marblehead Reporter

www.wickedlocal.com/marblehead

   Paid Weekly
   Marion   

The Sentinel

www.wickedlocal.com/marion

   Paid Weekly
   Marlborough   

Marlborough Enterprise

www.wickedlocal.com/marlborough

   Paid Weekly
   Marshfield   

Marshfield Mariner

www.wickedlocal.com/marshfield

   Paid Weekly
   Maynard/Stow   

The Beacon-Villager

www.wickedlocal.com/maynard

   Paid Weekly
   Medfield   

Medfield Press

www.wickedlocal.com/medfield

   Paid Weekly
   Medford   

Medford Transcript

www.wickedlocal.com/medford

   Paid Weekly
   Melrose   

Melrose Free Press

www.wickedlocal.com/melrose

   Paid Weekly
   Natick   

Natick Bulletin & Tab

www.wickedlocal.com/natick

   Paid Weekly
   North Andover   

North Andover Citizen

www.wickedlocal.com/northandover

   Paid Weekly
   Northborough/ Southborough   

The Northborough/Southborough Villager

www.wickedlocal.com/northborough

   Paid Weekly
   Norwell   

Norwell Mariner

www.wickedlocal.com/norwell

   Paid Weekly
   Norwood   

Norwood Transcript & Bulletin

www.wickedlocal.com/norwood

   Paid Weekly
   Pembroke   

Pembroke Mariner & Express

www.wickedlocal.com/pembroke

   Paid Weekly
   Plymouth   

Old Colony Memorial

www.wickedlocal.com/plymouth

   Paid Weekly
   Provincetown   

The Provincetown Banner

www.wikedlocal.com/provincetown

   Paid Weekly
   Reading   

The Reading Advocate

www.wickedlocal.com/reading

   Paid Weekly

 

123


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation
Type

   Rockland   

Rockland Mariner

www.wickedlocal.com/rockland

   Paid Weekly
   Roslindale   

Roslindale Transcript

www.wickedlocal.com/roslindale

   Paid Weekly
   Saugus   

Saugus Advertiser

www.wickedlocal.com/saugus

   Paid Weekly
   Scituate   

Scituate Mariner

www.wickedlocal.com/scituate

   Paid Weekly
   Sharon   

Sharon Advocate

www.wickedlocal.com/sharon

   Paid Weekly
   Shrewsbury   

Shrewsbury Chronicle

www.wickedlocal.com/shrewsbury

   Paid Weekly
   Somerville   

Somerville Journal

www.wickedlocal.com/somerville

   Paid Weekly
   Stoughton   

Stoughton Journal

www.wickedlocal.com/stoughton

   Paid Weekly
   Sudbury   

The Sudbury Town Crier

www.wickedlocal.com/sudbury

   Paid Weekly
   Swampscott   

Swampscott Reporter

www.wickedlocal.com/swampscott

   Paid Weekly
   Tewksbury   

Tewksbury Reporter

www.wickedlocal.com/tewksbury

   Paid Weekly
   Wakefield   

Wakefield Observer

www.wickedlocal.com/wakefield

   Paid Weekly
   Walpole   

The Walpole Times

www.wickedlocal.com/walpole

   Paid Weekly
   Waltham   

Waltham News Tribune

www.wickedlocal.com/waltham

   Paid Weekly
   Wareham   

Wareham Courier

www.wickedlocal.com/wareham

   Paid Weekly
   Watertown   

Watertown Tab & Press

www.wickedlocal.com/watertown

   Paid Weekly
   Wayland   

The Wayland Town Crier

www.wickedlocal.com/wayland

   Paid Weekly
   Wellesley   

The Wellesley Townsman

www.wickedlocal.com/wellesley

   Paid Weekly
   West Roxbury   

West Roxbury Transcript

www.wickedlocal.com/west-roxbury

   Paid Weekly
   Westborough   

Westborough News

www.wickedlocal.com/westborough

   Paid Weekly
   Westford   

Westford Eagle

www.wickedlocal.com/westford

   Paid Weekly
   Weston   

The Weston Town Crier

www.wickedlocal.com/weston

   Paid Weekly
   Weymouth   

Weymouth News

www.wickedlocal.com/weymouth

   Paid Weekly
   Winchester   

The Winchester Star

www.wickedlocal.com/winchester

   Paid Weekly
   Bellingham   

County Gazette

www.wickedlocal.com/franklin

   Free Weekly
   Boston   

Boston Homes

www.linkbostonhomes.com

   Free Weekly

 

124


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation
Type

   Bourne   

Bourne Courier

www.wickedlocal.com/bourne

   Free Weekly
   Bridgewater   

Bridgewater Independent

www.wickedlocal.com/bridgewater

   Free Weekly
   Brookline   

Brookline Tab

www.wickedlocal.com/brookline

   Free Weekly
   Canton   

Canton Journal

www.wickedlocal.com/canton

   Free Weekly
   Danvers    North Shore Sunday    Free Weekly
   Fall River   

OJornal

www.ojournal.com

   Free Weekly
   Falmouth   

Falmouth Bulletin

www.wickedlocal.com/falmouth

   Free Weekly
   Framingham   

Framingham Tab

www.wickedlocal.com/framingham

   Free Weekly
   Gloucester    Cape Ann Beacon    Free Weekly
   Needham   

Needham Times

www.wickedlocal.com/needham

   Free Weekly
   Newburyport   

The Newburyport Current

www.wickedlocal.com/newburyport

   Free Weekly
   Newton   

Newton Tab

www.wickedlocal.com/newton

   Free Weekly
   North Attleborough   

The North Attleborough Free Press

www.wickedlocal.com/northattleborough

   Free Weekly
   Randolph   

Randolph Herald

www.wickedlocal.com/randolph

   Free Weekly
   Raynham   

Raynham Call

www.wickedlocal.com/raynham

   Free Weekly
   Salem   

Salem Gazette

www.wickedlocal.com/salem

   Free Weekly
   Sandwich    Sandwich Broadsider    Free Weekly
   Stoneham   

Stoneham Sun

www.wickedlocal.com/stoneham

   Free Weekly
   Wilmington   

Wilmington Advocate

www.wickedlocal.com/wilmington

   Free Weekly
   Woburn   

Woburn Advocate

www.wickedlocal.com/woburn

   Free Weekly
   Fall River    South Coast Life    Shopper
   Taunton    Yellow Jacket    Shopper
   Amesbury    www.wickedlocal.com/amesbury    On-line Only
   Ashland    www.wickedlocal.com/ashland    On-line Only
   Avon    www.wickedlocal.com/avon    On-line Only
   Bellingham    www.wickedlocal.com/bellingham    On-line Only
   Berkley    www.wickedlocal.com/berkley    On-line Only
   Bolton    www.wickedlocal.com/bolton    On-line Only
   Boxborough    www.wickedlocal.com/boxborough    On-line Only
   Brewster    www.wickedlocal.com/brewster    On-line Only
   Brockton    www.wickedlocal.com/brockton    On-line Only
   Chatham    www.wickedlocal.com/chatham    On-line Only
   Clinton    www.wickedlocal.com/clinton    On-line Only
   Dennis    www.wickedlocal.com/dennis    On-line Only

 

125


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation
Type

   Dighton    www.wickedlocal.com/dighton    On-line Only
   Duxbury    www.wickedlocal.com/duxbury    On-line Only
   East Bridgewater    www.wickedlocal.com/bridgewatereast    On-line Only
   Eastham    www.wickedlocal.com/eastham    On-line Only
   Essex    www.wickedlocal.com/essex    On-line Only
   Fall River    www.wickedlocal.com/fall-river    On-line Only
   Foxborough    www.wickedlocal.com/foxborough    On-line Only
   Gloucester    www.wickedlocal.com/gloucester    On-line Only
   Halifax    www.wickedlocal.com/halifax    On-line Only
   Hanson    www.wickedlocal.com/hanson    On-line Only
   Harvard    www.wickedlocal.com/harvard    On-line Only
   Harwich    www.wickedlocal.com/harwich    On-line Only
   Holliston    www.wickedlocal.com/holliston    On-line Only
   Hopedale    www.wickedlocal.com/hopedale    On-line Only
   Hull    www.wickedlocal.com/hull    On-line Only
   Lakeville    www.wickedlocal.com/lakeville    On-line Only
   Lancaster    www.wickedlocal.com/lancaster    On-line Only
   Manchester    www.wickedlocal.com/manchester    On-line Only
   Mashpee    www.wickedlocal.com/mashpee    On-line Only
   Mattapoisett    www.wickedlocal.com/mattapoisett    On-line Only
   Medway    www.wickedlocal.com/medway    On-line Only
   Mendon    www.wickedlocal.com/mendon    On-line Only
   Middleborough    www.wickedlocal.com/middleborough    On-line Only
   Middleton    www.wickedlocal.com/middleton    On-line Only
   Milford    www.wickedlocal.com/milford    On-line Only
   Millis    www.wickedlocal.com/millis    On-line Only
   Milton    www.wickedlocal.com/milton    On-line Only
   Nantucket    www.wickedlocal.com/nantucket    On-line Only
   Norfolk    www.wickedlocal.com/norfolk    On-line Only
   North Boston    www.wickedlocal.com/northofboston    On-line Only
   Norton    www.wickedlocal.com/norton    On-line Only
   Orleans    www.wickedlocal.com/orleans    On-line Only
   Plainville    www.wickedlocal.com/plainville    On-line Only
   Plympton    www.wickedlocal.com/plympton    On-line Only
   Quincy    www.wickedlocal.com/quincy    On-line Only
   Rehoboth    www.wickedlocal.com/rehoboth    On-line Only
   Rochester    www.wickedlocal.com/rochester    On-line Only
   Rockport    www.wickedlocal.com/rockport    On-line Only
   Sandwich    www.wickedlocal.com/sandwich    On-line Only
   Sherborn    www.wickedlocal.com/sherborn    On-line Only
   Somerset    www.wickedlocal.com/somerset    On-line Only
   Southborough    www.wickedlocal.com/southborough    On-line Only
   Stow    www.wickedlocal.com/stow    On-line Only
   Swansea    www.wickedlocal.com/swansea    On-line Only
   Taunton    www.wickedlocal.com/taunton    On-line Only
   Topsfield    www.wickedlocal.com/topsfield    On-line Only
   Truro    www.wickedlocal.com/truro    On-line Only
   Upton    www.wickedlocal.com/upton    On-line Only
   Wellfleet    www.wickedlocal.com/wellfleet    On-line Only
   Wenham    www.wickedlocal.com/wenham    On-line Only
   West Bridgewater    www.wickedlocal.com/bridgewaterwest    On-line Only
   West Port    www.wickedlocal.com/westport    On-line Only

 

126


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation
Type

   Whitman    www.wickedlocal.com/whitman    On-line Only
   Wrentham    www.wickedlocal.com/wrentham    On-line Only
   Yarmouth    www.wickedlocal.com/yarmouth    On-line Only

New York

   Canandaigua   

Daily Messenger

www.mpnnow.com

www.mpnnow.com/commercialprinting

   Daily
   Newark/Palmyra   

Wayne Post

www.waynepost.com

   Paid Weekly
   Brighton/Pittsford   

Brighton-Pittsford Post

www.brightonpittsfordpost.com

   Free Weekly
   Canandaigua    Canandaigua Community Post    Free Weekly
   Fairport   

Fairport-ER Post

www.fairport-erpost.com

   Free Weekly
   Gates/Chili   

Gates-Chili Post

www.gateschilipost.com

   Free Weekly
   Greece   

Greece Post

www.greecepost.com

   Free Weekly
   Henrietta   

Henrietta Post

www.henriettapost.com

   Free Weekly
   Irondequoit   

Irondequoit Post

www.irondequiotpost.com

   Free Weekly
   Penfield   

Penfield Post

www.penfieldpost.com

   Free Weekly
   Victor   

Victor Post

www.victorpost.com

   Free Weekly
   Webster   

Webster Post

www.websterpost.com

   Free Weekly
   Lyons    Lyons Shopping Guide    Shopper
   Newark    Newark Pennysaver    Shopper
   Sodus    Sodus Pennysaver    Shopper
   Wayne County    Timesaver    Shopper

Delaware

   Dover   

Smyrna/Clayton Sun Times

www.scsuntimes.com

   Paid Weekly
   Dover   

The Middletown Transcript

www.middletowntranscript.com

   Paid Weekly
   Dover   

The Sussex Countian

www.sussexcountian.com

   Paid Weekly
   Dover   

Dover Post

www.doverpost.com

   Free Weekly
   Dover   

Community Publication

www.communitypub.com

   Free Weekly
   Dover   

Milford Beacon

www.milfordbeacon.com

   Free Weekly
   Dover   

The Express

www.delmarvaexpress.com

   Shopper

 

127


Table of Contents

Large Daily Newspapers

 

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

Illinois

   Freeport   

The Journal Standard

www.journalstandard.com

   Daily
   Lincoln   

The Courier

www.lincolncourier.com

   Daily
   Peoria   

Journal Star

www.pjstar.com

   Daily
   Rockford   

Rockford Register Star

www.rrstar.com

www.rockfordwoman.com

www.rockfordparent.com

   Daily
   Springfield   

The State Journal-Register

www.sj-r.com

   Daily
   Freeport    The Scene    Shopper
   Lincoln    Logan County Shopper    Shopper
   Peoria    JS Shopper    Shopper
   Peoria    Pekin Extra    Shopper
   Rockford    The Weekly    Shopper
   Springfield    Springfield Advertiser    Shopper
   Springfield    Springfield Shopper    Shopper

New York

   Herkimer   

The Evening Telegram

www.herkimertelegram.com

   Daily
   Little Falls   

The Evening Times

www.littlefallstimes.com

   Daily
   Utica   

Utica Observer-Dispatch

www.uticaod.com

   Daily
   Hamilton    Mid-York Weekly    Free Weekly
   Utica    The Pennysaver    Free Weekly
   Herkimer    Your Valley    Shopper

Ohio

   Canton   

The Repository

www.cantonrep.com

   Daily
   Dover/New Philadelphia   

The Times-Reporter

www.timesreporter.com

   Daily
   Massillon   

The Independent

www.indeonline.com

   Daily
   Green   

The Suburbanite

www.thesuburbanite.com

   Free Weekly
   Canton    The Wrap    Shopper
   Dover/New Philadelphia    TMC-ExTRa    Shopper
   Ohio    www.fridaynightohio.com    On-line Only

Connecticut

   Norwich   

The Bulletin

www.norwichbulletin.com

   Daily
   Norwich    Bulletin Deals    Shopper

 

128


Table of Contents

Local Media

 

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

Massachusetts

   Hyannis   

Cape Cod Times

www.CapeCodOnline.com

   Daily
   New Bedford   

The Standard-Times

www.southcoasttoday.com

   Daily
   Hyannis   

Barnstable Patriot

www.barnstablepatriot.com

   Paid Weekly
   Middleboro   

Middleboro Gazette

www.southcoasttoday.com

   Paid Weekly
   Nantucket   

Nantucket Inquirer & Mirror

www.ack.net

www.discovernantucket.com

   Paid Weekly
   New Bedford   

Advocate

www.southcoasttoday.com

   Paid Weekly
   New Bedford   

Chronicle

www.southcoasttoday.com

   Paid Weekly
   New Bedford   

Spectator

www.southcoasttoday.com

   Paid Weekly
   Fall River   

Fall River Spirit

www.southcoasttoday.com

   Free Weekly
   Hyannis    DollarSaver/TMC    Shopper
   Middleboro   

Middleboro Gazette

www.southcoasttoday.com

   Shopper
   New Bedford    SouthCoast MarketPlace/TMC    Shopper

New Hampshire

   Portsmouth   

Portsmouth Herald

www.seacoastonline.com

   Daily
   Exeter   

Exeter News-Letter

www.seacoastonline.com

   Paid Weekly
   Hampton   

Hampton Union

www.seacoastonline.com

   Paid Weekly
   Portsmouth   

Seacoast Sunday

www.seacoastonline.com

   Paid Weekly
   Hampton   

Beachcomber

www.seacoastonline.com

   Free Weekly

New York

   Middletown   

Times Herald-Record

www.recordonline.com

   Daily
   Middletown   

The Gazette

www.hudsonvalley.com

   Free Weekly
   Middletown   

Pointer View

www.pointerview.com

   Free Weekly
   Middletown    Extra/TMC    Shopper

Oregon

   Medford   

Ashland Daily Tidings

www.dailytidings.com

   Daily
   Medford   

Mail Tribune

www.mailtribune.com

   Daily
   Medford    A la Carte/TMC    Shopper
   Medford   

Nickel

www.medfordnickel.com

   Shopper

 

129


Table of Contents

State

  

City

  

Masthead

  

Circulation

Type

California

   Barstow   

Desert Dispatch

www.desertdispatch.com

   Daily
   Stockton   

The Stockton Record

www.recordnet.com

   Daily
   Victorville   

Victorville Daily Press

www.vvdailypress.com

   Daily
   Lucerne Valley   

Lucerne Valley Leader

www.lucernevalleyleader.com

   Paid Weekly
   Hesperia   

Hesperia Star

www.hesperiastar.com

   Free Weekly
   Stockton    VIDA    Free Weekly
   Victorville   

El Mojave

www.elmojave.com

   Free Weekly
   Apple Valley   

Apple Valley Review

www.applevalleyreview.net

   Shopper
   Barstow   

Barstow Plus

   Shopper
   Stockton   

The Valley Marketplace/TMC

www.valleymarketplace.com

   Shopper
   Victorville   

Review

   Shopper

Pennsylvania

   Stroudsburg   

Pocono Record

www.poconorecord.com

   Daily
   Stroudsburg    Pike & Monroe Life    Free Weekly
   Stroudsburg    Plus/TMC    Shopper

Maine

   Kennebunk   

York County Coast Star

www.seacoastonline.com

   Paid Weekly
   York   

York Weekly

www.seacoastonline.com

   Paid Weekly

Legal Proceedings

We become involved from time to time in claims and lawsuits incidental to the ordinary course of our business, including such matters as libel, invasion of privacy, intellectual property infringement, wrongful termination actions and complaints alleging discrimination. In addition, we are involved from time to time in governmental and administrative proceedings concerning employment, labor, environmental and other claims. Insurance coverage mitigates potential loss for certain of these matters. Historically, such claims and proceedings have not had a material adverse effect upon our consolidated results of operations or financial condition. While we are unable to predict the ultimate outcome of any currently outstanding legal actions, we believe that it is not a likely possibility that the disposition of these matters would have a material adverse effect upon our consolidated results of operations, financial condition or cash flow.

On September 4, 2013, our Predecessor, GateHouse, and the Debtors announced that our Predecessor, the Administrative Agent, Newcastle and the Participating Lenders under the 2007 Credit Facility entered into the Support Agreement, in which the parties agreed to support, subject to the terms and conditions of the Support Agreement, the Restructuring pursuant to the consummation of the Plan. The Support Agreement relates to the Restructuring of our Predecessor’s obligations under its Outstanding Debt and our Predecessor’s equity pursuant to the Plan.

Pursuant to the Restructuring, Newcastle made the Cash-Out Offer. The holders of the Outstanding Debt had the option of receiving, in satisfaction of their Outstanding Debt, their pro rata share of the (i) Cash-Out Offer and/or (ii) New Media Common Stock and the net proceeds, if any, of the GateHouse Credit Facilities. On

 

130


Table of Contents

the Effective Date, November 26, 2013, Newcastle received its pro rata share of New Media Common Stock and the net proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities for all Outstanding Debt it holds, including Outstanding Debt purchased in the Cash-Out Offer. All pensions, trade and all other unsecured claims will be paid in the ordinary course.

On September 20, 2013, our Predecessor commenced the Solicitation. On September 27, 2013, our Predecessor filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code, case number 13-12503. Under the Support Agreement, which terminated on the Effective Date, each of the Participating Lenders agreed to (a) support and take any reasonable action in furtherance of the Restructuring, (b) timely vote their Outstanding Debt to accept the Plan and not change or withdraw such vote, (c) support approval of the Disclosure Statement and confirmation of the Plan, as well as certain relief to be requested by Debtors from the Bankruptcy Court, (d) refrain from taking any action inconsistent with the confirmation or consummation of the Plan, and (e) not propose, support, solicit or participate in the formulation of any plan other than the Plan. Holders of Outstanding Debt sufficient to meet the requisite threshold of 67% in amount and majority in number (calculated without including any insider) necessary for acceptance of the Plan under the Bankruptcy Code voted to accept the Plan in the Solicitation. 100% of the holders of the Outstanding Debt voted to accept the Plan under the terms of the Support Agreement. On September 27, 2013, our Predecessor filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code, case number 13-12503. As a result, Debtors commenced Chapter 11 cases and sought approval of the Disclosure Statement and confirmation of the Plan therein. The Plan was confirmed by the Bankruptcy Court on November 6, 2013 and our Predecessor effected the transactions contemplated by the Plan to emerge from bankruptcy protection on November 26, 2013. See Note 2 to New Media’s Consolidated Financial Statements and Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements, “Voluntary Reorganization Under Chapter 11,” for additional discussion.

 

131


Table of Contents

OUR MANAGER AND MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT

This description is a summary and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, the provisions of the Amended and Restated Management Agreement filed as Exhibit 10.37 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

General

New Media is an externally managed by FIG LLC, an affiliate of Fortress, pursuant to the terms the Management Agreement.

Management Agreement

On November 26, 2013, we entered into a Management Agreement with our Manager, which provides for the day-to-day management of our operations. Our Management Agreement requires our Manager to manage our business affairs subject to the supervision of our Board of Directors.

Our Manager is responsible for, among other things, (i) the purchase and sale of our investments, (ii) the financing of our investments, and (iii) investment advisory services. Our Manager is responsible for our day-to-day operations and will perform (or cause to be performed) such services and activities relating to our assets and operations as may be appropriate, which may include, without limitation, the following:

 

  (i) serving as the Company’s consultant with respect to the periodic review of the investment criteria and parameters for investments of the Company (“Investments”), borrowings and operations;

 

  (ii) investigation, analysis, valuation and selection of investment opportunities;

 

  (iii) with respect to prospective Investments by the Company and dispositions of Investments, conducting negotiations with brokers, sellers and purchasers and their respective agents and representatives, investment bankers and owners of privately and publicly held companies;

 

  (iv) engaging and supervising, on behalf of the Company and at the Company’s expense, independent contractors that provide services relating to the Investments, including, but not limited to, investment banking, legal advisory, tax advisory, accounting advisory, securities brokerage, real estate advisory and brokerage, and other financial and consulting services as the Manager determines from time to time is advisable;

 

  (v) negotiating on behalf of the Company for the sale, exchange or other disposition of any Investments;

 

  (vi) coordinating and managing operations of any joint venture or co-investment interests held by the Company and conducting all matters with the joint venture or co-investment partners;

 

  (vii) providing executive and administrative personnel, office space and office services required in rendering services to the Company;

 

  (viii) administering the day-to-day operations of the Company and performing and supervising the performance of such other administrative functions necessary in the management of the Company as may be agreed upon by the Manager and our Board of Directors, including, without limitation, the collection of revenues and the payment of the Company’s debts and obligations and maintenance of appropriate computer services to perform such administrative functions;

 

  (ix) communicating on behalf of the Company with the holders of any equity or debt securities of the Company as required to satisfy the reporting and other requirements of any governmental bodies or agencies or trading markets and to maintain effective relations with such holders;

 

  (x) counseling the Company in connection with policy decisions to be made by our Board of Directors;

 

  (xi) evaluating and recommending to our Board of Directors modifications to the hedging strategies in effect on the date hereof and engaging in hedging activities on behalf of the Company;

 

132


Table of Contents
  (xii) counseling the Company regarding the maintenance of its exemption from the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the “Investment Company Act”) and monitoring compliance with the requirements for maintaining an exemption from the Investment Company Act;

 

  (xiii) assisting the Company in developing criteria that are specifically tailored to the Company’s investment objectives and making available to the Company its knowledge and experience with respect to its target assets;

 

  (xiv) representing and making recommendations to the Company in connection with the purchase and finance, and commitment to purchase and finance, of its target assets, and in connection with the sale and commitment to sell such assets;

 

  (xv) monitoring the operating performance of the Investments and providing periodic reports with respect thereto to our Board of Directors, including comparative information with respect to such operating performance, valuation and budgeted or projected operating results;

 

  (xvi) investing and re-investing any moneys and securities of the Company (including investing in short-term Investments pending investment in Investments, payment of fees, costs and expenses, or payments of dividends or distributions to stockholders and partners of the Company) and advising the Company as to its capital structure and capital raising;

 

  (xvii) causing the Company to retain qualified accountants and legal counsel, as applicable, to assist in developing appropriate accounting procedures, compliance procedures and testing systems with respect to financial reporting obligations and to conduct quarterly compliance reviews with respect thereto;

 

  (xviii) causing the Company to qualify to do business in all applicable jurisdictions and to obtain and maintain all appropriate licenses;

 

  (xix) assisting the Company in complying with all regulatory requirements applicable to the Company in respect of its business activities, including preparing or causing to be prepared all financial statements required under applicable regulations and contractual undertakings and all reports and documents required under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, (the “Exchange Act”);

 

  (xx) taking all necessary actions to enable the Company to make required tax filings and reports, including soliciting stockholders for required information to the extent provided by the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”);

 

  (xxi) handling and resolving all claims, disputes or controversies (including all litigation, arbitration, settlement or other proceedings or negotiations) in which the Company may be involved or to which the Company may be subject arising out of the Company’s day-to-day operations, subject to such limitations or parameters as may be imposed from time to time by our Board of Directors;

 

  (xxii) using commercially reasonable efforts to cause expenses incurred by or on behalf of the Company to be reasonable or customary and within any budgeted parameters or expense guidelines set by our Board of Directors from time to time;

 

  (xxiii) performing such other services as may be required from time to time for management and other activities relating to the assets of the Company as our Board of Directors shall reasonably request or the Manager shall deem appropriate under the particular circumstances; and

 

  (xxiv) using commercially reasonable efforts to cause the Company to comply with all applicable laws.

Indemnification

Pursuant to our Management Agreement, our Manager does not assume any responsibility other than to render the services called for thereunder in good faith and is not responsible for any action of our Board of Directors in following or declining to follow its advice or recommendations. Our Manager, its members, managers, officers and employees are not liable to us or any of our subsidiaries, to our Board of Directors, or our

 

133


Table of Contents

or any subsidiary’s stockholders or partners for any acts or omissions by our Manager, its members, managers, officers or employees, except by reason of acts constituting bad faith, willful misconduct, gross negligence or reckless disregard of our Manager’s duties under our Management Agreement. We shall, to the full extent lawful, reimburse, indemnify and hold our Manager, its members, managers, officers and employees and each other person, if any, controlling our Manager, harmless of and from any and all expenses, losses, damages, liabilities, demands, charges and claims of any nature whatsoever (including attorneys’ fees) in respect of or arising from any acts or omissions of an indemnified party made in good faith in the performance of our Manager’s duties under our Management Agreement and not constituting such indemnified party’s bad faith, willful misconduct, gross negligence or reckless disregard of our Manager’s duties under our Management Agreement.

Our Manager will, to the full extent lawful, reimburse, indemnify and hold us, our stockholders, directors, officers and employees and each other person, if any, controlling us, harmless of and from any and all expenses, losses, damages, liabilities, demands, charges and claims of any nature whatsoever (including attorneys’ fees) in respect of or arising from our Manager’s bad faith, willful misconduct, gross negligence or reckless disregard of its duties under our Management Agreement. Our Manager carries errors and omissions and other customary insurance.

Management Team

Following the commencement of “regular-way” trading of Common Stock on a major U.S. national securities exchange (the “Listing”) on February 14, 2014, the Manager is responsible for the compensation and benefits of our Chief Executive Officer. Any increase to our Chief Executive Officer’s compensation and benefits in effect as of the date of the Management Agreement will either be approved by the Manager or be paid for by the Company.

Devotion of Additional Time; Conflicts of Interest

Our management team is not required to exclusively dedicate their services to us and provides services for other entities affiliated with our Manager.

In addition, Fortress affiliates are not restricted from pursuing other opportunities that may create conflicts or competition for us. However, our code of business conduct and ethics prohibits, subject to the terms of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, the directors, officers and employees of our Manager from engaging in any transaction that involves an actual conflict of interest with us. See “Risk Factors—Risks Relating to Our Manager—There may be conflicts of interest in our relationship with our Manager, including with respect to corporate opportunities” and “Description of Our Capital Stock—Corporate Opportunity.”

Assignment

Our Manager may generally only assign our Management Agreement with the written approval of a majority of our independent directors; provided, however, that our Manager may assign our Management Agreement to an entity whose day-to-day business and operations are managed and supervised by Mr. Wesley R. Edens (the “Principal”), provided, further, that such transaction is determined at the time not to be an “assignment” for purposes of Section 205 of the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended, and the rules and regulations promulgated under such act and the interpretations thereof issued by the SEC. We may not assign our Management Agreement without the prior written consent of our Manager, except in the case of an assignment to our successor, in which case such successor organization shall be bound under our Management Agreement and by the terms of such assignment in the same manner as we are bound under our Management Agreement.

Term; Termination

The initial term of our Management Agreement will expire on the third anniversary of the Distribution and will be renewed automatically each year for an additional one-year period unless (i) a majority consisting of at least two-thirds of our independent directors or a simple majority of the holders of outstanding shares of our Common Stock, reasonably agree that there has been unsatisfactory performance that is materially detrimental to

 

134


Table of Contents

us or (ii) a simple majority of our independent directors agree that the management fee payable to our Manager is unfair; provided, that we shall not have the right to terminate our Management Agreement under clause (iii) foregoing if the Manager agrees to continue to provide the services under the Management Agreement at a fee that our independent directors have determined to be fair.

If we elect not to renew our Management Agreement at the expiration of the original term or any such one-year extension term as set forth above, our Manager will be provided with 60 days’ prior notice of any such termination. In the event of such termination, we would be required to pay the termination fee described below. We may also terminate our Management Agreement at any time for cause effective upon sixty (60) days prior written notice of termination from us to our Manager, in which case no termination fee would be due, for the following reasons:

 

  (i) the willful violation of the Management Agreement by the Manager in its corporate capacity (as distinguished from the acts of any employees of the Manager which are taken without the complicity of the Principal) under the Management Agreement;

 

  (ii) our Manager’s fraud, misappropriation of funds, or embezzlement against us; and

 

  (iii) our Manager’s gross negligence of duties under our Management Agreement.

In addition, our Manager may terminate our Management Agreement effective upon sixty (60) days prior written notice of termination to us in the event that we default in the performance or observance of any material term, condition or covenant contained in our Management Agreement and such default continues for a period of thirty (30) days after written notice thereof specifying such default and requesting that the same be remedied in such 30 day period.

If our Management Agreement is terminated by our Manager upon our breach, we would be required to pay our Manager the termination fee described below.

Management Fee

We pay our Manager an annual management fee equal to 1.50% per annum of our Total Equity calculated and payable monthly in arrears in cash. Total Equity is generally the equity transferred by Newcastle on the date on which our shares trade in the “regular way” market on the NYSE, plus total net proceeds from any equity capital raised (including through stock offerings), plus certain capital contributions to subsidiaries, plus the equity value of certain assets contributed to the Company, less capital dividends and capital distributions.

Our Manager computes each installment of the management fee within 15 days after the end of the calendar month with respect to which such installment is payable.

Incentive Compensation

Our Manager is eligible to receive on a quarterly basis annual incentive compensation in an amount equal to the product of 25% of the dollar amount by which (a) the adjusted net income of the Company exceeds (b)(i) the weighted daily average total equity (plus cash capital raising costs), multiplied by (ii) a simple interest rate of 10% per annum.

“Adjusted net income” means net income (computed in accordance with U.S. GAAP plus depreciation and amortization, and after adjustments for unconsolidated partnerships, joint ventures and permanent cash tax savings. Adjusted net income will be computed on an unconsolidated basis. The computation of adjusted net income may be adjusted at the direction of the independent directors based on changes in, or certain applications, of GAAP.

Upon any termination of our Management Agreement by either party, we shall be entitled to purchase our Manager’s right to receive incentive compensation from our Manager for a cash purchase price equal to the

 

135


Table of Contents

amount that would be distributed to our Manager if all of our assets were sold for cash at their then current fair market value (taking into account, among other things, expected future performance of the underlying investments) or otherwise continue to pay the incentive compensation to the Manager. In addition, if we do not elect to so purchase the Manager’s right to receive incentive compensation, our Manager will have the right to require us to purchase the same at the price described above. In either case, such fair market value shall be determined by independent appraisal to be conducted by a nationally recognized appraisal firm mutually agreed upon by us and our Manager.

Our Board of Directors may request that our Manager accept all or a portion of its incentive compensation in shares of our Common Stock, and our Manager may elect, in its discretion, to accept such payment in the form of shares, subject to limitations that may be imposed by the rules of the NYSE or otherwise.

Upon the successful completion of an offering of shares of our Common Stock or any shares of preferred stock, we will grant our Manager or an affiliate of our Manager options equal to 10% of the number of shares being sold in the offering (excluding the shares issued to Newcastle or its affiliates in the Local Media Contribution), with an exercise price equal to the offering price per share paid by the public or other ultimate purchaser. We are granting an affiliate of our Manager options in connection with this offering.

Reimbursement of Expenses

Because our Manager’s employees perform certain legal, accounting, due diligence tasks and other services that outside professionals or outside consultants otherwise would perform, following the Listing, our Manager is paid or reimbursed for the cost of performing such tasks, provided that such costs and reimbursements are no greater than those which would be paid to outside professionals or consultants on an arm’s-length basis.

We also pay all operating expenses, except those specifically required to be borne by our Manager under our Management Agreement. Our Manager is responsible for all costs incident to the performance of its duties under the Management Agreement, including compensation of our Manager’s employees, rent for facilities and other “overhead” expenses. The expenses required to be paid by us include, but are not limited to, issuance and transaction costs incident to the acquisition, disposition, operation and financing of our investments, legal and auditing fees and expenses, the compensation and expenses of our independent directors, the costs associated with the establishment and maintenance of any credit facilities and other indebtedness of ours (including commitment fees, legal fees, closing costs, etc.), expenses associated with other securities offerings of ours, the costs of printing and mailing proxies and reports to our stockholders, costs incurred by employees of our manager for travel on our behalf, costs associated with any computer software or hardware that is used solely for us, costs to obtain liability insurance to indemnify our directors and officers and the compensation and expenses of our distribution agent.

Termination Fee

The termination fee is a fee equal to the sum of (1) the amount of the management fee during the 12 months immediately preceding the date of termination, and (2) the “Incentive Compensation Fair Value Amount,” if such option is exercised by the Company or the Manager. The Incentive Compensation Fair Value Amount is an amount equal to the incentive compensation that would be paid to the Manager if our assets were sold for cash at their then current fair market value (as determined by an appraisal, taking into account, among other things, the expected future value of the underlying investments).

 

136


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT

Officers of New Media

The following individuals serve as the officers of New Media:

Michael E. Reed, age 47, is our Chief Executive Officer. He became our Chief Executive Officer at the Effective Date. Previously he had been GateHouse’s Chief Executive Officer since January of 2006 and served in this position when GateHouse filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code on September 27, 2013. He was a member of the board of directors of our Predecessor GateHouse since October 2006. He was formerly the President and Chief Executive Officer of Community Newspaper Holdings, Inc., or “CNHI,” a leading publisher of local news and information and had served in that capacity since 1999. Mr. Reed served as CNHI’s Chief Financial Officer from 1997 to 1999. Prior to that, he worked for Park Communications, Inc., a multimedia company, located in Ithaca, New York. Mr. Reed formerly served on the Board of Directors for the Newspaper Association of America. He currently serves on the Board of Directors for the Minneapolis Star Tribune, on which he has served since 2009. Mr. Reed formerly served as a director of the Associated Press and Chairman of the Audit Committee for the Associated Press. Mr. Reed was also a member of the Board of Visitors of the University of Alabama’s College of Communication and Information Sciences and was a member of the Grady College Journalism School’s Board of Advisors. Mr. Reed has a deep understanding of our operations, strategy and people, as well as our industry, serving as GateHouse’s Chief Executive Officer for over seven years. He has also served in senior executive capacities with other companies in the newspaper and publishing industries. Mr. Reed also has extensive corporate board experience.

Gregory Freiberg, age 47, is our Chief Financial Officer and Chief Accounting Officer. He became New Media’s Chief Financial Officer in January of 2014. He was formerly the Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Dex One Corporation, a leading marketing solutions provider and had served in that capacity from September 2011 to April 2013. Mr. Freiberg was the Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Dex One Corporation when Dex One Corporation filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code on March 18, 2013. Prior to that, he served as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Savvis, Inc. from April 2009 to August 2011, a global leader in cloud and managed solutions. Mr. Freiberg served as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of XO Holdings, Inc. and XO Communications, LLC from April 2006 to March 2009. Mr. Freiberg received his Bachelor of Science in Business Administration from the University of South Dakota, holds a CPA Certificate from the State of Nebraska, and served in the United States Army National Guard from 1986-1995.

Kirk Davis, age 52, is our Chief Operating Officer. He became our Chief Operating Officer and the Chief Executive Officer of GateHouse in January of 2014. He became the President and Chief Operating Officer of GateHouse, in January 2009 and still serves as its President. Mr. Davis was the President and Chief Operating Officer of GateHouse when GateHouse filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code on September 27, 2013. Mr. Davis has been an employee of GateHouse since 2006, when he served as the Chief Executive Officer of GateHouse Media New England. Prior to joining GateHouse, Mr. Davis served as the Chief Executive Officer of Enterprise NewsMedia, LLC, also known as the South of Boston Media Group, from 2004 to 2006. Prior to that, Mr. Davis served as Vice President of Publishing for Turley Publications, Inc., a publishing and printing company, from 2002 to 2004. In 2001, Mr. Davis formed Cracked Rock Media, Inc. and began acquiring newspapers in Central Massachusetts. Mr. Davis still owns Cracked Rock Media, but has no day-to-day operational involvement. Prior to that, Mr. Davis served as President of Community Newspaper Company (“CNC”) from 1998 to 2001. Mr. Davis also served as President of a newspaper group in the Boston area (TAB Newspapers), which was part of CNC, from 1996 to 1998. Mr. Davis also served as a Publisher and managed newspaper companies in Pennsylvania, Massachusetts and California from 1990 to 1996. Mr. Davis also served as Vice President of Circulation and Marketing for Ingersoll Publications from 1985 to 1990. Mr. Davis attended Wright State University and Ohio University. He is past chairman of the board for the Suburban Newspapers of America (“SNA”) and as well as past chairman of the SNA Foundation. In 2007, Mr. Davis was elected to the Board of Directors of the Alliance for Audited Media.

 

137


Table of Contents

Directors of New Media

In accordance with the terms of our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation, from and after the date of the first meeting of the Board of New Media following the Listing, the Board of New Media is divided into three classes of directors (designated Class I, Class II and Class III) of the same or nearly the same number to the extent practicable. At each annual meeting of stockholders, one class of directors will be elected for a three-year term to succeed the directors of the same class whose terms are then expiring. As a result, absent extenuating circumstances, a portion of the Board will be elected each year.

Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation authorizes a Board consisting of at least three, but no more than eleven, members, with the exact number of directors to be fixed from time to time by a resolution of the majority of the Board (or by a duly adopted amendment to the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation). Any additional directorships resulting from an increase in the number of directors will be distributed among the three classes so that, as nearly as possible, each class will consist of one-third of the directors. The division of the Board into classes with staggered three-year terms may delay or prevent a change of management or a change in control. The initial terms of the Class I, Class II, and Class III directors will expire on the dates of the first, second and third annual meetings of stockholders held after the Listing, respectively. Mr. Tarica will serve as a Class I director, Messrs. Janulis and Reed will each serve as a Class II director and Messrs. Edens and Sheehan will each serve as a Class III director. All officers serve at the discretion of the Board.

 

Name, Position, Age

  

Description

Wesley R. Edens

Chairman and Director

Age: 52

   Mr. Edens is Chairman of our Board. Mr. Edens is Co-Founder, Principal and Co-Chairman of the board of directors of Fortress, an affiliate of our Manager. He is also Chairman of the board of directors of each of New Residential Investment Corp., Florida East Coast Railway Corp., Nationstar Mortgage Holdings Inc., and Newcastle Investment Corp., and he is a director of Intrawest Resorts Holdings, Inc., GAGFAH S.A., Brookdale Senior Living Inc., Gaming and Leisure Properties Inc., Springleaf Finance Corporation, Springleaf Holdings Inc. and Springleaf Finance Inc. Mr. Edens was the Chief Executive Officer of Global Signal Inc. from February 2004 to April 2006 and Chairman of the board of directors from October 2002 to January 2007. Mr. Edens was the Chairman of the board of directors of GateHouse since June 2005 and served in this position when GateHouse filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code on September 27, 2013. Mr. Edens serves or has served on the boards of the following publicly traded companies and registered investment companies: Penn National Gaming Inc. from October 2008 to November 2013; Aircastle Limited from August 2006 to August 2012; RailAmerica Inc. from November 2006 to October 2012; Crown Castle Investment Corp. (merged with Global Signal Inc.) from January 2007 to July 2007; Eurocastle Investment Limited, from August 2003 to November 2011; Fortress Brookdale Investment Fund LLC, from August 2000 (deregistered with the SEC in March 2009); Fortress Pinnacle Investment Fund, from July 2002 (deregistered with the SEC in March 2008); Fortress Investment Trust II, from July 2002 (deregistered with the SEC in January 2011); GateHouse, from June 2005 (deregistered with the SEC in November 2013); and RIC Coinvestment Fund LP, from May 2006 (deregistered with the SEC in June 2009). Prior to forming Fortress Investment Group LLC, Mr. Edens was a partner and a managing director of BlackRock Financial Management Inc., where he headed BlackRock Asset Investors, a private equity fund. In addition, Mr. Edens was formerly a partner and a managing director of Lehman Brothers. Mr. Edens received a B.S. in Finance from Oregon State University. Mr. Edens’s extensive credit, private equity finance and management expertise, extensive experience as an officer and director of public companies and his deep familiarity with our Company led our Board of Directors to conclude that Mr. Edens should be elected to serve as our Chairman and director.

 

138


Table of Contents

Name, Position, Age

  

Description

Michael E. Reed

Director

Age: 47

   For Mr. Reed’s biography, see “—Officers of New Media.”

Kevin Sheehan

Director

Age: 59

  

Mr. Sheehan was a member of the board of directors of our Predecessor, GateHouse, from October 2006 through the Effective Date and served in this position when GateHouse filed voluntary petitions for relief under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code on September 27, 2013. Mr. Sheehan currently serves as Chief Executive Officer of Norwegian Cruise Line, which he joined in 2007. Previously, Mr. Sheehan provided consulting services to Cerebrus Capital Management LP (2006-2007) and provided consulting services to Clayton Dubilier & Rice from 2005 until 2006. Prior thereto, Mr. Sheehan was Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Cendant Corporation’s Vehicle Services Division (included responsibility for Avis Rent A Car, Budget Rent A Car, Budget Truck, PHH Fleet Management and Wright Express) from January 2003 until May 2005. From March 2001 until May 2003, Mr. Sheehan served as Chief Financial Officer of Cendant Corporation. From August 1999 to February 2001, Mr. Sheehan was President—Corporate and Business Affairs and Chief Financial Officer of Avis Group Holdings, Inc. and a director of that company from June 1999 until February 2001. From August 2005 to January 2008, Mr. Sheehan served on the faculty of Adelphi University as a Distinguished Visiting Professor—Accounting, Finance and Economics. Mr. Sheehan currently serves on the Boards of Dave & Busters and XOJETS. Mr. Sheehan is a graduate of Hunter College and New York University Graduate School of Business, and is a Certified Public Accountant.

 

Mr. Sheehan has significant experience in a senior management capacity for large corporations. Specifically, his experience as the Chief Financial Officer of several large corporations provide him with important experience and skills, as well as an understanding of the complexities of our current economic environment. Mr. Sheehan also brings significant financial expertise to our Board.

Theodore P. Janulis

Director

Age: 54

   Mr. Janulis joined CRT Greenwich LLC in 2014 as Chief Executive Officer. CRT Greenwich LLC is the parent company of CRT Capital Group LLC, an institutionally focused broker-dealer that provides research and trade execution services. Prior to that, Mr. Janulis served as CEO of Aurora Bank FSB. Before Aurora, he spent 23 years at Lehman Brothers in various senior management roles including Global Head of Mortgage Capital, Global Head of the Investment Management Division, which included Neuberger Berman, and Global Co-Head of Fixed Income. He also served on the firm’s Executive Committee. Mr. Janulis earned his Master of Business Administration from Columbia University Graduate Business School and A.B. from Harvard College. Mr. Janulis’s knowledge, skill, expertise and experience, including his extensive senior management experience, his service as Chief Executive Officer of two companies and his significant financial background, as evidenced by his professional and educational history, led our Board of Directors to conclude that he should serve as a director.

 

139


Table of Contents

Name, Position, Age

  

Description

Laurence Tarica

Director

Age: 64

   Mr. Tarica currently serves as President of Jimlar Corporation (“Jimlar”), a member of the Li and Fung Group. Jimlar was privately held until it was acquired by the Li and Fung Group in 2010. Mr. Tarica joined Jimlar in 1971 and served in leadership roles in sourcing, design, development, sales and marketing. He became President and Chief Operating Officer of Jimlar in 1991. Jimlar is one of the oldest footwear import companies in America. Mr. Tarica also serves on the Board of Directors of D’Addario and Company, the leading manufacturer of musical instrument accessories, and on the Advisory Board of Stuart Levine and Associates, a management consulting firm. Mr. Tarica earned his Bachelor of Science in Economics from the University of Pennsylvania, Wharton School of Business. Mr. Tarica’s knowledge, skill, expertise and experience, specifically his experiences in a variety of business divisions, including sales and marketing, his development of Jimlar’s digital services and social media strategy and his over 20 years of operational and leadership experience as the President and Chief Operating Officer of Jimlar, led our Board of Directors to conclude that he should serve as a director.

Corporate Governance Principles and Board Matters

New Media is committed to maintaining high standards of business conduct and corporate governance, which we believe are essential to running our business efficiently, serving our stockholders well and maintaining our integrity in the marketplace. To that end, we have adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics for our directors, officers and employees, including a separate Code of Ethics for our Chief Executive Officer and senior financial officers. In addition, we have adopted the Corporate Governance Guidelines of New Media (our “Corporate Governance Guidelines”), which, in conjunction with our Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation, Amended and Restated Bylaws, Audit Committee charter, Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee charter and Compensation Committee charter form the framework for our corporate governance. All of our corporate governance materials, including the Audit Committee charter, Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee charter, Compensation Committee charter and the Code of Ethics for Executive Officers, are available under the Investors tabs on our website at www.newmediainv.com.

These materials also are available in print to any stockholder upon request. The Board regularly reviews corporate governance developments and makes modifications as warranted.

Board and Board Committee Independence

The Board has determined that each of Theodore P. Janulis, Kevin Sheehan and Laurence Tarica have no material relationship with us and are independent in accordance with our Corporate Governance Guidelines and the NYSE listing standards.

Board Structure and Committee Composition

As of the date of this Prospectus, the Board has five directors, a standing Audit Committee, Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee and Compensation Committee. The committees’ memberships and functions are described below. The Audit Committee, Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee and Compensation Committee operate under written charters adopted by the Board.

Board Leadership Structure

Although we currently have no policy against combining the two roles, we currently split the roles of Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer. The Board believes that separating these two positions allows each person to focus on their individual responsibilities and enhances the accountability of our Chief

 

140


Table of Contents

Executive Officer to the Board. Under this structure, our Chief Executive Officer can focus his attention on the day-to-day operations and performance of our Company and on implementing our longer-term strategic direction. At the same time, our Chairman of the Board can focus his attention on longer term strategic issues, setting the agenda for and on providing insight and guidance to our Chief Executive Officer. We currently believe that the separation of the roles of Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer is appropriate, however, our Corporate Governance Guidelines do not require the separation of the offices of the Chairman of the Board and the Chief Executive Officer. The Board is free to choose its Chairman of the Board in any way that it deems best at any given point in time.

The Board’s Role in Risk Oversight

The Board is responsible for enterprise risk management, including risks associated with our corporate governance, such as board organization, membership, structure and leadership succession planning, as well as the management of risks arising from our executive compensation policies and programs. While the Board retains responsibility for the general oversight of risks, it has delegated financial oversight to our Audit Committee, which focuses on financial risk, including those that could arise from our accounting and financial reporting processes and our consolidated financial statement audits.

The Board and the Audit Committee work together to provide enterprise-wide oversight of our management and handling of risk. These responsibilities are satisfied through periodic reports from the Audit Committee chairman regarding the risk considerations within its area of expertise, as well as through periodic reports to the Board, or the Audit Committee, from our management team on areas of material risk to the Company, including operational, financial, legal, regulatory and strategic risks. The Board, or the Audit Committee with respect to risks within its scope, reviews these reports to enable it to understand our risk identification, risk management and risk mitigation strategies. The Audit Committee chairman will report to the Board at subsequent Board meetings regarding particular risks within the scope of the Audit Committee, enabling the Board and the Audit Committee to coordinate the risk oversight role.

Committees of the Board

We have established the following committees of our Board:

Audit Committee

The Audit Committee:

 

    reviews the audit plans and findings of our independent registered public accounting firm and our internal audit and risk review staff, as well as the results of regulatory examinations, and tracks management’s corrective action plans where necessary;

 

    reviews our financial statements, including any significant financial items and/or changes in accounting policies, with our senior management and independent registered public accounting firm;

 

    reviews our financial risk and control procedures, compliance programs and significant tax, legal and regulatory matters; and

 

    has the sole discretion to appoint annually our independent registered public accounting firm, evaluate its independence and performance and set clear hiring policies for employees or former employees of the independent registered public accounting firm.

The members of the Audit Committee are Kevin Sheehan (chair), Theodore P. Janulis and Laurence Tarica. Each member of the Audit Committee is “independent,” as defined under the rules of the NYSE and Rule 10A-3 of the Exchange Act. Our Board of Directors has determined that each director appointed to the Audit Committee is financially literate, and the Board of Directors has determined that Kevin Sheehan is our Audit Committee financial expert.

 

141


Table of Contents

Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee

The Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee:

 

    reviews the performance of our Board of Directors and makes recommendations to the Board of Directors regarding the selection of candidates, qualification and competency requirements for service on the Board of Directors and the suitability of proposed nominees as directors;

 

    advises the Board of Directors with respect to the corporate governance principles applicable to us;

 

    oversees the evaluation of the Board of Directors and management;

 

    reviews and approves in advance any related party transaction, other than those that are pre-approved pursuant to pre-approval guidelines or rules established by the committee; and

 

    recommends guidelines or rules to cover specific categories of transactions.

The members of the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee are Laurence Tarica (chair), Kevin Sheehan and Theodore P. Janulis. Each member of our Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee is independent, as defined under the rules of the NYSE.

Compensation Committee

The Compensation Committee:

 

    reviews and recommends to the Board of Directors the salaries, benefits and equity incentive grants for all employees, consultants, officers, directors and other individuals we compensate; and

 

    oversees our compensation and employee benefit plans.

The members of the Compensation Committee are Theodore P. Janulis (chair), Laurence Tarica and Kevin Sheehan. Each member of our Compensation Committee is independent, as defined under the rules of the NYSE. The “independent” directors that are appointed to the Compensation Committee are also “non-employee” directors as defined in Rule 16b-3(b)(3) under the Exchange Act and “outside” directors within the meaning of Section 162(m)(4)(c)(i) of the Internal Revenue Code.

Nonqualified Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan

We have adopted a Nonqualified Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan (the “Incentive Plan”). The Incentive Plan is intended to facilitate the use of long-term equity-based awards and incentives for the benefit of non-officer directors, officers, directors, employees, advisors, service providers, consultants and other personnel of New Media and our Manager.

A summary of the Incentive Plan is set forth below. This summary does not purport to be complete and is subject to and qualified in its entirety by the full text of the Incentive Plan, which is filed as Exhibit 10.34 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Summary of the Incentive Plan Terms

The Incentive Plan is administered by our Board of Directors and by the Compensation Committee (the “Committee”). As the administrator of the Incentive Plan, the Committee has the authority to grant awards under the Incentive Plan and to adopt, alter and repeal such administrative rules, guidelines and practices governing the Incentive Plan as it deems advisable for the administration of the Incentive Plan. The Committee also has the authority to interpret the terms and provisions of the Incentive Plan, any award issued under the Incentive Plan and any award agreements relating thereto, and to otherwise supervise the administration of the Incentive Plan. In particular, the Committee has the authority to determine the terms and conditions of awards under the Incentive

 

142


Table of Contents

Plan, including, without limitation, the exercise price, the number of shares of our Common Stock subject to awards, the term of the awards and the vesting schedule applicable to awards and to waive or amend the terms and conditions of outstanding awards. All decisions made by the Committee pursuant to the provisions of the Incentive Plan are final, conclusive and binding on all persons.

The terms of the Incentive Plan provide for the grant of stock options that are not intended to qualify as “incentive stock options” under Section 422 of the Code, stock appreciation rights (“SARs”), restricted stock, performance awards, tandem awards and other stock-based and non-stock based awards, in each case to our Manager, to the employees, officers, directors, consultants, service providers and advisors of our Manager who perform services for us, to our employees, officers, consultants, service providers and advisors, and to such other persons who the Committee selects to be participants in the Incentive Plan. Such awards may be granted singly, in tandem, or in combination with each of the other awards.

We have initially reserved 15,000,000 shares of our Common Stock for issuance under the Incentive Plan on the first day of each fiscal year beginning during the ten-year term of the Incentive Plan and in and after calendar year 2015, that number will be increased by a number of shares of our Common Stock equal to 10% of the number of shares of our Common Stock newly issued by us during the immediately preceding fiscal year (and in the case of fiscal year 2014, after the effective date of the Incentive Plan). The shares of our Common Stock which may be issued pursuant to an award under the Incentive Plan may be treasury stock, authorized but unissued stock or stock acquired on the open market to satisfy the requirements of the Incentive Plan. Awards may consist of any combination of such stock, or, at our election cash. The aggregate number of shares of our Common Stock that may be granted during any calendar year to any participant who is a “covered employee” for purposes of Section 162(m) of the Code during such calendar year may not be greater than the number of shares initially reserved for issuance under the Incentive Plan. If any shares of our Common Stock subject to an award are forfeited, cancelled, exchanged or surrendered or if an award otherwise terminates or expires without a distribution of shares to the participant, such shares will again be available for grants under the Incentive Plan. We reserve the right under the Incentive Plan to cancel any stock option with an exercise price that equals or exceeds the fair market value of a share of our Common Stock on the date of such cancellation, and any shares of Common Stock that were subject to such cancelled stock option will again be available for issuance of stock options under the Incentive Plan, including issuance to the participant who holds such cancelled stock option and irrespective of whether such issuance would be deemed a repricing of such stock option. We reserve the right under the Incentive Plan to cancel any stock option with an exercise price that equals or exceeds the fair market value of a share of our Common Stock on the date of such cancellation, and any shares of Common Stock that were subject to such cancelled stock option will again be available for issuance of stock options under the Incentive Plan, including issuable to the participant who held such cancelled stock option and irrespective of whether such issuance would be deemed a repricing of such stock option. The grant of a Tandem Award (as described below) will not reduce the number of shares of our Common Stock reserved and available for issuance under the Incentive Plan.

Upon the occurrence of any event which affects the shares of our Common Stock in such a way that an adjustment of outstanding awards is appropriate to prevent the dilution or enlargement of rights under the awards, the Committee will make appropriate equitable adjustments. The Committee may also provide for other substitutions or adjustments in its sole discretion, including, without limitation, the cancellation of any outstanding award and payment in cash or other property in exchange thereof, equal to the excess, if any, of the fair market value of the shares or other property subject to the award over the exercise price, if any.

We anticipate that we will grant our Manager or an affiliate of our Manager options in connection with our equity offerings as compensation for our Manager’s role in raising capital for us. In the event that we offer shares of our Common Stock to the public, we intend to simultaneously grant to our Manager or an affiliate of our Manager a number of options equal to up to 10% of the aggregate number of shares being issued in such offering at an exercise price per share equal to the offering price per share, as determined by the Committee. The main purpose of these options is to provide transaction-specific compensation to the Manager, in a form that aligns our

 

143


Table of Contents

Manager’s interests with those of our stockholders, for the valuable services it provides in raising capital for us to invest through equity offerings. We are granting an affiliate of our Manager options in connection with this offering. In each case, the Incentive Plan provides that such options will be fully vested as of the date of grant and exercisable as to 1/30 of the shares subject to the option on the first day of each of the 30 calendar months following the date of the grant. The exercise price of such options may be paid in cash or its equivalent, as determined by the Committee. Payment in whole or in part may also be made by the following cashless exercise procedures: (i) by withholding from shares of our Common Stock otherwise issuable upon exercise of such option, (ii) in the form of our unrestricted Common Stock already owned by our Manager which has a fair market value on the date of surrender equal to the aggregate option price of our Common Stock as to which such option shall be exercised or (iii) by means of any other cashless exercise procedure approved by the Committee.

Upon our Manager’s reasonable request, we will either (i) use commercially reasonable efforts to register under the Securities Act the securities that may be issued and sold under the Incentive Plan or the resale of such securities issued and sold pursuant to the Incentive Plan or (ii) enter into a registration rights agreement with our Manager on terms to be mutually agreed upon between us and our Manager.

In addition, the Committee will have the authority to grant such other awards to our Manager as it deems advisable, provided that no such award may be granted to our Manager in connection with any issuance by us of equity securities in excess of 10% of the maximum number of equity securities then being issued. Our Board of Directors may also determine to issue options to the Manager that are not subject to the Incentive Plan, provided that the number of shares underlying any options granted to the Manager in connection with capital raising efforts would not exceed 10% of the shares sold in such offering and would be subject to NYSE rules.

In addition, each of the Committee and our Manager will have the authority under the terms of the Incentive Plan to direct awards of tandem options (“Tandem Awards”) to employees of our Manager who act as officers or perform other services for us that correspond on a one-to-one basis with the options granted to our Manager, such that exercise by such employee of the Tandem Awards would result in the corresponding options held by our Manager being cancelled. As a condition to the grant of Tandem Awards, our Manager will be required to agree that so long as such Tandem Awards remain outstanding, our Manager will not exercise any options under any designated Manager options that relate to the options outstanding under such Tandem Awards. If any Tandem Awards are forfeited, expire or are cancelled without being exercised, the related options under the designated Manager options will again become exercisable in accordance with their terms. The terms and conditions of any Tandem Awards (e.g., the per-share exercise price, the schedule of vesting, exercisability and delivery, etc.) will be determined by the Committee or the Manager, as the case may be, in its sole discretion and must be included in an award agreement, provided, that the term of such Tandem Awards may not be greater than the term of the designated Manager options to which they relate. As determined by our Manager, in its sole discretion, payment of the exercise price of such Tandem Awards in whole or in part may be made by the following cashless exercise procedures: (i) by withholding from shares of our Common Stock otherwise issuable upon exercise of such Tandem Award, (ii) in the form of our unrestricted Common Stock already owned by the holder of such Tandem Award which has a fair market value on the date of surrender equal to the aggregate option price of our Common Stock as to which such Tandem Award shall be exercised or (iii) by means of any other cashless exercise procedure approved by the Committee. All options granted to our Manager will become fully vested and exercisable upon a “change of control” (as defined in the Incentive Plan) or a termination of the Manager’s services to us for any reason, and any Tandem Awards will be governed by the terms and condition set forth in the applicable award agreements, as determined by the Committee or the Manager, as the case may be.

As a general matter, the Incentive Plan provides that the Committee has the power to determine the number of shares of our Common Stock covered by options, the exercise price of options, at what time or times each option may be exercised and, subject to the provisions of the Incentive Plan, the period of time, if any, after death, disability or other termination of employment during which options may be exercised. Options may become vested and exercisable in installments, and the exercisability of options may be accelerated by the Committee. To the extent permitted by applicable law, we may make loans available to the optionee in connection with the exercise of stock options. Such loans must be evidenced by the delivery of a promissory note

 

144


Table of Contents

and will bear interest and be subject to such other terms and conditions (including, without limitation, the execution by the optionee of a pledge agreement) as the Committee may determine. In any event, such loan amount may not exceed the sum of (x) the exercise price less the par value of the shares of our Common Stock subject to such option then being exercised plus (y) any federal, state or local income taxes attributable to such exercise.

The Committee may also grant SARs in tandem with all or part of, or completely independent of, a grant of options or any other award under the Plan. A SAR issued in tandem with an option may be granted at the time of grant of the related option or at any time during the term of such option. The amount payable in cash and/or shares of our Common Stock with respect to each SAR will be equal in value to a percentage (including up to 100%) of the amount by which the fair market value per share of our Common Stock on the exercise date exceeds the fair market value per share of our Common Stock on the date of grant of the SAR. The applicable percentage will be established by the Committee. The award agreement under which the SAR is granted may state whether the amount payable is to be paid wholly in cash, wholly in shares of our Common Stock or in any combination of the foregoing, and if the award agreement does not state the manner of payment, the Committee will determine such manner of payment at the time of payment. The amount payable in shares of our Common Stock, if any, is determined with reference to the fair market value per share of our Common Stock on the date of exercise.

SARs issued in tandem with options shall be exercisable only to the extent that the options to which they relate are exercisable. Upon exercise of the tandem SAR, and to the extent of such exercise, the participant’s underlying option shall automatically terminate. Similarly, upon the exercise of the tandem option, and to the extent of such exercise, the participant’s related SAR will automatically terminate.

The Committee may also grant restricted stock, RSUs, performance awards, tandem awards and other stock and non-stock-based awards under the Incentive Plan. These awards will be subject to such conditions and restrictions as the Committee may determine, which may include, without limitation, the achievement of certain performance goals or continued service with us through a specific period.

The Incentive Plan provides for automatic annual awards of shares of our Common Stock to our non-officer or non-employee directors, in any case in an amount to be determined by the Committee from time to time, based on the fair market value of shares of our Common Stock on the date of grant. Such automatic annual awards, which will be fully vested on the date of grant, will begin on the first business day after our first annual stockholders’ meeting following December 31, 2014, and will continue to be made on the first business day after each such annual meeting thereafter during the term of the Incentive Plan. In addition, each new non-officer or non-employee member of our Board of Directors were granted an initial one-time grant of shares of restricted stock under the Incentive Plan. Such initial restricted stock grant has a fair market value equal to $75,000 on the date of grant and will vest ratably on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant subject to the holders continued service as a director through the specified vesting date.

While we intend to grant additional awards under the Incentive Plan to eligible participants, we have not yet established specific parameters regarding the granting of such future awards under the Incentive Plan. As such, the benefits or amounts that will be received by or allocated to any participants under the Incentive Plan following completion of this offering are not currently determinable.

Officers of GateHouse, our Predecessor

All references to “we,” “our,” “us” and the “Company” refer to GateHouse, our Predecessor.

The following individuals served as the officers of our Predecessor, GateHouse:

Michael E. Reed. For Mr. Reed’s biography, see “—Officers of New Media.”

 

145


Table of Contents

Melinda A. Janik, age 56, became our Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer in February 2009. She formerly served as an officer and Vice President and Controller of Paychex, Inc., a provider of payroll, human resource services, from 2005 to 2009. Prior to joining Paychex, Inc., Ms. Janik served as Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer for Glimcher Realty Trust, a mall Real Estate Investment Trust based in Columbus, Ohio, from 2002 to 2004. Ms. Janik was formerly Vice President and Treasurer of NCR Corporation, a global provider of financial and retail self service solutions and data warehousing based in Atlanta, Georgia, from 1997 to 2002. Prior to that, she worked for the accounting firm Pricewaterhouse LLP. Ms. Janik is a Certified Public Accountant and holds an MBA in finance and accounting and a bachelor’s degree in chemistry from the State University of New York at Buffalo.

Kirk Davis. For Mr. Davis’ biography, see “—Officers of New Media”.

Polly G. Sack, age 53, became our Vice President, Secretary and General Counsel in May 2006. Ms. Sack was named a Senior Vice President of ours in February 2009. She was formerly Senior Vice President and Director of Mergers and Acquisitions of IMG Worldwide, Inc. (“IMG”), a global sports, media and entertainment company, and had served in that capacity since 2001. Ms. Sack also served as IMG’s associate counsel and a vice president from 1992 to 2001. Prior to that, she worked in private practice for a major international law firm. Ms. Sack holds bachelor degrees in civil engineering and mathematics from the Massachusetts Institute of Technology and a master’s degree in civil engineering from Stanford University, in addition to a law degree from Stanford University Law School.

Mark Maring, age 47, became our Vice President of Investor Relations and Strategic Development in March 2008 and became our Treasurer in January 2009. Mr. Maring also served as our Interim Chief Financial Officer from August 2008 to February 2009. He was formerly a Vice President of Mendon Capital Advisors Corp, a registered investment advisor, from 2004 through 2008 where his responsibilities included risk management and hedging strategies. From 2000 to 2004 Mr. Maring was Vice President Investor Relations for Constellation Brands, Inc. (“Constellation”) an international producer and marketer of beverage alcohol brands. Mr. Maring also served as Constellation’s Director of Planning from 1997 to 2000. From 1992 to 1997, Mr. Maring worked with the accounting firm Arthur Andersen LLP. From 1987 to 1992 he worked for The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A. in investment banking. Mr. Maring is a certified public accountant and holds a master’s degree in finance and accounting, from the Simon School of Business at the University of Rochester and a B.S. from St. John Fisher College.

Directors of GateHouse, our Predecessor

 

Name, Position, Age

  

Description

Wesley R. Edens

Chairman of the Board

Age: 52

   For Mr. Edens’ biography, see “—Directors of New Media.”

Michael E. Reed

Director

Age: 47

   For Mr. Reed’s biography, see “—Officers of New Media.”

Kevin Sheehan

Director

Age: 59

   For Mr. Sheehan’s biography, see “—Directors of New Media.”

 

146


Table of Contents

COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS

Compensation of Directors of New Media

We pay an annual fee to each independent director equal to $150,000, payable semi-annually. In addition, an annual fee of $10,000 is paid to the chairs of each of the Audit, Nominating and Corporate Governance and Compensation committees of the board of directors. Fees to independent directors may be made by issuance of common stock, based on the value of such common stock at the date of issuance, rather than in cash, provided that any such issuance does not prevent such director from being determined to be independent and such shares are granted pursuant to a stockholder-approved plan or the issuance is otherwise exempt from NYSE listing requirements. Each independent director also (i) received an initial one time grant of shares of restricted stock under the Incentive Plan, the market value of which was equal to $75,000 on the date of the grant and which will vest ratably on each of the first three anniversaries of the date of grant, subject to the holder’s continued service as a director through the specified vesting date and (ii) beginning on the first business day after our first annual stockholders’ meeting following December 31, 2014, and on the first business day after each such annual meeting thereafter during the term of the Incentive Plan, will receive, automatic annual awards of shares of our Common Stock in respect of a portion of the annual fee in an amount to be determined by the Compensation Committee from time to time, based on the fair market value of shares of our common stock on the date of grant. For additional information on director equity compensation, see “Management—Nonqualified Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan.” Affiliated directors, however, are not separately compensated by us. All members of the board of directors are reimbursed for reasonable costs and expenses incurred in attending meetings of our board of directors.

Compensation of Directors of GateHouse, our Predecessor

All references to “we,” “our,” “us” and the “Company” refer to GateHouse, our Predecessor.

Our outside directors received an annual cash retainer of $50,000, which was payable in two semi-annual installments. We paid our Audit Committee chairperson a $10,000 annual cash retainer, which was payable in two semi-annual installments.

On February 19, 2013, the Board approved (without the participation of Mr. Sheehan) that Mr. Sheehan will receive (a) an annual cash retainer of $50,000; and (b) a per meeting fee of $1,000, as remuneration for his service as the sole member of the special committee formed by the board of directors of GateHouse on February 19, 2013 (the “Special Committee”) in connection with the Plan. The Special Committee was given the exclusive, full and plenary power and authority of GateHouse’s board of directors, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, to review, evaluate and approve or reject any potential proposal of Newcastle Investment Corp. in its capacity as Plan Sponsor and to review and evaluate strategic alternatives and all other matters pertaining thereto. These amounts are in addition to other amounts paid to Mr. Sheehan for service on the Board and for service as the Audit Committee chairperson.

 

147


Table of Contents

2013 Director Compensation Table

In keeping with our disclosure of business, financial and other information of GateHouse, our Predecessor, elsewhere in this Prospectus, we have included information in this Prospectus regarding the compensation earned by GateHouse’s, our Predecessor, outside directors during 2013 in the following table.

 

Name

   Fees Earned
or Paid in
Cash
($)(1)(2)
     Total ($)  

Wesley R. Edens(3)

     0         0   

Kevin M. Sheehan

     60,000         60,000   

 

(1) Amounts in this column reflect the annual cash retainer of $50,000 earned for 2013, and does not include the renumeration for Mr. Sheehan’s service on the Special Committee.
(2) Mr. Sheehan’s annual cash retainer includes an additional $10,000 retainer he earned as Chair of the Audit Committee.
(3) Mr. Edens is not an independent director (he is affiliated with our largest stockholder—Fortress) and he receives no compensation for his services as a director.

 

148


Table of Contents

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

Executive Compensation of New Media

In fiscal year 2013, our Chief Executive Officer, Michael E. Reed did not receive any compensation in respect of his service as our executive officer. Effective as of January 14, 2014, Mr. Reed resigned as our interim Chief Financial Officer and interim Chief Accounting Officer and Gregory Freiberg was appointed as our Chief Financial Officer and Chief Accounting Officer. In addition, effective as of January 14, 2014, Kirk A. Davis was appointed as our Chief Operating Officer. Following the date of the Listing, Mr. Reed’s compensation for service as our Chief Executive Officer and Mr. Freiberg’s compensation for service as our Chief Financial Officer and Chief Accounting Officer will be paid by the Manager pursuant to the terms of our Management Agreement. Our Management Agreement generally provides that our Manager is responsible for managing our affairs. Mr. Reed and Mr. Freiberg, in their capacities as employees of our Manager, will devote such portion of their time to our affairs as is necessary to enable us to operate our business. Mr. Reed and Mr. Freiberg will not receive any compensation from us for serving as our officers.

Executive Compensation of GateHouse, our Predecessor

All references to “we,” “our,” “us” and the “Company” refer to GateHouse, our Predecessor.

In keeping with our disclosure of business, financial and other information of GateHouse, our Predecessor, elsewhere in this Prospectus, we have included information in this Prospectus regarding the compensation of GateHouse’s Named Executive Officers for 2013 and prior years below.

Compensation Discussion and Analysis

The GateHouse board of directors is responsible for establishing, implementing and monitoring our executive compensation philosophy and objectives. The GateHouse board of directors’ focus is to establish compensation at levels necessary to attract, retain and motivate the best possible executive talent. Historically, our board of directors has developed our executive compensation programs based on input from our Chief Executive Officer, the officers’ current compensation, our financial condition, our operating results and individual performance.

The following Compensation Discussion and Analysis describes the material elements of compensation for our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and the three other executive officers identified in the Summary Compensation Table included below (“Named Executive Officers”), as well as the role and involvement of various parties in executive compensation analysis and decisions, and provides a discussion of the process and rationale for our board of directors’ decisions to compensate our Named Executive Officers with specific types and amounts of compensation. We have not established an extensive or complicated executive compensation program. Instead, we believe that we have a fairly simple executive compensation program that is intended to provide appropriate compensation for our Named Executive Officers, as determined by the GateHouse board of directors. As this Compensation Discussion and Analysis explains in greater detail, our executive compensation program currently has three key elements: (a) base salary; (b) an annual incentive in the form of an annual bonus; and (c) periodic long-term equity incentives, such as restricted share grants.

Executive Summary of Compensation Actions

Based on the global economic conditions, the performance of GateHouse stock and other factors, the key decisions made by our board of directors with respect to the executive compensation program in early 2013 and 2012:

 

    2013 and 2012 base salaries for the Named Executive Officers (other than Mr. Davis) were frozen at 2008 levels;

 

    No awards of equity compensation were granted in 2013 and 2012; and

 

149


Table of Contents
    On December 26, 2012, the GateHouse board of directors elected to pay discretionary annual bonuses to our Named Executive Officers for certain performance factors achieved in 2012 and as an incentive to remain in our employment. The 2013 discretionary annual bonuses were declared and paid to our Named Executive Officers in 2014.

Our board of directors believes that our executive compensation program has been tailored to promote the creation of value for our stockholders because we structure the executive compensation program to: (a) focus the executives’ performance on building long-term value through the achievement of short-term and long-term objectives; and (b) permit us to recruit, retain and motivate highly qualified executives by offering competitive compensation and rewarding superior performance.

At our 2013 Annual Meeting, we held our first stockholder advisory vote on our executive compensation program (the “Vote”) and our stockholders approved our fiscal year 2012 executive compensation program. Our board of directors has considered the results of the Vote and concluded that the executive compensation program continues to promote the creation of value for our stockholders, and therefore made no significant changes to the executive compensation program during the year.

Objectives of Our Compensation Program

The primary objective of our executive compensation program is to attract and retain executives with the requisite skills and experience to help us achieve our business mission and develop, expand and execute business opportunities to improve long-term stockholder value. The impact of the continuing global recession on the print and online advertising industries continues to create a challenging operating environment and to drive significant and rapid change. However, this economic environment has not changed the primary objectives of our executive compensation program of attracting and retaining talented executives. In fact, the weaknesses in the economy generally, and the financial markets specifically, has intensified the demand for exceptional leadership. We believe that a capable, experienced and highly motivated executive management team is critical to our success and to the creation of long-term stockholder value. In assessing the ability of our executive compensation program to meet these objectives, the board of directors evaluates both company and individual performance as well as market compensation. Through this evaluation, the board of directors works to help ensure that we maintain our ability to attract and retain superior employees in key positions and that compensation provided to key employees remains competitive relative to the compensation paid to similarly situated executives of peer companies.

Key Elements of Our Executive Compensation Program

We seek to achieve the objectives for our executive compensation program through three key compensation elements:

 

    a base salary;

 

    an annual incentive in the form of an annual bonus paid at GateHouse’s board of directors’ discretion, based on its evaluation of short-term company and individual performance; and

 

    periodic long-term equity incentives, such as restricted share grants, to align the interests of our Named Executive Officers with those of our stockholders.

Compensation Setting Process

Role of the GateHouse Board of Directors and Executive Officers

The GateHouse board of directors is primarily responsible for overseeing compensation of our executive officers, including Named Executive Officers. Since December 19, 2008, the board of directors, with the exception of our Chief Executive Officer, has assumed the functions previously carried out by the Compensation Committee. The board of directors, with the exception of our Chief Executive Officer, annually approves the compensation for our Named Executive Officers.

 

150


Table of Contents

Independent Compensation Consultants

On June 8, 2012, the Company retained, on an ad hoc basis, Towers Watson & Co (“Towers Watson”), an independent compensation consultant with particular expertise in compensation matters for the media, publishing and newspaper industries, to provide ad hoc compensation consulting services with respect to: (a) managing senior executives via potential change-in-control for both incentive opportunities and stability; and (b) developing a retention plan for key executives (collectively, the “Services”).

As authorized by the GateHouse board of directors, Towers Watson reported directly to the Ad Hoc Committee (the “Committee”), which had the authority to engage Towers Watson and to approve fee arrangements for work performed. Towers Watson was authorized to interact with: (a) the Company’s management, as needed, in connection with the Services; and (b) the Committee’s outside legal counsel, when applicable, on matters being brought to the Committee for consideration.

It is the Committee’s policy that the Chair of the Committee or the full Committee pre-approve any additional services provided by Towers Watson to the Company. In fiscal year 2012, Towers Watson only performed the Services for the Committee. Towers Watson did not perform any services for the Committee in fiscal year 2013. The Committee has assessed the independence of Towers Watson pursuant to SEC Rules and Regulations and concluded that Towers Watson’s work for the Company does not raise any conflict of interest.

Benchmarking Data

The GateHouse board of directors believes that each element of the compensation program should establish compensation levels taking into account current market practices. As such, the members of our board of directors may familiarize themselves with compensation trends and competitive conditions through the review of non-customized market surveys, data and other information about relevant market compensation practices. However, market compensation levels and practices are only one of the factors used by the board of directors in making executive compensation decisions. The GateHouse board of directors does not target a specific percentile within this market data and instead uses the comparative data solely as a validation after having determined the types and amount of compensation based on its own evaluation. Other factors considered in the board of directors’ evaluation may include the individual Named Executive Officer’s level of responsibility, the individual Named Executive Officer’s performance, historical company practices, long-term market trends, internal pay equity and expectations regarding the individual’s future contributions, our own performance, budget considerations and succession planning and retention strategies.

Executive Compensation Program

Our practices with respect to each of the three key compensation elements identified above, as well as other elements of compensation, are set forth below.

Base Salary

Each Named Executive Officer is paid a base salary providing him or her with a guaranteed income stream which does not vary with our performance. Each Named Executive Officer’s base salary is based on his or her job responsibilities, leadership and experience and value to, and length of service with, our Company. The salaries of our Named Executive Officers named in the Summary Compensation Table are determined by the board of directors. Such salaries may be reflected either in an employment agreement (described below in the section entitled “Employment Agreements”) or an offer letter. Decisions regarding adjustments to base salaries are made at the discretion of the GateHouse board of directors, and are influenced by, among other factors determined by the board of directors in its sole discretion, each Named Executive Officer’s current base salary and the base salaries paid to other executives performing substantially similar functions at similar companies with a market capitalization similar to ours.

 

151


Table of Contents

For both 2013 and 2012, in light of the current economic environment and considering other factors, the board of directors elected to freeze the base salaries of our Named Executive Officers (other than Mr. Davis, whose base salary was increased by approximately 3.8% in 2013) at their 2008 levels.

Annual Bonus Incentives for Named Executive Officers

Each of our Named Executive Officers is entitled to a discretionary annual bonus. The annual bonus incentives are used to ensure that a portion of our Named Executive Officer’s compensation is at risk, and that each Named Executive Officer has the opportunity to receive a variable amount of compensation based on the board of directors’ evaluation of our and the individual’s performance. The bonus is payable in our common stock or cash or a combination thereof, as determined by the GateHouse board of directors, in its sole discretion. Any bonus that is payable in common stock (a “Restricted Stock Bonus”) vests over a specified period.

While the amount, if any, of an annual bonus is determined by our board of directors in its sole discretion, the board of directors looks at many factors in its decision-making process relating to the amount, if any, of the annual bonus for our Named Executive Officers. The factors generally involve the following:

 

    Reviewing Company performance. Throughout the year, the GateHouse board of directors reviews all aspects of financial and operational performance of the Company, and also assesses Company performance in relation to the Company’s business direction, as determined by the board of directors, taking into account changing economic and market environments.

 

    Individual performance. The GateHouse board of directors also evaluates individual performance beyond purely financial measures, including, generally, one or any combination of the following: (i) exceptional performance of each individual’s functional responsibilities; (ii) leadership; (iii) creativity; (iv) innovation; (v) collaboration; (vi) development and implementation of growth initiatives; and (vii) other activities that are critical to driving long-term value for stockholders.

 

    Setting a target bonus. Our board of directors establishes a target bonus amount for certain Named Executive Officers. The target bonus takes into account all of the Company and individual factors that the board of directors deems relevant, however, no one factor by itself is determinative of the target bonus amount. For each of 2013 and 2012, Mr. Reed’s target bonus was $200,000, Ms. Janik’s target bonus was $137,500 and Mr. Maring’s target bonus was $140,000. Neither Mr. Davis nor Ms. Sack had a target bonus amount for 2013 or 2012.

 

    Measuring performance. After the end of the fiscal year, our board of directors reviews Company and individual performance of each of our Named Executive Officers. The board of directors does not apply a rigid set of rules for determining the relative importance of the factors discussed above. Our board of directors may emphasize or weight particular factors differently for each Named Executive Officer and differently for each fiscal year.

The GateHouse board of directors considered the above general factors, as well the specific accomplishments listed below, in awarding discretionary cash bonuses to our Named Executive Officers as follows:

Michael E. Reed: As our Chief Executive Officer, in 2012 Mr. Reed provided the leadership and direction necessary for our transformation to a truly multi-media enterprise. Mr. Reed played a critical role in conceptualizing and implementing our digital business initiatives while maintaining our supportive efforts for our traditional print business. On December 26, 2012, in light of these achievements and the above referenced general factors, our board of directors awarded Mr. Reed a discretionary bonus of $800,000 for 2012. On January 29, 2014, in light of the above referenced general factors and Mr. Reed’s strong leadership role in exploring strategic alternatives regarding the restructuring of our balance sheet and negotiating, achieving and implementing the Restructuring and our GateHouse Credit Facilities and effecting the Distribution, our board of directors awarded Mr. Reed a discretionary bonus of $200,000 for 2013.

 

152


Table of Contents

Melinda A. Janik: As our Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, in 2012 Ms. Janik played a critical role in designing operational metrics and reporting for our new digital ventures and new organizational structure. Ms. Janik also helped design and implement new compensation plans which were more closely aligned with our new goals and initiatives as part of our transformation to a multi-media enterprise. On December 26, 2012, in light of these achievements and the above referenced general factors, our board of directors awarded Ms. Janik a discretionary bonus of $125,000 for 2012. On February 20, 2014, in light of the above referenced factors and Ms. Janik’s oversight of and involvement with accounting matters related to the Restructuring, the acquisition and management of Local Media, and compliance with the terms of our GateHouse Credit Facilities as well as the Local Media Credit Facility, our board of directors awarded Ms. Janik a discretionary bonus of $70,000 for 2013.

Kirk A. Davis: As our President and Chief Operating Officer, in 2012 Mr. Davis played a crucial leadership role in implementing our new digital initiatives to grow our company and in executing the operational reorganization of GateHouse. On December 26, 2012, in light of these achievements and the above referenced general factors, our board of directors awarded Mr. Davis a discretionary bonus of $350,000 for 2012. On January 29, 2014, in light of the above referenced general factors and Mr. Davis’ strong leadership role in scaling our digital initiatives and overseeing the integration and operation of Local Media, our board of directors awarded Mr. Davis a discretionary bonus of $125,000 for 2013.

Polly Grunfeld Sack: As our Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, in 2012 Ms. Sack provided the legal advice, oversight and infrastructure necessary to formulate and implement our digital business and other new business initiatives, as well as providing the legal framework for our cost reduction initiatives. Ms. Sack also led our efforts to restructure and enhance our human resources function. On December 26, 2012, in light of these achievements and the above referenced general factors, our board of directors awarded Ms. Sack a discretionary bonus of $140,000 for 2012. On February 20, 2014, in light of the above referenced general factors and Ms. Sack’s legal leadership role in the implementation of the Restructuring and the negotiation and oversight of our GateHouse Credit Facilities and the Local Media Credit Facility, our board of directors awarded Ms. Sack a discretionary bonus of $70,000 for 2013.

Mark Maring: As our Vice President, Investor Relations and Strategic Development and Treasurer, in 2012 Mr. Maring played a crucial role in implementing our cost cutting measures and liaising with our lenders during the period that preceded the Restructuring. On December 26, 2012, in light of these achievements and the above referenced general factors, our board of directors awarded Mr. Maring a discretionary bonus of $80,000 for 2012. On February 20, 2014, in light of the above referenced general factors and Mr. Maring’s expanded role and his oversight of the financial modeling and analytics throughout the restructuring, our board of directors awarded Mr. Maring a discretionary bonus of $40,000 for 2013.

Periodic Long-Term Equity Incentive Compensation

The periodic long-term equity incentive program provides a periodic award (typically annual) of equity compensation under the GateHouse Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan (the “Equity Plan”). The objective of the program is to directly align compensation for our Named Executive Officers over a multi-year period with the interests of our stockholders by motivating and rewarding creation and preservation of long-term stockholder value. The level of long-term incentive compensation is determined based on an evaluation of competitive factors in conjunction with total compensation provided to our Named Executive Officers and the goals of the compensation program described above.

During 2013 and 2012, following our board of directors’ evaluation of our performance, and after consideration of any other appropriate factors determined by the board of directors in its sole discretion, the board of directors determined not to grant our Named Executive Officers any awards of long-term equity compensation. In making this decision, the GateHouse board of directors considered that Mr. Reed and Ms. Sack each previously entered into a management stockholder agreement (the “Management Stockholder Agreements”)

 

153


Table of Contents

pursuant to which they were awarded restricted share grants. Under the Management Stockholder Agreements, the restricted share grants are subject to a five-year vesting schedule, with one-third of the shares vesting on each of the third, fourth and fifth anniversaries from the grant date. In addition, Mr. Reed also purchased additional restricted shares of our common stock which are also subject to the Management Stockholder Agreements.

Following the adoption of the Equity Plan in October 2006, additional restricted share grants were awarded to certain of our Named Executive Officers under the Equity Plan in each of 2006, 2007 and 2008. The majority of the restricted share grants granted under the Equity Plan vest in one-third increments on each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the grant date. During 2013 and 2012, following our board of directors’ evaluation of our performance, and after consideration of any other appropriate factors determined by the GateHouse board of directors in its sole discretion, our board of directors determined not to grant our Named Executive Officers any awards of restricted share grants.

During the applicable vesting period, our Named Executive Officers holding restricted share grants have all the rights of a stockholder, including, without limitation, the right to vote and the right to receive all dividends or other distributions (at the same rate and on the same terms as all other stockholders). As of December 29, 2013 no equity awards to our Named Executive Officers were outstanding.

Benefits and Perquisites

The GateHouse board of directors supports providing benefits and perquisites to our Named Executive Officers that are substantially the same as those offered to our other executive officers, including vacation, sick time, participation in our medical, dental and insurance programs, all in accordance with the terms of such plans and programs in effect from time to time.

Policy With Respect to the $1 Million Deduction Limit

Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code generally disallows a tax deduction to public corporations for compensation greater than $1 million paid for any fiscal year to the corporation’s Chief Executive Officer and the three other most highly compensated executive officers as of the end of any fiscal year, other than the Chief Financial Officer. However, certain forms of performance-based compensation are excluded from the $1 million deduction limit if certain requirements are met. Our board of directors designs certain components of Named Executive Officer compensation, including awards granted under the Equity Plan, to permit, but not require, full deductibility. The GateHouse board of directors believes, however, that our stockholder interests are best served by not restricting its discretion and flexibility in crafting compensation programs, even though such programs may result in certain non-deductible compensation expenses. Accordingly, we have granted and may continue to grant awards such as time-based restricted share grants and/or enter into compensation arrangements under which payments are not deductible under Section 162(m) in the event that the GateHouse board of directors determines that such non-deductible arrangements are otherwise in the best interests of our stockholders.

Risk and Compensation Policies

In considering the risks to the Company and its business that may be implied by our compensation plans and programs, our board of directors considers the design, operation and mix of the plans and programs at all levels of the Company. Our compensation program is designed to mitigate the potential to reward excessive risk-taking that may produce short-term results that appear in isolation to be favorable, but that may undermine the successful execution of our long-term business strategy and erode shareholder value.

 

154


Table of Contents

2013 Summary Compensation Table

The table below summarizes the total compensation paid or earned by each of the Named Executive Officers for the fiscal years 2013, 2012 and 2011, ending December 29, 2013December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, respectively.

 

Name and Principal Position

   Year      Salary ($)      Bonus ($)     Change in
Pension Value
and
Nonqualified
Deferred
Compensation
Earnings ($)
    Total ($)(5)  

Michael E. Reed

     2013       $ 500,000       $ 200,000 (1)   $ 0     $ 700,000   

—Chief Executive Officer

     2012         500,000         800,000 (2)     0       1,300,000   
     2011         500,000         800,000 (3)     0       1,300,000   

Melinda A. Janik

     2013         275,000         70,000 (1)     0       345,000   

—Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

     2012         275,000         125,000 (2)     0       400,000   
     2011         275,000         125,000 (3)     0       400,000   

Kirk Davis

     2013         479,001         125,000 (1)     0 (4)     604,001   

—President and Chief Operating Officer

     2012         461,261         350,000 (2)     15,117 (4)     826,378   
     2011         461,261         350,000 (3)     8,527 (4)     819,788   

Polly Grunfeld Sack

     2013         260,000         70,000 (1)     0       330,000   

—Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary

     2012         260,000         140,000 (2)     0       400,000   
     2011         260,000         140,000 (3)     0       400,000   

Mark Maring

     2013         200,000         40,000 (1)     0       240,000   

—Vice President, Investor Relations and Strategic

     2012         200,000         80,000 (2)     0       280,000   

Development and Treasurer

     2011         200,000         80,000 (3)     0       280,000   

 

(1) This amount reflects the bonus amount that was earned in 2013 and paid in 2014.
(2) This amount reflects the bonus amount earned and paid in 2012.
(3) This amount reflects the bonus amount earned in 2011 and paid in 2012.
(4) The amount in this column represents the aggregate change in the actuarial present value of Mr. Davis’ accumulated benefit under the George W. Prescott Publishing Company Pension Plan, which was frozen effective December 31, 2008.

Employment Agreements

On March 6, 2012, our board of directors approved and we entered into an amendment to the existing employment agreement with each of our Named Executive Officers, other than Ms. Janik and Mr. Maring. These amendments provide for enhanced severance benefits upon the executive’s involuntary termination of employment without “cause” or voluntary termination of employment for “good reason,” in each case, within 18 months of the earlier to occur of the commencement of any discussion with any individual or entity that ultimately results in a “change in control” (as defined in the Equity Plan) or the occurrence of a change in control transaction. The amendments also added voluntary termination of employment for “good reason” as an event that would entitle the executive to non-enhanced severance that is unrelated to a change of control. The amendments also clarify our approach to compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and make conforming and clarifying changes to each of such executive’s restrictive covenants (such as non-competition, confidentiality and non-solicitation). No other changes were made to the existing employment agreements.

Cause” is defined as: (a) a conviction of, guilty plea concerning or confession of any felony; (b) any act of dishonesty in connection with our business; (c) any uncured material breach by the executive of his or her employment agreement; (d) any material breach of any reasonable and lawful rule or directive from us; (e) the

 

155


Table of Contents

gross or willful neglect of duties or gross misconduct by the executive; or (f) the habitual use of drugs or habitual, excessive use of alcohol to the extent that any of such uses materially interferes with the performance of the executive’s duties under his or her employment agreement.

Good reason” is defined as the occurrence of any one or more of the following at any time during the executive’s employment without the executive’s written consent: (a) the failure to maintain the executive in the same or better position with us which the executive held immediately prior to a change in control, or the removal of Executive as a member of the board of directors; (b) a significant adverse change in the nature or scope of the executive’s authorities, powers, functions, responsibilities or duties immediately prior to the change in control; (c) a reduction in the aggregate of the executive’s base salary or annual cash bonus; (d) a reduction in the executive’s long-term incentive compensation opportunity; (e) the termination or denial of the executive’s rights to retirement or welfare benefits or a reduction in the scope or value of such benefits (other than any a reduction that is generally applicable to all employees); (f) any change of the executive’s principal place of employment to a location more than 50 miles from the executive’s principal place of employment immediately prior to a change in control; (g) any uncured failure to pay the executive any compensation when due; (h) the delivery to the executive of a written notice of the intent to terminate the executive’s employment for any reason, other than cause or disability, regardless of when such termination is intended to become effective; or (i) any failure by us to comply with any provision of the executive’s employment agreement.

The enhanced severance benefit consists of: (a) a monthly payment for a specified period (27 months for Mr. Reed, 24 months for Mr. Davis and 21 months for Ms. Sack) equal to the executive’s monthly base salary and average monthly bonus (the average of the last three annual cash bonuses, or, if three annual cash bonuses have not been paid to the executive, the average of such bonuses that have been paid to the executive, in each case, divided by 12); (b) a pro-rated annual cash bonus for the year that the executive’s employment is terminated; (c) the accelerated vesting of any restricted stock awards that are unvested as of the date that the executive’s employment is terminated; (d) up to six months of outplacement services immediately following the executive’s termination of employment; and (e) up to 12 months of continued healthcare coverage.

The above description of the amendments is qualified in its entirety by the text of each respective amendment, which are filed as Exhibits 10.21, 10.22 and 10.24 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Also on March 6, 2012, our board of directors approved and we entered into an employment agreement with Ms. Janik, our Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer. This employment agreement generally embodies the terms of that certain offer letter, dated December 23, 2008, filed as Exhibit 10.10 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Under the employment agreement, Ms. Janik has the title of Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer and is entitled to continue to receive her current base salary at the annual rate of $275,000. Ms. Janik is eligible to receive each fiscal year a bonus (for each such fiscal year, a “Bonus”), based on the achievement, as determined by the GateHouse board of directors, of certain performance standards as agreed to by Ms. Janik and the GateHouse board of directors. Such Bonus is payable in such combination of cash and shares of common stock of the Company (“GateHouse Common Stock”) as determined by the board of directors, under the Equity Plan (or any similar or successor plan) (the stock portion of any such Bonus being a “Restricted Stock Grant”). The number of shares comprising any Restricted Stock Grant shall be determined by dividing the applicable portion of the Bonus being awarded in GateHouse Common Stock by the fair market value (as determined by our board of directors) of the GateHouse Common Stock on the date of grant. The cash portion of each Bonus shall be paid to Ms. Janik within a reasonable time after the end of the fiscal year, but in no event later than four months following completion of the fiscal year to which such Bonus relates (“Outside Payment Date”). The Restricted Stock Grant portion of each Bonus shall be made on such date as the board of directors determines in its discretion, though no later than the applicable Outside Payment Date. No Bonus in respect of any fiscal year will be due to Ms. Janik unless she is employed by us on the last day of the fiscal year in respect of which the Bonus is awarded. As described below, Ms. Janik’s employment agreement has the same type of severance provisions as those that are in Ms. Sack’s employment agreement.

 

156


Table of Contents

The above description of Ms. Janik’s employment agreement is qualified in its entirety by the text of such agreement, which is filed as Exhibit 10.23 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Michael E. Reed

In 2013, Mr. Reed was employed as our Chief Executive Officer pursuant to an employment agreement effective as of January 30, 2006, as amended on March 6, 2012. Under this agreement, he has the duties and responsibilities customarily exercised by the person serving as chief executive officer of a company of our size and nature.

Pursuant to his employment agreement, which has an initial three-year term that automatically renews subject to the same terms and conditions for additional one-year terms unless either we or Mr. Reed gives notice of non-renewal within ninety days prior to the end of the term, Mr. Reed receives an annual base salary of $500,000. Mr. Reed also is eligible for an annual, performance-based bonus. The agreement provides that Mr. Reed is eligible to receive an annual target bonus of $200,000 upon the achievement of certain performance goals agreed to by Mr. Reed and the GateHouse board of directors. The bonus is payable in either our common stock or cash in the discretion of our board of directors, provided that no more than 50% of the bonus shall be payable in our common stock without Mr. Reed’s approval.

Melinda A. Janik

On March 6, 2012, our board of directors approved and we entered into an employment agreement with Ms. Janik. This employment agreement is generally consistent with the prior offer letter between Ms. Janik and us. Under her employment agreement, Ms. Janik is entitled to receive a base salary of $275,000. Ms. Janik is also eligible to receive an annual bonus based on the achievement of certain performance requirements and satisfaction of a continuous employment requirement, as determined by the board of directors. Such annual bonus is payable in such combination of cash and shares of our common stock under the Equity Plan, as determined by the board of directors. Ms. Janik will be entitled to all of the usual benefits offered to employees at the executive level, including vacation, sick time, participation in our medical, dental and insurance programs, as well as the ability to participate in our 401(k) retirement savings plan. We will also reimburse Ms. Janik for any expenses reasonably and necessarily incurred by her in furtherance of her duties under the employment agreement.

Ms. Janik’s employment may be terminated (a) by us for “cause” (as such term is defined above); (b) by us at any time without “cause”; or (c) by Ms. Janik at any time. If Ms. Janik’s employment with us is terminated by us for “cause,” she shall not be entitled to any further compensation or benefits other than accrued but unpaid base salary and accrued and unused vacation pay through the date of such termination (collectively, the “Accrued Benefits”).

If Ms. Janik’s employment is terminated by us other than for “cause,” and not within 18 months of a “change in control” (as such term is defined above), then she shall be entitled to, upon providing us with a signed release of claims and subject to Ms. Janik’s continued compliance with restrictive covenants and confidentiality provisions of the employment agreement: (a) the Accrued Benefits, (b) an amount equal to 12 months base salary payable in the same manner as provided under the employment agreement, (c) any declared annual bonus not yet paid and (d) continuation of her coverage under our medical plan for 12 months from the date of such termination. If Ms. Janik’s employment is terminated by us without “cause” or Ms. Janik terminates her employment for “good reason” (as such term is defined above), in each case, within 18 months of the earlier to occur of the commencement of any discussion with any individual or entity that ultimately results in a change in control or the occurrence of a change in control transaction, Ms. Janik could become eligible to receive the same enhanced severance benefits described above in connection with the amendment to Ms. Sack’s employment agreement.

 

157


Table of Contents

Unless Ms. Janik breaches one of the restrictive covenants contained in the employment agreement, the payments described in the termination provisions in the employment agreement shall be paid over a period of 12 months commencing on the date of Ms. Janik’s termination of employment with us; provided that if such termination is by Ms. Janik for “good reason” or occurs within 18 months of a “change in control,” such payments shall be paid over a 21-month period.

Kirk Davis

In 2013, Mr. Davis was employed as our President and Chief Operating Officer pursuant to an employment agreement effective as of January 9, 2009, as amended on March 6, 2012. Under this agreement, he has the duties and responsibilities customarily exercised by the person serving as president and chief operating officer of a company of our size and nature.

Pursuant to his employment agreement, which has no guaranteed term of employment or renewal provision, Mr. Davis’ annual base salary shall be reviewed on an annual basis and adjusted in our sole discretion. Mr. Davis also is eligible for an annual bonus, based on the achievement, as determined by the GateHouse board of directors in its sole discretion, of certain performance standards agreed to by Mr. Davis and our board of directors. Such bonus may be paid in such combination of cash and shares of our common stock as determined by our board of directors, in its sole discretion under the Equity Plan (or any similar or successor plan).

Mr. Davis was appointed as our Chief Executive Officer on January 14, 2014 and continues to be employed in that role pursuant to his employment agreement described above.

Polly G. Sack

Ms. Sack is employed as our Senior Vice President, Secretary and General Counsel pursuant to an employment agreement effective as of May 17, 2006, as amended on March 6, 2012. Under this agreement, she has the duties and responsibilities customarily exercised by the person serving as chief legal officer of a company of our size and nature.

Pursuant to her employment agreement, which has no guaranteed term of employment or renewal provision, Ms. Sack’s annual base salary shall be reviewed on an annual basis and adjusted in our sole discretion. Ms. Sack also is eligible for an annual, performance-based bonus, without a target level, based upon the achievement of certain performance goals agreed to by Ms. Sack and our board of directors. Such bonus may be a Restricted Stock Bonus as determined by the GateHouse board of directors and without restriction as to the relative proportions of common stock or cash comprising such bonus. Ms. Sack’s employment agreement also provided for the reimbursement of her reasonable relocation expenses.

Mark Maring

Mr. Maring is currently employed as our Treasurer and Vice President of Investor Relations and Strategic Development. From August 19, 2008 to February 2, 2009, Mr. Maring also served as our Interim Chief Financial Officer. Pursuant to an offer letter effective as of February 6, 2008, Mr. Maring was initially employed as our Vice President of Investor Relations and Strategic Development, with the duties and responsibilities customarily exercised by the person serving as Vice President of Investor Relations and Strategic Development of a company of our size and nature.

Pursuant to his offer letter, which has no guaranteed term of employment or renewal provision, Mr. Maring’s initial annual base salary is at the rate of $200,000 per year. Mr. Maring also is eligible for an annual bonus based on achievement of annually agreed upon targets, of up to 70% of base pay. This bonus will be paid with a combination of cash and restricted stock and is subject to approval by the GateHouse board of directors.

 

158


Table of Contents

General

The employment agreements with the Named Executive Officers are referred to collectively as the “Employment Agreements.” Our Named Executive Officers have restrictive covenants in the Employment Agreements and/or their management stockholder agreements for our benefit relating to non-competition during the term of employment and for the one year period following termination of their employment for any reason. Each of the Employment Agreements also contains restrictive covenants relating to non-solicitation of our employees, directors, agents, clients, customers, vendors, suppliers or consultants during the term of employment and for the one year period following termination of their employment for any reason.

No Grants of Plan-Based Awards, No Equity Compensation Granted During 2013, No Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End and No Options Exercised or Stock Vested During 2013

We did not grant any plan-based awards or equity compensation to our Named Executive Officers during the fiscal year ending December 29, 2013. No equity awards were outstanding at the end of fiscal 2013. Our Named Executive Officers did not exercise any stock options nor were they vested in any stock awards during 2013.

Pension Benefits

The following table sets forth Mr. Davis’ retirement benefits under our retirement plans. No other Named Executive Officers participate in any pension plan.

 

Name

  Plan name     Number of years
credited service (#)
    Present value of
accumulated benefit
($)
    Payments during
last fiscal year ($)
 

Kirk Davis

    Prescott Pension Plan        4.8      $ 56,077      $ 0   

We maintain one defined benefit plan, the George W. Prescott Publishing Company Pension Plan (the “Prescott Pension Plan”). The Prescott Pension Plan benefits the employees of the George W. Prescott Publishing Company by providing funded, tax-qualified benefits up to the limits on compensation and benefits under the Internal Revenue Code. Benefits under the Prescott Pension Plan are funded by an irrevocable tax-exempt trust. An executive’s benefits under the Prescott Pension Plan are payable from the assets held by a tax-exempt trust, and are based on earnings up to a compensation limit under the Internal Revenue Code (which was $230,000 in 2008).

Effective December 31, 2008, the Prescott Pension Plan was amended to freeze benefit accruals and participation. The only Named Executive Officer who has benefits in the Prescott Pension Plan is Mr. Davis. The terms and conditions below relate solely to participants in the Prescott Pension Plan.

The “Normal Retirement Benefit” is expressed as an annual single life annuity payable from normal retirement age for the remainder of his life. The benefit under the Prescott Pension Plan is equal to an amount equal to the sum of (i) and (ii):

 

  (i) an amount equal to the product of:

(a) 0.5% of Mr. Davis’ Average Compensation (as defined below) not in excess of the covered compensation base plus 1% of his Average Compensation in excess of the covered compensation base; and (b) Mr. Davis’ years of Accrued Service (not in excess of 40).

 

  (ii) an amount equal to the product of:

(a) 0.67% of Mr. Davis’ Average Compensation; and

(b) Mr. Davis’ years of Accrued Service in excess of 40.

 

159


Table of Contents

“Average Compensation” means the average of Mr. Davis’ highest compensation paid during any five consecutive plan years of the ten plan years prior to December 31, 2008. “Compensation” means Mr. Davis’ total compensation in a plan year, excluding any bonuses, any overtime payments and employer contributions under the Prescott Pension Plan or under any other employee benefit plan of an affiliated company. Pay in excess of the Internal Revenue Code Section 401(a)(17) limit, is not considered. “Accrued Service” is the total number of years prior to January 1, 2009 (June 1, 2009 for IBT Union employees), during which the executive has completed at least 1,000 Hours of Service.

If Mr. Davis retires after reaching the age of 60 and has completed five years of vesting service, he is entitled to the benefit amount. However, the benefit amount will be reduced 0.56% for each month his retirement precedes his reaching the age of 65.

In the event Mr. Davis dies prior to the commencement of benefit payments, his spouse will be eligible for a death benefit protection. This provides that if Mr. Davis and spouse were married for at least one year prior to his date of death, then the spouse of Mr. Davis shall receive a survivor annuity which is equal to 50% of the pension Mr. Davis would have received had he retired on his date of death or age 60, if later, with a joint and 50% survivor annuity option.

If Mr. Davis dies after payment of his benefit under the Prescott Pension Plan has commenced, the death benefit payable, if any, shall be determined in accordance with the form in which the benefit was being paid. The pension benefit under the Prescott Pension Plan is reduced if paid before normal retirement age. The pension benefit is defined as a single life annuity. Optional annuity forms which are approximately equal in value are also available.

2013 Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation

None of our Named Executive Officers were participants in or made contributions to or withdrawals from any of our nonqualified deferred compensation plans during the fiscal year ending December 29, 2013.

Potential Payments Upon Resignation, Termination or Change in Control

The table beginning on page 147 in this Prospectus estimates the amount of compensation payable to each of our Named Executive Officers in the event of termination of such executives’ employment upon voluntary termination, termination for cause, death, disability, retirement, involuntary not for cause termination and termination following a change of control. The amounts shown are estimates assuming that such termination was effective as of December 29, 2013. Each of our Named Executive Officers is entitled to receive amounts earned during his or her term of employment regardless of the manner in which the Named Executive Officer’s employment is terminated. These amounts include accrued but unpaid base salary and accrued and unused vacation pay through the date of such termination (the “Accrued Benefits”). These amounts are not shown in the table. In addition, each of our Named Executive Officers may receive compensation under the terms of our Management Stockholder Agreements or the Equity Plan, as well as under the terms of their respective employment agreements.

The Management Stockholder Agreements with each of Mr. Reed and Ms. Sack contains a call option exercisable at our discretion pursuant to which we may purchase the shares of non-forfeited common stock which are subject to the Management Stockholder Agreement upon termination of his or her employment for any reason (the “Call Option”). The amount we will pay is determined as follows: (a) in the case of a termination for cause, the lower of the purchase price of one thousand dollars ($1,000) per share or the fair market value (as determined by our board of directors) or (b) in the case of a termination for any reason other than cause, the fair market value (as determined by our board of directors). Following the Restructuring, the Call Option has no value.

 

160


Table of Contents

Payments Made Upon Termination for Cause or Resignation without Good Reason

If the Named Executive Officer’s employment is terminated by the Company for cause or he or she voluntarily resigns without “good reason” (as such term is defined above), he or she would not be entitled to any further compensation or benefits other than Accrued Benefits. The Named Executive Officer would also forfeit all unvested shares subject to his or her initial stock grant and any restricted stock bonuses and, in the case of termination due to an act of dishonesty committed in connection with our business, he or she would forfeit all shares subject to his or her initial stock grant and any restricted stock bonuses. Under the Management Stockholder Agreements, we may exercise our Call Option.

Payments Made Upon Termination without Cause or Termination for Good Reason Unrelated to a Change in Control

If the Named Executive Officer’s employment is terminated by the Company other than for Cause or is terminated by the Named Executive Officer for “good reason” (as such term is defined above) unrelated to a change in control, in each case, not within 18 months of the earlier to occur of the commencement of any discussion with any individual or entity that ultimately results in a change in control or the occurrence of a change in control transaction (this period is referred to as the “Protection Period”), then he or she shall be entitled to:

(a) the Accrued Benefits;

(b) an amount equal to 12 months current base salary;

(c) the annual bonus, including any declared bonus not yet paid;

(d) continuation of health benefits at the same levels until the earlier of: (i) the time it takes the Named Executive Officer to become eligible for benefits from a new employer; or (ii) 12 months from the date of termination;

(e) the shares subject to the initial stock grant and any additional restricted stock bonuses that would have vested on the next anniversary date following the date of such termination, but in no event less than one-third (1/3) each of the shares to the initial stock grant and any additional restricted stock bonuses; and

(f) with respect to each of Mr. Reed and Ms. Sack only, under the Management Stockholder Agreement, we may exercise our Call Option.

Payments Made Upon Termination without Cause or Termination for Good Reason following a Change in Control

If the Named Executive Officer’s employment is terminated by the Company other than for Cause or is terminated by the Named Executive Officer for “good reason” (as such term is defined above) following a change in control, in each case within the Protection Period, then he or she shall be entitled to:

(a) the Accrued Benefits;

(b) an amount equal to:

 

  i. with respect to Mr. Reed, 27 months Base Salary plus Average Monthly Bonus (as defined in the Employment Agreements) current base salary;

 

  ii. with respect to Mr. Davis, 24 months Base Salary plus Average Monthly Bonus; and

 

  iii. with respect to each of Ms. Janik and Ms. Sack, 21 months Base Salary plus Average Monthly Bonus.

(c) a pro-rated bonus for the year of termination;

 

161


Table of Contents

(d) vesting of the portion of the shares of any Restricted Stock Grant and the Initial Restricted Stock Grant, respectively, that are not vested as of the date of termination, if the date of termination is within 12 months of the change in control;

(e) up to 6 months of outplacement services;

(f) continuation of health benefits at the same levels until the earlier of: (i) the time it takes the Named Executive Officer to become eligible for benefits from a new employer; or (ii) 12 months from the date of termination;

(g) the shares subject to the initial stock grant and any additional restricted stock bonuses that would have vested on the next anniversary date following the date of such termination, but in no event less than one-third (1/3) each of the shares to the initial stock grant and any additional restricted stock bonuses, if the date of termination is not within 12 months of the change in control; and

(h) with respect to each of Mr. Reed and Ms. Sack only, under the Management Stockholder Agreement, we may exercise our Call Option.

Payments Made Upon Resignation, Death or Disability

If the Named Executive Officer’s employment is terminated by reason of voluntary resignation (other than a voluntary termination for good reason), death or Disability (as defined in the Employment Agreements), he or she would not be entitled to receive any further compensation or benefits other than the Accrued Benefits. If any Named Executive Officer fails to perform his or her duties as a result of Disability or incapacity, he or she shall continue to receive his or her Base Salary and all other benefits and all other compensation unless and until his or her employment is terminated. In addition, under the Management Stockholder Agreements, we may exercise our Call Option.

 

162


Table of Contents

Potential Payments upon Termination or Change of Control(1)

 

    OFFICERS  

EVENT

  Michael E.
Reed
    Melinda A.
Janik
    Mark
Maring
    Kirk Davis     Polly G.
Sack
 

VOLUNTARY TERMINATION, TERMINATION FOR CAUSE OR RESIGNATION WITHOUT “GOOD REASON”

   

Call Option(1)

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

DEATH

         

Call Option(1)

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

Life insurance proceeds

  $ 500,000      $ 275,000      $ 200,000      $ 461,261      $ 260,000   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 500,000      $ 275,000      $ 200,000      $ 461,261      $ 260,000   

DISABILITY

         

Call Option(1)

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

RETIREMENT

         

Call Option(1)

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

TERMINATION WITHOUT CAUSE, TERMINATION FOR “GOOD REASON” UNRELATED TO A “CHANGE IN CONTROL”

   

Annual Bonus(2)

  $ 800,000      $ 125,000      $ 80,000      $ 350,000      $ 140,000   

Call Option(1)

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

Cash severance payment

  $ 500,000      $ 275,000      $ 200,000      $ 461,261      $ 260,000   

Continued health care benefits

  $ 9,119      $ 3,878      $ 9,119      $ 9,433      $ 8,520   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 1,309,119      $ 403,878      $ 289,119      $ 820,694      $ 408,520   

TERMINATION WITHOUT CAUSE, TERMINATION FOR “GOOD REASON” FOLLOWING A “CHANGE IN CONTROL”

   

Annual Bonus(3)

  $ 800,000      $ 125,000      $ 80,000      $ 350,000      $ 140,000   

Call Option(1)

  $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0      $ 0   

Cash severance payment(4)

  $ 2,887,479      $ 720,629      $ 200,000      $ 1,572,514      $ 691,250   

Continued health care benefits

  $ 9,119      $ 3,878      $ 9,119      $ 9,433      $ 8,520   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 3,696,598      $ 849,507      $ 289,119      $ 1,931,947      $ 839,770   

 

(1) This table assumes the specified termination events or change in control occurred on December 29, 2013.
(2) The Call Option has no value following the Restructuring.
(3) This is the maximum amount based on the previous year’s bonus and is payable only if previously declared.
(4) With respect to Mr. Reed, Ms. Janik, Mr. Davis and Ms. Sack, this is the maximum amount based on the previous year’s bonus and is subject to pro-ration for portion of the year elapsed. With respect to Mr. Maring, this is the maximum amount based on the previous year’s bonus and is payable only if previously declared.
(5) With respect to Mr. Reed, Ms. Janik, Mr. Davis and Ms. Sack, the “cash severance payment” consists of a monthly payment for a specified period (27 months for our Chief Executive Officer, 24 months for our Chief Operating Officer, 21 months for our Chief Financial Officer and 21 months for our General Counsel) equal to the executive’s monthly base salary and average monthly bonus (the average of the last three annual cash bonuses divided by 12). With respect to Mr. Maring, the “cash severance payment” equals twelve (12) months’ current base salary.

 

163


Table of Contents

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

The following table provides information with respect to the beneficial ownership of our Common Stock as of June 29, 2014 (except as otherwise noted) by (i) each person who is a beneficial owner of more than 5% of our outstanding Common Stock, (ii) each of our directors and our named executive officers, and (iii) all directors and executive officers as a group.

On the Effective Date of the Plan, we were deemed to have issued and distributed 1,362,479 New Media Warrants (as defined below). The New Media Warrants collectively represent the right to acquire New Media Common Stock, which in the aggregate was equal to 5% of New Media Common Stock as of the Effective Date (calculated prior to dilution from shares of New Media Common Stock issued pursuant to the Local Media Contribution) at a strike price of $46.35 calculated based on a total equity value of New Media prior to the Local Media Contribution of $1.2 billion. Former equity interests of GateHouse were cancelled under the Plan.

Except as otherwise noted in the footnotes below, each person or entity identified below has sole voting and investment power with respect to such securities. We have outstanding an aggregate of 30,015,870 shares of Common Stock as of the date of this Prospectus. The percentage of beneficial ownership of our Common Stock immediately after this offering is based on shares of our Common Stock issued and outstanding. The table assumes that the underwriters will not exercise their option to purchase up to 950,625 shares of our Common Stock.

 

    Immediately Prior to
this Offering
    Immediately After
this Offering
 

Name and Address of Beneficial Owner(1)

  Amount and Nature of
Beneficial Ownership
    Percent of Class(2)     Amount and Nature of
Beneficial Ownership
    Percent of Class  

Wesley R. Edens(3)(6)

    792,411        2.64     792,411        2.17

Michael E. Reed(4)

    9,550        *     9,550        *

Kevin M. Sheehan(5)(7)

    6,549        *     6,549        *

Theodore P. Janulis(7)

    5,290        *     5,290        *

Laurence Tarica(7)

    5,290        *     5,290        *

Kirk Davis(8)

    1,700       *     1,700       *

Gregory Freiberg

    —         *     —         *

All directors, nominees and executive officers as a group (7 persons)(9)

    820,790        2.73     820,790        2.25

Omega Advisors, Inc. and its affiliates(10)

    4,257,457        14.18     4,257,457        11.66

 

* Denotes less than 1%.
(1) The address of all of the officers and directors listed above are in the care of FIG LLC, 1345 Avenue of the Americas, 46th Floor, New York, New York 10105.
(2) Percentages shown assume the exercise by such persons of all options and warrants to acquire shares of our Common Stock that are exercisable within 60 days of June 29, 2014 and no exercise by any other person.
(3) Includes 200,246 shares of New Media Common Stock held by Mr. Edens, 74,872 shares of New Media Common Stock held by FOE I, which is an affiliate of our Manager and 517,293 shares of New Media Common Stock issuable upon exercise of the New Media Warrants held by FIF III Liberty Holdings LLC. Mr. Edens disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares of New Media Common Stock held by FOE I and the shares of New Media Common Stock issuable upon the exercise of the New Media Warrants held by FIF III Liberty Holdings LLC, except, in each case, to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein. Does not include 7,219 shares of New Media Common Stock held by a charitable trust of which Mr. Edens’s spouse is sole trustee, and Mr. Edens disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares of New Media Common Stock held by this charitable trust; does not include 7,219 shares of New Media Common Stock held by a charitable trust of which Mr. Edens is trustee, and Mr. Edens disclaims beneficial ownership of these shares of New Media Common Stock.

 

164


Table of Contents
(4) Includes 9,550 shares of New Media Common Stock issuable upon exercise of the New Media Warrants.
(5) Includes 1,259 shares of New Media Common Stock issuable upon exercise of the New Media Warrants.
(6) Mr. Edens, as a beneficial owner of FOE I, may be considered to have, together with the other beneficial owners of FOE I, shared voting and investment power with respect to the shares of New Media Common Stock held by FOE I.
(7) Includes with respect to each of these individuals the following number of restricted stock grants that vest in three equal installments on March 14 of each of 2015, 2016 and 2017, subject such individual’s continued service as a director through each vesting date: Sheehan – 5,290; Janulis – 5,290 and Tarica – 5,290.
(8) Includes 1,700 shares of New Media Common Stock issuable upon exercise of the New Media Warrants.
(9) Certain of our directors and officers may purchase shares in connection with this offering. Excludes any shares of New Media Common Stock that may be purchased by our directors and officers in connection with this offering.
(10) Based on information set forth in a Form 4 filed by Leon G. Cooperman on June 9, 2014. Includes: (i) 81,219 shares of New Media Common Stock held by Leon G. Cooperman (the “Reporting Person”); (ii) 269,086 shares of New Media Common stock held in the account of the Reporting Person’s spouse, Toby Cooperman, over which the Reporting Person has investment discretion; (iii) 3,189,195 shares of New Media Common Stock held in the accounts of private investment entities over which the Reporting Person has investment discretion; (iv) 83,024 shares of New Media Common Stock held in the account of the Leon & Toby Cooperman Family Foundation over which the Reporting Person has investment discretion; (v) 5,414 shares of New Media Common Stock held in the account of the Reporting Person’s son, Michael S. Cooperman, over which the Reporting Person has investment discretion; and (vi) 629,519 shares of New Media Common Stock held in managed accounts over which the Reporting Person has investment discretion. The Reporting Person disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares of New Media Common Stock referred to in sections (ii) through (vi) above, except, with regards to (iii) and (vi), to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein.

 

165


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PERSONS,

AFFILIATES AND AFFILIATED ENTITIES

Our Board has adopted written policies and procedures regarding the approval of any “related person transaction,” which is any transaction or series of transactions in which we or any of our subsidiaries is or are to be a participant, the amount involved exceeds $120,000, and a “related person” (as defined under SEC rules) has a direct or indirect material interest. Under the policy, a related person would need to promptly disclose to the legal department any proposed related person transaction and all material facts about the proposed transaction. The legal department would then assess and promptly communicate that information to our independent directors. Based on their consideration of all of the relevant facts and circumstances, our independent directors will decide whether or not to approve such transaction and will generally approve only those transactions that are in, or are not inconsistent with, the best interests of New Media, as determined by at least a majority of the independent directors. If we become aware of an existing related person transaction that has not been pre-approved under this policy, the transaction will be referred to our independent directors, who will evaluate all options available, including ratification, revision or termination of such transaction. Our policy requires any director who may be interested in a related person transaction to recuse himself or herself from any consideration of such related person transaction.

Transactions between the Company and the Manager or any affiliate of the Manager must be approved in advance by the majority of the independent directors and be determined by such independent directors to be in the best interests of the Company. If any affiliate transaction involving the acquisition of an asset by the Company from the Manager or an affiliate of the Manager is not approved in advance by a majority of the independent directors, then the Manager may be required to repurchase the asset at the purchase price (plus closing costs) to the Company.

As of December 29, 2013, Newcastle beneficially owned approximately 84.6% of the Company’s outstanding common stock. On February 13, 2014, Newcastle completed the spin-off of the Company. On February 14, 2014, New Media became a separate, publicly traded company trading on the NYSE under the ticker symbol “NEWM”. As a result of the spin-off, the fees included in the Management Agreement with the Company’s Manager became effective. As of June 29, 2014, Fortress and its affiliates owned approximately 1.5% of the Company’s outstanding stock and approximately 39.6% of the Company’s outstanding warrants.

In addition, the Company’s Chairman, Wesley Edens, is also the Co-Chairman of the board of directors of Fortress. The Company does not pay Mr. Edens a salary or any other form of compensation.

The Company’s Chief Operating Officer owns an interest in a company, from which the Successor Company and the Predecessor Company received $100,000, $0, $178,000, and $0 during the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013, respectively, for commercial printing services, which is included in commercial printing and other on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss).

The Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer are employees of Fortress and their salaries are paid by Fortress.

Management Agreement

On November 26, 2013, we entered into the Management Agreement with our Manager, as amended and restated, which provides for the day-to-day management of our operations. Our Management Agreement requires our Manager to manage our business affairs subject to the supervision of our Board. See “Our Manager and Management Agreement” included elsewhere in this Prospectus.

GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement

On November 26, 2013, New Media entered into the GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement (the “GateHouse Management Agreement”) with GateHouse, pursuant to which New Media managed the assets and

 

166


Table of Contents

the day-to-day operations of GateHouse. New Media was responsible for, among other things (i) the purchase and sale of GateHouse’s investments (ii) the financing of GateHouse’s investments and (iii) investment advisory services. Such services may have been performed by the Manager.

The GateHouse Management Agreement had an initial three-year term and would have been automatically renewed for one-year terms thereafter unless terminated by New Media or GateHouse. The GateHouse Management Agreement would have automatically terminated if the Management Agreement between New Media and the Manager was terminated.

New Media was (a) entitled to receive a management fee equal to 1.50% per annum of GateHouse’s Total Equity (as defined in the GateHouse Management Agreement) and (b) eligible to receive incentive compensation based on GateHouse’s performance. In addition, GateHouse was obligated to reimburse certain expenses incurred by New Media in connection with the performance of its duties under the GateHouse Management Agreement.

The GateHouse Management Agreement was terminated effective June 4, 2014.

Local Media Management and Advisory Agreement

GateHouse managed the assets of Local Media pursuant to the Local Media Management Agreement. The Local Media Management Agreement had a two-year term, with automatic renewal for successive two-year periods unless terminated. While the Local Media Management Agreement was in effect, GateHouse was entitled to receive an annual management fee of $1.1 million, subject to adjustments (up to a maximum annual management fee of $1.2 million), and an annual incentive compensation fee based on exceeding EBITDA targets of Local Media.

The Local Media Management Agreement was terminated effective June 4, 2014.

Holdings I Management Agreement

On June 4, 2014, the Company entered into a management agreement with Holdings I (as amended and restated, the “Holdings I Management Agreement”). The Holdings I Management Agreement requires the Company to manage the business affairs of Holdings I subject to the supervision of the Board of Directors of Holdings I.

The Holdings I Management Agreement has an initial three-year term and will be automatically renewed for one-year terms thereafter unless terminated by the Holdings I. The Company is (a) entitled to receive from the Holdings I a management fee and (b) eligible to receive incentive compensation that is based on the performance of Holdings I. In addition, Holdings I is obligated to reimburse certain expenses incurred by the Company. The Company is also entitled to receive a termination fee from Holdings I under certain circumstances. These fees eliminate in consolidation.

Registration Rights Agreement with Omega

New Media entered into a registration rights agreement (the “Omega Registration Rights Agreement) with Omega Advisors, Inc. and its affiliates (collectively, “Omega”). Under the terms of the Omega Registration Rights Agreement, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, New Media will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file a registration statement (the “Registration Statement”) providing for the registration and sale by Omega of its New Media Common Stock acquired pursuant to the Plan (the “Registrable Securities”) as soon as reasonably practicable, but not prior to the earlier of (i) 120 days following the Effective Date and (ii) 14 days after the required financials are completed in the ordinary course of business. During the first 12 months following the Listing, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, Omega may request one demand right with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities under the Registration Statement (the “Demand Registration”).

 

167


Table of Contents

Once New Media is eligible to use Form S-3, New Media will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file a resale shelf registration statement providing for the registration and sale on a continuous or delayed basis by Omega of its Registrable Securities (the “Shelf Registration”), subject to customary exceptions and limitations. Omega is entitled to initiate up to three offerings or sales with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration.

Omega may only exercise its right to request the Demand Registration and any Shelf Registrations if Registrable Securities to be sold pursuant to such Registration Statement or Shelf Registration are at least 3% of the then-outstanding New Media Common Stock. This description is a summary and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, the provisions of the Omega Registration Rights Agreement filed as Exhibit 4.1 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

 

168


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF OUR CAPITAL STOCK

The following descriptions are summaries of the material terms of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws. These descriptions contain all information which we consider to be material, but may not contain all of the information that is important to you. To understand them fully, you should read our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, copies of which are filed as Exhibits 3.1 and 3.2 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Please note that, with respect to any of our shares held in book-entry form through The Depository Trust Company or any other share depositary, the depositary or its nominee will be the sole registered and legal owner of those shares, and references in this Prospectus to any “stockholder” or “holder” of those shares means only the depositary or its nominee. Persons who hold beneficial interests in our shares through a depositary will not be registered or legal owners of those shares and will not be recognized as such for any purpose. For example, only the depositary or its nominee will be entitled to vote the shares held through it, and any dividends or other distributions to be paid, and any notices to be given, in respect of those shares will be paid or given only to the depositary or its nominee. Owners of beneficial interests in those shares will have to look solely to the depositary with respect to any benefits of share ownership, and any rights they may have with respect to those shares will be governed by the rules of the depositary, which are subject to change from time to time. We have no responsibility for those rules or their application to any interests held through the depositary.

Under our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, our authorized capital stock consists of:

 

    2,000,000,000 shares of Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share; and

 

    300,000 preferred shares, par value $0.01 per share.

There are outstanding 30,015,870 shares of our Common Stock and no outstanding shares of preferred stock. The number of shares of our Common Stock outstanding does not include the shares of Common Stock offered hereby or options to purchase 650,000 shares of our common stock, representing 10% of the number of shares being offered by us hereby, that will be granted to an affiliate of our Manager in connection with this offering, and subject to adjustment if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of our common stock.

The following is a description of the material terms of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws. We refer you to our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, copies of which have been filed as Exhibits 3.1 and 3.2 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Common Stock

Each holder of Common Stock is entitled to one vote for each share of Common Stock held on all matters submitted to a vote of stockholders. Except as provided with respect to any other class or series of stock, the holders of our Common Stock will possess the exclusive right to vote for the election of directors and for all other purposes. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws do not provide for cumulative voting in the election of directors, which means that the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Common Stock can elect all of the directors standing for election, and the holders of the remaining shares are not able to elect any directors.

Subject to any preference rights of holders of any preferred stock that we may issue in the future, holders of our Common Stock are entitled to receive dividends, if any, declared from time to time by our Board out of legally available funds. In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, the holders of our Common Stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets remaining after the payment of liabilities, subject to any rights of holders of our preferred stock prior to distribution.

 

169


Table of Contents

Holders of our Common Stock have no preemptive, subscription, redemption or conversion rights.

Preferred Stock

Our Board has the authority, without action by our stockholders, to issue preferred stock and to fix voting powers for each class or series of preferred stock, and to provide that any class or series may be subject to redemption, entitled to receive dividends, entitled to rights upon dissolution, or convertible or exchangeable for shares of any other class or classes of capital stock. The rights with respect to a series or class of preferred stock may be greater than the rights attached to our Common Stock. It is not possible to state the actual effect of the issuance of any shares of our preferred stock on the rights of holders of our Common Stock until our Board determines the specific rights attached to that preferred stock. The effect of issuing preferred stock could include, among other things, one or more of the following:

 

    restricting dividends in respect of our Common Stock;

 

    diluting the voting power of our Common Stock or providing that holders of preferred stock have the right to vote on matters as a class;

 

    impairing the liquidation rights of our Common Stock; or

 

    delaying or preventing a change of control of us.

Registration Rights Agreement with Omega

New Media entered into the Omega Registration Rights Agreement on the Effective Date. Under the terms of the Omega Registration Rights Agreement, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, New Media is required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file the Registration Statement providing for the registration and sale of the Registrable Securities as soon as reasonably practicable, but not prior to the earlier of (i) 120 days following the Effective Date and (ii) 14 days after the required financials are completed in the ordinary course of business. During the first 12 months following the Listing of New Media Common Stock on a major U.S. national securities exchange, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, Omega may request one Demand Registration.

Once New Media is eligible to use Form S-3, New Media will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file the Shelf Registration, subject to customary exceptions and limitations. Omega is entitled to initiate up to three offerings or sales with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration.

Omega may only exercise its right to request the Demand Registration and any Shelf Registrations if the Registrable Securities eligible to be sold pursuant to such Registration Statement or Shelf Registration are at least 3% of the then-outstanding New Media Common Stock. This description is a summary and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, the provisions of the Omega Registration Rights Agreement filed as Exhibit 4.1 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Anti-Takeover Effects of Delaware Law, Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws

The following is a summary of certain provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws that may be deemed to have an anti-takeover effect and may delay, deter or prevent a tender offer or takeover attempt that a stockholder might consider to be in its best interest, including those attempts that might result in a premium over the market price for the shares held by stockholders.

Authorized but Unissued Shares

The authorized but unissued shares of our Common Stock and our preferred stock will be available for future issuance without obtaining stockholder approval. These additional shares may be utilized for a variety of

 

170


Table of Contents

corporate purposes, including future public offerings to raise additional capital, corporate acquisitions and employee benefit plans. The existence of authorized but unissued shares of our Common Stock and preferred stock could render more difficult or discourage an attempt to obtain control over us by means of a proxy contest, tender offer, merger or otherwise.

Delaware Business Combination Statute

We are organized under Delaware law. Some provisions of Delaware law may delay or prevent a transaction that would cause a change in our control.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the “DGCL”), as amended, an anti-takeover law, will not apply to us. In general, this statute prohibits a publicly held Delaware corporation from engaging in a business combination with an interested stockholder for a period of three years after the date of the transaction by which that person became an interested stockholder, unless the business combination is approved in a prescribed manner. For purposes of Section 203, a business combination includes a merger, asset sale or other transaction resulting in a financial benefit to the interested stockholder, and an interested stockholder is a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns, or within three years prior, did own, 15% or more of voting stock.

Other Provisions of Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides for a staggered Board consisting of three classes of directors from and after the date of the first meeting of the Board of New Media following the Listing. Directors of each class are chosen for three-year terms upon the expiration of their current terms and each year one class of our directors will be elected by our stockholders. The terms of the first, second and third classes will expire on the dates of the first, second and third annual meetings of stockholders held after the Listing, respectively. We believe that classification of our Board will help to assure the continuity and stability of our business strategies and policies as determined by our Board. Additionally, there is no cumulative voting in the election of directors. This classified board provision could have the effect of making the replacement of incumbent directors more time consuming and difficult. At least two annual meetings of stockholders, instead of one, will generally be required to effect a change in a majority of our Board. Thus, the classified board provision could increase the likelihood that incumbent directors will retain their positions. The staggered terms of directors may delay, defer or prevent a tender offer or an attempt to change control of us, even though a tender offer or change in control might be believed by our stockholders to be in their best interest. In addition, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws provide that directors may be removed only for cause and only with the affirmative vote of at least 80% of the voting interest of stockholders entitled to vote.

Pursuant to our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, shares of our preferred stock may be issued from time to time, and the Board is authorized to determine and alter all rights, preferences, privileges, qualifications, limitations and restrictions without limitation. See “—Preferred Stock.”

Ability of our Stockholders to Act

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws do not permit our stockholders to call special stockholders meetings (provided, however, that for so long as Newcastle and certain other affiliates of Fortress and permitted transferees (collectively, the “Fortress Stockholders”) beneficially own at least 20% of our issued and outstanding Common Stock, Fortress Stockholders may call special meetings of our stockholders). Written notice of any special meeting so called shall be given to each stockholder of record entitled to vote at such meeting not less than 10 or more than 60 days before the date of such meeting, unless otherwise required by law.

 

171


Table of Contents

Under our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, any action required or permitted to be taken at a meeting of our stockholders may be taken without a meeting by written consent of a majority of our stockholders for so long as Fortress Stockholders beneficially own, directly or indirectly, at least 20% of our issued and outstanding Common Stock. After Fortress Stockholders beneficially own less than 20% of our issued and outstanding stock, only action by unanimous written consent of our stockholders can be taken without a meeting.

Our amended and restated bylaws provide that nominations of persons for election to our Board may be made at any annual meeting of our stockholders, or at any special meeting of our stockholders called for the purpose of electing directors, (a) by or at the direction of our Board or (b) by any of our stockholders. In addition to any other applicable requirements, for a nomination to be properly brought by a stockholder, such stockholder must have given timely notice thereof in proper written form to our Secretary of the Company. To be timely, a stockholder’s notice must be delivered to or mailed and received at our principal executive offices (a) in the case of an annual meeting of stockholders, not less than 90 days nor more than 120 days prior to the anniversary date of the immediately preceding annual meeting of stockholders; provided, however, that in the event that the annual meeting is called for a date that is not within 30 days before or after such anniversary date, notice by a stockholder in order to be timely must be so received not later than the close of business on the tenth day following the day on which such notice of the date of the annual meeting was mailed or such public disclosure of the date of the annual meeting was made, whichever first occurs; and (b) in the case of a special meeting of our stockholders called for the purpose of electing directors, not later than the close of business on the tenth day following the day on which notice of the date of the special meeting was mailed or public disclosure of the date of the special meeting was made, whichever first occurs.

Our amended and restated bylaws provide that no business may be transacted at any annual meeting of our stockholders, other than business that is either (a) specified in the notice of meeting given by or at the direction of our Board, (b) otherwise properly brought before the annual meeting by or at the direction of our Board, or (c) otherwise properly brought by any of our stockholders. In addition to any other applicable requirements, for business to be properly brought before an annual meeting by a stockholder, such stockholder must have given timely notice thereof in proper written form to our Secretary. To be timely, a stockholder’s notice must be delivered to or mailed and received at our principal executive offices not less than 90 days nor more than 120 days prior to the anniversary date of the immediately preceding annual meeting of stockholders; provided, however, that in the event that the annual meeting is called for a date that is not within 30 days before or after such anniversary date, notice by a stockholder in order to be timely must be so received not later than the close of business on the tenth day following the day on which such notice of the date of the annual meeting was mailed or such public disclosure of the date of the annual meeting was made, whichever first occurs.

Forum Selection Clause

Under our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware will be the sole and exclusive forum for (i) any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf, (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any of our directors or officers or our stockholders, (iii) any action asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the DGCL or our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or amended and restated bylaws or (iv) any action asserting a claim against the us governed by the internal affairs doctrine.

Limitations on Liability and Indemnification of Directors and Officers

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that our directors will not be personally liable to us or our stockholders for monetary damages for breach of a fiduciary duty as a director, except to the extent such exemption is not permitted under the DGCL, as amended from time to time.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws provide that we will indemnify our directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by law. We are also expressly authorized to

 

172


Table of Contents

advance certain expenses (including attorneys’ fees and disbursements and court costs) to our directors and officers and carry directors’ and officers’ insurance providing indemnification for our directors and officers for some liabilities. We believe that these indemnification provisions and insurance are useful to attract and retain qualified directors and executive officers.

We have entered into separate indemnification agreements with each of our directors and executive officers. Each indemnification agreement provides, among other things, for indemnification to the fullest extent permitted by law and our amended and restated certificate of incorporation against (i) any and all expenses and liabilities, including judgments, fines, penalties and amounts paid in settlement of any claim with our approval and counsel fees and disbursements, (ii) any liability pursuant to a loan guarantee, or otherwise, for any of our indebtedness and (iii) any liabilities incurred as a result of acting on our behalf (as a fiduciary or otherwise) in connection with an employee benefit plan. The indemnification agreements provide for the advancement or payment of all expenses to the indemnitee and for reimbursement to us if it is found that such indemnitee is not entitled to such indemnification under applicable law and our amended and restated certificate of incorporation. These provisions and agreements may have the practical effect in some cases of eliminating our stockholders’ ability to collect monetary damages from our directors and executive officers.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) may be permitted to directors, officers or persons controlling the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, we have been informed that, in the opinion of the SEC such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is therefore unenforceable.

Corporate Opportunity

Under our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, to the extent permitted by law:

 

    the Fortress Stockholders have the right to, and have no duty to abstain from, exercising such right to, engage or invest in the same or similar business as us, do business with any of our clients, customers or vendors or employ or otherwise engage any of our officers, directors or employees;

 

    if the Fortress Stockholders or any of their officers, directors or employees acquire knowledge of a potential transaction that could be a corporate opportunity, they have no duty to offer such corporate opportunity to us, our stockholders or affiliates;

 

    we have renounced any interest or expectancy in, or in being offered an opportunity to participate in, such corporate opportunities; and

 

    in the event that any of our directors and officers who is also a director, officer or employee of any of the Fortress Stockholders acquires knowledge of a corporate opportunity or is offered a corporate opportunity, provided that this knowledge was not acquired solely in such person’s capacity as our director or officer and such person acted in good faith, then such person is deemed to have fully satisfied such person’s fiduciary duty and is not liable to us if any of the Fortress Stockholders pursues or acquires such corporate opportunity or if such person did not present the corporate opportunity to us.

Transfer Agent

The registrar and transfer agent for our Common Stock is American Stock Transfer and Trust Company, LLC.

Listing

Our Common Stock was listed on the NYSE under the symbol “NEWM” on February 14, 2014.

 

173


Table of Contents

SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

Upon completion of this offering, we will have outstanding 36,515,870 shares of our Common Stock, assuming 6,500,000 shares are sold in this offering (or 37,466,495 shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of Common Stock in full).

All of the 6,500,000 shares of Common Stock sold in this offering (or 7,288,125 shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of common stock in full) will be freely transferable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act unless such shares are purchased by “affiliates” as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act.

Future sales of substantial amounts of our Common Stock in the public market, including shares issued upon exercise of outstanding options or warrants, or the anticipation of these sales, could adversely affect market prices prevailing from time to time and could impair our ability to raise capital through sales of equity securities.

In connection with this offering, we have granted to an affiliate of our Manager an option relating to shares of our Common Stock, equal in number to 10% of the number of shares being offered by us hereby, and subject to adjustment if the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares is exercised, at the public offering price of our shares in this offering (the “Manager Option”). The option shares are not registered in connection with this offering.

Sale of Restricted Securities

The shares of New Media Common Stock are freely transferable, except for shares received by persons who may be deemed to be New Media “affiliates” under the Securities Act, including any shares issued upon exercise of the Manager Option and the shares of our Common Stock sold in this offering to certain of our officers and directors. Persons who may be deemed to be affiliates of New Media generally include individuals or entities that control, are controlled by or are under common control with New Media and may include directors and certain officers or principal stockholders of New Media. New Media affiliates will be permitted to sell their shares of New Media Common Stock only pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act or an exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act, such as the exemptions afforded by Rule 144.

Rule 144

In general, under Rule 144 as currently in effect, a person (or persons whose shares are aggregated), including an affiliate, who beneficially owns “restricted securities” of a “reporting company” may not sell these securities until the person has beneficially owned them for at least six months. Thereafter, affiliates may not sell within any three-month period a number of shares in excess of the greater of: (i) 1% of the then outstanding shares of common stock as shown by the most recent report or statement published by the issuer; and (ii) the average weekly reported trading volume in such securities during the four preceding calendar weeks.

Sales under Rule 144 by our affiliates will also be subject to restrictions relating to manner of sale, notice and the availability of current public information about us and may be affected only through unsolicited brokers’ transactions.

Persons not deemed to be affiliates who have beneficially owned “restricted securities” for at least six months but for less than one year may sell these securities, provided that current public information about the Company is “available,” which means that, on the date of sale, we have been subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act for at least 90 days and are current in our Exchange Act filings. After beneficially owning “restricted securities” for one year, our non-affiliates may engage in unlimited re-sales of such securities.

Shares received by our affiliates in the Distribution or upon exercise of stock options or upon vesting of other equity-linked awards may be “controlled securities” rather than “restricted securities.” “Controlled securities” are subject to the same volume limitations as “restricted securities” but are not subject to holding period requirements.

 

174


Table of Contents

Lock-Up Agreements

We and our directors and executive officers have entered into lock-up agreements with the underwriters prior to the commencement of this offering pursuant to which each of these persons or entities, with limited exceptions, for a period of 45 days after the date of this prospectus, may not, without the prior written consent of the underwriters, offer, sell, contract to sell, pledge or otherwise dispose of, directly or indirectly, any shares of our common stock or securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for any shares of our common stock, enter into a transaction that would have the same effect, or enter into any swap, hedge or other arrangement that transfers, in whole or in part, any of the economic consequences of ownership of our common stock or securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for any shares of our common stock, whether any of these transactions are to be settled by delivery of our common stock or other securities, in cash or otherwise, or publicly disclose the intention to make any offer, sale, pledge or disposition, or to enter into any transaction, swap, hedge or other arrangement.

New Media Warrants

On the Effective Date, the Company was deemed to have issued and distributed 1,362,479 10-year warrants to former equity holders of GateHouse (the “New Media Warrants”). The New Media Warrants collectively represent the right to acquire New Media Common Stock, which in the aggregate was equal to 5% of New Media Common Stock as of the Effective Date (calculated prior to dilution from shares of New Media Common Stock issued pursuant to the Local Media Contribution) at a strike price per share of $46.35 calculated based on a total equity value of New Media prior to the Local Media Contribution of $1.2 billion as of the Effective Date. Former equity interests in GateHouse were cancelled under the Plan. New Media Warrants do not have the benefit of antidilution protections, other than customary protections including for stock splits and stock dividends. The New Media Warrants expire on November 26, 2023. This description is a summary and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, the provisions of the Amended and Restated Warrant Agreement filed as Exhibit 10.35 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

Registration Rights Agreement with Omega

New Media entered into the Omega Registration Rights Agreement on the Effective Date. Under the terms of the Omega Registration Rights Agreement, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, New Media is required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file the Registration Statement providing for the registration and sale of the Registrable Securities as soon as reasonably practicable, but not prior to the earlier of (i) 120 days following the Effective Date and (ii) 14 days after the required financials are completed in the ordinary course of business. During the first 12 months following the Listing of New Media Common Stock on a major U.S. national securities exchange, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, Omega may request one Demand Registration.

Once New Media is eligible to use Form S-3, New Media will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file the Shelf Registration, subject to customary exceptions and limitations. Omega is entitled to initiate up to three offerings or sales with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration.

Omega may only exercise its right to request the Demand Registration and any Shelf Registrations if the Registrable Securities eligible to be sold pursuant to such Registration Statement or Shelf Registration are at least 3% of the then-outstanding New Media Common Stock. This description is a summary and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, the provisions of the Omega Registration Rights Agreement filed as Exhibit 4.1 to our registration statement on Form S-1.

 

175


Table of Contents

UNDERWRITING

Citigroup Global Markets Inc. and Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC are acting as the underwriters. Subject to the terms and conditions stated in the underwriting agreement dated September 17, 2014, each underwriter named below has severally agreed to purchase, and we have agreed to sell to that underwriter, the number of shares set forth opposite the underwriter’s name.

 

Underwriters

   Number of
Shares
 

Citigroup Global Markets Inc.

     3,168,750   

Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC

     3,168,750   
  

 

 

 

Total

     6,337,500   

In addition, 162,500 shares of our common stock will be purchased directly from us by one of our directors and an officer of our Manager at a price of $16.25 per share. The underwriters will not receive any underwriting discount or fee relating to these shares.

The underwriting agreement provides that the obligations of the underwriters to purchase the shares included in this offering are subject to approval of legal matters by counsel and to other conditions. The underwriters are obligated to purchase all the shares (other than those covered by the over-allotment option described below) if they purchase any of the shares.

Shares sold by the underwriters to the public will initially be offered at the public offering price set forth on the cover of this Prospectus. Any shares sold by the underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount from the initial public offering price not to exceed $0.15 per share. If all the shares are not sold at the initial offering price, the underwriters may change the offering price and the other selling terms. The underwriters have advised us that they do not intend to make sales to discretionary accounts.

If the underwriters sell more shares than the total number set forth in the table above, we have granted to the underwriters an option to purchase up to 950,625 additional shares of Common Stock exercisable for 30 days from the date of this Prospectus, at the public offering price less the underwriting discount. The underwriters may exercise the option solely for the purpose of covering over-allotments, if any, in connection with this offering. To the extent the option is exercised, each underwriter must purchase a number of additional shares approximately proportionate to that underwriter’s initial purchase commitment. Any shares issued or sold under the option will be issued and sold on the same terms and conditions as the other shares that are the subject of this offering.

We and our executive officers and directors have agreed that, subject to limited exceptions, for a period of 45 days from the date of this Prospectus, we and they will not, without the prior written consent of the underwriters, dispose of or hedge any shares or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for our Common Stock. The underwriters, in their sole discretion, may release any of the securities subject to these lock-up agreements at any time without notice. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if (i) during the last 17 days of the 45-day restricted period, we issue an earnings release or material news or a material event relating to our company occurs; or (ii) prior to the expiration of the 45-day restricted period, we announce that we will release earnings results during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 45-day restricted period, the restrictions described above shall continue to apply until the expiration of the 18-day period beginning on the issuance of the earnings release or the occurrence of the material news or material event.

Our shares of Common Stock were listed on the NYSE under the symbol “NEWM” on February 14, 2014.

The underwriters plan to sell shares of our Common Stock in this offering to certain of our officers and directors and an officer of our Manager at the public offering price set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus. The underwriters will not receive any underwriting discounts or commissions on the sale of such shares.

 

176


Table of Contents

The following table shows the underwriting discounts and commissions that we are to pay to the underwriters in connection with this offering (other than in connection with the sale of shares of our Common Stock in this offering to certain of our officers and directors and an officer of our Manager, for which no discounts or commissions will be paid). These amounts are shown assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the underwriters’ over-allotment option.

 

     Paid by Us  
     No Exercise      Full Exercise  

Per share

   $ 0.60       $ 0.60   

Total

   $ 3,765,577.20       $ 4,335,952.20   

In addition, we estimate that the total expenses of this offering payable by us will be approximately $1.8 million. We will pay the filing fees and up to $35,000 of the expenses (including the fees and disbursements of counsel to the underwriters) related to obtaining the required approval of certain terms of this offering from FINRA. The underwriters may reimburse us for certain of these expenses.

In connection with this offering, the underwriters may purchase and sell shares in the open market. Purchases and sales in the open market may include short sales, purchases to cover short positions, which may include purchases pursuant to the over-allotment option, and stabilizing purchases.

 

    Short sales involve secondary market sales by the underwriters of a greater number of shares than they are required to purchase in this offering.

 

    “Covered” short sales are sales of shares in an amount up to the number of shares represented by the underwriters’ over-allotment option.

 

    “Naked” short sales are sales of shares in an amount in excess of the number of shares represented by the underwriters’ over-allotment option.

 

    Covering transactions involve purchases of shares either pursuant to the over-allotment option or in the open market after the distribution has been completed in order to cover short positions.

 

    To close a naked short position, the underwriters must purchase shares in the open market after the distribution has been completed. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the shares in the open market after pricing that could adversely affect investors who purchase in this offering.

 

    To close a covered short position, the underwriters must purchase shares in the open market after the distribution has been completed or must exercise the over-allotment option. In determining the source of shares to close the covered short position, the underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of shares available for purchase in the open market as compared to the price at which they may purchase shares through the over-allotment option.

 

    Stabilizing transactions involve bids to purchase shares so long as the stabilizing bids do not exceed a specified maximum.

The underwriters also may impose a penalty bid. Penalty bids permit the underwriters to reclaim a selling concession from a syndicate member when the underwriters, in covering short positions or making stabilizing purchases, repurchase shares originally sold by that syndicate member.

Purchases to cover short positions and stabilizing purchases, as well as other purchases by the underwriters for their own accounts, may have the effect of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of the shares. They may also cause the price of the shares to be higher than the price that would otherwise exist in the open market in the absence of these transactions. The underwriters may conduct these transactions on the NYSE, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise. If the underwriters commence any of these transactions, they may discontinue them at any time.

 

177


Table of Contents

The underwriters and their respective affiliates have, from time to time, performed, and may in the future perform, investment banking, commercial banking and financial advisory services for us and our affiliates, for which they received or will receive customary fees and expenses.

We have agreed to indemnify the underwriters against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, or to contribute to payments the underwriters may be required to make because of any of those liabilities.

Notice to Prospective Investors in the European Economic Area

In relation to each member state of the European Economic Area which has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a “Relevant Member State”), with effect from and including the date on which the Prospectus Directive is implemented in that Relevant Member State, no offer of shares may be made to the public in that Relevant Member State other than:

 

  (A) to any legal entity which is a qualified investor as defined in the Prospectus Directive (as defined below);

 

  (B) to fewer than 100 or, if the Relevant Member State has implemented the relevant provision of the 2010 PD Amending Directive, 150, natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors as defined in the Prospectus Directive), as permitted under the Prospectus Directive, subject to obtaining the prior consent of the underwriters; or

 

  (C) in any other circumstances falling within Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive,

provided that no such offer of shares shall require us or the underwriters to publish a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive or supplement a prospectus pursuant to Article 16 of the Prospectus Directive.

Each person in a Relevant Member State (other than a Relevant Member State where there is a Permitted Public Offer) who initially acquires any shares or to whom any offer is made will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed that (A) it is a “qualified investor” within the meaning of the law in that Relevant Member State implementing Article 2(1)(e) of the Prospectus Directive, and (B) in the case of any shares acquired by it as a financial intermediary, as that term is used in Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive, the shares acquired by it in the offering have not been acquired on behalf of, nor have they been acquired with a view to their offer or resale to, persons in any Relevant Member State other than “qualified investors” as defined in the Prospectus Directive, or in circumstances in which the prior consent of the has been given to the offer or resale. In the case of any shares being offered to a financial intermediary as that term is used in Article 3(2) of the Prospectus Directive, each such financial intermediary will be deemed to have represented, acknowledged and agreed that the shares acquired by it in the offer have not been acquired on a nondiscretionary basis on behalf of, nor have they been acquired with a view to their offer or resale to, persons in circumstances which may give rise to an offer of any shares to the public other than their offer or resale in a Relevant Member State to qualified investors as so defined or in circumstances in which the prior consent of has been obtained to each such proposed offer or resale.

This Prospectus has been prepared on the basis that any offer of shares in any Relevant Member State will be made pursuant to an exemption under the Prospectus Directive from the requirement to publish a prospectus for offers of shares. Accordingly any person making or intending to make an offer in that Relevant Member State of shares which are the subject of the offering contemplated in this Prospectus may only do so in circumstances in which no obligation arises for any of the underwriters or us to publish a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive in relation to such offer. Neither the Company nor the underwriters have authorized, nor do they authorize, the making of any offer of shares in circumstances in which an obligation arises for the Company or the underwriters to publish a prospectus for such offer.

For the purpose of the above provisions, the expression “an offer to the public” in relation to any shares in any Relevant Member State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information

 

178


Table of Contents

on the terms of the offer and the shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe the shares, as the same may be varied in the Relevant Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in the Relevant Member State and the expression “Prospectus Directive” means Directive 2003/71/EC (including the 2010 PD Amending Directive, to the extent implemented in the Relevant Member States) and includes any relevant implementing measure in the Relevant Member State and the expression “2010 PD Amending Directive” means Directive 2010/73/EU.

Notice to Prospective Investors in the United Kingdom

In the United Kingdom, this Prospectus is being distributed only to, and is directed only at, and any offer subsequently made may only be directed at persons who are “qualified investors” (as defined in the Prospectus Directive) (i) who have professional experience in matters relating to investments falling within Article 19(5) of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (Financial Promotion) Order 2005, as amended (the “Order”), and/or (ii) who are high net worth companies (or persons to whom it may otherwise be lawfully communicated) falling within Article 49(2)(a) to (d) of the Order (all such persons together being referred to as “relevant persons”). This Prospectus must not be acted on or relied on in the United Kingdom by persons who are not relevant persons. In the United Kingdom, any investment or investment activity to which this Prospectus relates is only available to, and will be engaged in with, relevant persons.

Notice to Prospective Investors in Hong Kong

The shares may not be offered or sold in Hong Kong by means of any document other than (i) in circumstances which do not constitute an offer to the public within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32, Laws of Hong Kong), or (ii) to “professional investors” within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571, Laws of Hong Kong) and any rules made thereunder, or (iii) in other circumstances which do not result in the document being a “prospectus” within the meaning of the Companies Ordinance (Cap. 32, Laws of Hong Kong) and no advertisement, invitation or document relating to the shares may be issued or may be in the possession of any person for the purpose of issue (in each case whether in Hong Kong or elsewhere), which is directed at, or the contents of which are likely to be accessed or read by, the public in Hong Kong (except if permitted to do so under the laws of Hong Kong) other than with respect to shares which are or are intended to be disposed of only to persons outside Hong Kong or only to “professional investors” within the meaning of the Securities and Futures Ordinance (Cap. 571, Laws of Hong Kong) and any rules made thereunder.

Notice to Prospective Investors in Singapore

This Prospectus has not been registered as a prospectus with the Monetary Authority of Singapore. Accordingly, this Prospectus and any other document or material in connection with the offer or sale, or invitation for subscription or purchase, of the shares may not be circulated or distributed, nor may the shares be offered or sold, or be made the subject of an invitation for subscription or purchase, whether directly or indirectly, to persons in Singapore other than (i) to an institutional investor under Section 274 of the Securities and Futures Act, Chapter 289 of Singapore (the “SFA”), (ii) to a relevant person, or any person pursuant to Section 275(1A), and in accordance with the conditions, specified in Section 275 of the SFA or (iii) otherwise pursuant to, and in accordance with the conditions of, any other applicable provision of the SFA.

Notice to Prospective Investors in Australia

No prospectus or other disclosure document (as defined in the Corporations Act 2001 (Cth) of Australia (‘‘Corporations Act’’)) in relation to the common stock has been or will be lodged with the Australian Securities & Investments Commission (‘‘ASIC’’). This document has not been lodged with ASIC and is only directed to certain categories of exempt persons. Accordingly, if you receive this document in Australia:

 

  (a) you confirm and warrant that you are either:

 

  (i) a ‘‘sophisticated investor’’ under section 708(8)(a) or (b) of the Corporations Act;

 

179


Table of Contents
  (ii) a ‘‘sophisticated investor’’ under section 708(8)(c) or (d) of the Corporations Act and that you have provided an accountant’s certificate to us which complies with the requirements of section 708(8)(c)(i) or (ii) of the Corporations Act and related regulations before the offer has been made;

 

  (iii) a person associated with the company under section 708(12) of the Corporations Act; or

 

  (iv) a ‘‘professional investor’’ within the meaning of section 708(11)(a) or (b) of the Corporations Act, and to the extent that you are unable to confirm or warrant that you are an exempt sophisticated investor, associated person or professional investor under the Corporations Act any offer made to you under this document is void and incapable of acceptance; and

 

  (b) you warrant and agree that you will not offer any of the common stock for resale in Australia within 12 months of that common stock being issued unless any such resale offer is exempt from the requirement to issue a disclosure document under section 708 of the Corporations Act.

 

180


Table of Contents

LEGAL MATTERS

Certain legal matters relating to this offering will be passed upon for the Company by Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP, New York, New York. Certain legal matters in connection with this offering will be passed upon for the underwriters by Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, New York, New York.

EXPERTS

Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, has audited the consolidated financial statements and schedule of New Media Investment Group Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) at December 29, 2013 (Successor) and December 30, 2012 (Predecessor) and for the period from November 7, 2013 to December 29, 2013 (Successor), the period from December 31, 2012 through November 6, 2013 (Predecessor), and for each of the two years in the period ended December 30, 2012 (Predecessor), as set forth in their report. The Company has included the consolidated financial statements and schedule in the Prospectus and elsewhere in the registration statement in reliance on Ernst & Young LLP’s report, given on their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.

Ernst & Young LLP, independent auditors, has audited the combined financial statements of Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc. at June 30, 2013 and 2012, and for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013, as set forth in their report. The Company has included the Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc. financial statements in the Prospectus and elsewhere in the registration statement in reliance on Ernst & Young LLP’s report, given on their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.

The consolidated financial statements of The Providence Journal Company as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2013, have been included herein in reliance upon the report of KPMG LLP, independent auditors, appearing elsewhere herein, and upon the authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

We have filed a registration statement on Form S-1 to register with the SEC the shares of our Common Stock to be sold in this offering. This document constitutes a part of that registration statement, together with all amendments, supplements, schedules and exhibits to the registration statement.

This Prospectus does not contain all of the information in the registration statement. Each statement contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any contract, agreement or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement is qualified in its entirety by reference to that exhibit for a more complete description of the matter involved. We are subject to the information and periodic reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, and we are required to file annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC.

Our SEC filings, including our registration statement may be read and copied at the SEC’s public reference room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the public reference room. The SEC maintains a website at http://www.sec.gov that contains reports, proxy and registration statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC. New Media maintains a website at http://www.newmediainv.com/. The information contained on or accessible through our website or the SEC’s website shall not be deemed to be a part of this Prospectus or the registration statement of which this Prospectus forms a part.

 

181


Table of Contents

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

     Page  

Consolidated Financial Statements of New Media Investment Group Inc.:

  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-2   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December  29, 2013 (Successor Company) and December 30, 2012 (Predecessor Company)

     F-3   

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the two months ended December  29, 2013 (Successor Company), the ten months ended November 6, 2013 (Predecessor Company) and the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 (Predecessor Company)

     F-4   

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity (Deficit) for the two months ended December 29, 2013 (Successor Company), the ten months ended November 6, 2013 (Predecessor Company) and the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 (Predecessor Company)

     F-5   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the two months ended December 29, 2013 (Successor Company), the ten months ended November 6, 2013 (Predecessor Company) and the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 (Predecessor Company)

     F-6   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-7   

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements of New Media Investment Group Inc.:

  

Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 29, 2014 (unaudited) and December 29, 2013

     F-57   

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 (Successor Company) and June 30, 2013 (Predecessor Company)

     F-58   

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statement of Stockholders’ Equity for the six months ended June 29, 2014

     F-59   

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the six months ended June 29, 2014 (Successor Company) and June 30, 2013 (Predecessor Company)

     F-60   

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-61   

Combined Financial Statements of Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

  

Report of Independent Auditors

     F-85   

Combined Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2013 and 2012

     F-86   

Combined Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013

     F-87   

Combined Statements of Equity for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013

     F-88   

Combined Statements of Cash Flows for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013

     F-89   

Notes to Combined Financial Statements

     F-90   

Consolidated Financial Statements of The Providence Journal Company:

  

Independent Auditors’ Report

     F-107   

Independent Auditors’ Review Report

     F-108   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2014 (unaudited) and as of December  31, 2013 and 2012 (audited)

     F-109   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the sixth month periods ended June  30, 2014 and 2013 (unaudited) and for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2013 (audited)

     F-110   

Consolidated Statements of Equity for the sixth month period ended June  30, 2014 (unaudited) and for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2013 (audited)

     F-111   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the sixth month periods ended June  30, 2014 and 2013 (unaudited) and for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2013 (audited)

     F-112   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-113   

 

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

The Board of Directors and Stockholders of

New Media Investment Group Inc.

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of New Media Investment Group Inc. and subsidiaries (formerly known as GateHouse Media, Inc.) as of December 29, 2013 (Successor) and December 30, 2012 (Predecessor), and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss), stockholders’ equity (deficit), and cash flows for the period from November 7, 2013 to December 29, 2013 (Successor), the period from December 31, 2012 through November 6, 2013 (Predecessor), and for each of the two years in the period ended December 30, 2012 (Predecessor). Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 15(a). These financial statements and schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and schedule based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

As discussed in Note 1, 2 and 3 to the consolidated financial statements on November 6, 2013, the Bankruptcy Court entered an order confirming the plan of reorganization, which became effective November 26, 2013. Accordingly, the accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with Accounting Standards Codification 852-10, “Reorganizations”, for the Successor Company as a new entity with assets, liability and a capital structure having carrying amounts not comparable with prior periods as described in Note 1, 2 and 3.

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of New Media Investment Group Inc. and subsidiaries at December 29, 2013 (Successor) and December 30, 2012 (Predecessor), and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for the period from November 7, 2013 to December 29, 2013 (Successor), the period from December 31, 2012 through November 6, 2013 (Predecessor), and for each of the two years in the period ended December 30, 2012 (Predecessor), in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

 

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP
Rochester, New York
March 19, 2014

 

F-2


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(In thousands, except share data)

 

     Successor
Company
December 29,
2013
         Predecessor
Company
December 30,
2012
 
ASSETS         

Current assets:

        

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31,811          $ 34,527   

Restricted cash

     6,477            6,467   

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $349 and $2,456 at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, respectively

     71,401            54,692   

Inventory

     7,697            6,019   

Prepaid expenses

     7,986            5,815   

Other current assets

     11,799            8,215   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total current assets

     137,171            115,735   

Property, plant, and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of $5,539 and $128,208 at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, respectively

     270,187            116,510   

Goodwill

     125,911            13,742   

Intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization of $1,049 and $196,878 at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, respectively

     145,401            218,981   

Deferred financing costs, net

     8,297            1,719   

Other assets

     2,363            2,605   

Assets held for sale

     623            474   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 689,953          $ 469,766   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)         

Current liabilities:

        

Current portion of long-term liabilities

   $ 699          $ 853   

Current portion of long-term debt

     4,312            6,648   

Accounts payable

     10,973            9,396   

Accrued expenses

     54,990            26,258   

Accrued interest

     828            4,665   

Deferred revenue

     30,620            25,217   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     102,422            73,037   

Long-term liabilities:

        

Long-term debt

     177,703            1,167,450   

Long-term liabilities, less current portion

     4,405            2,347   

Derivative instruments

     —             45,724   

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations

     10,061            15,367   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     294,591            1,303,925   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity (deficit):

        

Common stock, $0.01 par value, 2,000,000,000 and 150,000,000 shares authorized at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, respectively; 30,000,000 and 58,313,868 issued, and 30,000,000 and 58,077,031 outstanding at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, respectively

     300            568   

Additional paid-in capital

     387,398            831,344   

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

     458            (52,642

Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)

     7,206            (1,610,917

Treasury stock, at cost, 0 and 236,837 shares at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, respectively

     —              (310
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total New Media stockholders’ equity (deficit)

     395,362            (831,957

Noncontrolling interest

     —              (2,202
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity (deficit)

     395,362            (834,159
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity (deficit)

   $ 689,953          $ 469,766   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-3


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

(In thousands, except per share data)

 

    Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
 

Revenues:

           

Advertising

  $ 63,340          $ 265,078      $ 330,881      $ 357,134   

Circulation

    29,525            118,810        131,576        131,879   

Commercial printing and other

    10,366            29,402        26,097        25,657   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

    103,231            413,290        488,554        514,670   

Operating costs and expenses:

           

Operating costs

    56,614            232,066        268,222        281,884   

Selling, general, and administrative

    28,749            136,832        145,020        146,295   

Depreciation and amortization

    6,588            33,409        39,888        42,426   

Integration and reorganization costs

    1,758            1,577        4,393        5,884   

Impairment of long-lived assets

    —              91,599        —          1,733   

Loss on sale of assets

    27            1,163        1,238        455   

Goodwill impairment

    —              —          —          385   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

    9,495            (83,356     29,793        35,608   

Interest expense

    1,640            74,358        57,928        58,309   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    171            842        1,255        1,360   

Loss (gain) on derivative instruments

    —              14        (1,635     (913

Other (income) expense

    (13         1,004        (85     (395

Reorganization items, net

    —              (947,617     —          —     
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes

    7,697            788,043        (27,670     (22,753

Income tax expense (benefit)

    491            (197     (207     (1,803
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations

    7,206            788,240        (27,463     (20,950

Loss from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

    —              (1,034     (2,340     (699
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

    7,206            787,206        (29,803     (21,649

Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

    —              208        —          —     
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to New Media

  $ 7,206          $ 787,414      $ (29,803   $ (21,649
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) per share:

           

Basic and Diluted:

           

Income (loss) from continuing operations attributable to New Media

  $ 0.24          $ 13.58      $ (0.47   $ (0.36

Net income (loss) attributable to New Media

  $ 0.24          $ 13.56      $ (0.51   $ (0.37

Other comprehensive income:

           

Derivative instrument items:

           

Gain on derivative instruments, net of income taxes of $0

  $ —            $ 19,339      $ 4,364      $ 11,052   

Reclassification of accumulated other comprehensive loss related to derivative instruments, net of income taxes of $0

    —              26,313        —          —     
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivative items, net of income taxes of $0

    —              45,652        4,364        11,052   

Pension and other postretirement benefit items:

           

Net actuarial gain (loss)

    458            69        (2,530     (2,663

Amortization of net actuarial loss

    —              —          383        83   

Amortization of prior service credit

    —              —          (457     (457

Other adjustment

    —              —          (43     240   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total pension and other postretirement benefit items, net of income taxes of $0

    458            69        (2,647     (2,797
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income, net of tax

    458            45,721        1,717        8,255   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

    7,664            832,927        (28,086     (13,394

Comprehensive loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

    —              (208     —          —     
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to New Media

  $ 7,664          $ 833,135      $ (28,086   $ (13,394
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-4


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)

(In thousands, except share data)

 

    Common stock     Additional
paid-in capital
    Accumulated other
comprehensive
income (loss)
    Retained
earnings
(accumulated

deficit)
    Treasury stock     Non-
controlling
interest
in
subsidiary
       
    Shares     Amount           Shares     Amount       Total  

Balance at December 31, 2010, Predecessor Company

    58,313,868      $ 568      $ 830,787      $ (62,614   $ (1,559,465     235,261      $ (310   $ (1,087   $ (792,121

Net loss

    —          —          —          —          (21,649     —          —          (579     (22,228

Gain on derivative instruments, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          11,052        —          —          —          —          11,052   

Net actuarial loss and prior service cost, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          (2,797     —          —          —          —          (2,797

Non-cash compensation expense

    —          —          462        —          —          —          —          —          462   

Purchase of treasury stock

    —          —          —          —          —          1,576        —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at January 1, 2012, Predecessor Company

    58,313,868      $ 568      $ 831,249      $ (54,359   $ (1,581,114     236,837      $ (310   $ (1,666   $ (805,632
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

    —          —          —          —          (29,803     —          —          (536     (30,339

Gain on derivative instruments, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          4,364        —          —          —          —          4,364   

Net actuarial loss and prior service cost, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          (2,647     —          —          —          —          (2,647

Non-cash compensation expense

    —          —          95        —          —          —          —          —          95   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

    58,313,868      $ 568      $ 831,344      $ (52,642   $ (1,610,917     236,837      $ (310   $ (2,202   $ (834,159
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

    —          —          —          —          787,414        —          —          (208     787,206   

Gain on derivative instruments, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          19,339        —          —          —          —          19,339   

Reclassification of accumulated other comprehensive loss related to derivative instruments, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          26,313        —          —          —          —          26,313   

Net actuarial loss and prior service cost, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          69        —          —          —          —          69   

Non-cash compensation expense

    —          —          25        —          —          —          —          —          25   

Disposal of non wholly owned subsidiary

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          2,202       2,202   

Cancellation of Predecessor Company common stock, net of fair value of new warrants of $995

    (58,313,868     (568     (830,374     —          830,632        (236,837 )     310       —          —     

Elimination of Predecessor Company accumulated deficit and accumulated other comprehensive income

    —          —          —          6,921        (7,129     —          —          208        —     

Issuance of new common stock and contribution of Local Media in connection with emergence from Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code

    30,000,000        300        535,403        —          —          —          —          —          535,703   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at November 6, 2013, Predecessor Company

    30,000,000      $ 300      $ 536,398      $ —        $ —          —        $ —        $ —        $ 536,698   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

    —          —          —          —          7,206        —          —          —          7,206   

Net actuarial gain and prior service cost, net of income taxes of $0

    —          —          —          458        —          —          —          —          458   

Common stock cash dividends

    —          —          (149,000     —          —          —          —          —          (149,000
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 29, 2013, Successor Company

    30,000,000      $ 300      $ 387,398      $ 458      $ 7,206        —        $ —        $ —        $ 395,362   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(In thousands)

 

    Successor
Company
         Predecessor Company  
    Two Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year ended
December 30,
2012
    Year ended
January 1,
2012
 

Cash flows from operating activities:

           

Net income (loss)

  $ 7,206          $ 787,206      $ (29,803   $ (21,649

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

           

Depreciation and amortization

    6,588            33,466        40,627        43,393   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    171            842        1,255        1,360   

Loss (gain) on derivative instruments

    —              14        (1,635     (913

Non-cash compensation expense

    —              25        95        462   

Non-cash interest expense

    15            —          —          —     

Non-cash reorganization costs, net

    —              (954,605     —          —     

Non-cash interest related to unrealized losses upon designation of cash flow hedges

    —              26,313        —          —     

Loss on sale of assets

    27            2,318        1,270        806   

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations

    —              (1,137     (939     (1,859

Impairment of long-lived assets

    —              91,599        2,128        2,051   

Goodwill impairment

    —              —          216        385   

Changes in assets and liabilities:

           

Accounts receivable, net

    (7,075         4,210        3,448        2,478   

Inventory

    (247         105        (2     1,714   

Prepaid expenses

    173            (1,594     9,605        (4,977

Other assets

    232            (2,498     (1,903     (585

Accounts payable

    726            243        1,322        2,311   

Accrued expenses

    8,277            4,852        (1,789     (1,731

Accrued interest

    656            4,283        1,789        71   

Deferred revenue

    (665         (868     (1,597     (177

Other long-term liabilities

    76            (746     (588     (701
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

    16,160            (5,972     23,499        22,439   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

           

Purchases of property, plant, and equipment

    (1,536         (3,632     (4,687     (3,330

Proceeds from sale of publications, other assets and insurance

    159            833        3,643        2,599   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

    (1,377         (2,799     (1,044     (731
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

           

Payment of debt issuance costs

    (3,690         —          —          —     

Net borrowings under credit facilities

    149,000            —          —          —     

Capital contribution to Local Media

    —              1,610        —          —     

Repayments under current portion of long-term debt

    —              (6,648     (4,600     (11,249

Repayments under long-term debt

    —              —          (2,540     —     

Payment of dividends

    (149,000         —          —          —     
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in financing activities

    (3,690         (5,038     (7,140     (11,249
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    11,093            (13,809     15,315        10,459   

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

    20,718            34,527        19,212        8,753   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  $ 31,811          $ 20,718      $ 34,527      $ 19,212   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental disclosures on cash flow information:

           

Cash interest paid

  $ 925          $ 43,606      $ 55,976      $ 58,225   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share data)

(1) Description of Business, Basis of Presentation and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

(a) Description of Business

New Media Investment Group Inc. (“New Media,” “Company,” “us,” or “we”), formerly known as GateHouse Media, Inc. (“GateHouse” or “Predecessor”), was formed as a Delaware corporation on June 18, 2013. New Media was capitalized and issued 1,000 common shares to Newcastle Investment Corp. (“Newcastle”). Newcastle owned approximately 84.6% of New Media until February 13, 2014, upon which date Newcastle distributed the shares that it held in New Media to its shareholders on a prorata basis. New Media had no operations until November 26, 2013, when it assumed control of GateHouse and Local Media Group Holdings LLC (“Local Media Parent”). The Company’s Predecessor and certain of its subsidiaries (collectively, the “Debtors”) filed voluntary petitions under Chapter 11 of title 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code (the “Bankruptcy Code”), in the U.S. Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware (the “Bankruptcy Court”) on September 27, 2013. On November 6, 2013 (the “Confirmation Date”), the Bankruptcy Court confirmed the plan of reorganization (the “Plan” or Plan of Reorganization) and on November 26, 2013 (the “Effective Date”), the Debtors emerged from Chapter 11.

GateHouse was determined to be the predecessor to New Media, as the operations of GateHouse comprise substantially all of the business operations of the combined entities. As such, the consolidated financial statements presented herein for all periods prior to November 6, 2013 reflect the historical consolidated financial statements of GateHouse and its subsidiaries. Further, the Reorganization Value, as defined below, of GateHouse at the Confirmation Date, as defined below, approximated fair value as of November 26, 2013. The Company is a leading U.S. publisher of local newspapers and related publications that are generally the dominant source of local news and print advertising in their markets. As of December 29, 2013, the Company owned and operated 421 publications located in 24 states. The majority of the Company’s paid daily newspapers have been published for more than 100 years and are typically the only paid daily newspapers of general circulation in their respective nonmetropolitan markets. The Company’s publications generally face limited competition as a result of operating in small and midsized markets that can typically support only one newspaper. The Company has strategically clustered its publications in geographically diverse, nonmetropolitan markets in the Midwest and Northeast United States, which limits its exposure to economic conditions in any single market or region.

The Company’s operating segments (Large Community Newspapers, Small Community Newspapers, Local Media Newspapers and Directories) are aggregated into one reportable business segment.

(b) Basis of Presentation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of New Media and its subsidiaries. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated.

As discussed in Note 2, the Debtors emerged from Chapter 11 protection and adopted fresh start accounting in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”), Topic 852, Reorganizations” (“ASC 852”). The adoption of fresh start accounting resulted in the Company becoming a new entity for financial reporting purposes as of November 6, 2013. Accordingly, the consolidated financial statements on November 7, 2013 and subsequent periods are not comparable, in various material respects, to the Company’s consolidated financial statements prior to that date.

Fresh start accounting requires resetting the historical net book value of assets and liabilities to fair value by allocating the entity’s reorganization value (“Reorganization Value”) to its assets and liabilities pursuant to ASC

 

F-7


Table of Contents

Topic 805, “Business Combinations” (“ASC 805”). The excess reorganization value over the fair value of tangible and identifiable intangible assets is recorded as goodwill on the consolidated balance sheet. Deferred taxes are determined in conformity with ASC Topic 740, “Income Taxes” (“ASC 740”).

In addition, ASC 852 requires that financial statements, for periods including and subsequent to a Chapter 11 filing, distinguish transactions and events that are directly associated with the reorganization proceedings and the ongoing operations of the business, as well as additional disclosures. Effective September 27, 2013, expenses, gains and losses directly associated with the reorganization proceedings were reported as reorganization items in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. In addition, liabilities subject to compromise in the Chapter 11 cases were distinguished from liabilities not subject to compromise and from post-petition liabilities. Liabilities subject to compromise were reported at amounts allowed or expected to be allowed under Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings.

The “Company,” when used in reference to the period subsequent to the application of fresh start accounting on November 6, 2013, refers to the “Successor Company,” and when used in reference to periods prior to fresh start accounting, refers to the “Predecessor Company.” Further, references to the “Ten months ended November 6, 2013 refer to the period from December 31, 2012 to November 6, 2013 and references to the “Two months ended December 29, 2013 refer to the period from November 7, 2013 to December 29, 2013.

(c) Recent Developments

The newspaper industry and our Predecessor have experienced declining same store revenue and profitability over the past several years. As a result, the Company’s Predecessor previously implemented, and the Company continues to implement, plans to reduce costs and preserve cash flow. This includes cost reduction programs and the sale of non-core assets. The Company believes these initiatives will provide it with the financial resources necessary to invest in the business and provide sufficient cash flow to enable the Company to meet its commitments for the next year.

(d) Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Examples of significant estimates include fresh start accounting, pension and postretirement benefit obligation assumptions, income taxes and valuation of intangible assets. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

(e) Fiscal Year

The Company’s fiscal year is a 52 week operating year ending on the Sunday closest to December 31. The Company’s 2013 fiscal year ended on December 29, 2013 and encompassed a 52-week period. In 2012 a portion of the Company had 364 days of operations compared to 366 days in 2011. The Company’s 2012 fiscal year ended on December 30, 2012 and encompassed a 53-week period for approximately 60% of the Company.

(f) Accounts Receivable

Accounts receivable are stated at amounts due from customers, net of an allowance for doubtful accounts. The Company’s allowance for doubtful accounts is based upon several factors including the length of time the receivables are past due, historical payment trends and current economic factors. The Company generally does not require collateral.

 

F-8


Table of Contents

(g) Inventory

Inventory consists principally of newsprint, which is valued at the lower of cost or market. Cost is determined using the first-in, first-out (“FIFO”) method. In 2012 and 2013 the Company purchased approximately 75% and 95%, respectively, of its newsprint from one vendor. In 2014 the Company expects to purchases approximately 95% of newsprint from the same vendor.

(h) Property, Plant and Equipment

Property, plant and equipment are recorded at cost. Routine maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred.

Depreciation is calculated under the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives, principally 10 to 30 years for buildings and improvements, 2 to 13 years for machinery and equipment, and 2 to 5 years for furniture, fixtures and computer software. Leasehold improvements are amortized under the straight-line method over the shorter of the lease term or estimated useful life of the asset.

(i) Goodwill, Intangible, and Long-Lived Assets

Intangible assets consist of advertiser, subscriber and customer relationships, mastheads, trade names and publication rights. The excess of acquisition costs over the estimated fair value of tangible and identifiable intangible net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill.

Goodwill is not amortized pursuant to ASC Topic 350 “Intangibles—Goodwill and Other” (“ASC 350”). Mastheads are not amortized because it has been determined that the useful lives of such mastheads are indefinite.

In accordance with ASC 350, goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives are tested for impairment annually or when events indicate that an impairment could exist which may include an economic downturn in a market, a change in the assessment of future operations or a decline in the Company’s stock price. The Company performs an annual impairment assessment on the last day of its fiscal second quarter. As required by ASC 350, the Company performs its impairment analysis on each of its reporting units. The reporting units have discrete financial information which are regularly reviewed by management. The fair value of the applicable reporting unit is compared to its carrying value. Calculating the fair value of a reporting unit requires significant estimates and assumptions by the Company. The Company estimates fair value by applying third-party market value indicators to projected cash flows and/or projected earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, and amortization. In applying this methodology, the Company relies on a number of factors, including current operating results and cash flows, expected future operating results and cash flows, future business plans, and market data. If the carrying value of the reporting unit exceeds the estimate of fair value, the Company calculates the impairment as the excess of the carrying value of goodwill over its implied fair value.

Refer to Note 8 for additional information on the impairment testing of goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets.

The Company accounts for long-lived assets in accordance with the provisions of ASC Topic 360, “Property, Plant and Equipment” (“ASC 360”). The Company assesses the recoverability of its long-lived assets, including property, plant and equipment and definite lived intangible assets, whenever events or changes in business circumstances indicate the carrying amount of the assets, or related group of assets, may not be fully recoverable. Impairment indicators include significant under performance relative to historical or projected future operating losses, significant changes in the manner of use of the acquired assets or the strategy for the Company’s overall business, and significant negative industry or economic trends. The assessment of recoverability is based on management’s estimates by comparing the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows generated by the underlying asset, or other appropriate grouping of assets, to its carrying value to

 

F-9


Table of Contents

determine whether an impairment existed at its lowest level of identifiable cash flows. If the carrying amount of the asset is greater than the expected undiscounted cash flows to be generated by such asset, an impairment is recognized to the extent the carrying value of such asset exceeds its fair value.

(j) Revenue Recognition

Advertising revenue is recognized upon publication of the advertisement. Circulation revenue from subscribers is billed to customers at the beginning of the subscription period and is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the related subscription. Circulation revenue from single-copy income is recognized based on date of publication, net of provisions for related returns. Revenue for commercial printing is recognized upon delivery. Directory revenue is recognized on a straight-line basis over the period in which the corresponding directory is distributed.

(k) Income Taxes

Income taxes are accounted for under the asset and liability method. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date.

The Company has determined that it is more likely than not that its existing deferred tax assets will not be realized, and accordingly has provided a full valuation allowance. Any changes in the scheduled reversals of deferred taxes may require an additional valuation allowance against the remaining deferred tax assets. Any increase or decrease in the valuation allowance could result in an increase or decrease in income tax expense in the period of adjustment.

The Company accounts for uncertain tax positions under the provisions of ASC 740. The Company does not anticipate significant increases or decreases in our uncertain tax positions within the next twelve months. The Company recognizes penalties and interest relating to uncertain tax positions in tax expense.

(l) Fair Value of Financial Instruments

The carrying value of the Company’s cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable, and accrued expenses approximate fair value due to the short maturity of these instruments. An estimate of the fair value of the Company’s debt is disclosed in Note 11.

The Company accounts for derivative instruments in accordance with ASC Topic 815, “Derivatives and Hedging” (“ASC 815”) and ASC Topic 820 “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures” (“ASC 820”). These standards require an entity to recognize all derivatives as either assets or liabilities in the consolidated balance sheet and measure those instruments at fair value. Additionally, the fair value adjustments will affect either accumulated other comprehensive loss or net loss depending on whether the derivative instrument qualifies as an effective hedge for accounting purposes and, if so, the nature of the hedging activity. The fair value of the Company’s derivative financial instruments is disclosed in Note 12.

(m) Cash Equivalents

Cash equivalents represent highly liquid certificates of deposit which have original maturities of three months or less.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

(n) Deferred Financing Costs

Deferred financing costs consist of costs incurred in connection with debt financings. Such costs are amortized on a straight-line basis, which approximates the effective interest method, over the estimated remaining term of the related debt.

(o) Advertising

Advertising costs are expensed in the period incurred. The Company incurred total advertising expenses for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 of $808, $2,693, $3,419 and $2,620, respectively.

(p) Earnings (loss) per share

Basic earnings (loss) per share is computed as net income (loss) available to common stockholders divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Diluted earnings per share reflects the potential dilution that could occur from common shares issued through common stock equivalents.

(q) Stock-based Employee Compensation

ASC Topic 718, “Compensation—Stock Compensation” (“ASC 718”) requires that all share-based payments to employees, including grants of employee stock options, be recognized in the consolidated financial statements over the service period (generally the vesting period) based on fair values measured on grant dates.

(r) Pension and Postretirement Liabilities

ASC Topic 715, “Compensation—Retirement Benefits” (“ASC 715”) requires recognition of an asset or liability in the consolidated balance sheet reflecting the funded status of pension and other postretirement benefit plans such as retiree health and life, with current-year changes in the funded status recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss. For the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, a total of $458, $6,990, $(2,647) and $(2,797) net of taxes of $0, $0, $0 and $0, respectively, was recognized in other comprehensive loss (see Note 16).

(s) Self-Insurance Liability Accruals

The Company maintains self-insured medical and workers’ compensation programs. The Company purchases stop loss coverage from third parties which limits our exposure to large claims. The Company records a liability for healthcare and workers’ compensation costs during the period in which they occur as well as an estimate of incurred but not reported claims.

(t) Reclassifications

Certain amounts in the prior periods consolidated financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

(u) Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

In July 2013, the FASB issued ASU No. 2013-11, “Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists” which requires an unrecognized tax benefit to be presented as a reduction to a deferred tax asset for a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss or a tax credit carryforward that the entity intends to use as of the reporting date. The Company will adopt the provisions of ASU No. 2013-11 in fiscal 2014. The amendments in this Update are not expected to have a material impact on the financial statements.

 

F-11


Table of Contents

(v) Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

The changes in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) by component for the years ended December 30, 2012 and December 29, 2013 are outlined below.

 

     Gain
(loss) on
derivative
instruments
    Net actuarial
loss and prior
service cost(1)
    Total  

Balance at January 1, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ (50,017   $ (4,342   $ (54,359
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

     (24,405     (2     (24,407

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss

     28,771        (2,647     26,124  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current period other comprehensive income, net of taxes

     4,366       (2,649     1,717  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ (45,651   $ (6,991   $ (52,642
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

     (1,109     1       (1,108

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss

     46,760        69        46,829   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current period other comprehensive income, net of taxes

     45,651       70        45,721   

Elimination of Predecessor Company accumulated other comprehensive income

     —         6,921        6,921   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at November 6, 2013, Predecessor Company

   $ —       $ —       $ —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

     —         458       458   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current period other comprehensive income, net of taxes

     —         458       458   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 29, 2013, Successor Company

   $ —       $ 458      $ 458   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) This accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) component is included in the computation of net periodic benefit cost. See Note 16.

The following table presents reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012.

 

     Amounts Reclassified from
Accumulated Other
Comprehensive Income
(Loss)
    Affected Line Item in the
Consolidated Statements
of Operations and
Comprehensive Income
(Loss)
     Two months
ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten months
ended
November 6,
2013
   

Loss on interest rate swap agreements, designated as cash flow hedges

   $ —           $ 20,447      Interest expense

Amortization of prior service cost

     —             (383 )(1)   

Amortization of unrecognized loss

     —             452 (1)   

Reclassification of unrealized losses upon dedesignation of cash flow hedges

     —             26,313      Interest expense
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss

     —             46,829      Loss from continuing
operations before
income taxes

Income tax benefit

     —             —       Income tax benefit
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of taxes

   $ —           $ 46,829      Net income (loss)
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

F-12


Table of Contents

 

(1) This accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) component is included in the computation of net periodic benefit cost. See Note 16.

(2) Voluntary Reorganization Under Chapter 11

Our Predecessor and certain of its subsidiaries commenced voluntary Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings in the Bankruptcy Court on September 27, 2013 (the “Petition Date”). Concurrent with the bankruptcy filing, our Predecessor filed and requested confirmation of the Plan. On September 4, 2013, our Predecessor entered into a restructuring support agreement (“RSA”) with Cortland Products Corp., as administrative agent (the “Administrative Agent”) and certain of the lenders under the 2007 Credit Facility (as defined below), including Newcastle and its affiliates.

Pursuant to its RSA, the Company solicited votes on the Plan from holders of claims under the Company’s 2007 Credit Facility and certain related interest rate swaps. The Plan was accepted by the only impaired class of creditors entitled to vote on it. Specifically, 100% of holders of secured debt voted to accept the Plan. No creditors voted to reject the Plan.

Pension, trade and all other unsecured creditors of the Company were not impaired under the prepackaged Plan, and their votes were not solicited. The Company’s common stock was canceled under the Plan, and holders of secured debt had the option of receiving a cash distribution equal to 40% of their claims, or stock in New Media, a holding company that owns GateHouse and Local Media Parent, as described below.

The key terms of the Plan were as follows:

The Plan proposed a restructuring of the Company pursuant to a pre-packaged restructuring under Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code whereby each Creditor (as defined below) had the option of exchanging its holdings in the Outstanding Debt (as defined below) for either its pro rata share of cash or common stock in New Media (such common stock, “New Media Common Stock”) with ownership interests in the reorganized Company (such reorganized Company, “New GateHouse”).

The Plan included the restructuring of the following indebtedness of the Company (the “Outstanding Debt”):

(a) Indebtedness under the 2007 Credit Facility, consisting of a “Revolving Credit Facility,” a “Term Loan Facility,” a “Delayed Draw Term Loan Facility” and an “Incremental Term Loan Facility” (collectively, the “2007 Credit Facility Claims”). The 2007 Credit Facility Claims consisted of a (i) Revolving Credit Facility of $0 and $0 at December 30, 2012 and September 27, 2013, respectively, (ii) Term Loan Facility of $658,281 and $654,554 at December 30, 2012 and September 27, 2013, respectively, (iii) Delayed Draw Term Loan Facility of $245,627 and $244,236 at December 30, 2012 and September 27, 2013, respectively and (iv) Incremental Term Loan Facility of $270,190 and $268,660 at December 30, 2012 and September 27, 2013, respectively.

(b) Swap Liability, including (i) $100,000 notional amount executed February 27, 2007, (ii) $250,000 notional amount executed April 4, 2007, (iii) $200,000 notional amount executed April 13, 2007 and (iv) $75,000 notional amount executed September 18, 2007. As of December 31, 2012 and September 27, 2013, the carrying value of the Swap Liability totaled $45,724 and $28,440, respectively.

Holders of the Outstanding Debt are referred to herein as “Creditors.”

 

F-13


Table of Contents

The Plan restructured the Outstanding Debt as follows:

(a) Each Creditor of the Outstanding Debt received, in full and final satisfaction of its respective claim, at its election (with respect to all or any portion of its claims) to be made in connection with solicitation of the Plan, its pro rata share of:

i. Cash pursuant to the Cash-Out Offer (described below under “Cash-Out Offer”) (the “Cash-Out Option”); and/or

ii. (A) New Media Common Stock (subject to dilution as discussed herein) and (B) the Net Proceeds (as defined below), net of certain transaction costs (collectively, the “New Media Equity Option”).

Creditors that did not make an election during the Solicitation Period (as defined below) with respect to their claims were deemed to have elected the Cash-Out Option.

(b) Pension, trade and all other unsecured claims were unimpaired by the Plan.

(c) The interest of holders of equity interests in the Company, including warrants, rights and options to acquire such equity interests (“Former Equity Holders”), were cancelled, and Former Equity Holders received 10-year warrants, collectively representing the right to acquire, in the aggregate, equity equal to 5% of the issued and outstanding shares of New Media (the “New Media Warrants”) (subject to dilution) as of the Effective Date, with the strike price per share of $46.35 calculated based on a total equity value of New Media prior to the Local Media Contribution (as defined below) of $1,200,000 as of the Effective Date. New Media Warrants do not have the benefit of antidilution protections, other than customary protections including for stock splits and stock dividends.

Cash-Out Offer

In connection with the Plan, Newcastle (“Plan Sponsor”) (or its designated affiliates) offered to purchase, in cash, an amount equal to 40% of the sum of (a) $1,167,450 of principal of the claims under the 2007 Credit Facility, plus (b) accrued and unpaid interest at the applicable contract non-default rate with respect thereto, plus (c) all amounts due under and subject to the terms of the interest rate swaps secured under the 2007 Credit Facility (for the avoidance of doubt, excluding any default interest) on the Effective Date of the Plan. The Cash-Out Offer was coterminous with the Solicitation Period (as defined below).

Registration Rights

As of the Effective Date of the Plan, New Media entered into a registration rights agreement with certain holders of the Outstanding Debt that received 10% or more of the New Media Common Stock, to provide customary registration rights.

New Media Equity Option

Instead of the Cash-Out Offer, each Creditor could have elected to receive in satisfaction of its claims, a pro rata share of New Media Common Stock and the Net Proceeds (as defined below), net of certain transaction costs. New Media listed New Media Common Stock (the “Listing”) on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) on February 14, 2014 and may raise additional equity capital. The Listing was not a condition precedent to the effectiveness of the Plan. Under the Plan, New Media did not impose any transfer restrictions on New Media Common Stock.

Financing

The Company was to use commercially reasonable efforts based on market conditions and other factors, to raise up to $165,000 of new debt, including a $150,000 facility to fund distributions and other payments under

 

F-14


Table of Contents

the Plan (the “Financing”). The distribution was made to holders of New Media Common Stock, including Plan Sponsor (or its designated affiliates) on account of the Cash-Out Offer, on the Effective Date (the “Net Proceeds”). The Net Proceeds distributed to holders of the Outstanding Debt totaled $149,000. The Financing was not a condition precedent to the effectiveness of the Plan.

Contribution of Local Media Group Holdings LLC

The Plan Sponsor acquired Local Media Group, Inc. (“Local Media”), a publisher of weekly newspaper publications, on September 3, 2013. Subject to the terms of the Plan, the Plan Sponsor contributed Local Media Parent and assigned its rights under the related stock purchase agreement to New Media on the Effective Date (the “Local Media Contribution”) in exchange for shares of New Media Common Stock equal in value to the cost of the Local Media Acquisition (as defined below) (as adjusted pursuant to the Plan) based upon the equity value of New Media as of the Effective Date prior to the contribution.

Management Agreement

On the Effective Date, New Media entered into a management agreement with FIG LLC (the “Manager”) (the “Management Agreement”) pursuant to which the Manager manages the operations of New Media. The annual management fee is 1.50% of New Media’s gross equity as set forth in the Management Agreement and is eligible to receive incentive compensation.

Releases

To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, the restructuring included a full release from liability of the Company, Plan Sponsor, the Administrative Agent, the Creditors, and all current and former direct and indirect members, partners, subsidiaries, affiliates, funds, managers, managing members, officers, directors, employees, advisors, principals, attorneys, professionals, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, agents, and other representatives (including their respective members, partners, subsidiaries, affiliates, funds, managers, managing members, officers, directors, employees, advisors, principals, attorneys, professionals, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, agents, and other representatives) by the Company, Plan Sponsor and the Creditors from any claims or causes of action related to or arising out of the Company, the Outstanding Debt or the Restructuring on or prior to the Effective Date, except for any claims and causes of action for fraud, gross negligence or willful misconduct.

Confirmation of the Plan

On November 6, 2013, the Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Plan.

Investment Commitment Letter

On September 4, 2013 the Plan Sponsor and the Company entered into an investment commitment letter in connection with the restructuring, pursuant to which Plan Sponsor agreed to purchase the Cash-Out Offer claims, described above. The investment commitment letter provides that, on account of the claims purchased in the Cash-Out Offer on the Effective Date of the Plan, Plan Sponsor will receive its pro rata share of (a) New Media Common Stock and (b) Net Proceeds, net of transaction expenses associated with transactions under the Plan.

Liabilities Subject to Compromise

In accordance with ASC 852, the amount of liabilities subject to compromise represents certain liabilities of the Debtors pre-petition claims addressed in connection with the bankruptcy proceedings. Such liabilities are reported at the Debtors’ allowed claim amount, even though they may be settled for lesser amounts.

 

F-15


Table of Contents

Liabilities subject to compromise for the Predecessor Company were as follows:

 

     Predecessor Company
November 6,

2013
 

Accrued interest

   $ 8,769   

Lease termination liability

     886   

Long-term debt

     1,167,450   

Derivative instruments

     28,440   
  

 

 

 

Liabilities subject to compromise

   $ 1,205,545   
  

 

 

 

The Plan effects only the Company’s 2007 Credit Facility and derivative instruments. Refer to Note 11 for additional information. Pension, trade and other unsecured claims were not impaired under the Plan.

Reorganization Items, Net

In accordance with ASC 852 the Company has segregated reorganization items related to the Plan in its consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss). A summary of reorganization items, for the Predecessor Company is presented in the following table:

 

     Predecessor Company
Ten Months Ended
November 6,

2013
 

Write-off of deferred financing costs

   $ 948   

Credit agreement amendment fees

     6,790   

Bankruptcy fees

     11,643   

Net gain on reorganization adjustments

     (722,796

Net gain on fresh start adjustments

     (246,243

Adjustment to the allowed claim for derivative instruments

     2,041   
  

 

 

 

Reorganization items, net

   $ (947,617
  

 

 

 

For the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013, the Company paid approximately $6,988 for reorganization items.

(3) Fresh Start Accounting

Upon confirmation of the Plan by the Bankruptcy Court on November 6, 2013, the Company satisfied the remaining material conditions to complete the implementation of the Plan, and as a result, the Company adopted fresh start accounting as (i) the reorganization value of the assets of the Successor Company immediately before the date of confirmation of the Plan was less than the total of all post-petition liabilities and allowed claims and (ii) the holders of the Predecessor Company’s voting shares immediately before confirmation of the Plan received less than 50% of the voting shares of the emerging entity.

The Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Plan based upon an estimated enterprise value of the Company between $385,000 and $515,000, which was estimated using various valuation methods, including (i) a comparison of the Company and its projected performance to the market values of comparable companies; (ii) a review and analysis of several recent transactions of companies in similar industries to the Company; and (iii) a calculation of the present value of the future cash flows of the Company based on its projections. The Company concluded the enterprise value was $489,931 based upon the Cash-Out Offer and equity distribution plus estimated transaction fees.

 

F-16


Table of Contents

The determination of the estimated reorganization value was based on a discounted cash flow analysis. This value was reconciled to the transaction value as outlined within the Plan and was within a reasonable range of comparable market multiples. The assumptions used in the calculations for the discounted cash flow analysis included projected revenue, costs, and cash flows through 2016 and represented the Company’s best estimates at the time the analysis was prepared. The discounted cash flow method reflects the following assumptions: (i) terminal value, which was determined using a growth model that applied a long-term growth rate of 0.0% to GateHouse’s projected cash flows beyond 2016. The long-term growth rate was based on GateHouse’s internal projections as well as industry growth prospects; (ii) discount rates that considered various factors including bond yields, risk premiums, and tax rates to determine a weighted-average cost of capital (“WACC”), which represents a company’s cost of debt and equity weighted by the percentage of debt and equity in a company’s target capital structure. A WACC of 15% was used; and (iii) an effective tax rate of 39.15% and an assumed carry-over tax basis of $683,200 for fixed assets and intangibles. A deferred tax asset is not reflected within the fresh start opening balances given GateHouse’s history of losses. While the Company considers such estimates and assumptions reasonable, they are inherently subject to significant business, economic and competitive uncertainties, many of which are beyond the Company’s control and, therefore, may not be realized.

Upon adoption of fresh start accounting, the recorded amounts of assets and liabilities were adjusted to reflect their estimated fair values. Accordingly, the reported historical financial statements of the Predecessor Company prior to the adoption of fresh start accounting for periods ended on or prior to November 6, 2013 are not comparable to those of the Successor Company.

In applying fresh start accounting, the Company followed these principles:

The Reorganization Value, which represents the concluded enterprise value plus excess cash and cash equivalents and non-interesting bearing liabilities, of the Predecessor was allocated to the entity’s net assets in conformity with ASC 805. The Reorganization Value exceeded the sum of the fair value assigned to assets and liabilities. This excess was recorded as Successor Company goodwill as of November 6, 2013.

Each liability existing as of the fresh start accounting date, other than deferred taxes, has been stated at the fair value, and determined at appropriate risk adjusted interest rates. Deferred taxes were reported in conformity with applicable income tax accounting standards, principally ASC 740.

 

F-17


Table of Contents

The following table identifies the adjustments recorded to the Predecessor’s November 6, 2013 consolidated statement of financial position as a result of implementing the Plan and applying fresh start accounting:

 

     Predecessor
November 6,
2013
    Effects of Plan
Adjustments
    Fresh Start
Adjustments
    Successor
November 6,
2013
 
ASSETS         

Current Assets

        

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 20,718      $ —        $ —        $ 20,718   

Restricted cash

     6,716        —          —          6,716   

Accounts receivable

     64,315        —          —          64,315   

Inventory

     7,450        —          —          7,450   

Prepaid expenses

     9,420        —          —          9,420   

Other current assets

     10,533        —          —          10,533   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Assets

     119,152        —          —          119,152   

Property, plant, and equipment

   $ 176,644        —          97,475 (g)      274,119   

Goodwill

     14,204        725 (a)      110,982 (h)      125,911   

Intangible assets

     113,130        —          33,320 (h)      146,450   

Deferred financing costs, net

     2,061        —          —          2,061   

Other assets

     2,373        —          —          2,373   

Assets held for sale

     474        —          —          474   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Assets

   $ 428,038      $ 725      $ 241,777      $ 670,540   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY (DEFICIT)         

Current Liabilities:

        

Current portion of long-term liabilities

     698      $ —        $ (322 )(i)    $ 376   

Current portion of long-term debt

     813        —          —          813   

Accounts payable

     10,247        —          —          10,247   

Accrued expenses

     45,788        886 (b)      239 (i,j)      46,913   

Accrued interest

     172        —          —          172   

Deferred revenue

     31,348        —          —          31,348   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Current Liabilities

     89,066        886        (83     89,869   

Long-term Liabilities:

        

Long-term debt

     32,188        —          —          32,188   

Long-term liabilities, less current portion

     2,047        —          (1,105 )(j)      942   

Derivative instruments

     —          —          —          —     

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations

     14,120        —          (3,277 )(i)      10,843   

Liabilities subject to compromise

     1,205,545        (1,205,545 )(c)      —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities

     1,342,966        (1,204,659     (4,465     133,842   

Stockholders’ Equity (Deficit):

        

Predecessor common stock

     568        —          (568 )(k)      —     

Successor common stock

     —          300 (d)      —          300   

Additional paid-in capital

     831,369        536,398 (a,d,e)      (831,369 )(k)      536,398   

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (6,921     —          6,921 (k)      —     

Accumulated deficit

     (1,792,749     721,801 (f)      1,070,948 (k)      —     

Treasury stock, at cost

     (310     —          310 (k)      —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total New Media stockholders’ equity (deficit)

     (968,043     1,258,499        246,242        536,698   

Noncontrolling interest

     53,115        (53,115 )(a)      —          —     

Total Stockholders’ Equity (Deficit)

     (914,928     1,205,384        246,242        536,698   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity (Deficit)

   $ 428,038      $ 725      $ 241,777      $ 670,540   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-18


Table of Contents

Effects of Plan Adjustments

 

(a) As part of the Plan, the Plan Sponsor agreed to contribute 100% of the stock of Local Media Parent to New Media and assign its rights under the related stock purchase agreement to New Media in exchange for shares of New Media Common Stock, collectively equal in value to the cost of the Local Media Acquisition (as adjusted pursuant to the Plan) upon the Effective Date. The Company accounted for the consolidation of Local Media under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with ASC 805. Accordingly, the assets acquired and liabilities assumed were recorded at their acquisition date fair values. Any excess of the acquisition value over the fair value of assets acquired and liabilities assumed were allocated to goodwill.

On the Effective Date, the noncontrolling interest of $53,115 is eliminated and recorded as additional paid-in capital as New Media obtained controlling financial interest in Local Media. The adjustment to goodwill results from New Media’s application of ASC 805 on the Effective Date as compared to the previously recognized goodwill recognized by GateHouse upon the consolidation of Local Media on September 3, 2013.

 

(b) The adjustment reclassifies $886 related to rejected lease obligations previously recorded as liabilities subject to compromise (see note (c)). These rejected lease obligations are to be paid by the Successor Company in subsequent periods.
(c) The adjustment to liabilities subject to compromise relates to the extinguishment of the Outstanding Debt and allowed claim on rejected leases. The holders of the Outstanding Debt received a settlement of New Media Common Stock and the allowed claim on rejected leases will be paid in full and has been reclassified to current payables (see note (b)).
(d) This adjustment reflects the Successor Company’s common stock and additional paid-in capital resulting from the exchange of the Outstanding Debt at 40% for New Media Common Stock with a par value of $0.01 plus the value of the contribution of Local Media Parent for a total issuance of 30,000 shares of New Media Common Stock. The issuance of New Media Warrants as described in note (e) to the Former Equity Holders is also included within the additional paid-in capital as follows:

 

Exchange by Plan Sponsor of $549,000 Outstanding Debt acquired other than in the Cash-Out Offer for New Media Common Stock

   $  219,125   

Exchange by Plan Sponsor of $442,000 Outstanding Debt acquired in the Cash-Out Offer for New Media Common Stock

     176,615   

Exchange by debt holders other than Plan Sponsor of $215,000 Outstanding Debt for New Media Common Stock

     86,123   

Contribution by Plan Sponsor of Local Media for New Media Common Stock

     53,840   

New Media Warrants issued to Former Equity Holders

     995   

Impact of classification of issuance of warrants within additional paid in capital

     (995
  

 

 

 

Net impact of stockholders’ equity (deficit)

   $ 535,703   
  

 

 

 

 

(e) Former Equity Holders received New Media Warrants representing the right to acquire equity equal to 5.0% of the issued and outstanding shares of New Media as of the Effective Date of the Plan, with the strike price for such warrants calculated based on a total equity value of New Media, prior to the Local Media contribution, of $1,204,659 as of the Effective Date, subject to adjustment. Existing Predecessor equity values were cancelled under the Plan. The New Media Warrants were valued at $0.73 per share using the Black-Scholes valuation model. Significant assumptions used in determining the fair value of such warrants at issuance included an assumed dividend yield of 6.9%, share price volatility of 41.7% and a risk-free rate of return of 2.7% with a 10 year term. The dividend yield and volatility assumption were based on the implied volatility and historical realized volatility and historical yield for comparable companies. The risk-free rate assumption was based on 10-year U.S. Treasury bond yields. On the Effective Date, Former Equity Holders were deemed to have been issued 1,362,479 New Media Warrants with a value of $995. The New Media Warrants have a strike price of $46.35 per share and expire on November 26, 2023.

 

F-19


Table of Contents
(f) This adjustment reflects the net effect of the transaction related to the consummation of the Plan on Predecessor’s accumulated deficit and accumulated other comprehensive loss. The table below provides a summary of the adjustments to accumulated deficit as it pertains to the Plan:

 

Liabilities subject to compromise eliminated:

  

Secured indebtedness of $1,167,450 and accrued interest outstanding of $8,769

   $ 1,176,219   

Derivative instrument liability

     28,440   

Rejected lease claim

     886   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities subject to compromise eliminated

     1,205,545   

Consideration given:

  

Issuance of New Media common stock

     (481,863

Lease claim accrual

     (886
  

 

 

 

Gain on extinguishment of debt

     722,796   

Issuance of New Media Warrants

     (995
  

 

 

 

Total adjustment to accumulated deficit

   $ 721,801   
  

 

 

 

Fresh Start Adjustments

 

(g) An adjustment of $97,475 was recorded to adjust the net book value of property, plant and equipment to fair value. The Company obtained third party independent appraisals to assist in the determination of the fair values of property, plant and equipment. The property, plant and equipment appraisal included an analysis of recent comparable sales and offerings of land parcels in each of the subject’s markets. The appraised value used the standard accepted appraisal practices and valuation procedures. Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice require that the appraiser consider three basic approaches to value: the cost approach (used for equipment where an active secondary market is not available and building improvements), the direct sales comparison (market) approach (used for land and equipment where an active market is available), and the income approach (used for intangibles). These approaches are based on the cost to reproduce assets, market exchanges for comparable assets and the capitalization of income.
(h) Adjustment eliminated the balance of goodwill, mastheads, and other unamortized intangible assets of the Predecessor Company and records Successor Company intangible assets, including the reorganization value of assets in excess of amounts allocated to identified tangible and intangible assets, also referred to as Successor Company goodwill.

 

GateHouse business enterprise value

   $ 489,931   

Less: Transaction fees

     (7,073

Add: Local Media contribution

     53,840   

Add: Fair value of liabilities excluded from enterprise value

     133,842   

Less: Fair value of tangible assets

     (398,179

Less: Fair value of identified intangible assets

     (146,450
  

 

 

 

Reorganization value of assets in excess of amounts allocated to identified tangible and intangible assets (Successor company goodwill)

   $ 125,911   
  

 

 

 

The following represent the methodologies and significant assumptions used in determining the fair value of intangible assets, other than goodwill.

The Company valued the following intangible assets using the income approach, specifically the excess earnings method: subscriber relationships, advertiser relationships and customer relationships. In determining the fair value of these intangible assets, the excess earnings approach values the intangible asset at the present value of the incremental after-tax cash flows attributable only to the asset after deducting contributory asset charges. The incremental after-tax cash flows attributable to the subject intangible asset are then discounted to their present value. A static pool approach using historical attrition rates was used to

 

F-20


Table of Contents

estimate attrition rates of 5.0% to 7.5% for advertiser relationships, subscriber relationships and customer relationships. The growth rate was estimated to be 0.0% and the discount rates were estimated to range from 14.5% to 17.0% for advertiser relationships and 14.5% to 15.5% for subscriber and customer relationships.

The Company valued mastheads using the income approach, specifically the relief from royalty method. Under this method, the asset values were determined by estimating the hypothetical royalties that would have been paid if the mastheads were not owned. Key assumptions utilized in this valuation include revenue projections, royalty rates of 1.3% to 2.0%, a long term growth rate of 0.0% and discount rates of 14.5% to 16.5%.

(i) A decrease of $3,719 was recorded to measure the pension and post-retirement obligations at fair value. This adjustment primarily reflects the difference between the expected return on plan assets as compared to the fair value of the plan assets and the change in the duration weighted discount rate associated with the payment of the benefit obligations from prior measurement date and the Effective Date. The weighted average discount rate for the pension plan is 4.85% and the postretirement medical plan is 4.3%.
(j) As prescribed in ASC 805, lease arrangements are recognized at fair value as of the Effective Date. This adjustment reflects the elimination of Predecessor leases with escalating payment terms of $1,428. Also reflected is an unfavorable lease of $682. As part of the fresh start valuation, leases were reviewed to determine if terms were favorable or unfavorable. Based on a comparison of contractual lease terms and current market lease rates, eight leases were identified as unfavorable.
(k) The Predecessor Company’s accumulated deficit and accumulated other comprehensive income is eliminated in conjunction with the adoption of fresh start accounting. Also, pursuant to the Plan, Predecessor Company’s common stock and related additional paid in capital were eliminated as all Predecessor Company equity interests were cancelled. The Predecessor Company recognized a $246,242 gain related to the fresh start accounting adjustments as follows:

 

Establishment of Successor Company’s goodwill

   $ (125,911

Elimination of Predecessor Company’s goodwill

     14,204   

Add-back Local Media goodwill adjustment

     725   

Establishment of Successor Company’s other intangible assets

     (146,450

Elimination of Predecessor Company’s other intangible assets

     113,130   

Property, plant and equipment fair value adjustments

     (97,475

Pension and postretirement fair value adjustments

     (3,719

Rent and unfavorable lease fair value adjustments

     (746
  

 

 

 

Gain on fresh start accounting adjustments

   $ (246,242
  

 

 

 

The net effect of the above adjustments on additional paid in capital was $830,374 net of the impact of the classification of the warrants within additional paid in capital of $995.

(4) Local Media Acquisition

On September 3, 2013, Newcastle acquired Local Media. GateHouse entered into a management and advisory agreement with Local Media Parent, which was assigned to Local Media, to manage the operations of Local Media. In return, GateHouse receives compensation including an annual fee and is eligible to earn an annual incentive pay out equal to 12.5% of the EBITDA of Local Media in excess of budget. Although Newcastle owned 100.0% of the equity of Local Media, GateHouse manages the daily operations of Local Media. GateHouse determined that the management and advisory agreement resulted in Local Media being a variable interest entity and GateHouse has the power to direct the activities that most significantly affect the economic performance of the entity. As a result, GateHouse is the primary beneficiary and therefore consolidated Local Media’s financial position and results of operations beginning on September 3, 2013. As 100% of Local Media was owned by Newcastle, the net income (loss) of Local Media was reflected in noncontrolling interest through the Confirmation Date as Newcastle contributed the net assets of Local Media Parent to New Media as part of the Plan, refer to fresh start accounting discussion in Note 3 above.

 

F-21


Table of Contents

The Predecessor accounted for the consolidation of Local Media under the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, the net assets, including noncontrolling interest, were recorded at their fair values. The transaction costs were incurred by Newcastle not GateHouse. The net assets, including goodwill of Local Media were recorded in the consolidated balance sheet at their estimated fair value in accordance with ASC 805. The value allocated in consolidating Local Media, was approximately $83,060 and $2,089 of acquisition related costs were recognized. Local Media Parent contributed a net amount of $53,323 of equity and Local Media entered into a long-term debt agreement for $33,000. Local Media consists of eight daily and fifteen weekly newspapers as well as ten shopper publications, serving areas of New York, Massachusetts, California, Pennsylvania, Oregon and New Hampshire. The results of operations for Local Media were included in the Predecessor’s consolidated financial statements from September 3, 2013.

The following table summarizes estimated the fair values of the Local Media assets and liabilities as of September 3, 2013:

 

Current assets

   $ 18,673   

Property, plant and equipment

     73,718   

Mastheads

     4,100   

Goodwill

     462   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

     96,953   

Current liabilities

     13,893   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     13,893   
  

 

 

 

Net assets

   $ 83,060   
  

 

 

 

The Predecessor obtained third party independent appraisals to assist in the determination of the fair values of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets. The property, plant and equipment appraisal included an analysis of recent comparable sales and offerings of land parcels in each of the subject’s markets. The appraised value is supported with consideration and use of standard accepted appraisal practices and valuation procedures. The appraiser used the three basic approaches to value: the cost approach (used for equipment where an active secondary market is not available and building improvements), the direct sales comparison (market) approach (used for land and equipment where an active secondary market is available) and the income approach (used for intangible assets). These approaches used are based on the cost to reproduce assets, market exchanges for comparable assets and the capitalization of income. Useful lives range from 1 to 7 years for personal property and 17 to 38 years for real property.

The appraisal utilized a relief from royalty method, an income approach, to determine the fair value of mastheads. Key assumptions utilized in this valuation include revenue projections, a royalty rate of 1.5%, long term growth rate of 0%, tax rate of 39.2% and discount rate of 25.0%. Based on estimated discount rates, attrition levels and other available data, the advertiser and subscriber relationships were determined to have a fair value of $0.

Trade accounts receivable, having an estimated fair value of $13,427, were included in the acquired assets. The gross contractual amount of these receivables was $14,937 and the contractual cash flows not expected to be collected was estimated at $1,510 as of the acquisition date.

Local Media accounted for inventory using a weighted cost methodology, which was deemed to approximate fair value. The FIFO valuation method is used and is consistent with the Company’s inventory valuation. The difference between the weighted average and FIFO methodology does not have a material effect on the results of operations.

For the period from the date of acquisition through November 6, 2013 and for the period from November 7, 2013 through December 29, 2013 Local Media had revenues of $24,661 and $28,578, and net income (loss) of ($208) and $2,353, respectively.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

For tax purposes, the amount of goodwill that is expected to be deductible is $1,187 as of December 29, 2013.

The estimated fair values are preliminary pending the finalization of the valuation of the assets acquired, primarily working capital adjustments. The estimated fair values assigned to the net assets of Local Media upon consolidation as of September 3, 2013 approximated their estimated fair values as of the date Local Media was contributed by Newcastle to New Media.

Pro-Forma Results

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statement of operations information for 2013, set forth below, presents the results of operations as if the consolidation of the newspapers from Local Media had occurred on January 2, 2012. The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statement of operations information for 2012, set forth below, presents the results of operations as if the consolidation of the Local Media had occurred on January 2, 2012. These amounts are not necessarily indicative of future results or actual results that would have been achieved had the acquisitions occurred as of the beginning of such period.

 

     Successor
Company
           Predecessor Company  
     Two Months
ended
December 29,

2013
           Ten months
ended
November 6,

2013
     Twelve months
ended
December 30,

2012
 

Revenues

   $ 103,231            $ 516,919       $ 653,266   

Income (loss) from continuing operations

   $ 7,206            $ 747,637       $ (213,519

Income (loss) from continuing operations per common share:

             

Basic

   $ 0.24            $ 12.87       $ (3.68

Diluted

   $ 0.24            $ 12.87       $ (3.68

(5) Share-Based Compensation

As of November 6, 2013, all compensation cost for share-based payments have been recognized.

(a) Restricted Share Grants (“RSGs”)

Prior to the Predecessor’s Initial Public Offering (“IPO”) in 2006, the Predecessor had issued 792,500 RSGs to certain management investors pursuant to each investor’s management stockholder agreement (each, a “Management Stockholder Agreement”). Under the Management Stockholder Agreements, RSGs vest by one-third on each of the third, fourth and fifth anniversaries from the grant date. Following the adoption of the GateHouse Media, Inc. Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan (the “RSG Plan”) in October 2006, an additional 268,680 RSGs were granted during the year ended December 31, 2006 to the Predecessor’s directors, management, and employees. During the year ended December 31, 2007 an additional 198,846 RSGs were granted to the Predecessor’s directors, management and employees, 105,453 of which were both granted and forfeited. During the year ended December 31, 2009 an additional 266,795 RSGs were granted to the Predecessor’s directors, management and employees, 42,535 of which were both granted and forfeited. During the year ended December 31, 2010 an additional 100,000 RSGs were granted to the Predecessor’s management. The majority of the RSGs issued under the RSG Plan vest in increments of one-third on each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the grant date. In the event a grantee of an RSG is terminated by the Predecessor without cause, a number of unvested RSGs immediately vest that would have vested under the normal vesting period on the next succeeding anniversary date following such termination. In the event an RSG grantee’s employment with the Predecessor is terminated without cause within twelve months after a change in control as defined in the applicable award agreement, all unvested RSGs become immediately vested at the termination date. During the period prior to the lapse and removal of the vesting restrictions, a grantee of an RSG will have all of the rights of a stockholder, including without limitation, the right to vote and the right to receive all dividends or other distributions. With respect to the Predecessor employees, the value of the RSGs on the date of issuance is

 

F-23


Table of Contents

recognized as employee compensation expense over the vesting period or through the grantee’s eligible retirement date, if shorter, with an increase to additional paid-in-capital. The Company recognized $25, $95 and $462 for the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, respectively in share-based compensation expense related to RSGs and is recognized in the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss). All RSGs vested prior to the Petition Date and, as a result, all amounts relate to the Predecessor only.

As of November 6, 2013December 30, 2012, and January 1, 2012 there were 0, 25,424, and 84,181 RSGs, respectively, issued and outstanding with a weighted average grant date fair value of $0.00, $6.04, and $3.67, respectively.

RSG activity was as follows:

 

    Predecessor Company  
    Ten Months Ended
November 6, 2013
    Year Ended
December 30, 2012
    Year Ended
January 1, 2012
 
    Number
of RSGs
    Weighted-Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
    Number
of RSGs
    Weighted-Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
    Number
of RSGs
    Weighted-Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
 

Unvested at beginning of year

    25,424      $ 6.04        84,181      $ 3.67        299,560      $ 8.89   

Granted

    —          —          —          —          —          —     

Vested

    (25,424     6.04        (58,757     2.65        (215,379     10.93   

Forfeited

    —          —          —          —          —          —     
 

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Unvested at end of year

    —        $ —          25,424      $ 6.04        84,181      $ 3.67   
 

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

As part of the Plan discussed in Note 2, all Predecessor share-based awards were cancelled. Refer to Note 24 for new stock plans adopted in 2014.

(6) Restructuring

Over the past several years, and in furtherance of the Company’s cost reduction and cash preservation plans outlined in Note 1, the Company has engaged in a series of individual restructuring programs, designed primarily to right size the Company’s employee base, consolidate facilities and improve operations. These initiatives impact all of the Company’s geographic regions and are often influenced by the terms of union contracts within the region. All costs related to these programs, which primarily reflect involuntary severance expense, are accrued at the time of announcement.

Information related to restructuring program activity for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the year ended December 30, 2012 is outlined below.

 

     Severance and
Related Costs
    Other
Costs(1)
    Total  

Balance at January 1, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ 900      $ 426      $ 1,326   

Restructuring provision included in Integration and Reorganization (2)

     3,610        800        4,410   

Cash payments

     (3,826     (1,062     (4,888
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ 684      $ 164      $ 848   

Restructuring provision included in integration and reorganization

     1,539        38        1,577   

Cash payments

     (1,738     (207     (1,945

Balance at November 6, 2013, Predecessor Company

   $ 485      $ (5   $ 480   

Restructuring provision included in Integration and Reorganization

     1,758        —         1,758   

Cash payments

     (501     —         (501
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 29, 2013, Successor Company

   $ 1,742      $ (5   $ 1,737   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-24


Table of Contents

 

(1) Other costs primarily included costs to consolidate operations.
(2) Included above are amounts that were initially recognized in integration and reorganization and were subsequently reclassified to discontinued operations expense at the time the operations ceased.

The restructuring reserve balance as of December 29, 2013, for all programs was $1,737, which is expected to be paid out over the next twelve months.

The following table summarizes the costs incurred and cash paid in connection with these restructuring programs for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the year ended December 30, 2012.

 

     Successor Company          Predecessor Company  
     Two months ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten months ended
November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
 

Severance and related costs (2)

   $ 1,758          $ 1,539      $ 3,610   

Other costs (1)

     —             38        800   

Cash payments

     (501         (1,945     (4,888

 

(1) Other costs primarily included costs to consolidate operations.
(2) Included above are amounts that were initially recognized in integration and reorganization and were subsequently reclassified to discontinued operations expense at the time the operations ceased.

(7) Property, Plant and Equipment

Property, plant and equipment consisted of the following:

 

     Successor
Company
December 29,
2013
         Predecessor
Company
December 30,
2012
 

Land

   $ 23,087          $ 19,384   

Buildings and improvements

     110,941            84,028   

Machinery and equipment

     129,269            118,907   

Furniture, fixtures, and computer software

     11,713            20,673   

Construction in progress and other non-depreciating assets

     716            1,726   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 
     275,726            244,718   

Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization

     (5,539         (128,208
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total

   $ 270,187          $ 116,510   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Depreciation expense for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, for the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 was $5,539, $15,163, $16,305 and $18,550, respectively.

 

F-25


Table of Contents

(8) Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill and intangible assets consisted of the following:

 

     Successor Company December 29, 2013  
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
     Net
Carrying
Amount
 

Amortized intangible assets:

        

Advertiser relationships

   $ 58,520       $ 610       $ 57,910   

Customer relationships

     5,690         59         5,631   

Subscriber relationships

     36,120         375         35,745   

Trade name

     270         5         265   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 100,600       $ 1,049       $ 99,551   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Nonamortized intangible assets:

        

Goodwill

   $ 125,911         

Mastheads

     45,850         
  

 

 

       

Total

   $ 171,761         
  

 

 

       

 

     Predecessor Company December 30, 2012  
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
     Net
Carrying
Amount
 

Amortized intangible assets:

        

Noncompete agreements

   $ 4,970       $ 4,839       $ 131   

Advertiser relationships

     278,543         145,878         132,665   

Customer relationships

     8,940         3,597         5,343   

Subscriber relationships

     82,280         39,226         43,054   

Trade name

     5,493         3,204         2,289   

Publication rights

     345         134         211   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 380,571       $ 196,878       $ 183,693   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Nonamortized intangible assets:

        

Goodwill

   $ 13,742         

Mastheads

     35,288         
  

 

 

       

Total

   $ 49,030         
  

 

 

       

As of December 29, 2013, the weighted average amortization periods for amortizable intangible assets are 15.9 years for advertiser relationships, 16.0 years for customer relationships, 16.0 years for subscriber relationships and 10.0 years for trade names. The weighted average amortization period in total for all amortizable intangible assets is 15.9 years.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

Amortization expense for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 was $1,049, $18,246, $23,583 and $23,876, respectively. Estimated future amortization expense as of December 29, 2013, is as follows:

 

For the years ending the Sunday closest to December 31:

  

2014

   $ 6,292   

2015

     6,292   

2016

     6,292   

2017

     6,292   

2018

     6,292   

Thereafter

     68,091   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 99,551   
  

 

 

 

The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the years ended December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012 are as follows:

 

Gross balance at January 1, 2012

   $ 886,843   

Accumulated impairment losses

     (872,885
  

 

 

 

Net balance at January 1, 2012, Predecessor Company

     13,958   

Goodwill impairment from divestitures (1)

     (216
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

     13,742   

Gross balance at December 30, 2012

     886,843   

Accumulated impairment losses

     (873,101
  

 

 

 

Net balance at December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

     13,742   

Consolidation of Local Media

     462   

Elimination of Predecessor goodwill

     (14,204

Reorganization Plan effects and Fresh Start adjustments

     125,911   
  

 

 

 

Balance at November 6, 2013, Successor Company

     125,911   
  

 

 

 

Net balance at December 29, 2013, Successor Company

   $ 125,911   
  

 

 

 

 

(1) Goodwill impairment was initially recognized in continuing operations and was subsequently reclassified to discontinued operations expense at the time the operations were classified as held for sale.

As of December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, goodwill in the amount $567,086 and $606,013, respectively, was deductible for income tax purposes.

The Company’s annual impairment assessment is made on the last day of its fiscal second quarter.

As part of the annual impairment assessment, as of June 26, 2011, the fair values of the Company’s reporting units for goodwill impairment testing and newspaper mastheads were performed and resulted in no impairment being identified.

Due to an operational management change in the fourth quarter of 2011, certain properties having an allocated goodwill balance of $385 were transferred to a reporting unit that previously did not have a goodwill balance. The Company performed a Step 1 analysis for this reporting unit and determined that its carrying value exceeded fair value. As a result of the Step 2 analysis, the entire $385 of goodwill was impaired. The fair value of this reporting unit for impairment testing purposes was estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows, recent industry transaction multiples and using estimates, judgments and assumptions that

 

F-27


Table of Contents

management believed were appropriate in the circumstances. The estimates and judgments used in the assessment included multiples for revenue and EBITDA, the weighted average cost of capital and the terminal growth rate. Given the then current market conditions, the Company determined that recent transactions provided the best estimate of the fair value of this reporting unit. The Company performed further analysis of this reporting unit’s intangible and long-lived assets and determined that impairments of these assets were not present as of January 1, 2012.

During the first quarter of 2012, the Company reorganized its management structure to align with its publication types. The fair value of goodwill was allocated to each of the new reporting units: Small Community Newspapers, Large Daily Newspapers and Metro Newspapers. The Company determined that impairment indicators were present for the Metro Newspaper reporting unit, which had a goodwill balance of $216. As of April 1, 2012 the Company performed a Step 1 analysis for this reporting unit and determined that its carrying value exceeded fair value. As a result of the Step 2 analysis, the entire $216 of goodwill was impaired and this amount was subsequently reclassified to discontinued operations, see Note 22. The fair value of this reporting unit for impairment testing purposes was estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows, recent industry transaction multiples and using estimates, judgments and assumptions that management believed were appropriate in the circumstances. The estimates and judgments used in the assessment included multiples for revenue and EBITDA, the weighted average cost of capital and the terminal growth rate. Given the then current market conditions, the Company determined that recent transactions provided the best estimate of the fair value of this reporting unit. The Company performed further analysis of this reporting unit’s intangible and long-lived assets and determined that impairments of these assets were not present.

As part of the annual impairment assessments, as of June 30, 2013 and July 1, 2012, the fair values of the Company’s reporting units for goodwill impairment testing and newspaper mastheads were estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows, recent industry transaction multiples and using estimates, judgments and assumptions that management believed were appropriate in the circumstances. The estimates and judgments used in the assessment included multiples for revenue and EBITDA, the weighted average cost of capital and the terminal growth rate. Given the then current market conditions, the Company determined that recent transactions provided the best estimate of the fair value of its reporting units. As a result of the annual assessments performed no impairment of goodwill was identified. Additionally, the estimated fair value exceeded carrying value for all mastheads. The total Company’s estimate of fair value was reconciled to its then market capitalization (based upon the stock market price and fair value of debt) plus an estimated control premium.

The bankruptcy filing was considered a triggering event for the non amortizable intangibles and the Company performed a valuation analysis to determine if an impairment existed as of September 29, 2013. The fair values of the Company’s reporting units for goodwill and newspaper mastheads were estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows, recent industry transaction multiples and using estimates, judgments and assumptions that management believed were appropriate in the circumstances and were consistent with the terms of the Plan. The estimates and judgments used in the assessment included multiples for revenue and EBITDA, the weighted average cost of capital and the terminal growth rate. Given the current bankruptcy Plan, the Company determined that discounted cash flows provided the best estimate of the fair value of its reporting units. The estimated fair values of the Large Daily and the Small Community reporting units exceeded their carrying value and Step 2 of the analysis was not necessary. The estimated fair value of each reporting unit’s mastheads exceeded their carrying values, using consistent assumptions as discussed above. The masthead fair value was estimated using the relief from royalty valuation method.

The Company considered the impairment analysis for goodwill and mastheads, triggered by the bankruptcy filing, to be an indicator of impairment under ASC 360, and performed an analysis of its undiscounted cash flows for amortizable intangibles. For any groups where the carrying value exceeded the undiscounted cash flows a discounted cash flow analysis was performed to determine the amount of the impairment. Key assumptions within this analysis included earnings projections, discount rates, attrition rates, long term growth rates, and effective tax rate that the Company considers appropriate. Earnings projections reflected continued declines in print advertising revenue of 5.0% to 9.0% per year, which is expected to moderate in later years, growth in

 

F-28


Table of Contents

circulation revenue of up to 2.0% per year, and expense declines of up to 4.0% per year. Discount rates ranged from 14.5% to 17.0%, attrition rates ranged from 5.0% to 7.5%, the long term growth rate was 0% and the effective tax rate was 39.15%. The resulting cash flows were reconciled to the projections supporting the Plan.

Due to reductions in the Company’s operating projections during the third quarter in conjunction with the bankruptcy process, an impairment charge of $68,573 was recognized for advertiser relationships within the Company’s Metro and Small Community reporting units, an impairment charge of $19,149 was recognized for subscriber relationships within the Company’s Metro and Small Community reporting units, an impairment charge of $2,077 was recognized for customer relationships within the Company’s Metro reporting unit and an impairment charge of $1,800 was recognized for trade names and publication rights within the Directories business unit. These impairment charges were recorded in the caption “impairment of long-lived assets” on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss). Refer to Note 19 for additional information on the impairment charge. The increase in the fair value of the intangible assets pursuant to fresh start accounting primarily relates to the Company’s Large Dailies reporting unit based on the valuation methodologies, operational outlook, growth rates, discount rates and attrition rates as described above.

As of December 29, 2013, a review of impairment indicators was performed with the Company noting that its financial results and forecast had not changed materially since the fresh start accounting on November 6, 2013 and it was determined that no indicators of impairment were present.

The newspaper industry and the Company have experienced declining same store revenue and profitability over the past several years. Should general economic, market or business conditions decline, and have a negative impact on estimates of future cash flow and market transaction multiples, the Company may be required to record additional impairment charges in the future.

(9) Accrued Expenses

Accrued expenses consisted of the following:

 

     Successor Company
December 29, 2013
         Predecessor Company
December 30, 2012
 

Accrued payroll

   $ 5,235          $ 4,305   

Accrued bonus

     4,011            2,219   

Accrued vacation

     1,355            959   

Accrued insurance

     6,646            6,903   

Accrued legal and professional fees

     16,058            141   

Accrued other (1)

     21,685            11,731   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 
   $ 54,990          $ 26,258   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

 

(1) December 29, 2013 includes $4,626 accrual for Local Media to fund a pension liability that was retained by the seller. The cash was received prior to December 29, 2013 while payment was not made by Local Media until fiscal 2014.

 

F-29


Table of Contents

(10) Lease Commitments

The future minimum lease payments related to the Company’s non-cancelable operating lease commitments as of December 29, 2013 are as follows:

 

For the years ending the Sunday closest to December 31:

  

2014

   $ 4,320   

2015

     3,594   

2016

     3,277   

2017

     3,205   

2018

     2,299   

Thereafter

     1,895   
  

 

 

 

Total minimum lease payments

   $ 18,590   
  

 

 

 

Rental expense under operating leases for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 was $1,121, $4,685, $5,009 and $5,382, respectively.

In addition to minimum lease payments, certain leases require payment of the excess of various percentages of gross revenue or net operating income over the minimum rental payments. The leases generally require the payment of taxes assessed against the leased property and the cost of insurance and maintenance. The majority of lease terms range from 1 to 10 years, and typically, the leases contain renewal options. Certain leases include minimum scheduled increases in rental payments at various times during the term of the lease. These scheduled rent increases are recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease, resulting in an accrual, which is included in accrued expenses, for the amount by which the cumulative straight-line rent exceeds the contractual cash rent.

(11) Indebtedness

Successor Company

GateHouse Credit Facilities

The Revolving Credit, Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “First Lien Credit Facility”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among GateHouse, GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, LLC formerly known as GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, Inc. (“GMIH”), certain wholly-owned subsidiaries of GMIH, all of which are wholly owned subsidiaries of New Media (collectively with GMIH and GateHouse, the “Loan Parties”), PNC Bank, National Association, as the administrative agent, Crystal Financial LLC, as term loan B agent, and each of the lenders party thereto provides for (i) a term loan A in the aggregate principal amount of $25,000, a term loan B in the aggregate principal amount of $50,000, and a revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $40,000 (of which $25,000 was funded on the Effective Date). Borrowings under the First Lien Credit Facility bear interest at a rate per annum equal to (i) with respect to the revolving credit facility, the applicable Revolving Interest Rate (as defined the First Lien Credit Agreement), (ii) with respect to the term loan A, the Term Loan A Rate (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement), and (iii) with respect to the term loan B, the Term Loan B Rate (as defined in the First Lien Credit Agreement). Amounts outstanding under the term loans and revolving credit facility will be fully due and payable on November 26, 2018.

The Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “Second Lien Credit Facility” and together with the First Lien Credit Facility, the “GateHouse Credit Facilities”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among the Loan Parties, Mutual Quest Fund and each of the lenders party thereto provides for a term loan in an aggregate principal amount of $50,000. Borrowings under the Second Lien Credit Facility bear interest, at the Loan Parties’ option, equal to (i) the LIBOR Rate (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Facility) plus 11.00% or (ii) the Alternate Base Rate (as defined in the Second Lien Credit Facility) plus 10.00%. The outstanding principal will be fully due and

 

F-30


Table of Contents

payable on the maturity date of November 26, 2019. The GateHouse Credit Facilities are secured by a first and second priority security interest in substantially all assets of Loan Parties. In addition, the loans and other obligations of the Loan Parties under the GateHouse Credit Facilities are guaranteed by GateHouse Media, LLC. Under the revolving credit facility, the borrowers will also pay a quarterly commitment fee of 0.50% per annum on the unused portion of the revolving credit facility.

No principal payments are due on the revolving credit facility until the maturity date. Principal amounts outstanding under Term Loan A and Term Loan B of the First Lien Credit Facility will be payable in quarterly installments as follows: (I) four consecutive quarterly installments each in the amount of $875, commencing on January 1, 2014, (II) four consecutive quarterly installments each in the amount of $1,250, commencing on January 1, 2015, and (III) twelve consecutive quarterly installments each in the amount $2,000, commencing on January 1, 2016, followed by a final payment of all unpaid principal, accrued and unpaid interest and all unpaid fees and expenses which will be fully due and payable on November 26, 2018. The principal payments will be applied against Term Loan A until fully paid, and then to Term Loan B. The outstanding principal of the Second Lien Credit Facility will be fully due and payable on the maturity date of November 26, 2019. Only interest payments are due under the Second Lien Credit Facility until maturity. The Loan Parties are required to prepay borrowings under the GateHouse Credit Facilities in an amount equal to: (i) 100% of Excess Cash Flow (as defined in the GateHouse Credit Facilities) earned during any fiscal year quarter if the Leverage Ratio (as defined in the GateHouse Credit Facilities) as of the end of such fiscal quarter was greater than or equal to 2.75 to 1.0; (ii) 50% of Excess Cash Flow earned during any fiscal quarter if the Leverage Ratio of the Loan Parties as of the end of such fiscal quarter was less than 2.75 to 1.0 and greater than or equal to 2.5 to 1.0; and (iii) 0% of Excess Cash Flow earned during any fiscal quarter if the Leverage Ratio of the Loan Parties as of the end of such fiscal quarter was not more than 2.5 to 1.0. In addition, in the event of certain asset sales, borrowings or casualty events, the GateHouse Credit Facilities require the Loan Parties to prepay borrowings with the proceeds.

The GateHouse Credit Facilities impose upon GateHouse certain financial and operating covenants, including, among others, requirements that GateHouse satisfy certain financial tests, including a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of not less than 1.0 to 1.0, a maximum leverage ratio of not greater than 3.25 to 1.0, a minimum EBITDA and a limitation on capital expenditures, and restrictions on GateHouse’s ability to incur additional debt, incur liens and encumbrances, consolidate, amalgamate or merge with any other person, pay dividends, dispose of assets, make certain restricted payments, engage in transactions with affiliates, materially alter the business it conducts and taking certain other corporate actions. As of December 29, 2013, GateHouse was in compliance with all applicable covenants and could draw on the revolving credit facility under the First Lien Credit Facility if it chose to do so.

Pursuant to the Plan, holders of the Outstanding Debt who elected to receive New Media Common Stock received their pro rata share of the Proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities, net of certain transaction expenses (the “Net Proceeds”). The Net Proceeds distributed to holders of the Outstanding Debt totaled $149,000. The proceeds of additional drawings of the revolving credit facility under the First Lien Credit Facility after the Effective Date will be applied towards ongoing working capital needs, general corporate purposes, capital expenditures and potential acquisitions. As of December 29, 2013 the revolving credit facility had a weighted average interest rate of 3.42%.

New Media distributed to each holder of New Media Common Stock, including Newcastle on account of the Cash-Out Offer, its pro rata share of the $149,000 in Net Proceeds of the GateHouse Credit Facilities net of certain transaction costs. GateHouse’s entry into the GateHouse Credit Facilities was not a condition to the effectiveness of the Plan.

As of December 29, 2013, GateHouse is in compliance with all of the covenants and obligations under the GateHouse Credit Facilities.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

Local Media Credit Facility

Certain of Local Media’s subsidiaries (together, the “Borrowers”) and Local Media entered into a Credit Agreement, dated as of September 3, 2013, with a syndicate of financial institutions with Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch, as administrative agent (the “Local Media Credit Facility”).

The Local Media Credit Facility provided for: (a) a $33,000 term loan facility that matures on September 4, 2018; and (b) a $10,000 revolving credit facility (subject to the activation condition that Credit Suisse Loan Funding LLC, as lead arranger, assigns the revolving loan commitment to an unaffiliated lender), with a $3,000 sub-facility for letters of credit and a $4,000 sub-facility for swing loans, that matures on September 4, 2018. The revolving credit facility was activated on October 25, 2013. The Borrowers used the proceeds of the Local Media Credit Facility to (a) fund a portion of the acquisition of Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Local Media Acquisition”), (b) provide for working capital and other general corporate purposes of the Borrowers and (c) fund certain fees, costs and expenses associated with the transactions contemplated by the Local Media Credit Facility and consummation of the Local Media Acquisition. The Local Media Credit Facility is secured by a first priority security interest in substantially all assets of the Borrowers and Local Media. In addition, the loans and other obligations of the Borrowers under the Local Media Credit Facility are guaranteed by Local Media Group Holdings LLC.

Borrowings under the Local Media Credit Facility bear interest, at the borrower’s option, equal to the LIBOR Rate (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) plus 6.5% per annum for a LIBOR Rate Loan (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility), or the Base Rate (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) plus 5.5% per annum for a Base Rate Loan (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility). Under the revolving credit facility, the Borrowers will also pay a monthly commitment fee of 0.75% per annum on the unused portion of the revolving credit facility and a fee of 6.0% on the aggregate amount of outstanding letters of credit. As of December 29, 2013, the revolving credit facility had a weighted average interest rate of 7.5%.

No principal payments are due on the revolving credit facility until the maturity date. Principal payments are due on the term loan facility as follows: (a) $203 at the end of each fiscal quarter beginning with the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2013 through the fiscal quarter ending September 30, 2015; and (b) $406 beginning with the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2015 and at the end of each fiscal quarter thereafter with the remaining balance of principal becoming fully due and payable on the maturity date. The Borrowers are required to prepay borrowings under the Local Media Credit Facility in an amount equal to: (i) 100% of expected Excess Cash Flow (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) with respect to a fiscal quarter if the Leverage Ratio (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) of Local Media and the Borrowers as of the end of such fiscal quarter was greater than or equal to 2.0 to 1.0; (ii) 50% of expected Excess Cash Flow with respect to a fiscal quarter if the Leverage Ratio of Local Media and the Borrowers as of the end of such fiscal quarter was less than 2.0 to 1.0 and greater than or equal to 1.75 to 1.0; and (iii) 0% of expected Excess Cash Flow with respect to a fiscal quarter if the Leverage Ratio of Local Media and the Borrowers as of the end of such fiscal quarter was less than 1.75 to 1.0, in each case subject to an annual audit adjustment. In addition, the Borrowers are required to prepay borrowings under the Local Media Credit Facility with (A) net cash proceeds of certain asset dispositions, (B) 100% of Extraordinary Receipts (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility), (C) 100% of net cash proceeds of funded indebtedness (other than indebtedness permitted by the Local Media Credit Facility), and (D) 100% of all Specified Equity Contributions (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) to Local Media.

The Local Media Credit Facility contains financial covenants that require Local Media and the Borrowers to maintain (a) a Leverage Ratio of not more than 2.5 to 1.0 and a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) of at least 2.0 to 1.0, each measured at the end of each fiscal quarter for the four-quarter period then ended. The Local Media Credit Facility contains affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Local Media and the Borrowers customarily found in loan agreements for similar transactions, including, but not limited to, restrictions on their ability to incur indebtedness, create liens on assets, engage in certain lines of business, engage in mergers or consolidations, dispose of assets, make investments or

 

F-32


Table of Contents

acquisitions, engage in transactions with affiliates, pay dividends or make other restricted payments. The Local Media Credit Facility contains customary events of default, including, but not limited to, defaults based on a failure to pay principal, interest, fees or other obligations, subject to specified grace periods (other than with respect to principal); any material inaccuracy of representation or warranty; breach of covenants; default in other material indebtedness; a Change of Control (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility); bankruptcy and insolvency events; material judgments; certain ERISA events; and impairment of collateral. As of December 29, 2013, Local Media is in compliance with all of the covenants and obligations under the Local Media Credit Facility. The Local Media Credit Facility was amended on October 17, 2013 and February 28, 2014. The October 17, 2013 amendment corrected a typographical mistake. The February 28, 2014 amendment provided that among other things, sales of real property collateral and reinvestment of the proceeds from such sale could only be made with the consent of the Administrative Agent, modified the properties included in the real property collateral, and set forth in detail the documentary post-closing requirements with respect to the real property collateral.

Fair Value

The fair value of long-term debt under the GateHouse Credit Facilities was estimated at $150,000 as of December 29, 2013, based on discounted future contractual cash flows and a market interest rate adjusted for necessary risks, including the Company’s own credit risk as there are no rates currently observable in publically traded debt markets of risk with similar terms and average maturities. Accordingly, the Company’s long-term debt under the GateHouse Credit Facilities is classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

The fair value of long-term debt under the Local Media Credit Facility was estimated at $33,000 as of December 29, 2013, based on discounted future contractual cash flows and a market interest rate adjusted for necessary risks, including the Company’s own credit risk as there are no rates currently observable in publically traded debt markets of risk with similar terms and average maturities. Accordingly, the Company’s long-term debt under the Local Media Credit Facility is classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

Payment Schedule

As of December 29, 2013, scheduled principal payments of outstanding debt are as follows:

 

2014

     4,312   

2015

     5,813   

2016

     9,625   

2017

     10,031   

2018

     103,219   

2019

     50,000   
  

 

 

 
   $ 183,000   

Less: Short-term debt

     4,312   

Less: Remaining original issue discount

     985   
  

 

 

 

Long-term debt

   $ 177,703   
  

 

 

 

Predecessor Company

As part of the Restructuring, our Predecessor’s previous long term debt was extinguished pursuant to the Support Agreement on the Effective Date of the Plan.

2007 Credit Facility

GateHouse Media Operating, Inc. (“Operating”), an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, GateHouse Media Holdco, Inc. (“Holdco”), an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, and certain of

 

F-33


Table of Contents

their subsidiaries (together, the “Borrowers”) entered into an Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of February 27, 2007, with a syndicate of financial institutions with Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., successor-by-merger to Wachovia Bank, National Association (“Wells Fargo Bank”), as administrative agent (the “2007 Credit Facility”).

The 2007 Credit Facility, prior to execution of the Second Amendment (defined below), provided for: (a) a $670,000 term loan facility which would have matured on August 28, 2014; (b) a delayed draw term loan facility of up to $250,000 which would have matured on August 28, 2014, and (c) a revolving credit facility with a $40,000 aggregate loan commitment amount available, including a $15,000 sub-facility for letters of credit and a $10,000 swingline facility, which would have matured on February 28, 2014. The Borrowers used the proceeds of the 2007 Credit Facility to refinance existing indebtedness and for working capital and other general corporate purposes, including, without limitation, financing acquisitions permitted under the 2007 Credit Facility. The 2007 Credit Facility was secured by a first priority security interest in: (a) all present and future capital stock or other membership, equity, ownership or profits interest of Operating and all of its direct and indirect domestic restricted subsidiaries; (b) 65% of the voting stock (and 100% of the nonvoting stock) of all present and future first-tier foreign subsidiaries; and (c) substantially all of the tangible and intangible assets of Holdco, Operating and their present and future direct and indirect domestic restricted subsidiaries. In addition, the loans and other obligations of the Borrowers under the 2007 Credit Facility were guaranteed, subject to specified limitations, by Holdco, Operating and their present and future direct and indirect domestic restricted subsidiaries.

Borrowings under the 2007 Credit Facility bear interest, at the borrower’s option, equal to the LIBOR Rate for a LIBOR Rate Loan (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility), or the Alternate Base Rate for an Alternate Base Rate Loan (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility), plus an applicable margin. The applicable margin for the LIBOR Rate term loans and Alternate Base Rate term loans, as amended by the First Amendment (defined below), were 2.00% and 1.00%, respectively. The applicable margin for revolving loans was adjusted quarterly based upon Holdco’s Total Leverage (defined as the ratio of Holdco’s Consolidated Indebtedness (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility) on the last day of the preceding quarter to Consolidated EBITDA (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility) for the four fiscal quarters ending on the date of determination). The applicable margin ranges from 1.50% to 2.00%, in the case of LIBOR Rate Loans and, 0.50% to 1.00% in the case of Alternate Base Rate Loans. Under the revolving credit facility, GateHouse Media was also required to pay a quarterly commitment fee on the unused portion of the revolving credit facility ranging from 0.25% to 0.50% based on the same ratio of Consolidated Indebtedness to Consolidated EBITDA and a quarterly fee equal to the applicable margin for LIBOR Rate Loans on the aggregate amount of outstanding letters of credit. In addition, GateHouse Media was required to pay a ticking fee at the rate of 0.50% of the aggregate unfunded amount available to be borrowed under the delayed draw term facility.

No principal payments were due on the term loan facilities or the revolving credit facility until the applicable maturity date. The Borrowers were required to prepay borrowings under the term loan facilities in an amount equal to 50.0% of Holdco’s Excess Cash Flow (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility) earned during the previous fiscal year, except that no prepayments were required if the Total Leverage Ratio (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility) was less than or equal to 6.0 to 1.0 at the end of such fiscal year. In addition, the Borrowers were required to prepay borrowings under the term loan facilities with asset disposition proceeds in excess of specified amounts to the extent necessary to cause Holdco’s Total Leverage Ratio to be less than or equal to 6.25 to 1.00, and with cash insurance proceeds and condemnation or expropriation awards, in excess of specified amounts, subject, in each case, to reinvestment rights. The Borrowers were required to prepay borrowings under the term loan facilities with the net proceeds of equity issuances by GateHouse Media in an amount equal to the lesser of (a) the amount by which 50.0% of the net cash proceeds exceeds the amount (if any) required to repay any credit facilities of GateHouse Media or (b) the amount of proceeds required to reduce Holdco’s Total Leverage Ratio to 6.0 to 1.0. The Borrowers were also required to prepay borrowings under the term loan facilities with 100% of the proceeds of debt issuances (with specified exceptions), except that no prepayment was required if Holdco’s Total Leverage Ratio was less than 6.0 to 1.0. If the term loan facilities have been paid in full, mandatory prepayments were applied to the repayment of borrowings under the swingline facility and revolving credit facilities and the cash collateralization of letters of credit.

 

F-34


Table of Contents

The 2007 Credit Facility contained a financial covenant that required Holdco to maintain a Total Leverage Ratio of less than or equal to 6.5 to 1.0 at any time an extension of credit was outstanding under the revolving credit facility. The 2007 Credit Facility contained affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Holdco, Operating and their restricted subsidiaries customarily found in loan agreements for similar transactions, including restrictions on their ability to incur indebtedness (which GateHouse Media was generally permitted to incur so long as it satisfied an incurrence test that required it to maintain a pro forma Total Leverage Ratio of less than 6.5 to 1.0), create liens on assets, engage in certain lines of business, engage in mergers or consolidations, dispose of assets, make investments or acquisitions, engage in transactions with affiliates, enter into sale leaseback transactions, enter into negative pledges or pay dividends or make other restricted payments, except that Holdco was permitted to (a) make restricted payments (including quarterly dividends) so long as, after giving effect to any such restricted payment, Holdco and its subsidiaries have a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility) equal to or greater than 1.0 to 1.0 and would be able to incur an additional $1.00 of debt under the incurrence test referred to above and (b) make restricted payments of proceeds of asset dispositions to GateHouse Media to the extent such proceeds were not required to prepay loans under the 2007 Credit Facility and/or cash collateralize letter of credit obligations and such proceeds were used to prepay borrowings under acquisition credit facilities of GateHouse Media. The 2007 Credit Facility also permitted the borrowers, in certain limited circumstances, to designate subsidiaries as “unrestricted subsidiaries which were not subject to the covenant restrictions in the 2007 Credit Facility. The 2007 Credit Facility contained customary events of default, including defaults based on a failure to pay principal, reimbursement obligations, interest, fees or other obligations, subject to specified grace periods; any material inaccuracy of a representation or warranty; breach of covenant; failure to pay other indebtedness and cross-accelerations; a Change of Control (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility); events of bankruptcy and insolvency; material judgments; failure to meet certain requirements with respect to ERISA; and impairment of collateral.

First Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On May 7, 2007, the Borrowers entered into the First Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility (“the First Amendment”). The First Amendment provided an incremental term loan facility under the 2007 Credit Facility in the amount of $275,000. As amended by the First Amendment, the 2007 Credit Facility included $1,195,000 of term loan facilities and $40,000 of a revolving credit facility. The incremental term loan facility amortized at the same rate and matured on the same date as the existing term loan facilities under the 2007 Credit Facility. Interest on the incremental term loan facility accrued at a rate per annum equal to, at the option of the borrower, (a) adjusted LIBOR plus a margin equal to (i) 2.00%, if the corporate family ratings and corporate credit ratings of Operating by Moody’s Investors Service Inc. and Standard & Poor’s Rating Services, were at least B1, and B+, respectively, in each case with stable outlook or (ii) 2.25%, otherwise or (b) the greater of the prime rate set by Wells Fargo Bank, or the federal funds effective rate plus 0.50%, plus a margin 1.00% lower than that applicable to adjusted LIBOR-based loans. Any voluntary or mandatory repayment of the First Amendment term loans made with the proceeds of a new term loan entered into for the primary purpose of benefiting from a margin that is less than the margin applicable as a result of the First Amendment was subject to a 1.00% prepayment premium. The First Amendment term loans were subject to a “most favored nation” interest provision that granted the First Amendment term loans an interest rate margin that was 0.25% less than the highest margin of any future term loan borrowings under the 2007 Credit Facility.

As previously noted, the First Amendment also modified the interest rates applicable to the term loans under the 2007 Credit Facility. Term loans thereunder accrued interest at a rate per annum equal to, at the option of the Borrower, (a) adjusted LIBOR plus a margin equal to 2.00% or (b) the greater of the prime rate set by Wells Fargo Bank, or the federal funds effective rate plus 0.50%, plus a margin equal to 1.00%. The terms of the previously outstanding borrowings were also modified to include a 1.00% prepayment premium corresponding to the prepayment premium applicable to the First Amendment term loans and a corresponding “most favored nation” interest provision.

 

F-35


Table of Contents

Second Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On February 3, 2009, the Company entered into the Second Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility (the “Second Amendment”).

Among other things, the Second Amendment reduced the aggregate principal amounts available under the 2007 Credit Facility, as follows: (a) for revolving loans, from $40,000 to $20,000; (b) for the letter of credit subfacility, from $15,000 to $5,000; and (c) for the swingline loan subfacility, from $10,000 to $5,000.

In addition, the Second Amendment provided that Holdco may not incur additional term debt under the 2007 Credit Facility unless the Senior Secured Incurrence Test (as defined in the Second Amendment) was less than 4.00 to 1.00 and the current Incurrence Test (as defined in the Second Amendment) was satisfied.

Agency Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On April 1, 2011, the Borrowers entered into an Agency Succession and Amendment Agreement, dated as of March 30, 2011, to the 2007 Credit Facility (the “Agency Amendment”).

Pursuant to the Agency Amendment, among other things, (a) Wells Fargo Bank resigned as administrative agent and (b) Gleacher Products Corp. was appointed as administrative agent. In addition, the Agency Amendment effected certain amendments to the 2007 Credit Facility that provided that (x) the administrative agent need not be a lender under the 2007 Credit Facility and (y) the lenders holding a majority of the outstanding term loans and loan commitments under the 2007 Credit Facility have (i) the right, in their discretion, to remove the administrative agent and (ii) the right to make certain decisions and exercise certain powers under the 2007 Credit Facility that had previously been within the discretion of the administrative agent.

Fourth Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On September 4, 2013, the Company entered into the Fourth Amendment to the Credit Facility (the “Fourth Amendment”). Pursuant to the terms of the Fourth Amendment, the Company obtained the following improvement in terms: a clarified and expanded definition of “Eligible Assignee”; an increase in the base amount in the formula used to calculate the “Permitted Investments” basket from $35,000 to a base of $50,000; the removal of the requirement that the Company’s annual financial statements not have a “going concern” or like qualification to the audit; the removal of a cross default from any Secured Hedging Agreement to the 2007 Credit Facility; the removal of a Bankruptcy Default, as defined therein, arising from actions in furtherance of or indicating consent to the specified actions; and a waiver of any prior Default or Event of Default, as defined therein.

In consideration of the changes described above, the Company agreed to pay each of the lenders party to the Fourth Amendment that timely executed and delivered its signature to the Fourth Amendment and the RSA, an amendment fee equal to 3.5% multiplied by the aggregate outstanding amount of the Loans held (including through trades pending settlement) by such lender, unless waived in writing. Newcastle and certain other lenders elected to waive their amendment fee pursuant to the Fourth Amendment. Newcastle indemnified other Lenders with respect to their entry into the Fourth Amendment, subject to the limitations set forth in the Fourth Amendment for a total amendment fee paid of approximately $6,790.

2007 Credit Facility Excess Cash Flow Payment and Outstanding Balance

As required by the 2007 Credit Facility, as amended, on March 26, 2013 and March 15, 2012, the Company made principal payments of $6,648 and $4,600, respectively, which represented 50% of the Excess Cash Flow related to the fiscal years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, respectively. As of December 29, 2013, a total of $0 was outstanding under the 2007 Credit Facility.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

Bankruptcy or Receivership

On September 27, 2013, the Debtors commenced voluntary Chapter 11 proceedings under the Bankruptcy Code in the Bankruptcy Court. Concurrently with the commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases, the Debtors filed and requested confirmation of the Plan.

The Debtors solicited votes of holders of claims under the 2007 Credit Facility and certain interest rate swaps secured thereunder (collectively, the “Outstanding Debt”), including certain affiliates of the Debtors. The Plan was accepted by the only impaired class of creditors entitled to vote on the Plan. Specifically, 100% of holders of the Outstanding Debt voted to accept the Plan.

Pension, trade and all other unsecured claims of the Company were not impaired under the Plan and their votes were not solicited. The Company’s common stock was canceled under the Plan.

Pursuant to a support agreement executed by the administrative agent and lenders constituting the “Required Lenders” under the 2007 Credit Facility, the parties thereto agreed that the commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases in furtherance of the Debtors’ obligations under the support agreement shall not be deemed to constitute a default under the 2007 Credit Facility. Absent such agreement, the commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases would have constituted an event of default under the 2007 Credit Facility. On November 6, 2013, the Bankruptcy Court held a hearing and entered the Confirmation Order confirming the Plan. On November 26, 2013, the Debtors successfully emerged from bankruptcy.

(12) Derivative Instruments

The Company used certain derivative financial instruments to hedge the aggregate risk of interest rate fluctuations with respect to its borrowings under the 2007 Credit Facility, which required payments based on a variable interest rate index. These risks included: increases in debt rates above the earnings of the encumbered assets, increases in debt rates resulting in the failure of certain debt ratio covenants, increases in debt rates such that assets can no longer be refinanced, and earnings volatility.

In order to reduce such risks, the Company primarily used interest rate swap agreements to change floating-rate long-term debt to fixed-rate long-term debt. This type of hedge was intended to qualify as a “cash-flow hedge” under ASC 815. For these instruments, the effective portion of the change in the fair value of the derivative was recorded in accumulated other comprehensive loss in the consolidated statement of stockholders’ equity (deficit) and recognized in the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss) in the same period in which the hedged transaction impacts earnings. The ineffective portion of the change in the fair value of the derivative was immediately recognized in earnings.

The restructuring process resulted in the dedesignation of the hedging relationship as it was not probable that the forecasted transaction would occur according to the original strategy, any related amounts previously recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net were recognized into earnings of the Predecessor Company as of the Petition Date. The derivative liability balances were classified as liabilities subject to compromise at the allowed claim amount. The remaining amount of other comprehensive income totaling $26,313 was recognized through earnings for the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013.

 

F-37


Table of Contents

Fair Values of Derivative Instruments

 

    Liability Derivatives  
    Successor Company
December 29, 2013
         Predecessor Company
December 30, 2012
 
    Balance Sheet
Location
    Fair Value          Balance Sheet
Location
    FairValue  

Derivative designed as hedging instruments under ASC 815

           

Interest rate swaps

    Derivative instruments      $ —              Derivative instruments      $ 45,724   
   

 

 

         

 

 

 

Total derivatives

    $ —              $ 45,724   
   

 

 

         

 

 

 

Predecessor Company

The Effect of Derivative Instruments on the Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)

for the Ten Months Ended November 6, 2013, and Years Ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012

 

Derivatives in ASC 815
Fair Value Hedging

Relationships

  

Location of Gain or (Loss)
Recognized in
Income on Derivative

  

Amount of Gain or

(Loss) Recognized

in Income on Derivative

 
     

  2013  

   

  2012  

    

  2011  

 

Interest rate swaps

   (Loss) gain on derivative instruments    $ (14   $ 1,635       $ 913   

 

Derivatives in

ASC 815

Fair Value Hedging
Relationships

 

Amount of Gain or (Loss)
Recognized in OCI

on

Derivative

(Effective Portion)

   

Location of

Gain or (Loss)

Reclassified from

Accumulated OCI

into Income

(Effective Portion)

 

Amount of Gain or (Loss)
Reclassified from
Accumulated

OCI into Income

(Effective Portion)

   

Location of

Gain or (Loss)

Recognized in

Income on

Derivative

(Ineffective

Portion

and Amount

Excluded

from

Effectiveness

Testing)

 

Amount of Gain or

(Loss)

Recognized in Income on

Derivative (Ineffective

Portion) (1)

 
  2013     2012     2011       2013     2012     2011       2013     2012     2011  

Interest rate swaps

  $ 19,339      $ 5,832      $ 13,829      Interest (income)/
expense
  $ 46,760      $ 28,771      $ 29,560      Gain (loss) on
derivative instruments
  $ (14)      $ 20      $ 85   
                Reorganization items,
net
  $ (2,041)      $ —       $ —    

 

(1) During the quarter ended September 29, 2013, the Predecessor recognized $2,041 in reorganization items, net to adjust the fair value of derivatives to the allowed claim.

On June 23, 2005, the Predecessor entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $300,000, which matured in June 2012, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 4.135%, with settlements that occurred monthly. On February 20, 2006, the Predecessor redesignated the same interest rate swap as a cash flow hedge for accounting purposes. At December 31, 2006, the swap no longer qualified as an effective hedge. Therefore, the balance in accumulated other comprehensive income was reclassified into earnings over the life of the hedged item. On January 1, 2007, the Predecessor redesignated the same interest rate swap as a cash flow hedge for accounting purposes. On August 18, 2008, the Predecessor terminated the swap and entered into a settlement agreement with Goldman Sachs in the aggregate amount of $18,947, which also included the termination of the swap having a notional value of $270,000. The balance in accumulated other comprehensive income was reclassified into earnings over the remaining life of the item previously hedged. As of November 6, 2013, all amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income were reclassified into earnings.

In connection with financing obtained in 2006, the Predecessor entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $270,000, which matured in July 2011, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 5.359%, with settlements occurring monthly. On January 1, 2007, the swap was redesignated. Therefore, the balance in accumulated other comprehensive income was reclassified into earnings over the life of the hedged

 

F-38


Table of Contents

item. On August 18, 2008, the Predecessor terminated the swap and entered into a settlement agreement with Goldman Sachs in the aggregate amount of $18,947 which also included the termination of the swap having a notional value of $300,000. The balance in accumulated other comprehensive income was reclassified into earnings over the remaining life of the item previously hedged. As of November 6, 2013, all amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income were reclassified into earnings.

In connection with the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $100,000 which would have matured on September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 5.14%, with settlements that occurred monthly. For the Predecessor Company during the ten months ended November 6, 2013, the fair value of the swap increased by $2,835, of which $0 was recognized through earnings, an increase of $3,166 was recognized through accumulated other comprehensive income, and a decrease of $331 was recognized in reorganization items.

In connection with the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $250,000 which would have matured on September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 4.971%, with settlements that occurred monthly. For the Predecessor Company during the ten months ended November 6, 2013, the fair value of the swap increased by $6,837, of which an increase of $2 was recognized through earnings, an increase of $7,635 was recognized through accumulated other comprehensive income, and a decrease of $800 was recognized in reorganization items.

In connection with the First Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $200,000 which would have matured on September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 5.079% with settlements that occurred monthly. For the Predecessor Company during the ten months ended November 6, 2013, the fair value of the swap increased by $5,597, of which a decrease of $16 was recognized through earnings, an increase of $6,268 was recognized through accumulated other comprehensive income, and a decrease of $655 was recognized in reorganization items.

In connection with the First Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $75,000 which would have matured on September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 4.941% with settlements that occurred monthly. For the Predecessor Company during the ten months ended November 6, 2013, the fair value of the swap increased by $2,015, of which $0 was recognized through earnings, an increase of $2,270 was recognized through accumulated other comprehensive income, and a decrease of $255 was recognized in reorganization items.

The aggregate amount of unrealized loss related to derivative instruments recognized in other comprehensive loss as of December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012 was $0 and $45,651, respectively.

 

F-39


Table of Contents

(13) Income Taxes

Income tax expense (benefit) on loss from continuing operations for the periods shown below consisted of:

 

     Current     Deferred     Total  

Two months ended December 29, 2013, Successor Company:

      

U.S. Federal

   $ —       $ —       $ —    

State and local

     491        —         491   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 491        —       $ 491   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ten months ended November 6, 2013, Predecessor Company:

      

U.S. Federal

   $ —       $ (158   $ (158

State and local

     —         (39     (39
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ —         (197   $ (197
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Year ended December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company:

      

U.S. Federal

   $ 149      $ —       $ 149   

State and local

     (356     —         (356
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ (207     —       $ (207
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Year ended January 1, 2012, Predecessor Company:

      

U.S. Federal

   $ (1,368   $ —       $ (1,368

State and local

     (435     —         (435
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ (1,803     —       $ (1,803
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax expense (benefit) differed from the amounts computed by applying the U.S. federal income tax rate of 34% to income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes as a result of the following:

 

     Successor Company           Predecessor Company  
     Two Months Ended
December 29, 2013
          Ten Months
Ended
November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Year Ended
December 31,
2010
 

Computed “expected” tax expense (benefit)

   $ 2,617           $ 267,934      $ (9,303   $ (8,171

Increase (decrease) in income tax benefit resulting from:

             

State and local income taxes, net of federal benefit

     491             (39     20        (367

Net nondeductible meals, entertainment, and other expenses

     54             (173     393        358   

Return to provision adjustment

     —              (489     288        6   

Impairment of non-deductible goodwill

     —              —         —         51   

Change in valuation allowance

     (1,704          (53,913     8,462        6,183   

(Decrease) increase to provision for unrecognized tax benefits

     —              —         (356     120   

Cancellation of indebtedness and original issue discount

     (967          (213,517     —         —    

Other

     —              —         289        17   
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 491           $ (197   $ (207   $ (1,803
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-40


Table of Contents

The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant portions of the deferred tax assets as of December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012 are presented below:

 

     Successor Company
December 29, 2013
          Predecessor Company
December 30, 2012
 

Current deferred tax assets:

         

Accounts receivable

   $ 936           $ 962   

Accrued expenses

     13,204             12,077   

Inventory capitalization

     3,014             2,356   
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

Gross current deferred tax assets

     17,154             15,395   

Less valuation allowance

     (13,708          (15,395
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

Net current deferred tax assets

     3,446             —    
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

Non-current deferred tax assets:

         

Derivative instruments

     —              17,870   

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligation

     3,920             8,922   

Definite and indefinite lived intangible assets

     97,760             156,593   

Fixed assets

     —              3,538   

Net operating losses

     87,346             242,272   
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

Gross non-current deferred tax assets

     189,026             429,195   

Less valuation allowance

     (151,061          (429,195
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

Net non-current deferred tax assets

     37,965             —    

Non-current deferred tax liabilities:

         

Fixed assets

     41,411             —    
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

Gross non-current deferred tax liabilities

     41,411             —    
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

     —              —    
  

 

 

        

 

 

 

In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, management considers whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible.

During the year ended January 1, 2012, the valuation allowance increased by $10,980, of which $5,617 was charged to earnings and $5,363 was recorded through accumulated other comprehensive income. During the year ended December 30, 2012, the valuation allowance increased by $2,707 of which $6,551 was charged to earnings and $3,844 was recorded as a reduction through accumulated other comprehensive income. During the ten months ended November 6, 2013, the valuation allowance decreased by $277,679, of which $59,839 was a benefit to earnings, $370 was charged to discontinued operations, and $20,412 was recorded as a benefit through accumulated other comprehensive income, and a reduction of $197,748 was attributable to the reduction of tax attributes related to the cancellation of indebtedness and other fresh start adjustments. During the two months ended December 29, 2013, the valuation allowance decreased by $2,142, all of which was a benefit to earnings.

At December 29, 2013, the Company had net operating loss carryforwards for federal and state income tax purposes of approximately $223,108, which are available to offset future taxable income, if any. These federal and state net operating loss carryforwards begin to expire on various dates from 2019 through 2033. The majority of the operating losses are subject to the limitations of Internal Revenue Code (the “Code”) Section 382. This section provides limitations on the availability of net operating losses to offset current taxable income if significant ownership changes have occurred for Federal tax purposes.

At December 29, 2013, the Company had uncertain tax positions of $1,109 which, if recognized, would impact the effective tax rate. The Company did not record significant amounts of interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions for the Successor Company for two months ended December 29, 2013 and the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013.

 

F-41


Table of Contents

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of uncertain tax positions for the years ended December 29, 2013December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 are as follows:

 

Balance as of January 1, 2011

   $ 4,913   

Increases based on tax positions prior to 2011

     120   
  

 

 

 

Uncertain tax positions as of January 1, 2012

   $ 5,033   

Decreases based on tax positions prior to 2012

     (399

Increases based on tax positions prior to 2012

     43   
  

 

 

 

Uncertain tax positions as of December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ 4,677   

Decreases based on tax positions prior to 2013 and tax attribute reductions

     (3,568
  

 

 

 

Uncertain tax positions as of December 29, 2013, Successor Company

   $ 1,109   
  

 

 

 

The Company does not anticipate significant increases or decreases in our uncertain tax positions within the next twelve months. The Company recognizes penalties and interest relating to uncertain tax positions in the provision for income taxes. During the period, the Company did not recognize any accrued interest or penalties. At December 29, 2013, the accrual for uncertain tax positions, included $320 of interest and penalties.

The Company files a U.S. federal consolidated income tax return for which the statute of limitations remains open for the 2010 tax year and beyond. U.S. state jurisdictions have statute of limitations generally ranging from 3 to 6 years.

(14) Earnings (Loss) Per Share

The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share (“EPS”):

 

    Successor Company          Predecessor Company  
    Two Months Ended
December 29, 2013
         Ten Months Ended
November 6, 2013
    Year Ended
December 30, 2012
    Year Ended
January 1, 2012
 

Numerator for earnings per share calculation:

           

Income (loss) from continuing operations attributable to New Media

  $ 7,206          $ 788,448      $ (27,463   $ (20,950

Loss from discontinued operations, attributable to New Media, net of income taxes

    —             (1,034     (2,340     (699
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to New Media

  $ 7,206          $ 787,414      $ (29,803   $ (21,649

Denominator for earnings per share calculation:

           

Basic weighted average shares outstanding

    30,000,000            58,069,272        58,041,907        57,949,815   

Diluted weighted average shares outstanding

    30,000,000            58,069,272        58,041,907        57,949,815   

Income (loss) per share—basic and diluted:

           

Income (loss) from continuing operations attributable to New Media

  $ 0.24          $ 13.58      $ (0.47   $ (0.36

Loss from discontinued operations, attributable to New Media, net of taxes

    —             (0.02     (0.04     (0.01
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to New Media

  $ 0.24          $ 13.56      $ (0.51   $ (0.37

 

F-42


Table of Contents

During the two months ended December 29, 2013 the Successor Company excluded 1,362,479 common stock warrants from the computation of diluted income per share because their effect would have been antidilutive. For the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013, and the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, 0, 25,424 and 84,181 RSGs, respectively, were excluded from the computation of diluted loss per share because their effect would have been antidilutive.

(15) Employee Benefit Plans

For the year ended December 29, 2013, the Company maintained the GateHouse Media, Inc. Retirement Savings Plan (the “GateHouse 401(k) Plan”), which is intended to be a qualified defined contribution plan with a cash or deferred arrangement under Section 401(k) of the Code. In general, eligible employees of the Company and participating affiliates who satisfy minimum age and service requirements are eligible to participate. Eligible employees can contribute amounts up to 100% of their eligible compensation to the GateHouse 401(k) Plan, subject to IRS limitations. The GateHouse 401(k) Plan also provides for discretionary matching and nonelective contributions that can be made in separate amounts among different allocation groups. The Company implemented a Companywide matching contribution on January 1, 2008 and discontinued offering such matching contribution across the Company on January 1, 2009. Effective January 2, 2012 the Company reinstated the matching contribution across the entire Company. During 2011 the Company only offered a matching contribution to certain groups of the Company’s employees. For the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013, and for the year ended December 30, 2012, when the Company offered a matching contribution across the entire Company, the Company’s matching contributions to the GateHouse 401(k) Plan were $146, $845, and $117, respectively. During the year ended January 1, 2012, when the Company did not offer a matching contribution across the entire Company, the Company’s matching contributions to the GateHouse 401(k) Plan was $102. The Company did not make nonelective contributions for the reported years. Effective January 1, 2014, sponsorship of the GateHouse 401(k) Plan was transferred to New Media Investment Group, Inc. and the name of the Plan was changed to be the New Media Retirement Savings Plan.

For the year ended December 29, 2013, Local Media sponsored the Local Media Group, Inc. 401(k) Savings Plan (the “Local Media 401(k) Plan”), which also is intended to be a qualified defined contribution plan with a cash or deferred arrangement under Section 401(k) of the Code. In general, eligible employees of Local Media and participating affiliates who satisfied minimum age and service requirements were eligible to participate. Eligible employees were able to contribute amounts up to 25% of their eligible compensation to the Local Media 401(k) Plan, subject to IRS limitations. The Local Media 401(k) Plan also provided for a matching contribution up to 3.5% of a participant’s gross eligible compensation (based on an employee deferral election of at least 6% of eligible compensation). The Local Media 401(k) Plan did not provide for employer nonelective contributions and was frozen with respect to all new eligibility and contributions effective after December 31, 2013. Effective January 1, 2014, sponsorship of the Local Media 401(k) Plan was transferred to New Media.

The Company maintains three nonqualified deferred compensation plans, as described below, for certain of its employees.

The Company maintains the GateHouse Media, Inc. Publishers’ Deferred Compensation Plan (“Publishers Plan”), a nonqualified deferred compensation plan for the benefit of certain designated publishers of the Company’s newspapers. Under the Publishers Plan, the Company credits an amount to a bookkeeping account established for each participating publisher pursuant to a pre-determined formula, which is based upon the gross operating profits of each such publisher’s newspaper. The bookkeeping account is credited with earnings and losses based upon the investment choices selected by the participant. The amounts credited to the bookkeeping account on behalf of each participating publisher vest on an installment basis over a period of 15 years. A participating publisher forfeits all amounts under the Publishers Plan in the event that the publisher’s employment with the Company is terminated for “cause”, as defined in the Publishers Plan. Amounts credited to a participating publisher’s bookkeeping account are distributable upon termination of the publisher’s employment with the Company and will be made in a lump sum or installments as elected by the publisher. The

 

F-43


Table of Contents

Publisher’s Plan was frozen effective as of December 31, 2006, and all accrued benefits of participants under the terms of the Publisher’s Plan became 100% vested. The Company recorded $0, $0, $0 and $0 of compensation expense related to the Publishers Plan for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013, and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, respectively.

The Company maintains the GateHouse Media, Inc. Executive Benefit Plan (“Executive Benefit Plan”), a nonqualified deferred compensation plan for the benefit of certain key employees of the Company. Under the Executive Benefit Plan, the Company credits an amount, determined at the Company’s sole discretion, to a bookkeeping account established for each participating key employee. The bookkeeping account is credited with earnings and losses based upon the investment choices selected by the participant. The amounts credited to the bookkeeping account on behalf of each participating key employee vest on an installment basis over a period of 5 years. A participating key employee forfeits all amounts under the Executive Benefit Plan in the event that the key employee’s employment with the Company is terminated for “cause”, as defined in the Executive Benefit Plan. Amounts credited to a participating key employee’s bookkeeping account are distributable upon termination of the key employee’s employment with the Company, and will be made in a lump sum or installments as elected by the key employee. The Executive Benefit Plan was frozen effective as of December 31, 2006, and all accrued benefits of participants under the terms of the Executive Benefit Plan became 100% vested. The Company recorded $0, $0, $0 and $0 of compensation expense related to the Publishers Plan for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013, and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, respectively.

The Company maintains the GateHouse Media, Inc. Executive Deferral Plan (“Executive Deferral Plan”), a nonqualified deferred compensation plan for the benefit of certain key employees of the Company. Under the Executive Deferral Plan, eligible key employees may elect to defer a portion of their compensation for payment at a later date. Currently, the Executive Deferral Plan allows a participating key employee to defer up to 100% of his or her annual compensation until termination of employment or such earlier period as elected by the participating key employee. Amounts deferred are credited to a bookkeeping account established by the Company for this purpose. The bookkeeping account is credited with earnings and losses based upon the investment choices selected by the participant. Amounts deferred under the Executive Deferral Plan are fully vested and non-forfeitable. The amounts in the bookkeeping account are payable to the key employee at the time and in the manner elected by the key employee.

(16) Pension and Postretirement Benefits

As a result of the Enterprise News Media, LLC and Copley Press, Inc. acquisitions, the Company maintains a pension plan and postretirement medical and life insurance plans which cover certain employees. The Company uses the accrued benefit actuarial method and best estimate assumptions to determine pension costs, liabilities and other pension information for defined benefit plans.

The Enterprise News Media, LLC pension plan was amended to freeze all future benefit accruals as of December 31, 2008, except for a select group of union employees whose benefits were frozen during 2009. Also, during 2008 the medical and life insurance benefits were frozen and the plan was amended to limit future benefits to a select group of active employees under the Enterprise News Media, LLC postretirement medical and life insurance plan.

 

F-44


Table of Contents

The following provides information on the pension plan and postretirement medical and life insurance plan as of December 29, 2013 for the Successor Company and as of November 6, 2013 and December 30, 2012 for the Predecessor Company, for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013 and for the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and December 30, 2012.

 

     Pension          Pension     Pension     Postretirement          Postretirement     Postretirement  
     Successor          Predecessor     Successor          Predecessor  
     Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
 

Change in projected benefit obligation:

                    

Benefit obligation at beginning of period

   $ 24,651          $ 27,126      $ 23,926      $ 6,015          $ 6,666      $ 6,461   

Service cost

     48            252        300        6            32        40   

Interest cost

     187            913        1,203        41            188        273   

Actuarial (gain) loss

     (408         (2,111     3,422        176            (596     187   

Benefits and expenses paid

     (163         (1,529     (1,725     (29         (261     (282

Participant contributions

     —              —          —          2            12        14   

Employer implicit subsidy fulfilled

     —              —          —          (5         (26     (27
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

 

Projected benefit obligation at end of period

   $ 24,315          $ 24,651      $ 27,126      $ 6,206          $ 6,015      $ 6,666   
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in plan assets:

                    

Fair value of plan assets at beginning of period

   $ 19,981          $ 18,241      $ 16,498      $ —            $ —        $ —     

Actual return on plan assets

     472            2,121        2,353        —              —          —     

Employer contributions

     —              1,148        1,115        27            249        268   

Employer implicit subsidy contribution

     —              —          —          5            26        27   

Participant contributions

     —              —          —          2            12        14   

Employer implicit subsidy fulfilled

     —              —          —          (5         (26     (27

Benefits paid

     (123         (1,324     (1,402     (29         (261     (282

Expenses paid

     (40         (205     (323     —              —          —     
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fair value of plan assets at end of period

   $ 20,290          $ 19,981      $ 18,241      $ —            $ —        $ —     
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

 

Reconciliation of funded status:

                    

Benefit obligation at end of period

   $ (24,315       $ (24,651   $ (27,126   $ (6,206       $ (6,015   $ (6,666

Fair value of assets at end of period

     20,290            19,981        18,241        —              —          —     

Funded status

     (4,025         (4,670     (8,885     (6,206         (6,015     (6,666

Unrecognized prior service cost

     —              —          —          —              —          (1,525

Unrecognized actuarial (gain) loss

     (634         —          8,294        176            —          220   
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net accrued benefit cost

   $ (4,659       $ (4,670   $ (591   $ (6,030       $ (6,015   $ (7,971
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-45


Table of Contents
     Pension          Pension     Pension     Postretirement          Postretirement      Postretirement  
     Successor          Predecessor     Successor          Predecessor  
     Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
     Year Ended
December 30,
2012
 

Balance sheet presentation:

                     

Accrued liabilities

   $ —            $ —        $ —        $ 403          $ 79       $ 423   

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations

     4,025            4,670        8,885        5,803            5,936         6,243   

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     634            —          (8,294     (176         —           1,305   
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net accrued benefit cost

   $ 4,659          $ (4,670   $ 591      $ 6,030          $ 6,015       $ 7,971   
  

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

 

Comparison of obligations to plan assets:

                     

Projected benefit obligation

   $ 24,315          $ 24,651      $ 27,126      $ 6,206          $ 6,015       $ 6,666   

Accumulated benefit obligation

     24,315            24,651        27,126        6,206            6,015         6,666   

Fair value of plan assets

     20,290            19,981        18,241        —              —           —     

 

F-46


Table of Contents
    Pension     Postretirement  
    Successor          Predecessor     Successor          Predecessor  
    Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
    Two Months
Ended
December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
 

Components of net periodic benefit cost:

                       

Service cost

  $ 48          $ 252      $ 300      $ 200      $ 6          $ 32      $ 40      $ 42   

Interest cost

    187            913        1,203        1,238        41            188        273        303   

Expected return on plan assets

    (246         (1,140     (1,275     (1,324     —              —          —          —     

Amortization of prior service cost

    —              —          —          —          —              (383     (457     (457

Amortization of unrecognized (gain) loss

    —              432        382        82       —              —          —          —     
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net periodic benefit cost

  $ (11       $ 457      $ 610      $ 196      $ 47          $ (163   $ (144   $ (112
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other changes in plan assets and benefit obligations recognized in other comprehensive income:

                       

Net actuarial (gain) loss

  $ (634       $ (7,843   $ 2,343      $ 2,640      $ 176          $ 922      $ 187      $ 23   

Amortization of net actuarial loss

    —              (452     (383     (83     —              —          —          —     

Amortization of prior service credit

    —              —          —          —          —              383        457        457   

Other adjustment

    —              —          43        (240     —              —          —          —     
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total recognized in other comprehensive income

  $ (634       $ (8,295   $ 2,003      $ 2,317      $ 176          $ 1,305      $ 644      $ 480   
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following assumptions were used in connection with the Company’s actuarial valuation of its defined benefit pension and postretirement plans:

 

     Pension     Postretirement  
     Successor          Predecessor     Successor          Predecessor  
     Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
 

Weighted average discount rate

     5.0         4.85     4.1     4.5         4.3     3.6

Rate of increase in future compensation levels

     —              —          —          —              —          —     

Expected return on assets

     8.0         8.0     7.75     —              —          —     

Current year trend

     —              —          —          7.8         7.8     7.7

Ultimate year trend

     —              —          —          4.8         4.8     4.8

Year of ultimate trend

     —              —          —          2025            2025        2022   

 

F-47


Table of Contents

The following assumptions were used to calculate the net periodic benefit cost for the Company’s defined benefit pension and postretirement plans:

 

    Pension     Postretirement  
    Successor          Predecessor     Successor          Predecessor  
    Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
    Two Months
Ended

December 29,
2013
         Ten Months
Ended

November 6,
2013
    Year Ended
December 30,
2012
    Year Ended
January 1,
2012
 

Weighted average discount rate

    5.0         4.85     5.1     5.7     4.3         3.6     4.4     5.3

Rate of increase in future compensation levels

    —              —          —          —          —              —          —          —     

Expected return on assets

    8.0         8.0     7.75     7.75     —              —          —          —     

Current year trend

    —              —          —          —          7.8         7.7     8.1     8.5

Ultimate year trend

    —              —          —          —          4.8         4.8     4.8     4.8

Year of ultimate trend

    —              —          —          —          2025            2022        2022        2021   

To determine the expected long-term rate of return on pension plan assets, the Company considers the current and expected asset allocations, as well as historical and expected returns on various categories of plan assets, input from the actuaries and investment consultants, and long-term inflation assumptions. The expected allocation of pension plan assets is based on a diversified portfolio consisting of domestic and international equity securities and fixed income securities. This expected return is then applied to the fair value of plan assets. The Company amortizes experience gains and losses, including the effects of changes in actuarial assumptions and plan provisions over a period equal to the average future service of plan participants.

Amortization of prior service costs was calculated using the straight-line method over the average remaining service periods of the employees expected to receive benefits under the plan.

 

     Postretirement     Postretirement  
     Successor 2013     Predecessor 2012  

Effect of 1% increase in health care cost trend rates

    

APBO

   $ 6,611      $ 7,092   

Dollar change

   $ 405      $ 426   

Percent change

     6.5     6.4

Effect of 1% decrease in health care cost trend rates

    

APBO

   $ 5,863      $ 6,308   

Dollar change

   $ (343   $ (358

Percent change

     (5.5 )%      (5.4 )% 

Fair Value of plan assets are measured on a recurring basis using quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets, Level 1 input. The pension plan’s assets by asset category are as follows:

 

     Successor          Predecessor  
     Two Months Ended
December 29, 2013
         Ten Months Ended
November 6, 2013
    December 30, 2012  
     Dollar      Percent          Dollar      Percent     Dollar      Percent  

Equity mutual funds

   $ 14,738         73       $ 14,676         74   $ 12,299         67

Fixed income mutual funds

     4,021         20         4,074         20     5,320         29

Cash and cash equivalents

     803         4         645         3     575         3

Other

     728         3         586         3     47         1
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 20,290         100       $ 19,981         100   $ 18,241         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

       

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Plan fiduciaries of the George W. Prescott Publishing Company LLC Pension Plan set investment policies and strategies for the pension trust. Objectives include preserving the funded status of the plan and balancing risk against return. The general target allocation is 70% in equity funds and 30% in fixed income funds for the plan’s investments.

 

F-48


Table of Contents

To accomplish this goal, each plan’s assets are actively managed by outside investment managers with the objective of optimizing long-term return while maintaining a high standard of portfolio quality and proper diversification. The Company monitors the maturities of fixed income securities so that there is sufficient liquidity to meet current benefit payment obligations.

The following benefit payments, which reflect expected future services, as appropriate, are expected to be paid as follows:

 

     Pension      Postretirement  

2014

   $ 1,461       $ 412   

2015

     1,508         410   

2016

     1,536         410   

2017

     1,545         379   

2018

     1,565         390   

2019-2023

     8,126         1,584   

Employer contribution expected to be paid during the year ending December 31, 2014

   $ 1,501       $ 412   

The postretirement plans are not funded.

The aggregate amount of net actuarial loss and prior service cost related to the Company’s pension and postretirement plans recognized in other comprehensive income as of December 29, 2013 was $458 of which $0 is expected to be amortized in 2014.

Multiemployer Plans

The Company is a participant in three multi-employer pension plans covering certain employees with Collective Bargaining Agreements (“CBAs”) in Ohio, Massachusetts and Illinois. The risks of participating in these multi-employer plans are different from single-employer plans in the following aspects:

 

    The Company plays no part in the management of plan investments or any other aspect of plan administration.

 

    Assets contributed to the multi-employer plan by one employer may be used to provide benefits to employees of other participating employers.

 

    If a participating employer stops contributing to the plan, the unfunded obligations of the plan may be borne by the remaining participating employers.

 

    If the Company chooses to stop participating in some of its multi-employer plans, the Company may be required to pay those plans an amount based on the unfunded status of the plan, referred to as withdrawal liability.

The Company’s participation in these plans for the year ended December 29, 2013, is outlined in the table below. The “EIN/Pension Plan Number” column provides the Employee Identification Number (EIN) and the three-digit plan number. Unless otherwise noted, the two most recent Pension Protection Act (PPA) zone statuses available are for the plan’s for the years ended December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, respectively. The zone status is based on information that the company received from the plan and is certified by the plan’s actuary. Among other factors, plans in the red zone are generally less than 65% funded; plans in the orange zone are both a) less than 80% funded and b) have an accumulated/expected funding deficiency in any of the next six plan years, net of any amortization extensions; plans in the yellow zone meet either one of the criteria mentioned in the orange zone; and plans in the green zone are at least 80% funded. The “FIP/RP Status Pending/Implemented” column indicates plans for which a financial improvement plan (FIP) or a rehabilitation plan (RP) is either pending or has been implemented. The last column lists the expiration date(s) of the collective-bargaining agreement(s) to which the plans are subject.

 

F-49


Table of Contents

The Company makes all required contributions to these plans as determined under the respective CBAs. For each of the plans listed below, the Company’s contribution represented less than 5% of total contributions to the plan.

 

Pension Plan Name

  EIN Number/
Plan Number
    Zone
Status
    FIP/RP
Status
Pending/

Implemented
    Contributions
(in thousands)
    Surcharge
Imposed
    Expiration
Dates of CBAs
    2013     2012       2013     2012     2011      

CWA/ITU Negotiated Pension Plan

    13-6212879/001        Red        Red        Implemented      $ 12      $ 13      $ 9        No      5/31/17

GCIU—Employer Retirement Benefit Plan (1)(2)

    91-6024903/001        Red        Red        Implemented        91        89        87        No      11/14/2014

The Newspaper Guild International Pension Plan (1)

    52-1082662/001        Red        Red        Implemented        39        49        130        No      09/30/2014
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total

          $ 142      $ 151      $ 226       
         

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

(1) This plan has elected to utilize special amortization provisions provided under the Preservation of Access to Care for Medicare Beneficiaries and Pension Relief Act of 2010.
(2) During the fiscal year 2012 the Company accrued $1,185 related to this plan due to the discontinuance of press operations at its Suburban Chicago location.

(17) Stock Compensation Plans

Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan

On October 5, 2006, the Predecessor adopted a new equity incentive plan for its employees, the RSG Plan and presented the RSG Plan to the Predecessor’s stockholders’ for approval, which was received on October 6, 2006. The RSG Plan provided for the issuance of stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted shares, deferred shares, performance shares, unrestricted shares and other stock-based awards. A total of 2,000,000 shares of the Predecessor’s common stock were initially reserved for issuance under the RSG Plan, provided however, that commencing on the first day of each fiscal year beginning in calendar year 2007, the number of shares reserved and available for issuance was increased by an amount equal to 100,000. All such shares of the Predecessor’s common stock that were available for the grant of awards under the RSG Plan may be granted as incentive stock options. Section 162(m) of the Code states that the maximum aggregate number of shares that was subject to stock options or stock appreciation rights that may be granted to any individual during any fiscal year was 400,000 and the maximum aggregate number of shares that was subject to awards of restricted stock, deferred shares, unrestricted shares or other stock-based awards that may be granted to any individual during any fiscal year was 400,000.

The RSG Plan was administered by the Predecessor’s board of directors, although it may be administered by either the board of directors or any committee of the board of directors including a committee that complies with the applicable requirements of Section 162(m) of the Code, Section 16 of the Exchange Act and any other applicable legal or stock exchange listing requirements.

Except as otherwise provided by the RSG Plan administrator, on the first business day after the Predecessor’s annual meeting of stockholders and each such annual meeting thereafter during the term of the RSG Plan, each of the Predecessor’s independent directors who is serving following such annual meeting was automatically granted under the RSG Plan a number of unrestricted shares of common stock having a fair market value of $15 as of the date of grant; however, those of the Predecessor’s independent directors who were granted restricted common stock upon the consummation of the IPO will not be eligible to receive these automatic annual grants.

 

F-50


Table of Contents

The terms of the RSG Plan provided that the board of directors may amend, alter or discontinue the RSG Plan, but no such action may impair the rights of any participant with respect to outstanding awards without the participant’s consent. The RSG Plan administrator, however, reserves the right to amend, modify, or supplement an award to either bring it into compliance with Section 409A of the Code, or to cause the award to not be subject to such section. The RSG Plan was terminated on November 26, 2013 as a result of the bankruptcy filing.

As of December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, a total of 0 and 25,424 RSGs were outstanding under the RSG Plan, respectively. Refer to Note 5 for further discussion of our RSG Plan.

(18) Assets Held for Sale

As of December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, the Company intended to dispose of various assets which are classified as held for sale on the consolidated balance sheet in accordance with ASC 360. The following table summarizes the major classes of assets and liabilities held for sale at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012:

 

     Successor Company          Predecessor Company  
     December 29, 2013          December 30, 2012  

Long-term assets held for sale:

        

Property, plant and equipment, net

   $ 623          $ 474   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

Total long-term assets held for sale

   $ 623          $ 474   
  

 

 

       

 

 

 

These assets are real property and no publication related assets are included. The carrying value and fair value of the assets were insignificant as of December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012.

During the year ended December 30, 2012 the Company recorded an impairment charge in the amount of $2,128 related to property, plant and equipment and certain intangible assets which were classified as held for sale, refer to Note 19 for fair value measurement discussion. No such impairment charges were recorded during the year ended December 29, 2013.

(19) Fair Value Measurement

The Company measures and records in the accompanying consolidated financial statements certain assets and liabilities at fair value on a recurring basis. ASC 820 establishes a fair value hierarchy for those instruments measured at fair value that distinguishes between assumptions based on market data (observable inputs) and the Company’s own assumptions (unobservable inputs).

These inputs are prioritized as follows:

 

    Level 1: Observable inputs such as quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;

 

    Level 2: Inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable, either directly or indirectly, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities or market corroborated inputs; and

 

    Level 3: Unobservable inputs for which there is little or no market data and which require us to develop our own assumptions about how market participants price the asset or liability.

The valuation techniques that may be used to measure fair value are as follows:

 

    Market approach—Uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets or liabilities;

 

    Income approach—Uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts to a single present amount based on current market expectation about those future amounts;

 

    Cost approach—Based on the amount that currently would be required to replace the service capacity of an asset (replacement cost).

 

F-51


Table of Contents

The following table provides information for the Company’s major categories of financial assets and liabilities measured or disclosed at fair value on a recurring basis:

 

     Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using                
     Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Identical Assets
(Level 1)
     Significant Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
     Total Fair Value
Measurements
     Valuation
Technique
 

Predecessor, as of December 30, 2012

              

Assets

              

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 34,527       $ —         $ —         $ 34,527         Income   

Restricted cash

     6,467         —           —           6,467         Income   

Liabilities

              

Derivatives (1)

   $ —         $ —         $ 45,724       $ 45,724         Income   

Predecessor, as of November 6, 2013

              

Assets

              

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 20,718       $ —         $ —         $ 20,718         Income   

Restricted cash

     6,716         —           —           6,716         Income   

Liabilities

              

Derivatives (1)(2)

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —           Income   

Successor, as of December 29, 2013

              

Assets

              

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31,811       $ —         $ —         $ 31,811         Income   

Restricted cash

     6,477         —           —           6,477         Income   

 

(1) The Predecessor Company’s fair value of its interest-rate swaps was determined using a discounted cash flow method and the following significant inputs: the remaining term of the swap, the notional amount of the swap (ranging from $75,000 to $250,000), discount rates interpolated based on the one month LIBOR swap curves, the rate on the fixed leg of the swap, and a credit value adjustment to consider the likelihood of the Company’s nonperformance. The pricing model used was consistently applied and reflected the contractual terms of the derivatives as described above. In determining an appropriate spread to reflect its credit standing, the Predecessor Company considered credit default swap pricing on debt with similar credit risks and maturities. Therefore, the Predecessor Company’s interest-rate swaps are classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. An increase in the one month LIBOR and/or an increase in the credit default swap price would result in a decrease to fair value. A decrease in the one month LIBOR curve and/or a decrease in the credit default swap price would result in an increase to fair value.
(2) The Company recognized $2,041 in reorganization items, net to adjust the fair value of derivatives to the allowed claim.

The following tables reflect the activity of our derivative liabilities measured at fair value using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) for year ended December 29, 2013:

 

     Derivative
Liabilities
 

Balance as of December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ 45,724   

Total (gains) losses, net:

  

Included in earnings

     14   

Included in other comprehensive income

     (19,339

Included in reorganization items, net

     2,041   
  

 

 

 

Balance as of November 6, 2013, Predecessor Company

   $ 28,440   

Reclassification to liabilities subject to compromise

     (28,440
  

 

 

 

Balance as of December 29, 2013, Successor Company

   $ —     
  

 

 

 

 

F-52


Table of Contents

Certain assets are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments only in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment). During the quarter ended April 1, 2012, goodwill was written down to implied fair value using Level 3 inputs. The valuation techniques and significant inputs and assumptions utilized to measure fair value are discussed in Note 8.

During the twelve months ended December 30, 2012, the Company recorded an impairment charge in the amount of $2,128 related to property, plant and equipment and certain intangible assets which were classified as held for sale. The Company used assessed values and current market data, Level 2 inputs, to determine the fair value.

During the quarter ended September 29, 2013, the Company consolidated the assets and liabilities of Local Media under the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, the assets acquired and liabilities assumed were recorded at their fair value. Property plant and equipment was valued using Level 2 inputs and mastheads and goodwill were valued using Level 3 inputs. Refer to Note 4 for discussion of the valuation techniques and significant inputs and assumptions utilized and the fair value recognized.

During the quarter ended September 29, 2013, certain intangible assets were written down to their implied fair value using Level 3 inputs. The valuation techniques and significant inputs and assumptions utilized to measure fair value are discussed in Note 8. The fair value of select advertiser relationships was $19,120, subscriber relationships $5,310, customer relationships $270, trade names was $270, and publication rights was $0 at September 29, 2013.

During the quarter ended December 29, 2013, the Company applied fresh start accounting which resulted in its assets and liabilities being recorded at their fair values utilizing Level 3 inputs as of November 6, 2013. The valuation techniques and significant inputs and assumptions utilized to measure fair value are discussed in Note 3.

Refer to Note 11 for the discussion on the fair value of the Company’s total long-term debt.

Refer to Note 16 for the discussion on the fair value of the Company’s pension plan.

(20) Commitments and Contingencies

The Company becomes involved from time to time in claims and lawsuits incidental to the ordinary course of its business, including with respect to such matters as libel, invasion of privacy, intellectual property infringement, wrongful termination actions, and complaints alleging employment discrimination. In addition, the Company is involved from time to time in governmental and administrative proceedings concerning employment, labor, environmental and other claims. Insurance coverage maintained by the Company mitigates potential loss for certain of these matters. Historically, such claims and proceedings have not had a material effect upon the Company’s consolidated results of operations or financial condition. While the Company is unable to predict the ultimate outcome of any currently outstanding legal actions, it is the opinion of the Company’s management that it is a remote possibility that the disposition of these matters would have a material adverse effect upon the Company’s consolidated results of operations, financial condition or cash flow.

Restricted cash at December 29, 2013 and December 30, 2012, in the aggregate amount of $6,477 and $6,467, respectively, is used to collateralize standby letters of credit in the name of the Company’s insurers in accordance with certain insurance policies and as cash collateral for certain business operations.

(21) Related-Party Transactions

As of December 29, 2013, Newcastle (an affiliate of FIG LLC (“Fortress”)) beneficially owned approximately 84.6% of the Company’s outstanding common stock.

 

F-53


Table of Contents

In addition, the Company’s Chairman, Wesley Edens, is also the Co-Chairman of the board of directors of FIG LLC. The Company does not pay Mr. Edens a salary or any other form of compensation.

Our Chief Operating Officer owns an interest in a company that we received $117 during 2013 for commercial printing services which is included in commercial printing and other on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss).

Our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer are employees of Fortress and their salaries are paid by Fortress.

Management Agreement

On the Effective Date, we entered into a Management Agreement with our Manager. Our Management Agreement requires our Manager to manage our business affairs subject to the supervision of our Board of Directors.

Our Management Agreement has an initial three-year term and will be automatically renewed for one-year terms thereafter unless terminated either by us or our Manager. From the commencement date of our Common Stock trading on the “regular way” market on a major U.S. national securities exchange (the “Listing”), our Manager is (a) entitled to receive from us a management fee, (b) eligible to receive incentive compensation that is based on our performance and (c) eligible to receive options to purchase New Media Common Stock upon the successful completion of an offering of shares of our Common Stock or any shares of preferred stock with an exercise price equal to the price per share paid by the public or other ultimate purchaser in the offering. In addition, we are obligated to reimburse certain expenses incurred by our Manager. Our Manager is also entitled to receive a termination fee from us under certain circumstances.

GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement

On November 26, 2013, New Media entered into the GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement (the “GateHouse Management Agreement”) with GateHouse, pursuant to which New Media will manage the assets and the day-to-day operations of GateHouse. New Media will be responsible for, among other things (i) the purchase and sale of GateHouse’s investments (ii) the financing of GateHouse’s investments and (iii) investment advisory services. Such services may be performed by the Manager.

The GateHouse Management Agreement has an initial three-year term and will be automatically renewed for one-year terms thereafter unless terminated by New Media or Gate House. The GateHouse Management Agreement will automatically terminate if the Management Agreement between New Media and the Manager is terminated.

Commencing from the Listing, New Media is (a) entitled to receive a management fee equal to 1.50% per annum of GateHouse’s Total Equity (as defined in the GateHouse Management Agreement) and (b) eligible to receive incentive compensation that is based on GateHouse’s performance. In addition, GateHouse is obligated to reimburse certain expenses incurred by New Media in connection with the performance of its duties under the agreement. These fees eliminate in consolidation.

Local Media Management and Advisory Agreement

On August 27, 2013, GateHouse entered into the Local Media Management Agreement with Local Media Parent, which was substantially assigned to Local Media, to manage the operations of Local Media. Local Media Parent was a subsidiary of Newcastle (an affiliate of Fortress) prior to the Effective Date.

The agreement has a two-year term, with automatic renewal for successive two-year periods unless terminated. While the agreement is in effect, GateHouse will receive an annual management fee of $1,100, subject to adjustments (up to a maximum annual management fee of $1,200), and an annual incentive compensation fee based on exceeding EBITDA targets of Local Media. These fees eliminate in consolidation.

 

F-54


Table of Contents

Registration Rights Agreement with Omega

New Media entered into a registration rights agreement with Omega Advisors, Inc. and its affiliates (collectively, “Omega”). Under the terms of the registration rights agreement, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, New Media will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file a registration statement (the “Registration Statement”) providing for the registration and sale by Omega of its New Media Common Stock acquired pursuant to the Plan (the “Registrable Securities”) as soon as reasonably practicable, but not prior to the earlier of (i) 120 days following the Effective Date and (ii) 14 days after the required financials are completed in the ordinary course of business. During the first 12 months following the Listing, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, Omega may request one demand right with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities under the Registration Statement (the “Demand Registration”).

Once New Media is eligible to use Form S-3, New Media will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file a resale shelf registration statement providing for the registration and sale on a continuous or delayed basis by Omega of its Registrable Securities (the “Shelf Registration”), subject to customary exceptions and limitations. Omega is entitled to initiate up to three offerings or sales with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration.

Omega may only exercise its right to request the Demand Registration and any Shelf Registrations if the Registrable Securities eligible to be sold pursuant to such Registration Statement or Shelf Registration are at least 3% of the then-outstanding New Media Common Stock. This description is a summary and is subject to, and qualified in its entirety by, the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement filed as an exhibit hereto.

(22) Discontinued Operations

In May 2013, the Company disposed of a non wholly owned subsidiary in Chicago, Illinois. As a result, the asset, liability and noncontrolling interest carrying amounts of this subsidiary were derecognized. A loss of $1,146 was recognized in discontinued operations.

During the year ended December 30, 2012, the Company sold 22 publications in Suburban Chicago, Illinois for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $2,800. As a result, an impairment loss of $1,922 is included in loss from discontinued operations on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss) for this period. Additionally, an impairment loss of $206 is included in loss from discontinued operations net of income taxes on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss) for this period related to previously discontinued operations. The financial position and results of operations of the publications in Suburban Chicago, Illinois are reflected as discontinued operations for all periods presented.

During the year ended January 1, 2012, the Company discontinued a publication in New York. An impairment loss of $404 is included in discontinued operations on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss) for this period for the aforementioned discontinued operation and previously sold and discontinued operations.

The net revenue for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, for the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 for the aforementioned discontinued operations was $0, $394, $8,722 and $11,123, respectively. Loss, net of income taxes of $0, for the Successor Company for the two months ended December 29, 2013, for the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 and for the years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012 for the aforementioned discontinued operations was $0, $1,034, $2,340 and $699, respectively.

 

F-55


Table of Contents

(23) Quarterly Results (unaudited)

 

    Predecessor     Predecessor     Predecessor     Predecessor          Successor  
    Quarter Ended
March 31
    Quarter Ended
June 30
    Quarter Ended
September 29
    One Month Ended
November 6
         Two Months Ended
December 29
 

Year Ended December 29, 2013

             

Revenues

  $ 110,582      $ 119,597      $ 125,992      $ 57,119          $ 103,231   

Operating income

    (2,461     2,283        (90,143     6,965            9,495   

Income (loss) before income taxes

    (17,428     (13,175     (140,896     959,542            7,697   

Net income (loss)

    (17,515     (14,122     (129,153     948,204            7,206   

Basic income (loss) per share

  $ (0.30   $ (0.25   $ (2.22   $ 16.33          $ 0.24   

Diluted income (loss) per share

  $ (0.30   $ (0.25   $ (2.22   $ 16.33          $ 0.24   

 

     Predecessor     Predecessor     Predecessor     Predecessor  
     Quarter Ended
April 1
    Quarter Ended
July 1
    Quarter Ended
September 30
    Quarter Ended
December 30
 

Year Ended December 30, 2012

        

Revenues

   $ 117,211      $ 125,970      $ 119,980      $ 125,393   

Operating income (loss)

     936        11,644        6,881        10,332   

Income (loss) before income taxes

     (13,072     (2,342     (7,944     (4,312

Net income (loss)

     (13,241     (2,690     (9,313     (4,559

Basic income (loss) per share

   $ (0.23   $ (0.05   $ (0.16   $ (0.08

Diluted income (loss) per share

   $ (0.23   $ (0.05   $ (0.16   $ (0.08

(24) Subsequent Events

Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan

On February 3, 2014, the Board of Directors (the “Board”) of New Media Investment Group Inc. (“New Media”) adopted the New Media Investment Group Inc. Nonqualified Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan (the “Incentive Plan”).

On the same date, the Board adopted a form of the New Media Investment Group Inc. Non-Officer Director Restricted Stock Grant Agreement (the “Form Grant Agreement”) to govern the terms of awards of restricted stock (“Restricted Stock”) granted under the Incentive Plan to directors who are not officers or employees of New Media (the “Non-Officer Directors”). The Form Grant Agreement provides for the grant of Restricted Stock that vests in equal annual installments on each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the grant date, subject to the Non-Officer Director’s continued service as a member of the Board, and immediate vesting in full upon his or her death or disability. If the Non-Officer Director’s service terminates for any other reason, all unvested shares of Restricted Stock will be forfeited. Any dividends or other distributions that are declared with respect to the shares of Restricted Stock will be paid to the Non-Officer Director at the time such shares vest. On March 14, 2014, a grant of restricted shares totaling 15,870 was made to the Company’s Non-Officer Directors.

Spin-off

On February 13, 2014, Newcastle completed the spin-off of the Company. On February 14, 2014 New Media became a separate, publicly traded company trading on the NYSE under the ticker symbol “NEWM”. As a result of the spin-off, the fees included in the Management Agreement with our Manager became effective.

Acquisition

On February 28, 2014, the Company completed its acquisition of five publications from Freedom Communications for an aggregate purchase price of $8,000. The acquisition includes two daily and three weekly publications serving Southern California with an aggregate circulation of approximately 56.

Interest Rate Swap Agreement

On February 25, 2014, the Company entered into an interest rate swap agreement with PNC Bank in the notional amount of $6,250. The agreement swaps one month LIBOR, includes a fixed rate of 1.5% and terminates on November 26, 2018.

 

F-56


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets

(In thousands, except share data)

 

     June 29,
2014
    December 29,
2013
 
     (unaudited)        
ASSETS     

Current assets:

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31,347      $ 31,811   

Restricted cash

     6,477        6,477   

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $889 and $349 at June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013, respectively

     65,322        71,401   

Inventory

     7,463        7,697   

Prepaid expenses

     7,974        7,986   

Other current assets

     15,057        11,799   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     133,640        137,171   

Property, plant, and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of $22,241 and $5,539 at June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013, respectively

     258,498        270,187   

Goodwill

     126,571        125,911   

Intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization of $4,265 and $1,049 at June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013, respectively

     144,475        145,401   

Deferred financing costs, net

     3,543        8,297   

Other assets

     3,816        2,986   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 670,543      $ 689,953   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY     

Current liabilities:

    

Current portion of long-term liabilities

   $ 646      $ 699   

Current portion of long-term debt

     1,500        4,312   

Accounts payable

     5,454        10,973   

Accrued expenses

     40,853        55,818   

Deferred revenue

     31,746        30,620   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     80,199        102,422   

Long-term liabilities:

    

Long-term debt

     190,898        177,703   

Long-term liabilities, less current portion

     4,616        4,405   

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations

     9,407        10,061   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     285,120        294,591   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity:

    

Common stock, $0.01 par value, 2,000,000,000 shares authorized at June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013; 30,015,870 and 30,000,000 issued and 30,015,870 and 30,000,000 outstanding at June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013, respectively

     300        300   

Additional paid-in capital

     387,419        387,398   

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     458        458   

(Accumulated deficit) retained earnings

     (2,754     7,206   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ equity

     385,423        395,362   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

   $ 670,543      $ 689,953   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-57


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

 

     Successor
Company

Three months
ended

June 29, 2014
          Predecessor
Company

Three months
ended

June 30, 2013
    Successor
Company

Six months
ended

June 29, 2014
          Predecessor
Company

Six months
ended

June 30, 2013
 

Revenues:

                  

Advertising

   $ 95,837           $ 79,220      $ 178,460           $ 150,559   

Circulation

     46,102             33,047        90,471             65,513   

Commercial printing and other

     16,494             7,331        31,535             14,107   
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

 

Total revenues

     158,433             119,598        300,466             230,179   

Operating costs and expenses:

                  

Operating costs

     87,615             64,978        172,470             129,998   

Selling, general, and administrative

     52,235             41,156        102,251             78,722   

Depreciation and amortization

     10,109             9,791        19,918             19,636   

Integration and reorganization costs

     412             741        837             958   

Loss on sale of assets

     688             649        687             1,043   
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

 

Operating income (loss)

     7,374             2,283        4,303             (178

Interest expense

     3,827             14,456        7,632             28,886   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

     333             261        758             522   

Loss on early extinguishment of debt

     9,047             —          9,047             —     

Loss on derivative instruments

     76             5        51             9   

Other (income) expense

     (159          737        (158          1,008   
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

 

Loss from continuing operations before income taxes

     (5,750          (13,176     (13,027          (30,603

Income tax benefit

     (2,481          —          (3,067          —     
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

 

Loss from continuing operations

     (3,269          (13,176     (9,960          (30,603

Loss from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

     —               (946     —               (1,034
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

 

Net loss

     (3,269          (14,122     (9,960          (31,637
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

 
   

Loss per share:

                  

Basic and diluted:

                  

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (0.11        $ (0.23   $ (0.33        $ (0.53

Loss from discontinued operations, net of income taxes

     —               (0.01     —               (0.01
  

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (0.11        $ (0.24   $ (0.33        $ (0.54
   

Basic weighted average shares outstanding

     30,000,000             58,076,193        30,000,000             58,063,901   

Diluted weighted average shares outstanding

     30,000,000             58,076,193        30,000,000             58,063,901   
   

Comprehensive loss

   $ (3,269        $ (7,126   $ (9,960        $ (16,923

See accompanying notes to unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-58


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statement of Stockholders’ Equity

(In thousands, except share data)

 

     Common stock      Additional      Accumulated other
comprehensive
     (Accumulated
deficit) retained
       
     Shares      Amount      paid-in capital      income      earnings     Total  

Balance at December 30, 2013

     30,000,000       $ 300       $ 387,398       $ 458       $ 7,206      $ 395,362   

Net loss

     —          —          —          —          (9,960     (9,960

Restricted share grants

     15,870         —          —          —          —         —    

Non-cash compensation expense

     —          —          21         —          —         21   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at June 29, 2014

     30,015,870       $ 300       $ 387,419       $ 458       $ (2,754   $ 385,423   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-59


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(In thousands)

 

    Successor Company
Six months
ended
June 29, 2014
         Predecessor Company
Six months
ended
June 30, 2013
 

Cash flows from operating activities:

       

Net loss

  $ (9,960       $ (31,637

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities:

       

Depreciation and amortization

    19,918            19,693   

Amortization of deferred financing costs

    758            522   

Loss on derivative instruments, realized and unrealized

    (25         9   

Non-cash compensation expense

    21            25   

Non-cash interest expense

    107            —    

Non-cash loss on early extinguishment of debt

    5,949            —    

Loss on sale of assets

    687            2,198   

Pension and other postretirement benefit obligations

    (669         (428

Changes in assets and liabilities:

       

Accounts receivable, net

    6,783            4,912   

Inventory

    392            710   

Prepaid expenses

    234            518   

Other assets

    (4,046         194   

Accounts payable

    (5,667         (293

Accrued expenses

    (12,106         2,591   

Deferred revenue

    594            112   

Other long-term liabilities

    211            (215
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

    3,181            (1,089
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

       

Purchases of property, plant, and equipment

    (1,639         (2,018

Proceeds from sale of assets

    311            740   

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired

    (8,028         —    
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

    (9,356         (1,278
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

       

Payment of debt issuance costs

    (4,565         —    

Borrowings under term loans

    193,275            —    

Borrowings under revolving credit facility

    7,068            —    

Repayments under long-term debt

    (157,999         (6,648

Repayments under revolving credit facility

    (32,068         —    
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

    5,711            (6,648
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents

    (464         (9,015

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

    31,811            34,527   
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  $ 31,347          $ 25,512   
 

 

 

       

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements.

 

F-60


Table of Contents

NEW MEDIA INVESTMENT GROUP INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

(In thousands, except share and per share data)

(1) Unaudited Financial Statements

The accompanying unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements of New Media Investment Group Inc. and its subsidiaries (together, the “Company” or “New Media”) have been prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) for interim financial information and the instructions to Form 10-Q and applicable provisions of Regulation S-X, each as promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). Certain information and note disclosures normally included in comprehensive annual financial statements presented in accordance with GAAP have generally been condensed or omitted pursuant to SEC rules and regulations.

Management believes that the accompanying condensed consolidated financial statements contain all adjustments (which include normal recurring adjustments) that, in the opinion of management, are necessary to present fairly the Company’s consolidated financial condition, results of operations and cash flows for the periods presented. The results of operations for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the full year. These condensed consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the audited consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes for the year ended December 29, 2013, included in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

New Media, formerly known as GateHouse Media, Inc. (“GateHouse” or “Predecessor”), was formed as a Delaware corporation on June 18, 2013. New Media was capitalized and issued 1,000 common shares to Newcastle Investment Corp. (“Newcastle”). Newcastle owned approximately 84.6% of New Media until February 13, 2014, upon which date Newcastle distributed the shares that it held in New Media to its shareholders on a pro rata basis. New Media had no operations until November 26, 2013, when it assumed control of GateHouse and Local Media Group Holdings LLC (“Local Media Parent”). The Predecessor and certain of its subsidiaries (collectively, the “Debtors”) filed voluntary petitions under Chapter 11 of title 11 of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code (the “Bankruptcy Code”), in the U.S. Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware (the “Bankruptcy Court”) on September 27, 2013. On November 6, 2013 (the “Confirmation Date”), the Bankruptcy Court confirmed the plan of reorganization (the “Plan” or Plan of Reorganization) and on November 26, 2013 (the “Effective Date”), the Debtors emerged from Chapter 11.

As discussed in Note 2, upon emerging from Chapter 11 protection, the Debtors adopted fresh start accounting in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”), Topic 852, Reorganizations” (“ASC 852”). The adoption of fresh start accounting resulted in the Company becoming a new entity for financial reporting purposes as of November 6, 2013. Accordingly, the consolidated financial statements on November 7, 2013 and subsequent periods are not comparable, in various material respects, to the Company’s consolidated financial statements prior to that date.

GateHouse was determined to be the predecessor to New Media, as the operations of GateHouse comprise substantially all of the business operations of the combined entities. As such, the consolidated financial statements presented herein for all periods prior to November 6, 2013 reflect the historical consolidated financial statements of the Predecessor and its subsidiaries. Further, the Reorganization Value, as defined below, of the Predecessor at the Confirmation Date, approximated fair value as of November 26, 2013.

 

F-61


Table of Contents

The “Company,” when used in reference to the period subsequent to the application of fresh start accounting on November 6, 2013, refers to the “Successor Company,” and when used in reference to periods prior to fresh start accounting, refers to the “Predecessor Company.”

The Company’s operating segments (Large Community Newspapers, Small Community Newspapers, Local Media Newspapers and Ventures) are aggregated into one reportable segment.

The newspaper industry and the Predecessor have experienced declining same store revenue and profitability over the past several years. As a result, the Company’s Predecessor previously implemented, and the Company continues to implement, plans to reduce costs and preserve cash flow. This includes cost reduction programs and the sale of non-core assets. The Company believes these initiatives will provide it with the financial resources necessary to invest in the business and provide sufficient cash flow to enable the Company to meet its commitments for the next year.

For the six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013 the Company excluded 1,362,479 and 0 common stock warrants and 15,870 and 0 restricted stock grants, respectively, from the computation of diluted income per share because their effect would have been antidilutive.

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

The changes in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) by component for the six months ended June 29, 2014 are outlined below.

 

     Gain (loss) on
derivative
instruments
    Net actuarial loss
and prior service
cost(1)
    Total  

For the six months ended June 30, 2013, Predecessor Company:

      

Balance at December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ (45,651   $ (6,991   $ (52,642
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

     (396     —         (396

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss

     15,076       34        15,110   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current period other comprehensive income, net of taxes

     14,680        34        14,714   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at June 30, 2013, Predecessor Company

   $ (30,971   $ (6,957   $ (37,928
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

For the six months ended June 29, 2014, Successor Company:

      

Balance at December 29, 2013, Successor Company

   $ —       $ 458      $ 458   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

     —         —         —    

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income

     —         —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net current period other comprehensive income, net of taxes

     —         —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at June 29, 2014, Successor Company

   $ —       $ 458      $ 458   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)  This accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) component is included in the computation of net periodic benefit cost and there was no amortization for the Successor Company during the six months ended June 29, 2014 due to the impact of fresh start accounting. See Note 11.

 

F-62


Table of Contents

The following table presents reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the Successor Company for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and the Predecessor Company for the three and six months ended June 30, 2013.

 

    Amounts Reclassified from Accumulated Other Comprehensive
Loss
     
    Successor
Company Three
months ended
June 29, 2014
         Predecessor
Company Three
months ended
June 30, 2013
    Successor
Company Six
months ended
June 29, 2014
         Predecessor
Company Six
months ended
June 30, 2013
   

Affected Line Item in the Consolidated
Statements of Operations and

Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Realized gain on interest rate swap agreements, designated as cash flow hedges

  $ —           $ 7,543      $ —           $ 15,076      Interest expense

Amortization of prior service cost

    —             (114     —              (228   (1)

Amortization of unrecognized loss

    —             131        —             262      (1)
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss

    —             7,560        —             15,110      Loss from continuing operations before income taxes

Income tax expense

    —             —         —             —        Income tax expense
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of taxes

  $ —           $ 7,560      $ —           $ 15,110      Net loss
 

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

 

       

 

 

   

 

(1)  This accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) component is included in the computation of net periodic benefit cost. See Note 11.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

In July 2013, the FASB issued Accounting Standard Update (“ASU”) No. 2013-11, “Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists” which requires an unrecognized tax benefit to be presented as a reduction to a deferred tax asset for a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss or a tax credit carryforward that the entity intends to use as of the reporting date. The Company adopted the provisions of ASU No. 2013-11 in fiscal year 2014. The amendments in ASU No. 2013-11 did not have a material impact on the financial statements.

In April 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-08, “Presentation of Financial Statements and Property, Plant, and Equipment: Reporting Discontinued Operations and Disclosures of Disposals of Components of an Entity”. ASU 2014-08 changes the criteria for reporting discontinued operations while enhancing disclosures in this area and is effective for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2014. The amendments in ASU No. 2014-08 are not expected to have a material impact on the financial statements.

In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-09, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers.” ASU 2014-09 will replace all current U.S. GAAP guidance on this topic and eliminate all industry-specific guidance. The new revenue recognition standard provides a unified model to determine when and how revenue is recognized. The core principle is that a company should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. This guidance will be effective for annual and interim reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2016. The Company is currently reviewing the amendments in ASU No. 2014-09, but does not expect them to have a material impact on the financial statements.

 

F-63


Table of Contents

(2) Voluntary Reorganization Under Chapter 11

Predecessor and certain of its subsidiaries commenced voluntary Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings in the Bankruptcy Court on September 27, 2013 (the “Petition Date”). Concurrent with the bankruptcy filing, the Predecessor filed and requested confirmation of the Plan.

The Plan restructured the Predecessor debt as follows:

(a) Each holder of the Predecessor debt (“Creditors”) received, in full and final satisfaction of its respective claim, at its election (with respect to all or any portion of its claims) to be made in connection with solicitation of the Plan, its pro rata share of either:

i. Cash pursuant to the Cash-Out Offer (the “Cash-Out Option”). In connection with the Plan, Newcastle (or its designated affiliates) offered to purchase, in cash, an amount equal to 40% of the sum of (a) $1,167,450 of principal of the claims under the 2007 Credit Facility (as defined below), plus (b) accrued and unpaid interest at the applicable contract non-default rate with respect thereto, plus (c) all amounts due under and subject to the terms of the interest rate swaps secured under the 2007 Credit Facility (for the avoidance of doubt, excluding any default interest) on the Effective Date of the Plan; or

ii. (A) Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share, of New Media (“New Media Common Stock”) (subject to dilution as discussed herein) and (B) the net proceeds, net of certain transaction costs (collectively, the “New Media Equity Option”). Creditors who elected the New Media Equity Option received in satisfaction of their claims, a pro rata share of New Media Common Stock and the net proceeds from the Successor Company’s credit facilities entered into on November 26, 2013, net of certain transaction costs.

(b) Pension, trade and all other unsecured claims were unimpaired by the Plan.

(c) The interest of holders of equity interests in the Predecessor Company, including warrants, rights and options to acquire such equity interests (“Former Equity Holders”), were cancelled, and Former Equity Holders received 10-year warrants, collectively representing the right to acquire, in the aggregate, equity equal to 5% of the issued and outstanding shares of New Media (the “New Media Warrants”) (subject to dilution) as of the Effective Date.

Contribution of Local Media Group Holdings LLC

Local Media Parent, a wholly owned subsidiary of Newcastle, acquired Local Media Group, Inc. (“Local Media”), a publisher of daily and weekly newspaper publications, on September 3, 2013. Subject to the terms of the Plan, Newcastle contributed Local Media Parent and assigned its rights under the related stock purchase agreement to New Media on the Effective Date (the “Local Media Contribution”) in exchange for shares of New Media Common Stock equal in value to the cost of the Local Media Acquisition (as defined below) (as adjusted pursuant to the Plan) based upon the equity value of New Media as of the Effective Date prior to the contribution.

Fresh Start Accounting

Upon confirmation of the Plan by the Bankruptcy Court on the Effective Date, the Company satisfied the remaining material conditions to complete the implementation of the Plan, and as a result, the Company adopted fresh start accounting as (i) the reorganization value of the assets of the Successor Company immediately before the date of confirmation of the Plan was less than the total of all post-petition liabilities and allowed claims and (ii) the holders of the Predecessor’s voting shares immediately before confirmation of the Plan received less than 50% of the voting shares of the emerging entity.

The Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Plan based upon an estimated enterprise value of the Company between $385,000 and $515,000, which was estimated using various valuation methods, including (i) a

 

F-64


Table of Contents

comparison of the Company and its projected performance to the market values of comparable companies; (ii) a review and analysis of several recent transactions of companies in similar industries to the Company; and (iii) a calculation of the present value of the future cash flows of the Company based on its projections. The Company concluded the enterprise value was $489,931 based upon the Cash-Out Offer and equity distribution plus estimated transaction fees.

The determination of the estimated reorganization value was based on a discounted cash flow analysis. This value was reconciled to the transaction value as outlined within the Plan and was within a reasonable range of comparable market multiples. The assumptions used in the calculations for the discounted cash flow analysis included projected revenue, costs, and cash flows through 2016 and represented the Company’s best estimates at the time the analysis was prepared. While the Company considers such estimates and assumptions reasonable, they are inherently subject to significant business, economic and competitive uncertainties, many of which are beyond the Company’s control and, therefore, may not be realized.

Upon adoption of fresh start accounting, the recorded amounts of assets and liabilities were adjusted to reflect their estimated fair values (the “Reorganization Value”). Accordingly, the reported historical financial statements of the Predecessor prior to the adoption of fresh start accounting for periods ended on or prior to November 6, 2013 are not comparable to those of the Successor Company.

In applying fresh start accounting, the Company followed these principles:

The Reorganization Value, which represents the concluded enterprise value plus excess cash and cash equivalents and non-interesting bearing liabilities, of the Predecessor was allocated to the entity’s net assets in conformity with FASB ASC Topic 805, “Business Combinations” (“ASC 805”). The Reorganization Value exceeded the sum of the fair value assigned to assets and liabilities. This excess was recorded as Successor Company goodwill as of November 6, 2013.

Each liability existing as of the fresh start accounting date, other than deferred taxes, has been stated at the fair value, and determined at appropriate risk adjusted interest rates. Deferred taxes were reported in conformity with applicable income tax accounting standards, principally FASB ASC Topic 740, “Income Taxes” (“ASC 740”).

(3) Business Combinations

Local Media

On September 3, 2013, Local Media Parent, a wholly owned subsidiary of Newcastle, acquired Local Media. GateHouse entered into a management and advisory agreement with Local Media Parent, which was assigned to Local Media, to manage the operations of Local Media, which was terminated effective June 4, 2014. In return, GateHouse received compensation including an annual fee and was eligible to earn an annual incentive pay out equal to 12.5% of the EBITDA of Local Media in excess of budget. Although Newcastle indirectly owned 100% of the equity of Local Media, GateHouse managed the daily operations of Local Media. GateHouse determined that the management and advisory agreement resulted in Local Media being a variable interest entity and GateHouse had the power to direct the activities that most significantly affected the economic performance of the entity. As a result, GateHouse was the primary beneficiary and therefore consolidated Local Media’s financial position and results of operations beginning on September 3, 2013. As 100% of Local Media was indirectly owned by Newcastle, the net income (loss) of Local Media was reflected in noncontrolling interest through the Confirmation Date as Newcastle contributed the net assets of Local Media Parent (the direct parent of Local Media) to New Media as part of the Plan.

The Predecessor accounted for the consolidation of Local Media under the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, the net assets, including noncontrolling interest, were recorded at their fair values. The transaction costs were incurred by Newcastle not GateHouse. The net assets, including goodwill of Local Media were recorded in the consolidated balance sheet at their estimated fair value in accordance with ASC 805. The value

 

F-65


Table of Contents

allocated in consolidating Local Media, was approximately $83,450 and $2,089 of acquisition related costs were recognized. Local Media Parent contributed a net amount of $53,323 of equity and Local Media entered into a long-term debt agreement for $33,000. Local Media consists of eight daily and fifteen weekly newspapers as well as ten shopper publications, serving areas of New York, Massachusetts, California, Pennsylvania, Oregon and New Hampshire. The results of operations for Local Media were included in the Predecessor’s consolidated financial statements from September 3, 2013.

The following table summarizes estimated fair values of the Local Media assets and liabilities as of September 3, 2013:

 

Current assets

   $ 18,349   

Property, plant and equipment

     73,718   

Mastheads

     4,100   

Goodwill

     462   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

     96,629   

Current liabilities

     13,179   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     13,179   
  

 

 

 

Net assets

   $ 83,450   
  

 

 

 

The Predecessor obtained third party independent appraisals to assist in the determination of the fair values of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets. The property, plant and equipment appraisal included an analysis of recent comparable sales and offerings of land parcels in each of the subject’s markets. The appraised value is supported with consideration and use of standard accepted appraisal practices and valuation procedures. The appraiser used the three basic approaches to value: the cost approach (used for equipment where an active secondary market is not available and building improvements), the direct sales comparison (market) approach (used for land and equipment where an active secondary market is available) and the income approach (used for intangible assets). These approaches used are based on the cost to reproduce assets, market exchanges for comparable assets and the capitalization of income. Useful lives range from 1 to 7 years for personal property and 17 to 38 years for real property.

The appraisal utilized a relief from royalty method, an income approach, to determine the fair value of mastheads. Key assumptions utilized in this valuation include revenue projections, a royalty rate of 1.5%, long term growth rate of 0%, tax rate of 39.2% and discount rate of 25.0%. Based on estimated discount rates, attrition levels and other available data, the advertiser and subscriber relationships were determined to have a fair value of $0.

Trade accounts receivable, having an estimated fair value of $13,427, were included in the acquired assets. The gross contractual amount of these receivables was $14,937 and the contractual cash flows not expected to be collected was estimated at $1,510 as of the acquisition date.

Local Media accounted for inventory using a weighted cost methodology, which was deemed to approximate fair value. The FIFO valuation method is used and is consistent with the Company’s inventory valuation. The difference between the weighted average and FIFO methodology does not have a material effect on the results of operations.

For tax purposes, the amount of goodwill that is expected to be deductible is $1,187 as of June 29, 2014. This amount includes goodwill adjustments related to fresh start accounting.

Other Acquisition

During the six months ended June 29, 2014 the Company acquired two daily and three weekly publications in Victorville, CA for an aggregate purchase price, including estimated working capital, of $7,885. The rationale

 

F-66


Table of Contents

for the acquisition was primarily due to the attractive nature of the community newspaper assets with stable revenues and cash flows combined with cost saving opportunities available by clustering with the Company’s nearby newspapers.

The Company has accounted for this acquisition under the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, the assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recorded at their fair values. The net assets, including goodwill have been recorded in the condensed consolidated balance sheet at their estimated fair value in accordance with ASC 805.

The following table summarizes estimated fair values of the assets and liabilities:

 

Current assets

   $ 940   

Property, plant and equipment

     5,050   

Advertiser relationships

     980   

Subscriber relationships

     600   

Customer relationships

     180   

Mastheads

     530   

Goodwill

     660   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

     8,940   

Current liabilities

     1,055   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     1,055   
  

 

 

 

Net assets

   $ 7,885   
  

 

 

 

The Company obtained third party independent appraisals to assist in the determination of the fair values of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets. The appraisal used the three basic approaches: the Cost Approach (used for equipment where an active secondary market is not available and building improvements), the Direct Sales Comparison (Market) Approach (used for land and equipment where an active secondary market is available) and the Income Approach (used for subscriber relationships, advertiser relationships, customer relationships and mastheads).

For tax purposes, the amount of goodwill that is expected to be deductible is $660 as of June 29, 2014.

The estimated fair values are preliminary pending the finalization of the valuation.

Pro-Forma Results

The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statement of operations information for 2013, set forth below, presents the results of operations as if the consolidation of the newspapers from Local Media had occurred on December 31, 2012. These amounts are not necessarily indicative of future results or actual results that would have been achieved had the acquisitions occurred as of the beginning of such period.

 

     Three months
ended
June 30, 2013
    Six months
ended
June 30, 2013
 

Revenues

   $ 159,306      $ 305,393   

Loss from continuing operations

   $ (38,334   $ (55,809

Loss from continuing operations per common share:

    

Basic

   $ (0.66   $ (0.96

Diluted

   $ (0.66   $ (0.96

 

F-67


Table of Contents

(4) Share-Based Compensation

The Company and Predecessor recognized compensation cost for share-based payments of $18, $1, $21 and $25 during the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013, respectively. The total compensation cost not yet recognized related to non-vested awards as of June 29, 2014 was $187, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 2.71 years through March 2017.

On February 3, 2014, the Board of Directors of New Media adopted the New Media Investment Group Inc. Nonqualified Stock Option and Incentive Award Plan (the “Incentive Plan”) that authorized up to 15,000,000 shares that can be granted under the Incentive Plan. On the same date, the New Media Board adopted a form of the New Media Investment Group Inc. Non-Officer Director Restricted Stock Grant Agreement (the “Form Grant Agreement”) to govern the terms of awards of restricted stock (“New Media Restricted Stock”) granted under the Incentive Plan to directors who are not officers or employees of New Media (the “Non-Officer Directors”). The Form Grant Agreement provides for the grant of New Media Restricted Stock that vests in equal annual installments on each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the grant date, subject to the Non-Officer Director’s continued service as a member of the New Media Board, and immediate vesting in full upon his or her death or disability. If the non-officer director’s service terminates for any other reason, all unvested shares of New Media Restricted Stock will be forfeited. Any dividends or other distributions that are declared with respect to the shares of New Media Restricted Stock will be paid to the Non-Officer Director at the time such shares vest. During the period prior to the lapse and removal of the vesting restrictions, a grantee of a Restricted Share Grant (“RSG”) will have all the rights of a stockholder, including without limitation, the right to vote and the right to receive all dividends or other distributions. As a result, the RSGs are reflected as outstanding common stock. The value of the Non-Officer Director RSGs on the date of issuance is recognized as selling, general and administrative expense over the vesting period with an increase to additional paid-in-capital. On March 14, 2014, a grant of restricted shares totaling 15,870 shares was made to the Company’s Non-Officer Directors.

Under the Predecessor’s GateHouse Media, Inc. Omnibus Stock Incentive Plan (the “Predecessor RSG Plan”), 266,795 RSGs were granted to Company directors, management and employees, 42,535 of which were both granted and forfeited during the year ended December 31, 2008. An additional 100,000 RSGs were granted to Company management during the year ended December 31, 2009. The majority of the RSGs issued under the Predecessor RSG Plan vested in increments of one-third on each of the first, second and third anniversaries of the grant date. All Predecessor RSGs vested prior to the Predecessor filing for bankruptcy.

As of June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013, there were 15,870 and 0 RSGs, respectively, issued and outstanding with a weighted average grant date fair value of $14.18 and $0.00, respectively. As of June 29, 2014, the aggregate intrinsic value of unvested RSGs was $217. During the six months ended June 29, 2014, the aggregate fair value of vested RSGs was $0.

RSG activity during the six months ended June 29, 2014 was as follows:

 

     Number of RSGs      Weighted-Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
 

Unvested at December 29, 2013

     —        $ —    

Granted

     15,870         14.18   
  

 

 

    

Unvested at June 29, 2014

     15,870       $ 14.18   
  

 

 

    

FASB ASC Topic 718, “Compensation – Stock Compensation”, requires the recognition of share-based compensation for the number of awards that are ultimately expected to vest. The Company’s estimated forfeitures are based on the Company’s historical forfeiture rates. Estimated forfeitures are reassessed periodically and the estimate may change based on new facts and circumstances.

 

F-68


Table of Contents

(5) Restructuring

Over the past several years, and in furtherance of the Company’s cost reduction and cash flow preservation plans outlined in Note 1, the Company has engaged in a series of individual restructuring programs, designed primarily to right size the Company’s employee base, consolidate facilities and improve its operations. These initiatives impact all of the Company’s geographic regions and are often influenced by the terms of union contracts within each region. All costs related to these programs, which primarily reflect severance expense, are accrued at the time of announcement.

Information related to restructuring program activity for the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014 and the two months ended December 29, 2013, and for the Predecessor Company for the ten months ended November 6, 2013 is outlined below.

 

     Severance and
Related Costs
    Other
Costs(1)
    Total  

Balance at December 30, 2012, Predecessor Company

   $ 684      $ 164      $ 848   

Restructuring provision included in integration and reorganization

     1,539        38        1,577   

Cash payments

     (1,738     (207     (1,945
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at November 6, 2013, Predecessor Company

   $ 485      $ (5   $ 480   

Restructuring provision included in Integration and Reorganization(2)

     1,758        —         1,758   

Cash payments

     (501     —         (501
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 29, 2013, Successor Company

   $ 1,742      $ (5   $ 1,737   

Restructuring provision included in Integration and Reorganization

     1,465        —         1,465   

Reversals of prior accruals included in Integration and Reorganization

     (628     —         (628

Cash payments

     (1,621     5       (1,616
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at June 29, 2014, Successor Company

   $ 958      $ —       $ 958   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) Other costs primarily included costs to consolidate operations.
(2)  Included above are amounts that were initially recognized in integration and reorganization costs and were subsequently reclassified to discontinued operations expense at the time the affected operations ceased.

The restructuring reserve balance, which is included in accrued expenses, as of June 29, 2014, for all programs was $958, which is expected to be paid out over the next twelve months.

The following table summarizes the costs incurred and cash paid in connection with these restructuring programs for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013.

 

    Successor Company
Three Months Ended
June 29, 2014
         Predecessor Company
Three Months Ended
June 30, 2013
    Successor Company
Six Months Ended
June 29, 2014
         Predecessor Company
Six Months Ended
June 30, 2013
 

Severance and related costs

  $ 1,040          $ 726      $ 1,465          $ 920   

Reversals of prior accruals

    (628         —         (628         —    

Other costs

    —             15        —             38   

Cash payments

    (812         (371     (1,616         (1,021

 

F-69


Table of Contents

(6) Goodwill and Intangible Assets

Goodwill and intangible assets consisted of the following:

 

     June 29, 2014  
     Gross carrying
amount
     Accumulated
amortization
     Net carrying
amount
 

Amortized intangible assets:

        

Advertiser relationships

   $ 59,500       $ 2,487       $ 57,013   

Customer relationships

     5,870         267         5,603   

Subscriber relationships

     36,720         1,493         35,227   

Trade name

     270         18         252   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 102,360       $ 4,265       $ 98,095   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Nonamortized intangible assets:

        

Goodwill

   $ 126,571         

Mastheads

     46,380         
  

 

 

       

Total

   $ 172,951         
  

 

 

       
     December 29, 2013  
     Gross Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
     Net Carrying
Amount
 

Amortized intangible assets:

        

Advertiser relationships

   $ 58,520       $ 610       $ 57,910   

Customer relationships

     5,690         59         5,631   

Subscriber relationships

     36,120         375         35,745   

Trade name

     270         5         265   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 100,600       $ 1,049       $ 99,551   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Nonamortized intangible assets:

        

Goodwill

   $ 125,911         

Mastheads

     45,850         
  

 

 

       

Total

   $ 171,761         
  

 

 

       

As of June 29, 2014, the weighted average amortization periods for amortizable intangible assets are 15.9 years for advertiser relationships, 15.9 years for customer relationships, 16.0 years for subscriber relationships and 10.0 years for trade names. The weighted average amortization period in total for all amortizable intangible assets is 15.9 years.

Amortization expense for the Successor Company for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and for the Predecessor Company for the three and six months ended June 30, 2013 was $1,623, $5,823, $3,216 and $11,668, respectively. Estimated future amortization expense as of June 29, 2014 is as follows:

For the years ending the Sunday closest to December 31:

 

2014

   $ 3,244   

2015

     6,457   

2016

     6,457   

2017

     6,457   

2018

     6,457   

Thereafter

     69,023   
  

 

 

 

Total

   $ 98,095   
  

 

 

 

 

F-70


Table of Contents

The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the period from December 29, 2013 to June 29, 2014 are as follows:

 

Balance at December 29, 2013

   $ 125,911   

Goodwill acquired in business combination

     660   
  

 

 

 

Balance at June 29, 2014

   $ 126,571   
  

 

 

 

The Company’s annual impairment assessment is made on the last day of its fiscal second quarter.

As of March 30, 2014 and December 29, 2013, a review of impairment indicators was performed with the Company noting that its financial results and forecast had not changed materially since the fresh start accounting on November 6, 2013 and it was determined that no indicators of impairment were present.

The carrying value of goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets are evaluated for possible impairment on an annual basis or between annual tests if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit or indefinite-lived intangible asset below its carrying value. We are required to determine goodwill impairment using a two-step process. The first step is used to identify potential impairment by comparing the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the impairment test is performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.

As part of the annual impairment assessments, as of June 29, 2014 the fair values of the Company’s reporting units for goodwill impairment testing, which include Large Daily Newspapers, Metro Newspapers, Small Community Newspapers, Local Media Newspapers, and Ventures, and newspaper mastheads were estimated using the expected present value of future cash flows, recent industry multiples and using estimates, judgments and assumptions that management believes were appropriate in the circumstances. The estimates and judgments used in the assessment included multiples for revenue and EBITDA, the weighted average cost of capital and the terminal growth rate. The Company determined that the future cash flow and industry multiple analyses provided the best estimate of the fair value of its reporting units. As a result of the annual assessments Step 1 analysis that was performed, no impairment of goodwill was identified. The Company uses a “relief from royalty” approach which utilizes a discounted cash flow model to determine the fair value of each masthead. Additionally, the estimated fair value exceeded carrying value for all mastheads. The total Company’s estimate of reporting unit fair value was reconciled to its then market capitalization (based upon the stock market price and fair value of debt) plus an estimated control premium.

Given the recent revaluation of assets related to fresh start accounting, there is a relatively small amount of fair value excess for certain reporting units. Specifically the fair value of the Large Daily Newspapers, Metro Newspapers and Small Community Newspaper reporting units exceeded carrying value by less than 10%. In addition, the masthead fair value for these groups exceeded carrying value by less than 3%. Considering a relatively low headroom for these reporting units and mastheads and declining same store revenue and profitability in the newspaper industry over the past several years, these are considered to be at risk for a future impairment in the event of decline in general economic, market or business conditions or any significant unfavorable changes in the forecasted cash flows, weighted-average cost of capital and/or market transaction multiples.

(7) Indebtedness

Successor Company

GateHouse Credit Facilities

The Revolving Credit, Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “First Lien Credit Facility”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among GateHouse, GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, LLC formerly known as

 

F-71


Table of Contents

GateHouse Media Intermediate Holdco, Inc. (“GMIH”), certain wholly-owned subsidiaries of GMIH, all of which are wholly owned subsidiaries of New Media (collectively with GMIH and GateHouse, the “Loan Parties”), PNC Bank, National Association, as the administrative agent, Crystal Financial LLC, as term loan B agent, and each of the lenders party thereto provided for (i) a term loan A in the aggregate principal amount of $25,000, (ii) a term loan B in the aggregate principal amount of $50,000, (iii) and a revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of up to $40,000.

The Term Loan and Security Agreement (the “Second Lien Credit Facility” and together with the First Lien Credit Facility, the “GateHouse Credit Facilities”) dated November 26, 2013 by and among the Loan Parties, Mutual Quest Fund and each of the lenders party thereto provided for a term loan in an aggregate principal amount of $50,000. The GateHouse Credit Facilities were secured by a first and second priority security interest in substantially all the assets of the Loan Parties.

The GateHouse Credit Facilities imposed upon GateHouse certain financial and operating covenants, including, among others, requirements that GateHouse satisfy certain financial tests, including a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio of not less than 1.0 to 1.0, a maximum leverage ratio of not greater than 3.25 to 1.0, a minimum EBITDA and a limitation on capital expenditures, and restrictions on GateHouse’s ability to incur additional debt, incur liens and encumbrances, consolidate, amalgamate or merge with any other person, pay dividends, dispose of assets, make certain restricted payments, engage in transactions with affiliates, materially alter the business it conducts and taking certain other corporate actions.

The GateHouse Credit Facilities were paid in full on June 4, 2014.

Local Media Credit Facility

Certain of Local Media Parent’s subsidiaries (together, the “Borrowers”) and Local Media Parent entered into a Credit Agreement, dated as of September 3, 2013, with a syndicate of financial institutions with Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch, as administrative agent (the “Local Media Credit Facility”).

The Local Media Credit Facility provided for: (a) a $33,000 term loan facility; and (b) a $10,000 revolving credit facility, with a $3,000 sub-facility for letters of credit and a $4,000 sub-facility for swing loans. The Borrowers used the proceeds of the Local Media Credit Facility to (a) fund a portion of the acquisition of Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Local Media Acquisition”), (b) provide for working capital and other general corporate purposes of the Borrowers and (c) fund certain fees, costs and expenses associated with the transactions contemplated by the Local Media Credit Facility and consummation of the Local Media Acquisition. The Local Media Credit Facility was secured by a first priority security interest in substantially all assets of the Borrowers and Local Media Parent. In addition, the loans and other obligations of the Borrowers under the Local Media Credit Facility are guaranteed by Local Media Group Holdings LLC.

The Local Media Credit Facility contained financial covenants that required Local Media Parent and the Borrowers to maintain (a) a Leverage Ratio of not more than 2.5 to 1.0 and a Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility) of at least 2.0 to 1.0, each measured at the end of each fiscal quarter for the four-quarter period then ended. The Local Media Credit Facility contained affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Local Media and the Borrowers customarily found in loan agreements for similar transactions, including, but not limited to, restrictions on their ability to incur indebtedness, create liens on assets, engage in certain lines of business, engage in mergers or consolidations, dispose of assets, make investments or acquisitions, engage in transactions with affiliates, pay dividends or make other restricted payments. The Local Media Credit Facility contained customary events of default, including, but not limited to, defaults based on a failure to pay principal, interest, fees or other obligations, subject to specified grace periods (other than with respect to principal); any material inaccuracy of representation or warranty; breach of covenants; default in other material indebtedness; a Change of Control (as defined in the Local Media Credit Facility); bankruptcy and insolvency events; material judgments; certain ERISA events; and impairment of collateral. The Local Media

 

F-72


Table of Contents

Credit Facility was amended on October 17, 2013 and February 28, 2014. The October 17, 2013 amendment corrected a typographical mistake. The February 28, 2014 amendment provided that among other things, sales of real property collateral and reinvestment of the proceeds from such sale could only be made with the consent of the Administrative Agent, modified the properties included in the real property collateral, and set forth in detail the documentary post-closing requirements with respect to the real property collateral.

The Local Media Credit Facility was paid in full on June 4, 2014.

New Media Credit Agreement

On June 4, 2014, New Media Holdings II LLC (the “New Media Borrower”), a wholly owned subsidiary of New Media, entered into a credit agreement (the “New Media Credit Agreement”) among the New Media Borrower, New Media Holdings I LLC (“Holdings I”), the lenders party thereto, RBS Citizens, N.A. and Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners, Credit Suisse AG, Cayman Islands Branch as syndication agent and Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania as administration agent which provides for (i) a $200,000 senior secured term facility (the “Term Loan Facility”) and (ii) a $25,000 senior secured revolving credit facility, with a $5,000 sub-facility for letters of credit and a $5,000 sub-facility for swing loans, (the “Revolving Credit Facility” and together with the Term Loan Facility, the “Senior Secured Credit Facilities”). In addition, the New Media Borrower may request one or more new commitments for term loans or revolving loans from time to time up to an aggregate total of $75,000 (the “Incremental Facility”) subject to certain conditions. On June 4, 2014, the New Media Borrower borrowed $200,000 under the Term Loan Facility (the “Term Loans”). The Term Loans mature on June 4, 2020 and the maturity date for the Revolving Credit Facility is June 4, 2019.

The proceeds of the Term Loans, which included a $6,725 original issue discount, were used to repay in full all amounts outstanding under the GateHouse Credit Facilities, the Local Media Credit Facility and to pay fees associated with the financing, with the balance going to the Company for general corporate purposes.

Borrowings under the Term Loan Facility bear interest, at the New Media Borrower’s option, at a rate equal to either (i) the Eurodollar Rate (as defined in the New Media Credit Agreement), plus an applicable margin equal to 6.25% per annum (subject to a Eurodollar Rate floor of 1.00%) or (ii) the Base Rate (as defined in the New Media Credit Agreement), plus an applicable margin equal to 5.25% per annum (subject to a Base Rate floor of 2.00%).

Borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facility bear interest, at the New Media Borrower’s option, at a rate equal to either (i) the Eurodollar Rate, plus an applicable margin equal to 5.25% per annum or (ii) the Base Rate, plus an applicable margin equal to 4.25% per annum, with a step down based on achievement of a certain total leverage ratio.

If any borrowings under the Incremental Facility have an all-in yield more than 50 basis points greater than the Term Loans (the “Incremental Yield”), the all-in yield for the Term Loans shall be adjusted to be 50 basis points less than the Incremental Yield.

The Senior Secured Credit Facilities are unconditionally guaranteed by Holdings I and certain subsidiaries of the New Media Borrower (collectively, the “Guarantors”) and is required to be guaranteed by all future material wholly-owned domestic subsidiaries, subject to certain exceptions. All obligations under the New Media Credit Agreement are secured, subject to certain exceptions, by substantially all of the New Media Borrower’s assets and the assets of the Guarantors, including (a) a pledge of 100% of the equity interests of the New Media Borrower and the Guarantors (other than Holdings I), (b) a mortgage lien on the New Media Borrower’s material real property and that of the Guarantors and (c) all proceeds of the foregoing.

Repayments made under the Term Loans are equal to 1.0% annually of the original principal amount in equal quarterly installments for the life of the Term Loans, with the remainder due at maturity. The New Media

 

F-73


Table of Contents

Borrower is permitted to make voluntary prepayments at any time without premium or penalty, except in the case of prepayments made in connection with certain repricing transactions with respect to the Term Loans effected within six months of the closing date of the New Media Credit Agreement, to which a 1.00% prepayment premium applies. The New Media Borrower is required to repay borrowings under the Senior Secured Credit Facilities (without payment of a premium) with (i) net cash proceeds of certain debt obligations (except as otherwise permitted under the New Media Credit Agreement), (ii) net cash proceeds from non-ordinary course asset sales (subject to reinvestment rights and other exceptions), and (iii) commencing with the Company’s fiscal year started December 30, 2013, 100% of Excess Cash Flow (as defined in the New Media Credit Agreement), subject to step-downs to 50%, 25% and 0% of Excess Cash Flow based on achievement of a total leverage ratio of less than or equal to 3.00 to 1.00 but greater than 2.75 to 1.00; less than or equal to 2.75 to 1.00 but greater than 2.50 to 1.00; and less than or equal to 2.50 to 1.00, respectively.

The New Media Credit Agreement contains customary representations and warranties and customary affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Holdings I, the New Media Borrower and the New Media Borrower’s subsidiaries, including, among other things, restrictions on indebtedness, liens, investments, fundamental changes, dispositions, and dividends and other distributions. The New Media Credit Agreement contains a financial covenant that requires Holdings I, the New Media Borrower and the New Media Borrower’s subsidiaries to maintain a maximum total leverage ratio of 3.25 to 1.00. The New Media Credit Agreement contains customary events of default. The foregoing descriptions of the Senior Secured Credit Facilities are qualified in their entirety by reference to the Senior Secured Credit Facilities. The New Media Credit Agreement was amended on July 17, 2014 to cure an omission.

One lender under the New Media Credit Agreement was also a lender under the GateHouse Credit Facilities. This portion of the transaction was accounted for as a modification under ASC Subtopic 470-50, “Debt Modifications and Extinguishments” (“ASC Subtopic 470-50”), as the difference between the present value of the cash flows under the New Media Credit Agreement and the present value of the cash flows under the GateHouse Credit Facilities was less than 10%. The unamortized deferred financing costs and original issuance discount balances as of the refinance date pertaining to this lender’s portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities will be amortized over the terms of the new facility. The remaining portion of the GateHouse Credit Facilities and the Local Media Credit Facility debt refinancing constituted an extinguishment of debt under ASC Subtopic 470-50, and was accounted for accordingly. In connection with this transaction, the Company incurred approximately $10,202 of fees and expenses, of which $6,725 were recognized as original issue discount and $1,700 were capitalized as deferred financing costs. These amounts will be amortized over the term of the new Senior Secured Credit Facilities. Additionally, the Company recorded a loss on early extinguishment of debt of $9,047 associated with this transaction, which consisted of the write-off of unamortized deferred financing costs and other expenses not eligible for capitalization under ASC Subtopic 470-50.

As of June 29, 2014, the Company is in compliance with all of the covenants and obligations under the New Media Credit Agreement.

Fair Value

The fair value of long-term debt under the Senior Secured Credit Facilities was estimated at $200,000 as of June 29, 2014, based on discounted future contractual cash flows and a market interest rate adjusted for necessary risks, including the Company’s own credit risk as there are no rates currently observable in publically traded debt markets of risk with similar terms and average maturities. Accordingly, the Company’s long-term debt under the Senior Secured Credit Facilities is classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.

 

F-74


Table of Contents

Payment Schedule

As of June 29, 2014, scheduled principal payments of outstanding debt are as follows:

 

2014

   $ 500   

2015

     2,000   

2016

     2,000   

2017

     2,500   

2018

     1,500   

Thereafter

     191,500   
  

 

 

 
   $ 200,000   

Less: Short-term debt

     1,500   

Less: Remaining original issue discount

     7,602   
  

 

 

 

Long-term debt

   $ 190,898   
  

 

 

 

Predecessor Company

As part of the Restructuring, the Predecessor’s previous long term debt was extinguished pursuant to the Support Agreement on the Effective Date of the Plan.

2007 Credit Facility

GateHouse Media Operating, Inc. now known as GateHouse Media Operating, LLC (“Operating”), an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, GateHouse Media Holdco, Inc. now known as GateHouse Media Holdco, LLC (“Holdco”), an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, and certain of their subsidiaries (together, the “Borrowers”) entered into an Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of February 27, 2007, with a syndicate of financial institutions with Wells Fargo Bank, N.A., successor-by-merger to Wachovia Bank, National Association (“Wells Fargo Bank”), as administrative agent (the “2007 Credit Facility”).

The 2007 Credit Facility, prior to execution of the Second Amendment (defined below), provided for: (a) a $670,000 term loan facility which would have matured on August 28, 2014; (b) a delayed draw term loan facility of up to $250,000 which would have matured on August 28, 2014, and (c) a revolving credit facility with a $40,000 aggregate loan commitment amount available, including a $15,000 sub-facility for letters of credit and a $10,000 swingline facility, which would have matured on February 28, 2014. The Borrowers used the proceeds of the 2007 Credit Facility to refinance existing indebtedness and for working capital and other general corporate purposes, including, without limitation, financing acquisitions permitted under the 2007 Credit Facility. The 2007 Credit Facility was secured by a first priority security interest in substantially all of the tangible and intangible assets of Holdco, Operating and their present and future direct and indirect domestic restricted subsidiaries. In addition, the loans and other obligations of the Borrowers under the 2007 Credit Facility were guaranteed, subject to specified limitations, by Holdco, Operating and their present and future direct and indirect domestic restricted subsidiaries.

The 2007 Credit Facility also contained a financial covenant that required Holdco to maintain a Total Leverage Ratio of less than or equal to 6.5 to 1.0 at any time an extension of credit was outstanding under the revolving credit facility and other affirmative and negative covenants applicable to Holdco, Operating and their restricted subsidiaries customarily found in loan agreements for similar transactions. The 2007 Credit Facility contained customary events of default, including defaults based on a failure to pay principal, reimbursement obligations, interest, fees or other obligations, subject to specified grace periods; any material inaccuracy of a representation or warranty; breach of covenant; failure to pay other indebtedness and cross-accelerations; a Change of Control (as defined in the 2007 Credit Facility); events of bankruptcy and insolvency; material judgments; failure to meet certain requirements with respect to ERISA; and impairment of collateral.

 

F-75


Table of Contents

First Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On May 7, 2007, the Borrowers entered into the First Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility (the “First Amendment”). The First Amendment provided, among other things, an incremental term loan facility under the 2007 Credit Facility in the amount of $275,000. As amended by the First Amendment, the 2007 Credit Facility included $1,195,000 of term loan facilities and $40,000 of a revolving credit facility.

Second Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On February 3, 2009, the Company entered into the Second Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility (the “Second Amendment”).

Among other things, the Second Amendment reduced the aggregate principal amounts available under the 2007 Credit Facility, as follows: (a) for revolving loans, from $40,000 to $20,000; (b) for the letter of credit subfacility, from $15,000 to $5,000; and (c) for the swingline loan subfacility, from $10,000 to $5,000.

In addition, the Second Amendment provided that Holdco may not incur additional term debt under the 2007 Credit Facility unless the Senior Secured Incurrence Test (as defined in the Second Amendment) was less than 4.00 to 1.00 and the current Incurrence Test (as defined in the Second Amendment) was satisfied.

Agency Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On April 1, 2011, the Borrowers entered into an Agency Succession and Amendment Agreement, dated as of March 30, 2011, to the 2007 Credit Facility (the “Agency Amendment”).

Pursuant to the Agency Amendment, among other things, (a) Wells Fargo Bank resigned as administrative agent and (b) Gleacher Products Corp. was appointed as administrative agent. In addition, the Agency Amendment effected certain amendments to the 2007 Credit Facility that provided that (x) the administrative agent need not be a lender under the 2007 Credit Facility and (y) the lenders holding a majority of the outstanding term loans and loan commitments under the 2007 Credit Facility have (i) the right, in their discretion, to remove the administrative agent and (ii) the right to make certain decisions and exercise certain powers under the 2007 Credit Facility that had previously been within the discretion of the administrative agent.

Fourth Amendment to 2007 Credit Facility

On September 4, 2013, the Company entered into the Fourth Amendment to the Credit Facility (the “Fourth Amendment”). Pursuant to the terms of the Fourth Amendment, the Company obtained the following improvement in terms: a clarified and expanded definition of “Eligible Assignee”; an increase in the base amount in the formula used to calculate the “Permitted Investments” basket from $35,000 to a base of $50,000; the removal of the requirement that the Company’s annual financial statements not have a “going concern” or like qualification to the audit; the removal of a cross default from any Secured Hedging Agreement to the 2007 Credit Facility; the removal of a Bankruptcy Default, as defined therein, arising from actions in furtherance of or indicating consent to the specified actions; and a waiver of any prior Default or Event of Default, as defined therein.

In consideration of the changes described above, the Company agreed to pay each of the lenders party to the Fourth Amendment that timely executed and delivered its signature to the Fourth Amendment and the RSA, an amendment fee equal to 3.5% multiplied by the aggregate outstanding amount of the Loans held (including through trades pending settlement) by such lender, unless waived in writing. Newcastle and certain other lenders elected to waive their amendment fee pursuant to the Fourth Amendment. Newcastle indemnified other Lenders with respect to their entry into the Fourth Amendment, subject to the limitations set forth in the Fourth Amendment for a total amendment fee paid of approximately $6,790.

 

F-76


Table of Contents

2007 Credit Facility Excess Cash Flow Payment and Outstanding Balance

As required by the 2007 Credit Facility, as amended, on March 26, 2013 and March 15, 2012, the Company made principal payments of $6,648 and $4,600, respectively, which represented 50% of the Excess Cash Flow related to the fiscal years ended December 30, 2012 and January 1, 2012, respectively. As of December 29, 2013, a total of $0 was outstanding under the 2007 Credit Facility.

(8) Derivative Instruments

The Company is exposed to certain risks relating to its ongoing business operations. The primary risk managed by the Company using derivative instruments is interest rate risk. On February 25, 2014, the Company entered into an interest rate swap with a notional amount of $6,250, which matures in November 2018 to economically hedge the risk of fluctuations in interest payments with respect to the First Lien Credit Facility under the GateHouse Credit Facilities. The interest rate swap agreement was terminated on June 4, 2014 when the GateHouse Credit Facilities were paid in full. Under the swap agreement, the Company received interest equivalent to one-month LIBOR and paid a fixed rate of 1.5%, with settlements occurring monthly. The Company did not designate this swap as a cash flow hedge for accounting purposes. The gains (losses) on the swap were recorded in gain (loss) on derivative instruments on the consolidated statements of operations. The counterparty on the interest rate swap was PNC Bank, N.A.

The Company’s derivative instruments are carried at fair value and are generally valued using models with observable market inputs that can be verified and which do not involve significant judgment. The significant observable inputs used in determining the fair value of its Level 2 derivative contracts are contractual cash flows and market based parameters such as interest rates.

The bankruptcy filing on September 27, 2013 was a termination event under the Predecessor’s interest rate swap agreements. The Predecessor used certain derivative financial instruments to hedge the aggregate risk of interest rate fluctuations with respect to its borrowings under the 2007 Credit Facility, which required payments based on a variable interest rate index. These risks included: increases in debt rates above the earnings of the encumbered assets, increases in debt rates resulting in the failure of certain debt ratio covenants, increases in debt rates such that assets can no longer be refinanced, and earnings volatility.

In order to reduce such risks, the Predecessor primarily used interest rate swap agreements to change floating-rate long-term debt to fixed-rate long-term debt. This type of hedge was intended to qualify as a “cash-flow hedge” under ASC Topic 815 Derivatives” (“ASC 815”). For these instruments, the effective portion of the change in the fair value of the derivative was recorded in accumulated other comprehensive loss in the consolidated statement of stockholders’ equity (deficit) and recognized in the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss) in the same period in which the hedged transaction impacts earnings. The ineffective portion of the change in the fair value of the derivative was immediately recognized in earnings.

The restructuring process resulted in the dedesignation of the hedging relationship as it was not probable that the forecasted transaction would occur according to the original strategy, any related amounts previously recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net were recognized into earnings of the Predecessor as of the Petition Date. The derivative liability balances were classified as liabilities subject to compromise at the allowed claim amount. The remaining amount of other comprehensive income totaling $26,313 was recognized through earnings for the Predecessor for the ten months ended November 6, 2013. There are no derivative assets outstanding as of June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013.

 

F-77


Table of Contents

The Effect of Derivative Instruments on the Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)

for the Successor Company for the Three Months Ended June 29, 2014 and for the

Predecessor Company for the Three Months Ended June 30, 2013

 

    Location of Gain or (Loss)   Amount of Gain or (Loss)
Recognized in Income on
Derivative
 

Derivatives in ASC 815 Fair Value
Hedging Relationships

 

Recognized in Income on

Derivative

  Successor Company
2014
         Predecessor Company
2013
 

Interest rate swaps

  Gain (loss) on derivative instruments   $ (76       $ (5

 

Derivatives in ASC 815 Fair Value Hedging
Relationships

  Amount of Gain or
(Loss)

Recognized in Other
Comprehensive
Income (“OCI”)
on Derivative
(Effective Portion)
   

Location of

Gain or
(Loss)

Reclassified
from

Accumulated
OCI

into Income

(Effective
Portion)

  Amount of Gain or
(Loss)

Reclassified from
Accumulated
OCI into Income
(Effective Portion)
   

Location of

Gain or
(Loss)

Recognized
in

Income on

Derivative

(Ineffective
Portion

and Amount

Excluded
from

Effectiveness

Testing)

  Amount of Gain or
(Loss)

Recognized in Income
on

Derivative (Ineffective
Portion and Amount
Excluded from
Effectiveness Testing)
 
  Successor
Company
2014
         Predecessor
Company
2013
      Successor
Company
2014
         Predecessor
Company
2013
      Successor
Company
2014
         Predecessor
Company
2013
 

Interest rate swaps

  $ —           $ 6,979      Interest income/(expense)   $ —           $ 7,543      Gain (loss) on derivative instruments   $ (76       $ (5

The Effect of Derivative Instruments on the Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)

for the Successor Company for the Six Months Ended June 29, 2014 and for the

Predecessor Company for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2013

 

Derivatives in ASC 815 Fair Value
Hedging Relationships

  Location of Gain or (Loss)   Amount of Gain or (Loss)
Recognized in Income on
Derivative
 
 

Recognized in Income on

Derivative

  Successor Company
2014
         Predecessor Company
2013
 

Interest rate swaps

  Gain (loss) on derivative instruments   $ (51       $ (9

 

Derivatives in ASC 815 Fair Value Hedging
Relationships

  Amount of Gain or
(Loss)

Recognized in Other
Comprehensive
Income (“OCI”)
on Derivative
(Effective Portion)
   

Location of

Gain or
(Loss)

Reclassified
from

Accumulated
OCI

into Income

(Effective
Portion)

  Amount of Gain or
(Loss)

Reclassified from
Accumulated
OCI into Income
(Effective Portion)
   

Location of

Gain or
(Loss)

Recognized
in

Income on

Derivative

(Ineffective
Portion

and Amount

Excluded
from

Effectiveness

Testing)

  Amount of Gain or
(Loss)

Recognized in Income
on

Derivative (Ineffective
Portion and Amount
Excluded from
Effectiveness Testing)
 
  Successor
Company
2014
         Predecessor
Company
2013
      Successor
Company
2014
         Predecessor
Company
2013
      Successor
Company
2014
         Predecessor
Company
2013
 

Interest rate swaps

  $ —           $ 14,680      Interest income/ (expense)   $ —           $ 15,076      Gain (loss) on derivative instruments   $ (51       $ (9

 

F-78


Table of Contents

In connection with the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor Company entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $100,000 maturing September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor Company received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and pays a fixed rate of 5.14%, with settlements occurring monthly.

In connection with the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor Company entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $250,000 maturing September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor Company received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and pays a fixed rate of 4.971%, with settlements occurring monthly.

In connection with the First Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor Company entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $200,000 maturing September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor Company received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and pays a fixed rate of 5.079% with settlements occurring monthly.

In connection with the First Amendment to the 2007 Credit Facility, the Predecessor Company entered into and designated an interest rate swap based on a notional amount of $75,000 maturing September 2014, as a cash flow hedge. Under the swap agreement, the Predecessor Company received interest equivalent to one month LIBOR and pays a fixed rate of 4.941% with settlements occurring monthly.

The aggregate amount of unrealized loss related to derivative instruments recognized in other comprehensive loss as of June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013 was $0 and $0, respectively.

(9) Related Party Transactions

As of December 29, 2013, Newcastle (an affiliate of FIG LLC (“Fortress”)) beneficially owned approximately 84.6% of the Company’s outstanding common stock. On February 13, 2014, Newcastle completed the spin-off of the Company. On February 14, 2014 New Media became a separate, publicly traded company trading on the NYSE under the ticker symbol “NEWM”. As a result of the spin-off, the fees included in the Management Agreement with the Company’s Manager became effective. As of June 29, 2014, Fortress and its affiliates owned approximately 1.5% of the Company’s outstanding stock and approximately 39.6% of the Company’s outstanding warrants.

In addition, the Company’s Chairman, Wesley Edens, is also the Co-Chairman of the board of directors of FIG LLC. The Company does not pay Mr. Edens a salary or any other form of compensation.

The Company’s Chief Operating Officer owns an interest in a company that the Successor Company and the Predecessor Company received $100, $0, $178 and $0 during the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013, respectively, for commercial printing services which is included in commercial printing and other on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income (loss).

The Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer are employees of Fortress and their salaries are paid by Fortress.

Management Agreement

On the Effective Date, the Company entered into a management agreement with FIG LLC (the “Manager”) (as amended and restated, the “Management Agreement”). The Management Agreement requires the Manager to manage the Company’s business affairs subject to the supervision of the Company’s Board of Directors.

The Management Agreement has an initial three-year term and will be automatically renewed for one-year terms thereafter unless terminated either by the Company or the Manager. From the commencement date of the

 

F-79


Table of Contents

Company’s Common Stock trading on the “regular way” market on a major U.S. national securities exchange (the “Listing”), the Manager is (a) entitled to receive from the Company a management fee, (b) eligible to receive incentive compensation that is based on the Company’s performance and (c) eligible to receive options to purchase New Media Common Stock upon the successful completion of an offering of shares of the Company’s Common Stock or any shares of preferred stock with an exercise price equal to the price per share paid by the public or other ultimate purchaser in the offering. In addition, the Company is obligated to reimburse certain expenses incurred by the Manager. The Manager is also entitled to receive a termination fee from the Company under certain circumstances.

The Company recognized $1,464 and $2,229 for management fees and $0 and $0 for incentive compensation within selling, general and administrative expense and $1,741 and $1,741 was paid to Fortress during the three and six months ended June 29, 2014, respectively. No management fees or incentive compensation were incurred during the three and six months ended June 30, 2013.

GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement

On November 26, 2013, New Media entered into the GateHouse Management and Advisory Agreement (the “GateHouse Management Agreement”) with GateHouse, pursuant to which New Media will manage the assets and the day-to-day operations of GateHouse. New Media was responsible for, among other things (i) the purchase and sale of GateHouse’s investments (ii) the financing of GateHouse’s investments and (iii) investment advisory services. Such services were permitted to be performed by the Manager.

Commencing from the Listing, New Media was (a) entitled to receive a management fee equal to 1.50% per annum of GateHouse’s Total Equity (as defined in the GateHouse Management Agreement) and (b) eligible to receive incentive compensation that was based on GateHouse’s performance. In addition, GateHouse was obligated to reimburse certain expenses incurred by New Media in connection with the performance of its duties under the agreement. These fees eliminated in consolidation.

The GateHouse Management Agreement was terminated effective June 4, 2014.

Local Media Management and Advisory Agreement

On August 27, 2013, GateHouse entered into the Local Media Management Agreement with Local Media Parent, which was substantially assigned to Local Media, to manage the operations of Local Media. Local Media Parent was a subsidiary of Newcastle (an affiliate of Fortress) prior to the Effective Date.

While the agreement was in effect, GateHouse received an annual management fee of $1,100, subject to adjustments (up to a maximum annual management fee of $1,200), and an annual incentive compensation fee based on exceeding EBITDA targets of Local Media. These fees eliminate in consolidation.

The Local Media Management Agreement was terminated effective June 4, 2014.

Holdings I Management Agreement

On June 4, 2014, the Company entered into a management agreement with Holdings I (as amended and restated, the “Holdings I Management Agreement”). The Holdings I Management Agreement requires the Company to manage the business affairs of Holdings I subject to the supervision of the Board of Directors of Holdings I.

The Holdings I Management Agreement has an initial three-year term and will be automatically renewed for one-year terms thereafter unless terminated by the Holdings I. The Company is (a) entitled to receive from the Holdings I a management fee and (b) eligible to receive incentive compensation that is based on the performance of Holdings I. In addition, Holdings I is obligated to reimburse certain expenses incurred by the Company. The Company is also entitled to receive a termination fee from Holdings I under certain circumstances. These fees eliminate in consolidation.

 

F-80


Table of Contents

Registration Rights Agreement with Omega

The Company entered into a registration rights agreement with Omega Advisors, Inc. and its affiliates (collectively, “Omega”). Under the terms of the registration rights agreement, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, New Media is required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file a registration statement (the “Registration Statement”) providing for the registration and sale by Omega of its New Media Common Stock acquired pursuant to the Plan (the “Registrable Securities”) as soon as reasonably practicable, but not prior to the earlier of (i) 120 days following the Effective Date and (ii) 14 days after the required financials are completed in the ordinary course of business. During the first 12 months following the Listing, subject to customary exceptions and limitations, Omega may request one demand right with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities under the Registration Statement (the “Demand Registration”).

Once the Company is eligible to use Form S-3, New Media will be required to use commercially reasonable efforts to file a resale shelf registration statement providing for the registration and sale on a continuous or delayed basis by Omega of its Registrable Securities (the “Shelf Registration”), subject to customary exceptions and limitations. Omega is entitled to initiate up to three offerings or sales with respect to some or all of the Registrable Securities pursuant to the Shelf Registration.

Omega may only exercise its right to request the Demand Registration and any Shelf Registrations if the Registrable Securities eligible to be sold pursuant to such Registration Statement or Shelf Registration are at least 3% of the then-outstanding New Media Common Stock.

(10) Income Taxes

The Company performs a quarterly assessment of its deferred tax assets and liabilities. ASC 740 limits the ability to use future taxable income to support the realization of deferred tax assets when a company has experienced a history of losses even if future taxable income is supported by detailed forecasts and projections.

In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, which is included in other assets, the Company considers whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible. The Company considers the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, projected future taxable income, and tax planning strategies in making this assessment. The Company concluded that during the six months ended June 29, 2014, a net increase to the valuation allowance of $2,515 would be necessary to offset additional deferred tax assets. Of this amount, a $2,515 increase was recognized through the Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss).

The realization of the remaining deferred tax assets is primarily dependent on the scheduled reversals of deferred taxes. Any changes in the scheduled reversals of deferred taxes may require an additional valuation allowance against the remaining deferred tax assets. Any increase or decrease in the valuation allowance could result in an increase or decrease in income tax expense in the period of adjustment.

The computation of the annual expected effective tax rate at each interim period requires certain estimates and assumptions including, but not limited to, the expected operating income (loss) for the year, projections of the proportion of income (or loss), permanent and temporary differences, including the likelihood of recovering deferred tax assets generated in the current year. The accounting estimates used to compute the provision for income taxes may change as new events occur, more experience is acquired, or as additional information is obtained. To the extent that the estimated annual effective tax rate changes during a quarter, the effect of the change on prior quarters is included in tax expense for the current quarter.

For the six months ended June 29, 2014, the expected federal tax benefit at 34% is $4,429. The difference between the expected tax and the effective tax benefit of $3,067 is primarily attributable to the tax effect of the federal valuation allowance of $2,184, the tax benefit related to non-deductible expenses of $319, deferred tax benefits that expired of $100, and state tax benefit of $403.

 

F-81


Table of Contents

The Company and its subsidiaries file a U.S. federal consolidated income tax return. The U.S. federal and state statute of limitations generally remains open for the 2010 tax year and beyond.

In accordance with ASC 740, the Company recognizes penalties and interest relating to uncertain tax positions in the provision for income taxes. As of June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013, the Company had unrecognized tax benefits of approximately $1,109 and $1,109, respectively. The Company did not record significant amounts of interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits for the periods ending June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013. The Company does not expect significant changes in unrecognized tax benefits within the next 12 months.

(11) Pension and Postretirement Benefits

The Company maintains a pension plan and several postretirement medical and life insurance plans which cover certain employees. The Company uses the accrued benefit actuarial method and best estimate assumptions to determine pension costs, liabilities and other pension information for defined benefit plans.

The following provides information on the pension plan and postretirement medical and life insurance plans for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and June 30, 2013.

 

     Successor Company
Three Months
Ended
June 29, 2014
   

 

   Predecessor Company
Three Months
Ended
June 30, 2013
    Successor Company
Six Months Ended
June 29, 2014
   

 

   Predecessor Company
Six Months Ended
June 30, 2013
 
     Pension     Postretirement    

 

   Pension     Postretirement     Pension     Postretirement    

 

   Pension     Postretirement  

Components of net periodic benefit costs:

                          

Service cost

   $ 75      $ 9           $ 75      $ 10      $ 150      $ 17           $ 150      $ 20   

Interest cost

     295        63             271        57        590        127             542        115   

Expected return on plan assets

     (406     —               (340     —          (812     —               (680     —     

Amortization of prior service cost

     —          —               —          (114     —          —               —          (228

Amortization of unrecognized loss

     —          —               131        —          —          —               262        —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ (36   $ 72           $ 137      $ (47   $ (72   $ 144           $ 274      $ (93
  

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

        

 

 

   

 

 

 

For the Successor Company for the three and six months ended June 29, 2014 and for the Predecessor Company for the three and six months ended June 30, 2013, the Company recognized a total of $36, $90, $72, and $181 in pension and postretirement benefit expense, respectively.

The following assumptions were used in connection with the Company’s actuarial valuation of its defined benefit pension and postretirement plans for the six months ended June 29, 2014:

 

     Pension     Postretirement  

Weighted average discount rate

     5.0     4.47

Rate of increase in future compensation levels

     —          —     

Expected return on assets

     8.0     —     

Current year trend

     —          7.75

Ultimate year trend

     —          4.75

Year of ultimate trend

     —          2025   

 

 

F-82


Table of Contents

(12) Fair Value Measurement

Fair value measurements and disclosures require the use of valuation techniques to measure fair value that maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. These inputs are prioritized as follows:

 

    Level 1: Observable inputs such as quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

 

    Level 2: Inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable, either directly or indirectly, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities or market corroborated inputs.

 

    Level 3: Unobservable inputs for which there is little or no market data and which require the Company to develop their own assumptions about how market participants price the asset or liability.

The valuation techniques that may be used to measure fair value are as follows:

 

    Market approach – Uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets or liabilities.

 

    Income approach – Uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts to a single present amount based on current market expectation about those future amounts.

 

    Cost approach – Based on the amount that currently would be required to replace the service capacity of an asset (replacement cost).

The following table presents financial assets and liabilities measured or disclosed at fair value on a recurring basis for the periods presented:

 

     Fair Value Measurements at Reporting Date Using      Total Fair Value
Measurements
     Valuation
Technique
     Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Identical Assets

(Level 1)
     Significant Other
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
     Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
       

As of December 29, 2013

              

Assets

              

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31,811       $ —         $ —         $ 31,811       Income

Restricted cash

     6,477         —           —           6,477       Income

As of June 29, 2014

              

Assets

              

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 31,347       $ —         $ —         $ 31,347       Income

Restricted cash

     6,477         —           —           6,477       Income

Certain assets are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments only in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment).

During the quarter ended September 29, 2013, the Company consolidated the assets and liabilities of Local Media under the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, the assets acquired and liabilities assumed were recorded at their fair value. Property plant and equipment was valued using Level 2 inputs and mastheads and goodwill were valued using Level 3 inputs. Refer to Note 3 for discussion of the valuation techniques and significant inputs and assumptions utilized and the fair value recognized.

During the quarter ended December 29, 2013, the Company applied fresh start accounting which resulted in its assets and liabilities being recorded at their fair values utilizing Level 3 inputs as of November 6, 2013.

During the quarter ended March 30, 2014, the Company consolidated the assets and liabilities of the other acquisition under the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, the assets acquired and liabilities assumed were recorded at their fair value. Property plant and equipment was valued using Level 2 inputs and mastheads and goodwill were valued using Level 3 inputs.

 

F-83


Table of Contents

(13) Commitments and Contingencies

The Company becomes involved from time to time in claims and lawsuits incidental to the ordinary course of its business, including with respect to matters such as libel, invasion of privacy, intellectual property infringement, wrongful termination actions, and complaints alleging employment discrimination. In addition, the Company is involved from time to time in governmental and administrative proceedings concerning employment, labor, environmental and other claims. Insurance coverage maintained by the Company mitigates potential loss for certain of these matters. Historically, such claims and proceedings have not had a material effect upon the Company’s condensed consolidated results of operations or financial condition. While the Company is unable to predict the ultimate outcome of any currently outstanding legal actions, it is the opinion of the Company’s management that it is a remote possibility that the disposition of these matters would have a material adverse effect upon the Company’s condensed consolidated results of operations, financial condition or cash flows.

Restricted cash at June 29, 2014 and December 29, 2013, in the aggregate amount of $6,477 for both periods, is used to collateralize standby letters of credit in the name of the Company’s insurers in accordance with certain insurance policies and as cash collateral for certain business operations.

(14) Discontinued Operations

For the Successor Company for the six months ended June 29, 2014, no publications were discontinued. The net revenue for the Predecessor Company for the three and six months ended June 30, 2013 for previously discontinued operations was $63 and $394, respectively. Loss, net of income taxes of $0, for the Predecessor Company for the three and six months ended June 30, 2013 for previously discontinued operations was $946 and $1,034, respectively.

(15) Subsequent Events

On June 30, 2014, the Company completed two acquisitions of 20 publications with a total purchase price of $15,849, which includes estimated working capital. The acquisitions include six daily, ten weekly publications, and four shoppers serving areas of Texas, Oklahoma, Kansas and Virginia with an aggregate circulation of approximately 54. The acquisitions were funded with $9,849 of cash and $6,000 from the Revolving Credit Facility.

On July 22, 2014, the Company entered into a definitive asset purchase agreement to purchase The Providence Journal with a total purchase price of $46,000. The acquisition will include one daily and two weekly publications serving areas of Rhode Island with a daily circulation of approximately 72 and 96 on Sunday and is anticipated to close before the end of the third quarter of 2014.

 

F-84


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Auditors

The Board of Directors and Shareholders

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

We have audited the accompanying combined financial statements of Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc., which comprise the combined balance sheets as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, and the related combined statements of operations and comprehensive (loss) income, equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013, and the related notes to the combined financial statements.

Management’s Responsibility for the Financial Statements

Management is responsible for the preparation and fair presentation of these financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles; this includes the design, implementation, and maintenance of internal control relevant to the preparation and fair presentation of financial statements that are free of material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.

Auditor’s Responsibility

Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement.

An audit involves performing procedures to obtain audit evidence about the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. The procedures selected depend on the auditor’s judgment, including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to fraud or error. In making those risk assessments, the auditor considers internal control relevant to the entity’s preparation and fair presentation of the financial statements in order to design audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the entity’s internal control. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes evaluating the appropriateness of accounting policies used and the reasonableness of significant accounting estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements.

We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our audit opinion.

Opinion

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the combined financial position of Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc. at June 30, 2013 and 2012, and the combined results of its operations and it cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended June 30, 2013, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP

New York, New York

September 10, 2013

 

F-85


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Combined Balance Sheets

(In Thousands)

 

     June 30  
     2013      2012  

Assets

     

Current assets:

     

Cash

   $ 567       $ 1,878   

Accounts receivable, net

     13,984         14,130   

Inventory

     1,657         1,579   

Deferred income taxes

     848         949   

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     3,247         2,580   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current assets

     20,303         21,116   

Property and equipment, net

     64,299         70,644   

Deferred income taxes

     38,408         34,508   

Intangible assets, net

     4,426         46,714   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 127,436       $ 172,982   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities and equity

     

Current liabilities:

     

Accounts payable

   $ 1,320       $ 1,235   

Accrued wages

     5,259         4,929   

Deferred revenue

     7,706         7,967   

Pension and postretirement benefits

     1,417         1,672   

Income taxes payable

     34         —     

Other current liabilities

     5,606         5,574   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     21,342         21,377   

Pension and postretirement benefits

     53,265         73,772   

Other noncurrent liabilities

     12,191         12,050   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     86,798         107,199   

Commitments and contingencies

     

Total equity

     40,638         65,783   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

   $ 127,436       $ 172,982   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the combined financial statements.

 

F-86


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Combined Statements of Operations and Comprehensive (Loss) Income

(In Thousands)

 

     For the Fiscal Years Ended June 30  
     2013     2012     2011  

Revenues:

      

Advertising

   $ 83,096      $ 92,502      $ 106,381   

Circulation and subscription

     51,192        52,493        52,332   

Other

     24,271        24,275        23,131   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenues

     158,559        169,270        181,844   

Operating expenses

     136,340        142,281        154,026   

Depreciation and amortization

     7,858        8,500        9,601   

Impairments and restructuring

     42,268        197,869        247   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     186,466        348,650        163,874   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating (loss) income

     (27,907     (179,380     17,970   

Income tax benefit (expense)

     10,242        34,682        (8,504
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (loss) income

     (17,665     (144,698     9,466   

Other comprehensive income (loss):

      

Pension and postretirement plans adjustment

     11,578        (29,955     6,114   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive (loss) income

   $ (6,087   $ (174,653   $ 15,580   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the combined financial statements.

 

F-87


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Combined Statements of Equity

(In Thousands)

Fiscal Years Ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011

 

     Parent
Company
Investment
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
(Loss) Income
    Total  

Balance, June 30, 2010

   $ 295,273      $ (30,740   $ 264,533   

Net income

     9,466        —          9,466   

Comprehensive income

     —          6,114        6,114   

Net decrease in parent company investment

     (23,962     —          (23,962
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, June 30, 2011

     280,777        (24,626     256,151   

Net loss

     (144,698     —          (144,698

Comprehensive loss

     —          (29,955     (29,955

Net decrease in parent company investment

     (15,715     —          (15,715
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, June 30, 2012

     120,364        (54,581     65,783   

Net loss

     (17,665     —          (17,665

Comprehensive income

     —          11,578        11,578   

Net decrease in parent company investment

     (19,058     —          (19,058
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, June 30, 2013

   $ 83,641      $ (43,003   $ 40,638   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the combined financial statements.

 

F-88


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Combined Statements of Cash Flows

(In Thousands)

 

     For the Fiscal Years Ended June 30  
     2013     2012     2011  

Operating activities

      

Net (loss) income

   $ (17,665   $ (144,698   $ 9,466   

Adjustments to reconcile net (loss) income to net cash provided by operating activities:

      

Depreciation and amortization

     7,858        8,500        9,601   

Impairments

     42,268        197,869        —     

Provision for doubtful accounts

     802        478        1,170   

(Gain) loss on disposal of property and equipment

     (81     (1,458     1,371   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

      

Accounts receivable, net

     (656     1,510        (198

Inventory

     (78     (716     (1,534

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

     (666     1,293        (390

Accounts payable and accrued wages

     449        (465     590   

Deferred income taxes, net

     (11,635     (36,695     5,119   

Pension and postretirement benefits

     (1,349     (10,082     1,467   

Deferred revenue

     (261     121        (317

Other liabilities

     173        (18     (1,763
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

     19,159        15,639        24,582   

Investing activities

      

Capital expenditures

     (1,938     (2,180     (3,758

Proceeds from sale of property and equipment

     526        2,036        3,569   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (1,412     (144     (189

Financing activities

      

Net transfers to Parent and affiliates

     (19,058     (15,715     (23,962
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in financing activities

     (19,058     (15,715     (23,962
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in cash

     (1,311     (220     431   

Cash, beginning of year

     1,878        2,098        1,667   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash, end of year

   $ 567      $ 1,878      $ 2,098   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to the combined financial statements.

 

F-89


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements

(In Thousands)

June 30, 2013

1. Organization

Overview

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc. (LMG or the Company) operates as a business unit of Dow Jones & Company, Inc. (Parent), a wholly-owned subsidiary of News Corporation. The Company operates print and online community media franchises, Internet sites, digital services, magazines, other news, and advertising niche publications and commercial print and household distribution services. These combined financial statements were prepared on a stand-alone basis derived from the financial statements and accounting records of the Company and Parent, and reflect the combined historical financial position, results of operations, and cash flows of the Company’s businesses in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP). Certain costs that were incurred centrally by Parent for functions such as corporate overhead for services and administrative functions have been allocated to the Company and included in the combined financial statements. We believe the assumptions underlying such allocations were made on a reasonable basis.

On June 28, 2013, the Company and Parent entered into a stock purchase agreement with Newcastle Investment Corp., whereby Newcastle Investment Corp. would acquire the Company for $82 million. The transaction received regulatory approvals and closed on September 3, 2013. These combined financial statements have been prepared in contemplation of this transaction.

Basis of Presentation

These financial statements are presented as if the businesses of the Company had been combined for all periods presented. All intracompany transactions and accounts within LMG have been eliminated in combination. The assets and liabilities in the combined financial statements have been reflected on an historical cost basis as adjusted for the acquisition of Parent by News Corporation in December 2007. Cash is managed centrally, with net earnings reinvested locally and working capital requirements met from existing liquid funds. LMG reflects transfers of cash to and from Parent’s cash management system as a component of parent company investment.

Income tax benefit (expense) in the combined statements of operations and comprehensive (loss) income has been calculated as if LMG filed a separate tax return and was operating as a stand-alone business. Therefore, cash tax payments and items of current and deferred taxes may not be reflective of LMG’s actual tax balances had it been a stand-alone business.

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Principles of Combination

The combined financial statements include certain assets and liabilities that have historically been held at Parent’s corporate level, but are specifically identifiable or otherwise attributable to LMG. All significant intercompany transactions between Parent and LMG have been included within parent company investment in these combined financial statements.

LMG’s fiscal year ends on the Sunday closest to June 30. Fiscal 2013 and 2012 included 52 weeks, while fiscal 2011 included 53 weeks with the 53rd week falling in the fourth fiscal quarter. All references to June 30, 2013June 30, 2012, and June 30, 2011 relate to the twelve month periods ended June 30, 2013, July 1, 2012, and July 3, 2011, respectively. For convenience purposes, LMG continues to date its combined financial statements as of June 30.

 

F-90


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Use of Estimates

The preparation of LMG’s combined financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts that are reported in the combined financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

Accounts Receivable, Net

The Company provides an allowance for doubtful accounts equal to estimated uncollectible amounts. The Company’s estimate is based on historical collection experience and a review of the current status of such accounts receivable. It is reasonably possible that the Company’s estimate of the allowance for doubtful accounts will change. Accounts receivable are presented net of an allowance for doubtful accounts of $1,450 and $1,572 at June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

Advertising Expenses

The Company expenses advertising costs as incurred. Included in operating expenses are advertising expenses of $22,521, $23,553, and $22,760 for the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively.

Shipping and Handling

Costs incurred for shipping and handling are reflected in operating expenses in the combined statements of operations.

Concentrations of Credit and Other Risks

Advertising spending, which drives a significant portion of LMG’s revenues, is sensitive to economic conditions. Local economic conditions affect the levels of advertising revenues. Economic factors that have adversely affected advertising revenues include lower consumer and business spending, high unemployment and depressed home sales. Advertising revenues are particularly adversely affected if advertisers respond to weak and uneven economic conditions by reducing their budgets or shifting spending patterns or priorities, or if they are forced to consolidate or cease operations. Continuing weak and uncertain economic conditions and outlook could adversely affect the level of advertising revenues and combined financial condition and results of operations.

Contingencies

Certain conditions may exist which may result in a loss to the Company, but which will only be resolved when one or more future events occur or fail to occur. The Company’s management, insurance advisers and legal counsel assess such contingent liabilities, and such assessment inherently involves an exercise of judgment. In assessing loss contingencies related to legal proceedings that are pending against the Company, or unasserted claims that may result in such proceedings, the Company’s legal counsel evaluates the perceived merits of any legal proceedings or unasserted claims, as well as the perceived merits of the amount of relief sought or expected to be sought therein.

If the assessment of a contingency indicates that it is probable that a material loss has been incurred and the amount of the liability can be estimated, the estimated liability would be accrued in the Company’s combined

 

F-91


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

financial statements. If the assessment indicates that a potentially material loss contingency is not probable but is reasonably possible, or is probable but cannot be estimated, the nature of the contingent liability, together with an estimate of the range of possible loss if determinable and material, would be disclosed.

Loss contingencies considered remote are generally not disclosed unless they arise from guarantees, in which case the guarantees would be disclosed.

Income Taxes

LMG accounts for income taxes in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (ASC) 740, Income Taxes (ASC 740). ASC 740 requires an asset and liability approach for financial accounting and reporting for income taxes. Under the asset and liability approach, deferred taxes are provided for the net tax effects of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes. Valuation allowances are established where management determines that it is more likely than not that some portion or all of a deferred tax asset will not be realized.

Inventory

Inventory is comprised of newsprint and is valued using weighted average cost.

Property and Equipment, Net

Property and equipment are stated at cost. Depreciation is provided using the straight-line method over an estimated useful life of 3 to 25 years for equipment and 10 to 40 years for buildings and improvements. Leasehold improvements are amortized using the straight-line method over the shorter of their estimated useful lives or the life of the lease. Costs associated with the repair and maintenance of property are expensed as incurred. Changes in circumstances, such as technological advances or changes to LMG’s business model or capital strategy could result in the actual useful lives differing from LMG’s estimates.

Revenue Recognition

Advertising revenues from the publication of newspapers are recognized when advertisements are published in newspapers or placed on digital platforms or, with respect to certain digital advertising, each time a user either clicks on or views certain ads, net of commissions and provisions for estimated sales incentives including rebates, rate adjustments, and discounts.

Circulation revenues include single-copy and subscription revenues. Circulation revenues are based on the number of copies of the printed newspaper (through home-delivery subscriptions and single-copy sales) and digital subscriptions sold and the rates charged to the respective customers. Single-copy revenue is recognized based on date of publication, net of provisions for related returns. Proceeds from subscription revenues are deferred at the time of sale and are recognized in earnings on a pro rata basis over the terms of the subscriptions. Several factors are considered to determine whether the Company is a principal, most notably whether the Company is primary obligor to the customer and has determined the selling price and product specifications.

Other revenues are recognized when the related service or product has been delivered.

 

F-92


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Billings to clients and payments received in advance of the performance of services or delivery of products are recorded as deferred revenue until the services are performed or the product is delivered.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

LMG has intangible assets, including goodwill, trade names, and advertising and subscriber relationships. Goodwill is recorded as the difference between the cost of acquired entities and amounts assigned to their tangible and identifiable intangible net assets. In accordance with ASC 350, Intangibles—Goodwill and Other (ASC 350), LMG’s indefinite-lived intangible assets are tested annually for impairment or earlier if events occur or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value below its carrying amount. Intangible assets with finite lives are generally amortized over their estimated useful lives. The impairment assessment of indefinite-lived intangibles compares the fair value of these intangible assets to their carrying value.

LMG’s goodwill impairment reviews are performed using a two-step process. The first step of the process is to compare the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, the goodwill of the reporting unit is not impaired and the second step of the impairment review is not necessary. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment review is required to be performed to estimate the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill. The implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill is compared with the carrying amount of that goodwill. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.

Long-lived Assets

ASC 360, Property, Plant, and Equipment, and ASC 350 require that LMG periodically reviews the carrying amounts of its long-lived assets, including property and equipment and finite-lived intangible assets, to determine whether current events or circumstances indicate that such carrying amounts may not be recoverable. If the carrying amount of the asset is greater than the expected undiscounted cash flows to be generated by such asset, an impairment adjustment is recognized if the carrying value of such asset exceeds its fair value. LMG generally measures fair value by considering sale prices for similar assets or by discounting estimated future cash flows using an appropriate discount rate. Considerable management judgment is necessary to estimate the fair value of assets; accordingly, actual results could vary significantly from such estimates.

Self-Insurance Plans

The Company has self-insured health plans for all its employees. The Company has purchased stop-loss insurance in order to limit its exposure, which will reimburse the Company for individual claims in excess of $450 annually. Self-insurance losses are accrued based on the Company’s estimates of the aggregate liability for uninsured claims incurred using certain actuarial assumptions followed in the insurance industry. Included in accrued wages is an estimate for self-insured health plan expenses of $850 and $950 at June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

The Company is self-insured for property and casualty losses, and included in other current liabilities is an accrual for losses of $3,622 and $3,755 at June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

F-93


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

Fair Value Measurements

In accordance with ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements, LMG measures assets and liabilities using inputs from the following three levels of the fair value hierarchy: (i) inputs that are quoted prices in active markets (Level 1); (ii) inputs other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable, including quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities (Level 2); and (iii) inputs that require the entity to use its own assumptions about market participant assumptions (Level 3).

The fair values of the Company’s financial instruments, such as accounts receivable and accounts payable approximate their carrying values due to the short-term maturities of these assets and liabilities. The Company’s assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis include long-lived assets, indefinite-lived intangible assets and goodwill. The Company reviews the carrying amounts of such assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amounts may not be recoverable or at least annually as of June 30 for indefinite-lived intangible assets and goodwill. Any resulting asset impairment would require that the asset be recorded at its fair value. The resulting fair value measurements of the assets are considered to be Level 3 measurements.

During fiscal 2012, the Company recorded non-cash impairment charges of $152,842 relating to Goodwill, $44,335 relating to Trade Names and $692 relating to long-lived assets as a result of a potential sale of the Company below its carrying value. The Company recorded an additional impairment in fiscal 2013 for $42,268 to further reduce the carrying value as a result of the pending sale that subsequently closed on September 3, 2013.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

In July 2012, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the FASB) issued ASU 2012-02, Intangibles— Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Testing Indefinite-Lived Intangible Assets for Impairment (ASU 2012-02), which permits an entity to make a qualitative assessment of whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit’s indefinite-lived intangible asset is less than the asset’s carrying value before applying a quantitative impairment assessment. If it is determined through the qualitative assessment that the fair value of a reporting unit’s indefinite-lived intangible asset is more likely than not greater than the asset’s carrying value, the remaining impairment steps would be unnecessary. The qualitative assessment is optional, allowing companies to go directly to the quantitative assessment. ASU 2012-02 is effective for the Company for annual and interim indefinite-lived intangible asset impairment tests performed beginning July 1, 2013. The Company does not expect the adoption of ASU 2012-02 will have a significant impact on its combined financial statements.

In February 2013, the FASB issued ASU 2013-02, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220): Reporting of Amounts Reclassified Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (ASU 2013-02), which requires the Company to provide information about the amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by component. In addition, it requires the Company to present, either on the face of the statement where net income is presented or in the notes, significant amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income by the respective line items of net income, but only if the amount reclassified is required under GAAP to be reclassified to net income in its entirety in the same reporting period. For other amounts that are not required under GAAP to be reclassified in their entirety to net income, the Company is required to cross-reference to other disclosures required under GAAP that provide additional detail about those amounts. ASU 2013-02 is effective for the Company for interim reporting periods beginning July 1, 2013. The Company does not expect the adoption of ASU 2012-02 will have a significant impact on its combined financial statements, as it relates to disclosures only.

 

F-94


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (continued)

 

In July 2013, the FASB issued ASU 2013-11, Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists (ASU 2013-11). ASU 2013-11 clarifies guidance and eliminates diversity in practice on the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits when a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward exists at the reporting date. This new guidance is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2013 and subsequent interim periods. The Company does not expect the adoption of ASU 2013-11 will have a significant impact on its combined financial statements.

3. Property and Equipment, Net

Property and equipment, net was comprised of the following:

 

     As of June 30  
     2013     2012  

Property and equipment:

    

Land

   $ 11,252      $ 11,334   

Buildings and leasehold improvements

     38,604        39,207   

Machinery and equipment

     61,435        57,953   

Construction-in-progress

     60        1,699   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
     111,351        110,193   

Less: Accumulated depreciation and amortization

     (47,052     (39,549
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment, net

   $ 64,299      $ 70,644   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Depreciation expense for the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011 was $7,838, $8,431, and $8,995, respectively. During the fiscal year ended June 30, 2012, the Company recorded impairment to property and equipment of $692.

4. Intangible Assets, Net and Goodwill

The changes in the carrying values of LMG’s intangible assets, goodwill and related accumulated amortization for the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013 and 2012, were as follows:

 

     Goodwill(a)     Trade
Names(a)
    Subscriber
Relationships(b)
    Advertising
Relationships(c)
    Total
Intangible
Assets, Net
 

Balance, June 30, 2011

   $ 152,842      $ 66,300      $ 3,010      $ 21,808      $ 91,118   

Amortization

     —          —          (69     —          (69

Impairments

     (152,842     (44,335     —          —          (44,335
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, June 30, 2012

     —          21,965        2,941        21,808        46,714   

Amortization

     —          —          (20     —          (20

Impairments

     —          (21,965     (2,399     (17,904     (42,268
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, June 30, 2013

   $ —        $ —        $ 522      $ 3,904      $ 4,426   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) Goodwill and Trade Names are not subject to amortization.

 

F-95


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

4. Intangible Assets, Net and Goodwill (continued)

 

(b) Net of accumulated amortization of $2,379 and $2,359 as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The useful life of Subscriber Relationships is ten years, primarily based on historical attrition rates of subscribers.
(c) Net of accumulated amortization of $7,292 as of June 30, 2013 and 2012. The useful life of Advertising Relationships is 25 years, primarily based on historical attrition rates of advertisers.

Aggregate amortization expense for the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011 was $20, $69, and $606, respectively.

Based on the current amount of amortizable intangible assets, net, the estimated amortization expense for each of the succeeding five fiscal years is less than $1.

The Company evaluates the recoverability of identifiable intangible assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that an intangible asset’s carrying amount may not be recoverable. Such circumstances could include, but are not limited to: (1) a significant decrease in the market value of an asset, (2) a significant adverse change in the extent or manner in which an asset is used, or (3) an accumulation of costs significantly in excess of the amount originally expected for the acquisition of an asset. The Company measures the carrying amount of the asset against the estimated undiscounted future cash flows associated with it. Should the sum of the expected future net cash flows be less than the carrying value of the asset being evaluated, an impairment loss would be recognized. The impairment loss would be calculated as the amount by which the carrying value of the asset exceeds its fair value. The fair value is measured based on quoted market prices, if available. If quoted market prices are not available, the estimate of fair value is based on various valuation techniques, including the discounted value of estimated future cash flows. The evaluation of asset impairment requires the Company to make assumptions about future cash flows over the life of the asset being evaluated. These assumptions require significant judgment and actual results may differ from assumed and estimated amounts.

During fiscal 2012, LMG received an offer to sell its business for an amount that was less than the carrying amount of its net assets, excluding goodwill. As of result, this indicator led the Company to record an impairment charge to Goodwill of $152,842 and Trade Names of $44,335 during the year ended June 30, 2012. On June 28, 2013, Parent entered into an agreement to sell the Company for $82,000 and due to the net proceeds being less than previously estimated, the Company recorded an additional impairment to Trade Names, Advertising Relationships and Subscriber Relationships totaling $42,268. Impairment charges of $42,268 and $197,177 for fiscal years ended June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively, are included in impairment and restructuring in the accompanying combined statements of operations and comprehensive (loss) income.

5. Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits

Certain of LMG’s U.S. employees participate in defined benefit pension plans sponsored by the Company (Direct Plans), of which certain plans are frozen. Accordingly, the funded and unfunded position of each Direct Plan is recorded in LMG’s combined balance sheets. Actuarial gains and losses that have not yet been recognized through income are recorded in accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income net of taxes, until they are amortized as a component of net periodic benefit cost. The determination of benefit obligations and the recognition of expenses related to Direct Plans are dependent on various assumptions. The major assumptions primarily relate to discount rates, long-term expected rates of return on plan assets, and future compensation increases. Management develops each assumption using relevant company experience in conjunction with market-related data. The funded status of the Direct Plans can change from year to year, but the assets of the funded plans have been sufficient to pay all benefits that came due in each of the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011.

 

F-96


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

5. Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits (continued)

 

The Company uses a June 30 measurement date for all direct pension and postretirement benefit plans. The following table sets forth the change in the projected benefit obligation, change in the fair value of Direct Plans plan assets and funded status:

 

     Pension Benefits     Postretirement
Benefits
 
     As of June 30  
     2013     2012     2013     2012  

Projected benefit obligation, beginning of year

   $ 254,431      $ 223,237      $ 7,854      $ 7,628   

Service cost

     51        45        162        124   

Interest cost

     10,551        12,436        277        371   

Benefits paid

     (13,868     (13,674     (913     (1,158

Settlements

     (10,238     (8,896     —          —     

Actuarial (gain) loss

     (16,549     41,283        (970     889   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Projected benefit obligation, end of year

     224,378        254,431        6,410        7,854   

Change in the fair value of plan assets

        

Fair value of plan assets, beginning of year

     186,842        195,662        —          —     

Actual return on plan assets

     12,649        3,248        —          —     

Employer contributions

     721        10,501        913        1,158   

Benefits paid

     (13,868     (13,674     (913     (1,158

Settlements

     (10,238     (8,895     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fair value of plan assets, end of year

     176,106        186,842        —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Funded status

   $ (48,272   $ (67,589   $ (6,410   $ (7,854
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amounts recognized in the balance sheets consist of:

 

     Pension Benefits    

Postretirement Benefits

 
     As of June 30  
     2013     2012     2013     2012  

Pension and postretirement benefits

   $ (48,272   $ (67,590   $ (6,410   $ (7,854
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net amount recognized

   $ (48,272   $ (67,590   $ (6,410   $ (7,854
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income consist of:

 

     Pension Benefits     

Postretirement Benefits

 
     As of June 30  
     2013      2012      2013     2012  

Actuarial loses (gains)

   $ 79,933       $ 99,510       $ (1,895   $ (937

Prior service benefit

     —           —           (5,544     (6,666
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net amount recognized

   $ 79,933       $ 99,510       $ (7,439   $ (7,603
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-97


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

5. Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits (continued)

 

Amounts in accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income expected to be recognized as a component of net periodic pension cost in fiscal 2014:

 

     Pension Benefits      Postretirement
Benefits
 
     As of June 30  
     2013      2012  

Actuarial loses (gains)

   $ 2,336       $ (111

Prior service benefit

     —           (1,122
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net amount recognized

   $ 2,336       $ (1,233
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Accumulated pension benefit obligations as of June 30, 2013 and 2012 were $224,378 and $254,432, respectively. The accumulated benefit obligation exceeds the fair value of the plan assets for all of the Company’s plans. Below is information about funded and unfunded pension plans:

 

     Funded Plans      Unfunded Plans  
     As of June 30  
     2013      2012      2013      2012  

Projected benefit obligation

   $ 216,734       $ 246,036       $ 7,644       $ 8,395   

Accumulated benefit obligation

     216,672         245,968         7,644         8,395   

Fair value of plan assets

     176,106         186,842         —           —     

The components of net periodic pension and postretirement expense (benefit) were as follows:

 

     Pension Benefits     Postretirement Benefits  
     For the Fiscal Years Ended June 30  
     2013     2012     2011     2013         2012             2011      

Service cost benefits earned during the period

   $ 51      $ 45      $ 197      $ 162      $ 124      $ 113   

Interest cost on projected benefit obligations

     10,551        12,436        12,406        277        371        416   

Expected return on plan assets

     (12,615     (13,235     (12,622     —          —          —     

Amortization of deferred losses

     2,993        3,025        4,176        (12     (87     (104

Amortization of prior service benefit

     —          —          —          (1,122     (1,122     (1,122
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net pension and postretirement expense (benefit)

   $ 980      $ 2,271      $ 4,157      $ (695   $ (714   $ (697
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-98


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

5. Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits (continued)

 

Assumptions

The following are weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at year end:

 

     Pension Benefits     Postretirement Benefits  
     For the Years Ended June 30  
     2013     2012     2011     2013     2012     2011  

Additional information

            

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations:

            

Discount rate

     5.00     4.25     5.75     4.75     3.75     5.25

Rate of increase in future compensation

     N/A        3.25     3.25     N/A        N/A        N/A   

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine net periodic benefit cost:

            

Discount rate

     4.25     5.75     5.75     3.75     5.25     5.50

Expected return on plan assets

     7.00     7.00     7.00     N/A        N/A        N/A   

Rate of increase in future compensation

     N/A        3.25     3.25     N/A        N/A        N/A   

The following assumed health care trend rates as of June 30 were also used in accounting for postretirement benefits:

 

     Postretirement Benefits  
     2013     2012  

Health care cost trend rate

     6.8     7.2

Rate to which the cost trend rate is assumed to decline (the ultimate trend rate)

     5.0     5.0

Year that the rate reaches the ultimate trend rate

     2019        2019   

Assumed health care cost trend rates could have a significant effect on the amounts reported for the postretirement health care plan. The effect of a one percentage point increase and one percentage point decrease in the assumed health care cost trend rate would have the following effects on the results for fiscal 2013:

 

     Service and
Interest Cost
    Benefit
Obligation
 

One percentage point increase

   $ 46,874      $ 385,456   

One percentage point decrease

     (38,895     (334,384

The following table sets forth the estimated benefit payments for the next five fiscal years, and in the aggregate for the five fiscal years thereafter. The expected benefits are estimated based on the same assumptions used to measure LMG’s benefit obligation at the end of the fiscal year and include benefits attributable to estimated future employee service:

 

     Pension
Benefits
     Postretirement
Benefits
 

2014

   $ 14,119       $ 716   

2015

     14,261         603   

2016

     14,391         539   

2017

     14,479         486   

2018

     14,559         435   

2019–2023

     74,323         2,333   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   $ 146,132       $ 5,112   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-99


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

5. Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits (continued)

 

The Company does not expect to receive U.S. Medicare subsidy receipts.

Plan Assets

LMG applies the provisions of ASC 715 Compensation—Retirement Plans, which required disclosures include: (i) investment policies and strategies; (ii) the major categories of plan assets; (iii) the inputs and valuation techniques used to measure plan assets; (iv) the effect of fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs on changes in plan assets for the period; and (v) significant concentrations of risk within plan assets.

The table below presents LMG’s plan assets by level within the fair value hierarchy, as described in Note 2 as of June 30, 2013 and 2012.

The fair values of the Company’s pension plan assets as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, by asset category, are as follows:

 

     As of June 30, 2013      As of June 30, 2012  
            Fair Value Measurements
at Reporting Date Using
            Fair Value Measurements
at Reporting Date Using
 

Description

   Total      Level 1      Level 2      Level 3      Total      Level 1     Level 2      Level 3  

Assets

                   

Short-term investments

   $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —         $ —        $ —         $   —     

Pooled funds(a):

                   

Money market funds

     142         —           142         —           24,175         —          24,175         —     

Domestic equity funds

     46,552         —           46,552         —           13,514         13,514        —           —     

International equity funds

     43,227         —           43,227         —           27,219         19,148        8,071         —     

Domestic fixed income funds

     76,479         —           76,479         —           33,584         33,584        —           —     

Balanced funds

                 28,490         15,773        12,717      

Common stocks(b)

                      

U.S. common stocks

     —           —           —           —           27,847         27,760        87         —     

Government and agency obligations(c):

                   

Domestic government obligations

     —           —           —           —           2,767         —          2,767         —     

International government obligations

     —           —           —           —           8,029         —          8,029         —     

Corporate obligations(c)

     —           —           —           —           2,720         —          2,720         —     

Partnership interests(d)

     —           —           —           —           4,067         —          4,067         —     

Other

     9,706         9,706         —           —           14,430         (359     14,726         63   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 176,106       $ 9,706       $ 166,400       $   —         $ 186,842       $ 109,420      $ 77,359       $ 63   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a) Open-ended pooled funds that are registered and/or available to the general public are valued at the daily published net asset value (NAV). Other pooled funds are valued at the NAV provided by the fund issuer.

 

F-100


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

5. Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits (continued)

 

(b) Common stocks that are publicly traded are valued at the closing price reported on active markets in which the individual securities are traded.
(c) The fair value of corporate, government, and agency obligations are valued based on a compilation of primary observable market information or a broker quote in a non-active market.
(d) The fair values of partnerships that are not publicly traded are based on fair value obtained from the general partner.

The table below sets forth a summary of changes in the fair value of investments reflected as Level 3 assets as of June 30, 2013 and 2012:

 

     Partnership
Interests
     Other     Total  

Beginning balance at June 30, 2011

   $     —         $ 2      $ 2   

Actual return on plan assets:

       

Relating to assets still held at end of year

     —           42        42   

Purchases, sales, settlements, and issuances

     —           19        19   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at June 30, 2012

     —           63        63   

Purchases, sales, settlements, and issuances

     —           (63     (63
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance at June 30, 2013

   $ —         $     —        $     —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Company’s investment policy includes various guidelines and procedures designed to ensure assets are invested in a manner necessary to meet expected future benefits earned by participants. The investment guidelines consider a broad range of economic conditions. Central to the policy are target allocation ranges by asset class.

The objectives of the target allocations are to maintain investment portfolios that diversify risk through prudent asset allocation parameters, achieve asset returns that meet or exceed the plans’ actuarial assumptions, and achieve asset returns that are competitive with like institutions employing similar investment strategies.

The investment policy is periodically reviewed by the Company and a designated third-party fiduciary for investment matters. The policy is established and administered in a manner that is compliant at all times with applicable government regulations.

LMG pension assets are managed by News Corporation. News Corporation’s investment strategy for its pension plans is to maximize the long-term rate of return on plan assets within an acceptable level of risk in order to minimize the cost of providing pension benefits, while maintaining adequate funding levels. News Corporation’s practice is to conduct a periodic strategic review of its asset allocation. News Corporation’s current broad strategic targets are to have a pension asset portfolio comprising of 54% equity securities and 46% fixed income securities. News Corporation’s equity portfolios are managed in such a way as to achieve optimal diversity. News Corporation’s fixed income portfolio is investment grade in the aggregate. News Corporation does not manage any assets internally.

 

F-101


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

5. Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits (continued)

 

LMG’s benefit plan weighted-average asset allocations, by asset category, are as follows:

 

     Pension Benefits
As of June 30
 
     2013     2012  

Asset category:

    

Equity securities

     50     37

Debt securities

     42        35   

Cash and other

     8        28   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100     100
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Required pension plan contributions for the next fiscal year are expected to be approximately $701; however, actual contributions may be affected by pension asset and liability valuation changes during the year.

Defined Contribution Plan

LMG has a defined contribution plan for the benefit of substantially all employees meeting certain eligibility requirements. The Company has limited contribution requirements for this plan.

6. Income Taxes

The income tax (benefit) expense in the combined statements of operations has been calculated as if LMG filed a separate tax return and was operating as a stand-alone business. Therefore, cash tax payments and items of current and deferred taxes may not be reflective of LMG’s actual tax balances had it been a standalone business.

(Loss) income before income tax benefit (expense) was attributable to the following jurisdiction:

 

     For the Fiscal Years Ended June 30  
     2013     2012     2011  

U.S.

   $ (27,907   $ (179,380   $ 17,970   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Loss) income before income tax benefit (expense)

   $ (27,907   $ (179,380   $ 17,970   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Significant components of LMG’s (benefit) provision for income taxes were as follows:

 

     For the Fiscal Years Ended June 30  
     2013     2012     2011  

Current:

      

Federal

   $ (18   $ 456      $ 2,115   

State and local

     1,410        1,556        2,038   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current

     1,392        2,012        4,153   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred:

      

Federal

     (9,426     (29,061     3,676   

State and local

     (2,208     (7,633     675   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred

     (11,634     (36,694     4,351   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total (benefit) provision for income taxes

   $ (10,242   $ (34,682   $ 8,504   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-102


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

6. Income Taxes (continued)

 

The reconciliation between the effective tax rate and the U.S. statutory rate was as follow:

 

     For the Fiscal Years Ended
June 30
 
     2013     2012     2011  

U.S. federal income tax rate

     35.00     35.00     35.00

Non-deductible goodwill on asset impairment(a)

     —          (17.82     —     

State and local taxes, net of federal benefit

     2.40        2.22        10.04   

Other

     (0.70     (0.06     2.28   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective tax rate

     36.70     19.34     47.32
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(a) See Note 4

The following is a summary of the components of the deferred tax accounts:

 

     As of June 30  
     2013     2012  

Deferred tax assets:

    

Pension and postretirement benefits

   $ 22,069      $ 30,554   

Amortization of goodwill and intangibles

     16,365        3,483   

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

     11,295        11,098   

Other

     1,616        3,205   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

     51,345        48,340   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

    

Property and equipment

     (11,638     (12,432
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

     (11,638     (12,432
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax asset

     39,707        35,908   

Less: valuation allowance

     (451     (451
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax asset

   $ 39,256      $ 35,457   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

LMG had net current deferred tax assets of $848 and $949 as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively, and noncurrent deferred tax assets of $38,408 and $34,508 as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively. LMG had no current and non-current deferred tax liabilities as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

We have recorded a deferred tax asset of $1,404 and $2,982 associated with our net operating loss carryforwards as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively. In accordance with the Company’s accounting policy, valuation allowances of $451 and $451 have been established to reduce the deferred tax asset associated with our net operating losses to an amount that will more likely than not be realized as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

As of June 30, 2013, LMG had $15,824 net operating loss or capital loss carryforwards available to offset future taxable income.

 

F-103


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

6. Income Taxes (continued)

 

The following table sets forth the change in the accrual for uncertain tax positions, excluding interest and penalties:

 

     For the Fiscal Years Ended June 30  
     2013     2012     2011  

Balance, beginning of year

   $ 12,606      $ 12,107      $ 12,347   

Adjustment for current year tax positions

     1,560        2,438        1,939   

Reductions for prior year tax position

     (1,617     (1,939     (2,179
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

   $ 12,549      $ 12,606      $ 12,107   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

LMG recognizes interest and penalty charges related to unrecognized tax benefits as income tax expense, which is consistent with the recognition in prior reporting periods. LMG recognized interest charges of $911, $895 and $855 during the fiscal year ended June 30, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. LMG recorded liabilities for accrued interest of approximately $5,614 and $4,703 as of June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

LMG is subject to tax in various domestic jurisdictions and, as a matter of ordinary course, LMG is regularly audited by federal and state tax authorities. LMG believes it has appropriately accrued for the expected outcome of all other pending tax matters and does not currently anticipate that the ultimate resolution of other pending tax matters will have a material adverse effect on its combined financial condition, future results of operations or liquidity. LMG’s income tax returns for 2006 and later are subject to examination in various jurisdictions. As of June 30, 2013 and 2012, approximately $11,171 would affect LMG’s effective income tax rate, if and when recognized in future fiscal years. The Company believes that it is reasonably possible that a decrease of up to $11,728 in unrecognized tax benefits related to state exposures may occur within the next twelve months.

LMG paid $70, $163 and $143 for income taxes during the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively.

7. Accumulated Other Comprehensive (Loss) Income

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income is related to the actuarial gains and losses related to the pension and postretirement benefit plans. The balance of $43,003 and $54,581 at June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively, is net of tax of $29,491 and $37,326 at June 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 

F-104


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

 

8. Commitments and Contingent Liabilities

Operating Leases

Operating lease commitments are primarily for office space and equipment. Certain office space leases provide for rent adjustments relating to changes in real estate taxes and other operating costs. Rental expense amounted to $437 in 2013, $467 in 2012, and $397 in 2011. The minimum rental commitments under non-cancelable leases, net of subleases, as of June 30, 2013 were as follows:

 

2014

   $ 274   

2015

     69   

2016

     28   

2017

     5   

Thereafter

     —     
  

 

 

 

Total minimum lease payments

   $ 376   
  

 

 

 

9. Related Parties

Parent and News Corporation provide various cash management, human resources, financial, tax, legal, insurance, and other services to LMG. These services include processing certain cash activity; cash is generally maintained by News Corporation. Costs of these services are allocated to LMG based upon established criteria, primarily determined by the associated cash outflows of the business or the specific amount of services provided. The total costs allocated to LMG for these services were $2,254, $2,200, and $1,496 for the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively. In addition, News Corporation billed LMG for insurance related to certain specified events of $2,769, $4,468, and $2,723 for the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively. Management believes that the allocations are reasonable. Settlement of amounts owed to and by the Parent are generally cleared through equity.

LMG purchases content for its newspapers from Parent and in certain geographic area purchases and/or delivers Parent’s and News Corporation’s newspapers for agreed-upon fees. Under these agreements, total purchases were $2,880, $2,933, and $2,891 and fees received were $271, $299, and $303 for the fiscal years ended June 30, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively.

LMG’s arrangements with Parent and News Corporation have been entered into in the context of a parent-subsidiary relationship; therefore, these arrangements are not the result of arm’s-length negotiations between independent parties. There can be no assurance that any of such arrangements has been effected on terms more or less as favorable to LMG as could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties.

10. Subsequent Events

In accordance with ASC 855, Subsequent Events, the Company evaluated subsequent events through September 10, 2013, the date these combined financial statements were available to be issued.

On September 3, 2013, Parent sold the Company to a subsidiary of Fortress Investment Group LLC. As a result, the Company’s operations are now managed by GateHouse Media, Inc.

 

F-105


Table of Contents

Dow Jones Local Media Group, Inc.

Notes to Combined Financial Statements (continued)

(In Thousands)

10. Subsequent Events (continued)

 

On September 3, 2013, the Company along with other specified related parties entered into a credit agreement (the “Credit Agreement”). The Credit Agreement consists of a $33.0 million senior secured term loan, which was funded on September 3, 2013, and a senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility of up to $10 million, but which will not be funded until certain conditions precedent have been met under the Credit Agreement. The Credit Agreement expires on September 4, 2018 or earlier in the case of an Event of Default as defined per the Credit Agreement.

 

F-106


Table of Contents

Independent Auditors’ Report

The Board of Directors

The Providence Journal Company:

Report on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying consolidated financial statements of The Providence Journal Company, which comprise the consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the related consolidated statements of operations, equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2013.

Management’s Responsibility for the Financial Statements

Management is responsible for the preparation and fair presentation of these consolidated financial statements in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles; this includes the design, implementation, and maintenance of internal control relevant to the preparation and fair presentation of consolidated financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error.

Auditors’ Responsibility

Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free from material misstatement.

An audit involves performing procedures to obtain audit evidence about the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. The procedures selected depend on the auditors’ judgment, including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to fraud or error. In making those risk assessments, the auditor considers internal control relevant to the entity’s preparation and fair presentation of the consolidated financial statements in order to design audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the entity’s internal control. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes evaluating the appropriateness of accounting policies used and the reasonableness of significant accounting estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements.

We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our audit opinion.

Opinion

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of The Providence Journal Company as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the years then ended, in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

/s/ KPMG LLP

Dallas, Texas

August 21, 2014

 

F-107


Table of Contents

Independent Auditors’ Review Report

The Board of Directors

The Providence Journal Company:

Report on the Financial Statements

We have reviewed the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of The Provide Journal Company as of June 30, 2014, the related consolidated statements of operations and cash flows for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, and the related consolidated statement of equity for the six-month period ended June 30, 2014.

Management’s Responsibility

The Company’s management is responsible for the preparation and fair presentation of the interim financial information in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles; this responsibility includes the design, implementation, and maintenance of internal control sufficient to provide a reasonable basis for the preparation and fair presentation of interim financial information in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

Auditors’ Responsibility

Our responsibility is to conduct our reviews in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America applicable to reviews of interim financial information. A review of interim financial information consists principally of applying analytical procedures and making inquiries of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters. It is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America, the objective of which is the expression of an opinion regarding the financial information. Accordingly, we do not express such an opinion.

Conclusion

Based on our reviews, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to the accompanying interim financial information for it to be in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

/s/ KPMG LLP

Dallas, Texas

August 21, 2014

 

F-108


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands)

 

     June 30,      December 31  
     2014      2013      2012  
     (unaudited)                
Assets         

Current assets:

        

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 213        237        295  

Accounts receivable, net

     7,423        8,904        8,651  

Deferred tax assets, net

     466        477        —     

Inventories

     2,657        2,613        1,867  

Prepaids and other current assets

     2,054        1,826        1,279  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current assets

     12,813        14,057        12,092  

Property, plant and equipment, net

     30,539        31,313        32,696  

Intangible assets, net

     2,915        5,101        9,473  

Other assets

     36        389        1,046  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 46,303        50,860        55,307  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Liabilities and Equity         

Current liabilities:

        

Accounts payable

   $ 1,914        1,771        1,923  

Accrued expenses

     3,169        3,334        3,379  

Deferred tax liabilities, net

     —           —           47  

Deferred revenue

     4,337        4,342        4,011  

Other current liabilities

     68        31        34  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     9,488        9,478        9,394  

Deferred tax liabilities, net

     5,181        6,090        7,948  

Other long-term liabilities

     30        32        17  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     14,699        15,600        17,359  

Total equity

     31,604        35,260        37,948  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

   $ 46,303        50,860        55,307  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-109


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Operations

(in thousands)

 

     Six months ended June 30     Years ended December 31  
     2014     2013     2013      2012     2011  
     (unaudited)     (unaudited)                     

Net operating revenue:

           

Advertising

   $ 18,975       19,890       41,015        45,995       52,886  

Circulation

     16,844       16,437       34,042        34,562       33,797  

Other revenue

     7,693       6,379       15,012        13,209       8,382  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net operating revenue

     43,512       42,706       90,069        93,766       95,065  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating costs and expense:

           

Salaries, wages and employee benefits

     15,740       17,521       37,619        43,814       46,649  

Other production, distribution and operating costs

     14,373       15,020       26,441        24,377       25,065  

Newsprint, ink and other supplies

     7,822       7,215       15,964        15,328       12,523  

Depreciation

     1,413       2,035       3,500        5,243       5,152  

Amortization

     2,186       2,186       4,372        4,372       4,372  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating costs and expenses

     41,534       43,977       87,896        93,134       93,761  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (expense), net

     (55 )     1       256        (15 )     4  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

     1,923       (1,270 )     2,429        617       1,308  

Income tax provision (benefit)

     827       (488 )     1,269        479       526  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 1,096       (782 )     1,160        138       782  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-110


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Equity

(in thousands)

 

     Total  
           equity        

Balance at December 31, 2010

   $ 46,378  

Net income

     782  

Net distribution to Parent

     (3,748 )
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2011

     43,412  

Net income

     138  

Net distribution to Parent

     (5,602 )
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2012

     37,948  

Net income

     1,160  

Net distribution to Parent

     (3,848 )
  

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2013

     35,260  

Net income

     1,096  

Net distribution to Parent

     (4,752 )
  

 

 

 

Balance at June 30, 2014 (unaudited)

   $ 31,604  
  

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-111


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(in thousands)

 

    Six months ended June 30     Years ended December 31  
    2014     2013     2013     2012     2011  
    (unaudited)     (unaudited)                    

Operating activities:

         

Net income (loss)

  $ 1,096       (782 )     1,160       138       782  

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash and cash equivalents provided by operating activities:

         

Depreciation and amortization

    3,599       4,221       7,872       9,615       9,524  

Bad debt expense

    128       171       315       188       181  

(Gain) loss on disposal of fixed assets

    —          (1 )     (254 )     15       (4 )

Deferred income taxes

    (900 )     (1,307 )     (2,381 )     (1,450 )     (2,317 )

Changes in working capital and other operating assets and liabilities, net:

         

Accounts receivable

    1,353       1,006       (569 )     147       (135 )

Inventories

    (44 )     (165 )     (746 )     (208 )     (252 )

Prepaid expenses and other assets

    127       (31 )     109       (1,898 )     (130 )

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

    (22 )     (335 )     (197 )     119       (3,299 )

Deferred revenue

    (5 )     (238 )     331       1,446       (114 )

Other liabilities

    35       42       13       (8 )     17  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash and cash equivalents provided by operating activities

    5,367       2,581       5,653       8,104       4,253  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities:

         

Capital expenditures

    (639 )     (1,360 )     (1,863 )     (2,417 )     (676 )
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash and cash equivalents used for investing activities

    (639 )     (1,360 )     (1,863 )     (2,417 )     (676 )
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities:

         

Net distribution to Parent

    (4,752 )     (1,176 )     (3,848 )     (5,602 )     (3,748 )
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash and cash equivalents used for financing activities

    (4,752 )     (1,176 )     (3,848 )     (5,602 )     (3,748 )
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net change in cash and cash equivalents

    (24 )     45       (58 )     85       (171 )

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year

    237       295       295       210       381  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

  $ 213       340       237       295       210  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-112


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

(1) Organization

 

  (a) Description of Business

The Providence Journal Company (the Company) headquartered in Providence, Rhode Island, is a wholly owned subsidiary of A.H. Belo Corporation (the Parent). The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Providence Holdings, Inc., its wholly owned subsidiary. The Company produces the oldest continuously published daily newspaper in the United States and has won four Pulitzer Prizes. The Company also operates print and online community media franchises, internet sites, digital services, magazines, and advertising niche publications.

 

  (b) Basis of Presentation

These consolidated financial statements were prepared on a stand-alone basis derived from the financial statements and accounting records of the Company and Parent, and reflect the consolidated historical financial position, results of operations and cash flows of the Company’s business in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP).

All intercompany transactions and accounts within the Company have been eliminated in consolidation. Certain operating functions are primarily or fully managed by the Parent, including cash, treasury, IT services, taxation, annual audit, and employee benefits including share-based compensation, insurance coverage, and the pension plan. The Company’s share of expenses related to these functions and the other overhead expenses incurred by the Parent were charged to the Company where identifiable, or allocated on a rational basis such as employee headcount.

The balance sheet accruals for certain such items, including employee medical insurance, share-based compensation, workers compensation, auto and general liability insurance, income taxes, and unfunded pension liability are specifically recorded by the Parent. The Company’s portion of such accruals are effectively recorded by the Company via expenses charged through the intercompany account except for the other comprehensive income component of the pension liability. Additionally, the Company’s primary cash accounts are swept to the Parent on a daily basis and accounts payable and payroll disbursements are funded by the Parent. The cash flows swept to the Parent are used to first satisfy intercompany liabilities with excess cash transfers being recorded as a distribution to the Parent. Intercompany operating charges are reflected in the consolidated statements of cash flows as cash used in operating activities.

 

  (c) Unaudited Interim Financial Data

The accompanying unaudited consolidated interim financial statements as of June 30, 2014 and for the six-months period ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 have been prepared in accordance with GAAP for interim financial information and in accordance with the Securities and Exchange Commission’s (SEC) instructions to Form 10-Q and Article 10 of Regulation S-X. Accordingly, they do not include all of the information and notes required by GAAP for complete financial statements. The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates. In the opinion of management, all adjustments considered necessary for a fair presentation were included. Operating results for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, may not be necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.

 

   F-113    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

 

All dollar amounts are presented in thousands, except for the shares amount, unless the context requires otherwise.

 

(2) Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

 

  (a) Cash and Cash Equivalents

The Company considers all highly liquid instruments purchased with a remaining maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents.

 

  (b) Accounts Receivable

Accounts receivable are net of a valuation reserve that represents an estimate of amounts considered uncollectible. The Company estimates the allowance for doubtful accounts based on historical write-off experience and the Company’s knowledge of the customers’ ability to pay amounts due. The Company’s policy is to write-off accounts after all collection efforts fail; generally, amounts past due by more than four months are written-off. Expense for such uncollectible amounts is included in other production, distribution, and operating costs. Bad debt expense for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 was $315, $188, and $181, respectively, and $128 and $171 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Write-offs, net of recoveries for 2013, 2012, and 2011 were $331, $269, and $273, respectively, and $140 and $150 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 

  (c) Risk Concentration

A significant portion of the Company’s customer base is concentrated within the local geographical area of the newspaper. The Company generally extends credit to customers, and the ultimate collection of accounts receivable could be affected by the national and local economy. Management continually performs credit evaluations of its customers and may require cash in advance or other special arrangements from certain customers. The Company maintains an allowance for losses based upon the collectibility of accounts receivable. Management does not believe significant credit risk exists that could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial condition, liquidity, or results of operations.

 

  (d) Inventories

Inventories consist primarily of newsprint, ink, and other supplies used in printing newspapers. Newsprint is recorded at actual cost of each roll as specifically identified and all other inventories are recorded at cost determined using the first-in, first-out (FIFO) method. The Company reviews its inventories for obsolescence and records an expense for any items that no longer have future value.

 

   F-114    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

  (e) Property, Plant, and Equipment

The Company records property, plant, and equipment at cost or its fair value if acquired through a business acquisition or nonmonetary exchange. Depreciable assets are reviewed to ensure the remaining useful life of the assets continue to be appropriate and the Company records any resulting adjustments to depreciation expense on a prospective basis. Depreciation of property, plant, and equipment is recorded on a straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives of the assets as follows:

 

     Estimated
     useful lives

Buildings and improvements

   5–30 years

Newspaper publishing equipment

   2–20 years

Other

   2–10 years

 

  (f) Long-Lived Assets

The Company evaluates its ability to recover the carrying value of property, plant, and equipment and finite-lived intangible assets, using the lowest level of cash flows associated with the assets, which are grouped based on the Company’s intended use of these assets. This evaluation is performed whenever a change in circumstances indicates that the carrying value of the asset groups may not be recoverable from future undiscounted cash flows. If the analysis of future cash flows indicates the carrying value of the long-lived assets cannot be recovered, the assets are adjusted to the lower of its carrying value or fair value.

 

  (g) Self-Insured Risks

The Parent self-insures certain risks for employee medical costs, workers’ compensation, general liability, commercial automotive claims, and records a liability for such risks. The Company is charged by the Parent through the intercompany account for its share of these costs. The Parent purchases stop-loss insurance and/or high deductible policies with third-party insurance carriers to limit these risks, and third-party administrators are used to process claims. At the end of each fiscal year, the Parent estimates, utilizing third-party experts, the undiscounted liability associated with its uninsured risks based on historical claim patterns, employee demographic data, assets insured, and the insurance policy. Allocation of expenses to the Company from the Parent are primarily determined based on claims and cost incurred related to the Company’s employees or operations. The estimates associated with these uninsured liabilities are monitored by the Parent’s management for adequacy based on information currently available. However, actual amounts could vary significantly from such estimates if actual trends, including the severity or frequency of claims and/or medical cost inflation, were to change. The expenses related to employee medical costs, workers’ compensation, general liability, and commercial automotive claims for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 were $308, $151, and $383, respectively, and $166 and $194 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 

  (h) Equity

Total equity includes the Parent’s investment in the Company net of distributions paid to the Parent. The Company has 1,000 shares of common stock authorized, issued, and outstanding as of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and 2012 and all such shares are owned by the Parent.

 

   F-115    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

  (i) Contingencies

The Company is involved in certain claims and litigation related to its operations and is required to assess the likelihood of any adverse judgments or outcomes to these matters as well as potential ranges of probable losses. A determination of the amount of reserves required, if any, for these contingencies is made after careful analysis of each individual matter. Such amounts may change in future periods due to new developments in each matter or changes in approach, such as a change in settlement strategy in dealing with these matters.

The Company’s facilities are subject to environmental laws and regulations imposed by federal, state and local authorities. The Company believes that its policies and procedures with regard to environmental matters are adequate to prevent significant risk of environmental damage and related financial liability. While the Company’s policy is to accrue for losses associated with environmental remediation obligations when such losses are probable and reasonably estimable, the Company is not aware of any environmental matters that could have a significant effect on the Company’s operations.

 

  (j) Revenue Recognition

The Company’s principal sources of revenue are the advertising space in published issues of its newspapers and on the Company’s Web sites, the sale of newspapers to distributors and individual subscribers, as well as amounts charged to customers for commercial printing, and distribution. Advertising revenue is recorded at the time the advertisements are published in the newspaper and ratably over the period of time the advertisement is placed on the Web sites. Proceeds from subscriptions are deferred and included in revenue ratably over the term of the subscriptions. Subscription revenue under buy-sell arrangements with distributors is recorded based on the net amount received from the distributor, whereas subscription revenue under fee-based delivery arrangements with distributors is recorded based on the amount received from the subscriber. Commercial printing and distribution revenue is recorded when the product is distributed or shipped.

 

  (k) Stock-Based Compensation

The Company’s employees participate in the Parent’s long-term incentive plan. Stock-based compensation represents the cost related to stock-based awards granted to Company employees and is recognized on a straight-line basis over the vesting period. The Parent grants Company employees Restricted Stock Units (RSUs). RSUs entitle the holder to shares of the Parent’s common stock as the award vests, typically over a period of up to three years. The fair value of the awards is determined and fixed on the grant date based on the Parent’s common stock price. Expense charged to the Company is calculated for each individual award granted to Company employees. Stock-based compensation expense for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 was $490, $445, and $211, respectively, and $416 and $355 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 

  (l) Income Taxes

The Company uses the asset and liability method of accounting for income taxes and recognizes deferred tax assets and liabilities based on the difference between the financial statement and tax basis of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates. The Company establishes a valuation allowance if it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The factors used to assess the likelihood of realization of the deferred tax asset include reversal of future deferred tax liabilities,

 

   F-116    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

available tax planning strategies and future taxable income. The Company participates in the consolidated return of the Parent. Income taxes are reflected in these consolidated financial statements as if the Company filed tax returns on a stand-alone basis. All tax activities are recorded through the intercompany account with the Parent.

The Company also evaluates any uncertain tax positions and recognizes a liability for the tax benefit associated with an uncertain tax position if it is more likely than not that the tax position will not be sustained on examination by the taxing authorities, based on the technical merits of the position. The tax benefits recognized in the financial statements from such positions are measured based on the largest benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement. The Company records a liability for uncertain tax positions taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. Any change in judgment related to the expected ultimate resolution of uncertain tax positions is recognized in earnings in the period in which such change occurs. Interest and penalties, if any, related to unrecognized tax benefits are recorded in interest expense.

 

  (m) Use of Estimates

The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes and include valuation allowances for doubtful accounts, self-insured liabilities, uncertain tax positions and deferred tax assets, and assumptions related to impairment and recovery of long-lived assets. Estimates are based on past experience and other considerations reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results may differ from these estimates. In the opinion of management, all adjustments considered necessary for a fair presentation are included.

 

  (n) Fair Value Measurements

The Company’s financial instruments, including cash, cash equivalents, accounts receivable, interest receivable, accounts payable, and amounts due to customers are carried at cost, which approximates its fair value because of the short-term nature of these instruments.

 

  (o) New Accounting Standards

In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606). This guidance generally clarifies the principles for recognizing revenue and develops a common revenue standard for GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards. The standard outlines a single comprehensive model for entities to use in accounting for revenue arising from contracts with customers and supersedes the most current revenue recognition guidance. The core principle of the guidance is that an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. The update is effective for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2016, and interim periods in those years. The Company is evaluating the impact of adoption and has not yet selected a transition method, but does not anticipate this update to have a material impact on its recognition and presentation of revenue within the consolidated statements of operations.

 

   F-117    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

(3) Intangible Assets, Net

Intangible assets, net consist of the following:

 

    June 30,     December 31  
    2014     2013     2012  
    (unaudited)              

Gross asset value:

     

Subscriber list

  $ 78,698        78,698        78,698   

Less accumulated amortization

    (75,783     (73,597     (69,225
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total intangible assets, net

  $ 2,915        5,101        9,473   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amortization expense for each of the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 was $4,372 and was $2,186 for each of the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Subscriber lists are amortized over 18 years, and have a remaining life of one year, five months as of December 31, 2013. As of December 31, 2013, future intangible assets amortization by year and in the aggregate consisted of the following:

 

Year:

  

2014

   $ 4,372  

2015

     729  
  

 

 

 

Total future intangible assets amortization expense

   $ 5,101  
  

 

 

 

No impairments were recognized for intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013.

 

(4) Property, Plant, and Equipment, Net

Property, plant, and equipment, net consist of the following:

 

     June 30,     December 31  
     2014     2013     2012  
     (unaudited)              

Land

   $ 13,560       13,560       13,685  

Buildings

     33,604       33,412       32,516  

Newspaper publishing equipment

     35,704       35,638       35,389  

Other property, plant, and equipment

     4,646       4,614       4,615  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     87,514       87,224       86,205  

Accumulated depreciation and amortization

     (56,975 )     (55,911 )     (53,509 )
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 30,539       31,313       32,696  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Depreciation expense for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 was $3,500, $5,243, and $5,152, respectively, and $1,413 and $2,035 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 

   F-118    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

As indicated in note 10 – Subsequent Events, the Company entered into an asset purchase agreement to sell substantially all of the operations of the Company, excluding certain assets and liabilities. Certain land and building assets will be retained by the Parent as part of the agreement.

 

(5) Pension And Post Retirement Benefits

 

  (a) Defined-Benefit Plans

On January 1, 2011, the Parent established and sponsored the A. H. Belo Pension Plan II (the Plan), which provides benefits to certain current and former employees of the Company. The Parent maintains the liability for the unfunded balance of the Plan and allocates the related net periodic pension (benefit) expense to the Company. For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, and for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 net periodic pension (benefit) expense attributable to the employees of the Company and allocated to the Company was $(1,461), $(1,000), $153, $(955), and $(730), respectively. The unfunded balance of the Plan, which is evaluated on an annual basis and recorded by the Parent was $15,343 and $44,038 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. No contributions were required by the Parent to the Plan for fiscal year 2013, although the Parent made a voluntary contribution of $1,651. The Parent made required and voluntary contributions to the Plan in fiscal year 2012 of $8,465 and $3,448, respectively, and $6,324 and $15,510, respectively, in fiscal year 2011. No contributions were required or made to the plan during the six months ended June 30, 2014.

As indicated in note 10, Subsequent Events, on July 22, 2014, the Company entered into an asset purchase agreement to sell substantially all the operations of the Company, excluding certain assets and liabilities. The Plan is an excluded liability and will be retained by the Parent. Accordingly, the Company will not receive an allocation of net periodic pension (benefit) expense subsequent to the sale and the Parent will be solely responsible for the pension liability.

 

  (b) Other Postemployment Benefits

Included in allocated expenses from the Parent are approximately $31, $39, and $39, of other postretirement benefits expense attributable to the Company for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively, and $12 and $16 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, which has been reflected within salaries, wages, and employee benefits expenses in the consolidated statements of operations.

 

  (c) Defined-Contribution Plans

The A. H. Belo Savings Plan, a defined contribution 401(k) plan, sponsored by the Parent, covers substantially all employees of the Company. Participants may elect to contribute a portion of their pretax compensation, as provided by the plan and the Internal Revenue Code. Employees can contribute up to 100% of their annual eligible compensation (less required withholdings and deductions) up to statutory limits. The Parent provides an ongoing dollar-for-dollar match of eligible employee contributions, up to 1.5% of the employees’ compensation on a per-pay-period basis. The Company recorded expense of $348, $364, and $207 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively, and $171 and $181 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, for matching contributions to these plans.

 

   F-119    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

The Parent sponsored the A. H. Belo Pension Transition Supplement Plan (PTS Plan), a defined contribution plan, which covered certain employees affected by the curtailment of a defined benefit plan sponsored by the former parent company. The Parent was obligated to make contributions to this plan based on the earnings of actively employed participants for a period of five years, which concluded on March 31, 2013. The Company recorded expense for the PTS Plan of $486, $1,900, and $2,192 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively, and $0 and $486 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Contributions, generally paid in the first quarter following each plan year, were $2,380, $2,192, and $2,492 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively, and $0 and $2,380 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. As a result of fulfilling its obligations to the PTS Plan and in order to achieve efficient administration of the Parent’s defined contribution plans, the PTS Plan was merged into the A. H. Belo Savings Plan on July 1, 2013. Accordingly, individual participant account balances within the PTS Plan were transferred to their respective accounts of the A. H. Belo Savings Plan and the PTS Plan has ceased to exist as a stand-alone benefit plan of the Parent.

 

(6) Income Taxes

The table below sets forth income tax provision (benefit) related to the Company’s operations.

 

     June 30     December 31  
     2014     2013         2013             2012             2011      
     (unaudited)     (unaudited)                    

Current:

          

Federal

   $ 1,347       639       2,862       1,637       2,297  

State

     379       180       789       292       547  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current

     1,726       819       3,651       1,929       2,844  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred:

          

Federal

     (707 )     (1,019 )     (1,874 )     (1,102 )     (1,811 )

State

     (192 )     (288 )     (508 )     (348 )     (507 )
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred

     (899 )     (1,307 )     (2,382 )     (1,450 )     (2,318 )
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income tax provision (benefit)

   $ 827       (488 )     1,269       479       526  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The table below sets forth income tax provision computed by applying the applicable United States federal income tax rate and is reconciled to the tax provision computed at the effective income tax rate.

 

    June 30     December 31  
    2014     2013         2013             2012             2011      
    (unaudited)     (unaudited)                    

Computed expected income tax provision (benefit)

  $ 673       (445 )     850       216       457  

State income tax (net of federal taxes)

    121       (70 )     183       (37 )     26  

Other

    33       27       236       299       42  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax provision (benefit)

  $ 827       (488 )     1,269       478       525  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

   F-120    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

The table below sets forth the significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities.

 

     June 30,      December 31  
     2014          2013              2012      
     (unaudited)                

Deferred tax assets

        

Accrued expenses

   $ 966        1,035        803  

Other

     260        265        598  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

     1,226        1,300        1,401  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities

        

Depreciation and amortization

     5,297        6,138        8,222  

Prepaid expenses

     455        454        838  

Other

     188        322        336  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

     5,940        6,914        9,396  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities, net

   $ 4,714        5,614        7,995  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred taxes are classified as current and long-term deferred assets or liabilities based on the classification of the related assets or liabilities in the Parent’s consolidated balance sheets as of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and 2012. The Parent places a threshold for recognition of deferred tax assets based on whether it is more likely than not that these assets will be realized. In making this determination, all positive and negative evidence is considered, including future reversals of existing taxable temporary differences, tax planning strategies, future taxable income, and taxable income in prior carryback years.

During 2013, the Parent effectively completed the U.S. federal audit for tax years 2008 and 2009 and the Parent is not currently under examination by federal or state jurisdictions for income tax purposes.

The Parent follows accounting guidance under ASC 740-10Income Taxes – Overall, related to uncertainty in income tax positions, which clarifies the accounting and disclosure requirements for uncertainty in tax positions. The Parent assessed its filing positions in all significant jurisdictions where it is required to file income tax returns for all open tax years. The Company’s portion of the Parent’s reserve for uncertain tax positions was insignificant for all periods presented.

 

(7) Commitments

As of December 31, 2013, the Company had contractual obligations for leases and capital expenditures that primarily related to newspaper production equipment. The table below sets forth the summarized commitments of the Company as of December 31, 2013.

 

         Operating      
     lease  

Years ending December 31:

  

2014

   $ 143  

2015

     42  
  

 

 

 
   $ 185  
  

 

 

 

 

   F-121    (Continued)


Table of Contents

THE PROVIDENCE JOURNAL COMPANY

AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Financial Statements

Years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 and

six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

 

Total lease expense for rental of property and equipment was $509, $645, and $674 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively, and $259 and $255 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 

(8) Contingencies

In June 2013, the Company executed an agreement allowing it to effectively assume the distribution of various national and regional newspapers and magazines previously managed by a third-party distributor. The agreement also settled claims and disputes between the Company and the third-party distributor (the Settlement). Under the agreement, the Company is required to pay the third-party distributor approximately $1,330 over a two-year period for the acquisition of business and settlement of claims. The Company anticipates profits from the distribution contracts to exceed the amounts paid under the agreement. The Company allocated approximately one-half of the cost of the agreement as a loss on the settlement of claims and, accordingly, a loss of $665 was recognized in the second quarter of 2013. The remaining amounts to be paid will be treated as contract acquisition costs and are being expensed as incurred over three years starting in July 2013, consistent with the contract terms between the Company and the newspaper and magazine publishers.

In addition to the matter above, a number of legal proceedings are pending against the Company. In the opinion of management, liabilities, if any, arising from these legal proceedings would not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations, liquidity, or financial condition.

 

(9) Related-Party Transactions

In addition to self-insurance, pension expense, defined-contribution plan expense, stock-based compensation and income taxes, the Company has been allocated expenses from the Parent of $6,939, $7,776, and $9,017 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively, and $3,430 and $3,470 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. These allocated costs are primarily related to corporate administrative expenses, rental and usage fees for shared assets for the following functional groups: information technology, legal services, accounting and finance services, human resources, marketing and contract support, customer support, treasury, facility, and other corporate and infrastructural services. The costs associated with these services and support functions have been allocated to the Company using allocation methodologies based primarily on proportional revenue and headcount.

 

(10) Subsequent Events

In accordance with ASC 855, Subsequent Events, the Company evaluated subsequent events through August 21, 2014, the date these consolidated financial statements were available to be issued.

On July 22, 2014, the Parent entered into an Asset Purchase Agreement for the sale of substantially all assets comprising the newspaper operations of The Providence Journal and related real property, and the assumption of certain liabilities of the Company to LMG Rhode Island Holdings, Inc., a subsidiary of New Media Investment Group Inc., for $46 million in cash. The final purchase price is subject to adjustment either upward or downward based upon the net current assets being sold at the closing of the sale. Certain assets will be retained by the Parent, which include all cash, the 75 Fountain Street headquarters building, downtown parking lots, and the former Rhode Island Monthly/Sunday inserting building. The Parent will also retain the obligation for the Plan as well as certain personnel-related and tax-related liabilities.

 

F-122


Table of Contents

 

 

6,500,000 Shares

 

LOGO

New Media Investment Group Inc.

COMMON STOCK

 

 

PROSPECTUS

 

 

Citigroup

Credit Suisse

 

 

 

 

 


Dates Referenced Herein   and   Documents Incorporated by Reference

This ‘424B4’ Filing    Date    Other Filings
11/26/23
6/4/20
11/26/19
6/4/19
11/26/18
9/4/18
1/1/17
12/15/16
1/1/16
12/31/15
9/30/15
1/1/15
12/31/14
12/28/14
12/15/14
9/23/144
Filed on:9/19/14
9/17/14S-1/A
9/3/148-K
8/28/14
8/21/14
8/12/14
7/31/1410-Q,  8-K
7/22/148-K
7/17/14
6/30/14
6/29/1410-Q
6/9/143/A,  4
6/4/148-K
3/30/1410-Q
3/19/1410-K,  3/A,  4/A,  8-K
3/14/144
2/28/14
2/25/14
2/20/14
2/14/14
2/13/14
2/6/144,  4/A
2/4/143/A,  4
2/3/143/A,  8-K
1/30/143,  3/A
1/29/14
1/14/14
1/1/14
12/31/13
12/30/13
12/29/1310-K
12/15/13
11/26/13
11/7/13
11/6/13
10/25/13
10/17/13
9/29/13
9/27/1310-12B
9/20/13
9/10/13
9/4/13
9/3/13
9/2/13
8/27/13
7/1/13
6/30/13
6/28/13
6/18/13
3/31/13
3/26/13
3/18/13
2/19/13
2/4/13
12/31/12
12/30/12
12/26/12
7/1/12
6/30/12
6/8/12
4/1/12
3/15/12
3/6/12
1/2/12
1/1/12
12/31/11
7/3/11
6/30/11
6/26/11
4/1/11
3/30/11
1/1/11
12/31/10
6/30/10
12/31/09
6/1/09
2/3/09
2/2/09
1/9/09
1/1/09
12/31/08
12/23/08
12/19/08
8/19/08
8/18/08
2/6/08
1/1/08
12/31/07
9/18/07
5/7/07
4/30/07
4/13/07
4/4/07
2/28/07
2/27/07
1/1/07
12/31/06
10/6/06
10/5/06
5/17/06
2/20/06
1/30/06
6/23/05
 List all Filings
Top
Filing Submission 0001193125-14-347050   –   Alternative Formats (Word / Rich Text, HTML, Plain Text, et al.)

Copyright © 2024 Fran Finnegan & Company LLC – All Rights Reserved.
AboutPrivacyRedactionsHelp — Fri., Mar. 29, 8:55:33.3am ET